nadir PEs Bee Hartt Ne yy eerie :s f . 3 ps : roars i VOLUME II. PROCEEDINGS THE SECOND EXPEDITION, 1831— 1836, CAPTAIN ROBERT FITZ-ROY, R.N. — tT a it TIO A ~~ ., ad, ry f 7. ai ald oat 4 1 POSS OES 2 al, NARRATIVE OF THE SURVEYING VOYAGES OF HIS MAJESTY’S SHIPS ADVENTURE AND BEAGLE, BETWEEN THE YEARS 1826 AND 1836, DESCRIBING THEIR EXAMINATION OF THE SOUTHERN SHORES OF SOUTH AMERICA, AND THE BEAGLE’S CIRCUMNAVIGATION OF THE GLOBE, IN THREE VOLUM LONDON: HENRY COLBURN, GREAT MARLBOROUGH STREET. 1839. LONDON: Printed by J. L. Cox and Sons, 75, Great Queen Street, Lincoln’s-Inn Fields. » TPs all ’ t CONTENTS. VOLUME II. CHAPTER I. PAGE Explanation—Natives of Tierra del Fuego, or Fuegians—Pas- sages across the Equator (Atlantic) —Letters — Small-pox —Hospital—Boat— Memory—Fuegians in London—At Walthamstow — At St. James’s — Beagle re-commis- sioned —Correspondence with Mr. Wilson—Fuegians re- embark CHAPTER II. Hydrographer’s Opinion — Continuation of Survey — Chain of Meridian Distances —Efficient Arrangements— Repair and raise Deck— Outfit — Boats — Lightning-Conductors —Rudder—Stove—W indlass—Chronometers—Mr. Dar- win—Persons on board—Changes—List of those who returned—Supplies—Admiralty Instructions—Memoran- dum—Hydrographer’s Memorandum ...........0.ssseeeeeees 17 CHAPTER III. Ready for sea—Detained—Sail from England—Well pro- vided—Bay of Biscay —Compasses— Local attraction — Eight Stones— Madeira— Deception—Squall— Teneriffe —Santa Cruz—Quarantine—Squalls—Cape Verde Islands —Port Praya—Produce—Orchilla—Bad season—St. Paul Rocks—Cross Equator—Fernando de Noronha—Bahia— Slavery—Abrolhos—Cape Frio Vili CONTENTS. PAGE CHAPTER IV. Loss of the Thetis—Causes of her wreck—Approach to Rio de Janeiro — Owen Glendower — Disturbance in Rio Harbour—Observations—— Chronometers— Return to Ba- hia — Deaths — Macacu — Malaria — Return to Rio de Janeiro — Meridian Distances — Regatta — Fuegians — Lightning — Leave Rio — Equipment — Santa Martha— Weather—Santa Catharina—Santos—River Plata—Pam- peroes—Gales off Buenos Ayres—Monte Video—Point Piedras—Cape San Antonio—River Plata—Currents— Tides—Barometer— Absence of Trees—Cattle............ 67 CHAPTER V. Eastern Pampa Coast — Point Medanos — Mar-chiquito — Ranges of Hills—Direction of Inlets, Shoals, and Rivers —Cape Corrientes—Tosca Coast—Blanco Bay— Mount Hermoso— Port Belgrano—Mr. Harris—Ventana Moun- tain— View— Argentino— Commandant—Major—Situa- tion—Toriano—Indians—Fossils—Animals—Fish— Cli- mate—Pumice—Ashes—Conway—Deliberations—Conse- quent Decision—Responsibility incurred—Paz—Liebre— Gale — Hunger — Fossils at Hermoso — Fossils at Point Alta— Express sent to Buenos Ayres — Suspicions and absprd alarm—RodrigteZ, css espsbanndevecnd-besr omen enndenans 97 CHAPTER VI. Beagle sails with Paz and Liebre — Part company — Beagle visits Buenos Ayres—Nautical remarks on the Plata—Sail from Monte Video for San Blas—Lieut. Wickham and ten- ders — Butterflies — Sail for Tierra del Fuego— White water — Icebergs — Rocks — Cape San Sebastian—Oens men—Cape San Diego—Good Success Bay—Natives— Guanacoes — Cape Horn — St. Martin Cove — Gales — Heavy Seas—Nassau Bay—Goree Road—Prepare to land Matthews and the Fuegians.........ccccccccsceeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 114 DIRECTIONS TO THE BINDER FOR PLACING THE PLATES. VOLUME II. Chart of Tierra del Fuego ae be - Loose. Chart of Childe F ae ae . Loose. Fuegian (Yapoo Tekeenica) 35 3 =e Frontispiece. Panoramic View of Madeira 2 fe in to face page 46 Crossing the Line .. 2° ae oe .. +. 57 San Salvador, Bahia a6 ae 62 Patagonians at Gregory Bay oc ne 136 Fuegians—Yacana, Pecheray, &c. oe + aD se 14] Fuegians going to trade in cages! with the Patagonians 171 Woollya ae ate dé 208 Berkeley Sd“ neebad eet =5 ae ac 248 Bivouac at the Head of Port Desire Inlet — ae 316 Button Island, near Woollya a0 ae Ae se 323 Fuegians—Y ork Minster, &c. ae a oe ae 324 Cove in Beagle Channel, &c. “ = ae 326 Beagle laid ashore in Santa Cruz .. 336 Santa Cruz—Plan of Port and River Le ae Ae 339 Basalt Glen—River Santa Cruz .. si Le Ac 348 Santa Cruz River—distant view of Andes oa ae is 351 Mystery Plain, near the Santa Cruz “5 x we sc 352 Mount Sarmiento, from Warp Bay Be ss ae a6 359 Valdivia ae eS 58 46 te os 398 Remains of the Cathodes at Concepcion Ac Se 405 Albemarle Island, &c. ae : we 498 Otaheite, or Tahiti ee 3 as 509 Otaheite, Eimeo, Matavai, enapals oe 517 New Zealanders A ne 568 Notre.—The loose Plates are to be folded into pockets in the volumes. the covers of pe + 4 b = uae fav ot eeor Fe tay | HATH FAL OT PROTA ee 3 Or 4 Wom) pect ie vane Avery eee fous : s CONTENTS, x] PAGE CHAPTER XVI. -Soundings— Anchor in Santa Cruz—Lay Beagle ashore for repair—Prepare to ascend river—Set out— View of sur- rounding country — Rapid stream — Cold — Ostriches— Guanacoes — Indians — Fish — Cliffs— Firewood— Lava Cliffs — Difficulties — Chalia — See Andes — Farthest West—View round—Return—Danger—Guanaco hunters —Puma—Cat—Tides—Sail from Santa Cruz.............4+ 336 CHAPTER XVII. Beagle and Adventure sail from Port Famine through Mag- dalen and Cockburn Channel — Enter Pacific — Death of Mr. Rowlett—Chil6e—Chile— Government— Adventure sold — Consequent changes — Plans—Mr. Low—Chonos —Lieut. Sulivan’s party— Moraleda—Ladrilleros—De Vea—Sharp—San Andres—Vallenar—Mr. Stokes—San Estevan—Distressed sailors— Anna Pink Bay—Port Low —Potatoes—Indian names— Huafo— Volcano—Chilotes —Aborigines — Militia — Freebooters— Climate— Docks —Tides — Witchcraft — Alerse — Calbucanos — Cesares —Search for men—Meteors ........scsscecvecsceseeecereeees 359 CHAPTER XVIII. Leave Chil6e—Valdivia—Earthquake—Aborigines—Tradi- tions— Words—Convicts—Tolten— Boroa—Imperial— Mocha—Shocks of Earthquake— Anchor off Talcahuano —Ruins—Account of a great Earthquake, which destroyed the city of Concepcion; and was felt from Childe to Copi- apd; from Juan Fernandes to Mendoza .............e.e000+ 396 CHAPTER XIX, *Mocha—Movement of Land—Penco— Ulloa—Shells—Coal —Maule—Topocalma—Aconcagua—Valparaiso—Horcon —Papudo — Pichidanque — Conchali — Herradura—Co- xi CONTENTS. PAGE quimbo —Wreck—Challenger—Blonde—Ride—Estate— Colcura—Villagran—Arauco—Former caciques—Coloco- lo—Caupolican— Scenery — Quiapo—Night travelling— Leiibu—Tucapel—Valdivia—Lautaro—Challenger......... 419 CHAPTER XX. Challenger sails—Sounds off Mocha—Wrecked on the main- land—Crew saved—Stores landed—Camp formed—Great exertions, and excellent conduct—Mr. Consul Rouse— Leiibu—Plague of mice—Curious rats—Return to Blonde —Ul]pu—Araucanian dress—Arauco— Boroanos’—Tubul —Bar rivers—Apples—Ferry—Blonde sails—Seek for the Leiibu— Schooner Carmen—Errors and delay—Embark Challenger’s crew—Rescue the Carmen—Talcahuano— New Concepcion— Valparaiso— Coquimbo— Challenger’s sail in Conway —— Reflections pc... sa-~sntrammebinees ostapeke 451 CHAPTER XXI. Andes— Aconcagua— Villarica— Islay —Powder—Callao— Rejoin Beagle—Constitucion—Plans— W ilson—Carrasco —‘Galapagos’—Iguanas—Lava Rocks—Land-tortoises— Craters— Turtle—Shells— Dye—Volcanoes—Settlement —Albemarle Island—Cyclopian Scene—Tagus Cove— Tide Ripples—Settlers—Climate—Salt—Dampier—Birds —Transportation of Tortoises—Currents—Temperature OF Water, cee 5-.000n0inaht «0 AMHamond, my e PANORAMIC VIEW OF WADEIRA. Published. by Henry Colburn.Great Maniborough Street. 1838 1832. DECEPTION——SQUALL—TENERIFFE. 4T the vessel’s distance from the shore, and not taking time to sound accurately. Closing the land quickly after passing some time at sea— approaching high cliffs, or hilly shores, after being, for a time, accustomed to low coasts—or nearing a flat shore, after the eye has been used to precipices and mountains—almost always is a cause of error in estimating distance, however experienced a seaman may be. While passing at a few leagues from the land, a ‘cohen squall came from the west, Tes was near doing damage: after one puff there was a short calm, with heavy rain, and then a sudden blast struck the ship so violently that we were obliged to take in all sail and run before it during the few minutes it lasted. This squall was one of very many which haye reminded me of the old doggrel lines— When rain comes before the wind, Halyards, sheets, and braces mind : But if wind comes before rain, Set and trim your sails again. At daylight the next morning we saw the Salvages, and at sun- set thought we could distinguish the Peak of Teneriffe. Karly on the 6th we saw part of the island, and soon after- wards the upper clouds dispersed, and we enjoyed a magni- ficent view of the monarch of the Atlantic: the snow-covered peak glittering in the rays of the morning sun. Yet as our ideas are very dependent upon comparison, I suppose that persons who have seen the Himalaya Mountains, or the Andes, in all their grandeur, would not dwell much upon the view of Teneriffe, had it not become classical by its historical asso- ciations, and by the descriptions of Humboldt and many dis- tinguished travellers. Although some geographers adopted the Peak of Teneriffe as a zero point from which to reckon longitude, I am free to say, that a less satisfactory one could hardly have been selected 5 because there are no means of connecting the position of the peak with that of the observer, whether on the shore of the 48 ZERO FOR LONGITUDE—SANTA CRUZ. Jan. island, or on board a ship in the offing, except by a trigono- metrical process, always open to errors. Indeed the summit of the peak is not visible from the east, on account of intervening land, unti] the observer is at some distance from the shore. Hence all meridian distances measured from Teneriffe must depend upon the degree of accuracy with which the position of the actual starting-point, with respect to the Peak, was deter- mined. How many errors have been caused in ascertaining the lon- gitudes of distant places, by a mistake in the longitude of the position from which a ship, or an observer, actually departed ! How many discrepancies between the measurements of different nations would vanish, if the precise points from which each observer set out were known; and if the positions of those points, with respect to one another, were accurately verified ! About noon we approached the sun-burned, uninviting town of Santa Cruz. Lying upon a level, arid space, at the foot of hills, that rise slowly to a considerable height, so as to shut out the more elevated part of the island ; hardly a tree to be seen, and no appearance of cultivation ; guarded by a rocky shore, on which there is always a disagreeable—often a danger- ous surf; it offers indeed little to tempt delay. But notwith- standing this unpromising exterior, and a port so exposed that Spanish ships of war were ordered by their Government to moor there with four anchors, there is much to be found in the higher and interior parts of Teneriffe which amply repays the labour of ascending to and exploring those regions. In one of the churches in Santa Cruz is still hanging the remains of a flag, taken from the English, or left behind, when Nelson lost his arm. Our anchor had just touched the ground, when a boat from the Health Office approached nearly along-side, conveying the British vice-consul and some quarantine officers, who told us, after hearing whence we came, that it would be impossible to grant permission for any person to land; and that until we should have performed a strict quarantine of twelve days’ dura- tion, no personal communication could be expected. This 1832. QUARANTINE—SWELL—SQUALL. 49 regulation was adopted on account of the reports which had reached them respecting the cholera in England. Observations on shore being indispensable for our purpose, and finding, after some discussion, that there was no chance of attaining our object in a manner that would at all compensate for the delay caused by anchoring and performing quarantine, we weighed without further loss of time, and made sail for the Cape Verd Islands. This was a great disappointment to Mr. Darwin, who had cherished a hope of visiting the Peak. To see it—to anchor and be on the point of landing, yet be obliged to turn away without the slightest prospect of beholding Teneriffe again— was indeed to him a real calamity. During the whole of the 7th, the Peak was visible; but on the following day no land was in sight, and we made rapid progress. A very long swell from the north-west, which we felt until the 10th, was probably caused by a gale in the nor- thern Atlantic; and, judging from its size and velocity, I should think that it could not have subsided before traversing many, perhaps ten more, degrees of latitude; which would be to about 10° north. It is interesting to notice how far the undulatory movement of water reaches: in this case it ex- tended through at least ten degrees of latitude where the wind was from different quarters, and probably much farther. An unusual appearance was observed on the 12th. A cloud like a dense fog-bank approached ; and as it drew near, the lower and darker part became arched, and rose rapidly, while under it was a white glare, which looked very suspicious. Sail was immediately reduced—we expected a violent squall ; but the cloud dispersed suddenly, and only a common fresh breeze came from the foreboding quarter. Neither the sympie- someter nor the barometer had altered at all; but the cloud was so threatening that I put no trust in their indications, not being then so firm a believer in their prophetic movements as I am at present. Nevertheless, I would by no means advocate the neglect of any precaution suggested by appearances of the VOL. II. E 50 INDICATIONS OF SQUALLS. Jan. weather, although no change should be foretold by the glasses. A mistake may be made by the observer, or a variation in the height of the column may have passed unheeded ; while it is seldom that a practised eye can be deceived by the visible signs of an approaching squall or gale of wind. Undoubtedly the worst wind, next to a hurricane, which a vessel can encounter, is a violent ‘ white squall, so called because it is accompanied by no cloud or peculiar appearance in the sky, and because of its tearing up the surface of the sea, and sweeping it along so as to make a wide sheet of foam. By squalls of this description, frequent in the West-Indies, and occasionally felt in other parts of the world, no notice will be given much above the horizon; but by consulting a good barometer or sympiesometer, and frequently watching the surface of the sea itself, even a white squall may be areraed against in sufficient time. Squalls accompanied by clouds are so common, and at sea every one is so much accustomed to look out for them, that I may cause a smile by these notices ; yet as there is often much doubt in a young officer’s mind, whether an approaching cloud will be accompanied by wind or rain, or by both, and many persons are unable to distinguish, by the mere appearance of a cloud, what is likely to come with or from it, I will venture to mention that when they look hard, or hard- edged (like Indian ink rubbed upon an oily plate), they indicate wind, and perhaps rain; but before the rain falls, those clouds will assume a softer appearance. When they are undefined, and look soft, rain will follow, but probably not much wind. Dark clouds, hard mixed with soft, and inky fragments in rapid motion beneath them, accompanied perhaps by light- ning and distant thunder, are the fore-runners of a heavy squall. Soft, shapeless clouds, in which it is impossible to point out a definite edge, usually bring rain, but not wind : and, generally speaking, the more distinctly defined the edges of clouds are, the more wind they foretell. A little attention 1832. REEL—CAPE VERD ISLANDS. 51 to these simple observations, so familar to persons who have been some time at sea, may save young officers unnecessary anxiety in one case, and prompt them to shorten sail at a proper time in the other.* In again trying for soundings with three hundred fathoms of line, near the Island of St. Jago, we became fully con- vinced’ of the utility of a reel, which Captain Beaufort had advised me to procure, and of which Captain Vidal had spoken to him in very favourable terms. ‘Two men were able to take in the deep sea line, by this machine, without interfering with any part of the deck, except the place near the stern, where the reel was firmly secured. Throughout our voyage this simple contrivance answered its object ex- tremely well, and saved the crew a great deal of harassing work. 15th. In consequence of a thick haze, very prevalent about the Cape Verd Islands, land was not distinctly seen until we were within three miles of it, and we then found ourselves rather too far westward, owing to a current setting towards the west, at the rate of two knots an hour; this was close to the north point of St. Jago. Next day we anchored in Port Praya. The wind being always from the north or east during this season of the year (from December to June), a ship can moor as close to the weather shore as may be convenient ; but during July, August, September and October, no vessel should deem the bay secure, or anchor near the shore, because southerly gales sometimes blow with much strength, and the rollers, or heavy swell sent in by them, are dangerous to ships which have bad ground tackle, or are lying near the land. As I have myself experienced the force of these gales in the vicinity of the Cape Verd Islands, and witnessed the sea raised by them, I can confidently warn those who are inclined to be incredulous about a gale of wind being found in fifteen degrees of north latitude, beyond the limits of the hurricane regions. * Inthe Appendix are a few remarks on clouds. 5) Low 52 PORT PRAYA—RIBEIRA GRANDE. Jan Strong gusts come over the land into the bay during the fine season, when the breeze is fresh; therefore a ship entering, with intent to anchor, ought to have a reef in her top-sails, and be ready to clew up the top-gallant sails at a moment’s warning. The vicinity of Port Praya offers little that is agreeable to the eye of an ordinary visitor, though interesting enough to a geologist. A desolate and hilly country, sun-burned and stony, with but few trees even in the vallies, and those only the withering, spectre-like trunks of old palms, surrounds the har- bour. The distant and higher parts of the island, however, pre- sent a striking outline; and in the interior there is more to be seen, as the following extract from a few notes made by Mr. Rowlett will show. “¢ We procured some indifferent horses and rode to Ribeira Grande, the remains of an old town, about nine miles west of Port Praya, which was formerly the residence of the Portu- guese governor of the Cape Verd Islands ; but in consequence of the anchorage becoming blocked up,* the seat of govern- ment was shifted to the small straggling town, or rather village, which stands upon a height overlooking the port of Praya. We passed through the fertile and beautiful vallies of Achao and San Martin, and enjoyed drinking some of the finest water we had ever tasted. On a commanding height stood the ruins of a very large fortress, and within the limits of the old town were remains of a cathedral, a bishop’s palace, and a college; besides a modern church, in tolerable repair, an inhabited convent, and a hospital supported by charity. In the convent we saw some good paintings from scriptural subjects; and there were some curious old tombs, on one of which, said to be that of a bishop, was the date 1571, and on another we thought the almost obliterated figures were 1497. ‘No person who has only visited the port of Praya can form the slightest idea of the beauty of the interior coun- try ; it exceeded any thing I had seen, either in Brazil or in the West Indies. * Perhaps by an earthquake ? 1832. PRODUCE—POPULATION—ARCHILLA. 58 *« Fruit was abundant; there were oranges, grapes, plantains, bananas, sour-sops, mammee apples, pomegranates, guavas, quinces, sapodillas, papaw apples, pines, citrons, medlars, figs, and occasionally apples.” Notwithstanding its unfavourable exterior, its small and dirty town, and its black or brown population, I am inclined to think Port Praya of more consequence to shipping than is usually supposed. Water may be procured by rafting the casks, placing a pump in the well, and hiring a few of the natives to do the more laborious work of filling and rolling. The local authorities are attentive and obliging: it is indeed their interest to be so, because much of their trade, and even many of the necessaries of life, depend upon the visits of ship- ping. Fowls, turkeys, and pigs, are very plentiful, but it is better to procure them by barter than with money. Clothes, new or old, are eagerly sought for, and their full value may be obtained in the produce of the island. The population is said to be about thirty thousand, a few of whom are Portuguese by birth, and many are descended from Portuguese parents, but the greater number are negroes. I could hear no decided account of any earthquake having happened ; but being so near Fogo, now an active volcano, one may suppose that St. Jago is not exempted from an occa- sional shock. The exports of the Cape Verd Islands are small quantities of sugar, cotton, and coffee. Hides of small bullocks, sheep and goat-skins, are likewise exported ; and horses, mules, and asses, of an inferior description, are sometimes sent to the West- Indies. The Archilla weed, so much used in dyeing, is however the staple commodity, and, under proper managc- ment, might be made highly profitable. At the time of our visit, the yearly revenue arising out of the government monc- poly of this article amounted to fifty thousand dollars; and in some years it has been as much as three hundred thou- sand dollars. This weed grows like a kind of moss upon the cliffs, and is collected by men who climb up or are let down by ropes, like the samphire gatherers.. 54 RAINY SEASON—STORMS. Jan. The natural dye is blue, approaching to purple; but by using metallic and other solutions, it may be turned to purple, crimson, or scarlet. Money having been slowly remitted of late years from the mother-country, a great part of the archilla has been applied to the payment of the authorities, the clergy, and the troops (such as they are). A story is told of the last governor having caused a sham mutiny, in order that he might have a good reason for selling the archilla gathered that year, and with the produce paying the troops—and himself. He was brought out with a rope round his neck into the street, and there obliged to promise that he would sell the archilla, then in the government storehouse, to the best bidder. A kind of castor-oil plant is found, from which a small quantity of oil is obtained, and a sort of soap. Yams are very scarce, being grown only at one part of the island. Mandioca is common, but it degenerates rapidly, and will not produce even a second crop. Vegetables of various kinds are abun- dant in their seasons. From August to October is the rainy and sickly season. In September, a south-west gale is usually experienced ; but from five to ten hours before its commencement, a dark bank of clouds is seen in the southern horizon, which is a sure forerunner of the gale. Should a vessel be at anchor in the port at such a time, she ought to weigh and put to sea, until the storm has ceased and the swell subsided. In the month of September preceding our visit, an American merchant-brig and a Portuguese slaver were at anchor in Port Praya. A bank of clouds was seen during the day in the S.W., and the American went to sea; but the slaver remained at anchor. A storm arose at night, drove the slave-vessel ashore, and dashed her to pieces in less than half an hour, yet did the American no damage whatever, and the next day she an- chored again in the port. In a valley near the town is a very remarkable tree, of the Baobab kind, supposed to be more than a thousand years old ; but I am not aware of the grounds upon which this 1832. FEVERS—DUST—MASSEY S LEADS. 55 assertion is made. Wild guinea-fowls are found in flocks, and there are wild-cats in the unfrequented parts of the island; but if induced to take a gun in pursuit of the guinea- fowls, I would advise a stranger not to overheat himself, or sleep on shore at night; for fatal fevers have been contracted by Europeans, who were unguarded as to their health, while passing a few days in this hot climate, after being for some time accustomed to the cold weather of a high northern latitude. Except during the rainy season, the wind is always north- easterly, and then the sky is clear and the sun very powerful ; but a dry haze hangs over the island in a peculiar manner, and a quantity of fine dust, quite an impalpable powder, fre- quently settles on every exposed surface, even on the sails and rigging of a vessel, when passing near the islands. On the 8th of February our instruments were re-embarked, and, after swinging the ship to ascertain the amount of local attraction, we weighed anchor and sailed. By the compass fixed upon a stanchion in front of the poop, not twenty minutes difference of bearing could be detected, in any position of the vessel : the object observed being the highest point of a sharp peak, distant eleven miles. On the 10th we spoke the Lyra packet, going from England to Rio de Janeiro, and received a box from her, containing six of Massey’s sounding-leads, those excellent contrivances which we frequently found so useful. These machines, as formerly made, did not answer for a much greater depth than one hundred fathoms; because their hollow cylinder yielded to the pressure of the water: but Mr. Massey has since remedied that defect in their construction. On the 13th a very confused swell seemed to presage a change of weather. Hitherto the wind had been steady from the north-east, and the sky clear; but on this day large soft clouds, light variable breezes, rain, and sometimes a short calm, showed us that we had passed the limits of the north- east trade wind. 14th. Similar weather, with a good deal of rain, but still breeze enough to keep us moving on our course. On the 15th, the wind was steady from east south-east, 56 ST. PAUL ROCKS—BIRDS. Feb. and the sky free from heavy threatening clouds. We had then entered the south-east trade wind, without having had two hours calm. St. Paul Rocks, or Penedo de San Pedro, were seen on the horizon at sunset of the 15th. They appeared extremely small, being about eight miles distant ; and had we not been looking out for them, I doubt whether they would have attracted attention. Excepting ‘‘ Las Hormigas,” on the coast of Peru, I never saw such mere rocks at so great a distance from any land. At daylight next morning, two boats were sent to land upon, and examine them; while the Beagle sailed round this “sunk mountain top,” sounding, and taking angles. Good observations were made during the day, as the sky was clear, and the water smooth. When our party had effected a landing through the surf, and had a moment’s leisure to look about them, they were astonished at the multitudes of birds which covered the rocks, and absolutely darkened the sky. Mr. Darwin afterwards said, that till then he had never-believed the stories of men knock- ing down birds with sticks; but there they might be kicked, before they would move out of the way. The first impulse of our invaders of this bird-covered rock, was to lay about them like schoolboys; even the geo- logical hammer at last became a missile. ‘* Lend me the ham- mer ?” asked one. ‘ No, no,” replied the owner, “ you'll break the handle ;” but hardly had he said so, when, overcome by the novelty of the scene, and the example of those around him, away went the hammer, with all the force of his own right-arm. While our party were scrambling over the rock, a deter- mined struggle was going on in the water, between the boats? crews and sharks. Numbers of fine fish, like the groupars (or garoupas) of the Bermuda Islands, bit eagerly at baited hooks put overboard by the men; but as soon as a fish was caught, a rush of voracious sharks was made at him, and notwith- standing blows of oars and boat hooks, the ravenous monsters could not be deterred from seizing and taking away more than half the fish that were hooked. ” Bhi . N \ N SS eine 1832. SHARKS— CROSS EQUATOR. 57 At short intervals the men beat the water with their oars all round the boats, in order to drive away the sharks; and for a few minutes afterwards the groupars swarmed about the baited hooks, and were caught as fast as the lines could be hauled up—then another rush of sharks drove them away — those just caught were snatched off the hooks; and again the men were obliged to beat the water. When the boats returned they were deeply laden with birds and fish, both welcome to those who had been living on salt provisions. From the highest point of the rock,* no discoloured water, nor any breaking of the sea, could be discerned, apart from the place itself; and from the soundings taken in the boats, as well as on board the ship, I conclude that it is uncon- nected with any shoal, being merely the summit of a steep- sided mountain rising from the bottom of the ocean. "There was a slight current setting to the westward, not amounting to a mile an hour. At sunset that day we were out of sight of St. Paul (or St. Peter), and soon after dark were hailed by the gruff voice of a pseudo-Neptune. A few credulous novices ran upon the forecastle to see Neptune and his car, and were received with the watery honours which it is customary to bestow, on such occasions. Next morning we crossed the Equator, and the usual cere- monies were performed. Deep was the bath, to wash away all ill ; Notched was the razor—of bitter taste the pill. Most ruffianly the barber looked—his comb was trebly nailed— And water, dashed from every side, the neophyte assailed. The disagreeable practice alluded to has been permitted in most ships, because sanctioned by time ; and though many con- demn it as an absurd and dangerous piece of folly, it has also many advocates. Perhaps it is one of those amusements, of which the omission might be regretted. Its effects on the minds of those engaged in preparing for its mummeries, who enjoy it * Sixty-four feet above the sea. 58 CEREMONIES—REMARKS. Feb. at the time, and talk of it long afterwards, cannot easily be judged of without being an eye-witness. During the early ages of navigation, before the invention of the compass, somewhat similar, though really ceremonious rites were observed in Spanish, Portuguese, and Italian ves- sels, when they passed the more remarkable promontories then known. A modern voyager, Kotzebue, notices this subject in a manner which appears to me so sensible, that I shall quote his words without affecting to add another remark. ‘On the 11th of October we crossed the Equator, at twenty- five degrees west longitude, reckoning from Greenwich. Hav- ing saluted the southern hemisphere by the firing of guns, our crew proceeded to enact the usual ceremonies. A sailor, who took pride in having frequently passed the line, directed the performance with much solemnity and decorum. He appeared as Neptune, attired in a manner that was meant to be terribly imposing, accompanied by his consort, seated on a gun-car- riage instead of a shell, drawn by negroes, as substitutes for . tritons. In the evening the sailors represented, amidst general applause, a comedy of their own composition. “‘ These sports, while they serve to keep up the spirits of the men, and make them forget the difficulties they have to go through, produce also the most beneficial influence upon their health ; a cheerful man being much more capable of resisting a fit of sickness than a melancholy one. It is the duty of com- manders to use every innocent means of maintaining this temper in their crews; for, in long voyages, when they are several months together wandering on an element not destined by nature for the residence of man, without enjoying even occasionally the recreations of the land, the mind naturally tends to melancholy, which of itself lays the foundation of many diseases, and some- times even of insanity. Diversion is often the best medicine, and used as a preservative, seldom fails of its effect.” —(Kotzebue’s Voyage, 1823-26.) Before sunset on the 19th we saw the island of Fernando Noronha, with its singular peak towering aloft, and at mid- night anchored in the roadstead. 1832. FERNANDO NORONHA. 59 Next morning I landed with difficulty for observations, the surf being so high that any common boat would have been swamped. By taking great care, our broad and well-built whale- boats landed the instruments and a small party, and re-em- barked them afterwards, without accident. We landed in a small bay under the (so called) citadel, but there is a safer and in every way preferable landing-place about a mile to the northward. My object being chiefly to take sights of the sun, for time, and compare the chronometers used on shore as scon as possible with those on board, I preferred landing as near as I could to the place where the lamented Captain Foster observed :—but it was difficult to ascertain the house in which his pendulum observations were made. Not even the governor could tell me, for he had arrived since Cap- tain Foster’s departure; and most of the inhabitants of the island had changed their dwellings frequently, being all exiles from Brazil. The governor was a major in the Brazilian service, born at Pernambuco, and under his command were two hundred black troops, and about eight hundred human beings, only thirty of whom were women, and a very few children. We obtained some fire-wood from one of the islets north- ward of the principal island; but it was full of centipedes and other noxious insects, from which it was not easy to free it even by charring and washing. Water we did not try to get, because of the heavy surf, but there is no scarcity of it on the island. Neither live-stock nor vegetables could be pro- cured from the apathetic inhabitants. This place is rather picturesque ; and the lofty barren peak, already mentioned, is conspicuous from every point of view. Near the summit is a station from which a look-out is kept, not only over all the island, but over many leagues of the sur- rounding sea; so that neither ship nor boat can approach or depart, during daylight, without being noticed. No boats are allowed to be kept on the island, and no intercourse is held with shipping without permission and the strictest inspection. We sailed from Fernando Noronha the same evening, passed 60 BAHIA—SAN SALVADOR. Feb. round the north-east extremity of the island, and steered for Bahia de Todos Santos. Having remained only one day at anchor, in consequence of information that no better landing could be expected for many days ; and wishing to ascertain the rates of the chronometers, as well as to procure a supply of water, I decided to go to Bahia, as the nearest port convenient for both purposes. From the 23d to the 27th we found a cur- rent setting us southward, between twenty and thirty miles each day. This was quite unexpected by me, for I thought that we should have been set westward. At daylight on the 28th we made the land about Bahia, and before noon were at anchor in the port. As we sailed in rapidly from the monotonous sea, and passed close along the steep but luxuriantly wooded north shore, we were much struck by the pleasing view. After the light-house was passed, those by whom the scene was unex- pected were agreeably surprised by a mass of wood, clinging to a steep bank, which rose abruptly from the dark-blue sea, showing every tint of green, enlivened by bright sunshine, and contrasted by deep shadow: and the general charm was heightened by turretted churches and convents, whose white walls appeared above the waving palm trees; by numerous shipping at anchor or under sail; by the delicate airy sails of innumerable canoes; and by the city itself, rising like an amphitheatre from the water-side to the crest of the heights. We found ourselves in the middle of the rainy season, and although favoured by a fine day at arriving, cloudy weather and frequent rain succeeded it, and during the short stay we made, much embarrassed our observations. Bahia has declined ever since its separation from Por- tugal: unsettled, weak governments, occupied too constantly by party strife to be able to attend to the real improvement of their country, have successively misruled it. Revolutions, and risings of the negro population, interrupting trade, have repeatedly harassed that rich and beautiful country, and are still impending. Were property secure, and industry encouraged, the trade from Bahia might be very extensive, particularly in sugar and 1832. SLAVERY IN BRAZIL. 61 cotton : but who will embark much capital upon so insecure a foundation as is there offered ? The immense extent and increase of the slave population is an evil long foreseen and now severely felt. Humanely as the Brazilians in general treat their slaves, no one can suppose that any benevolence will eradicate feelings excited by the situation of those human beings. Hitherto the obstacles to combinations and general revolt among the negroes, have been ignorance, mutual distrust, and the fact of their being natives of various countries, speaking different languages, and in many cases hostile to each other, to a degree that hardly their hatred of white men can cause them to conquer, even for their imme- diate advantage. The slave trade has already entailed some of its lamentable consequences upon the Brazilians, in demoralizing them by ex- treme indolence, and its sure accompaniment, gross sensuality ; but there are in store afflictions hitherto unfelt, occasioned by the growing hordes of enemies who are yearly causing more perplexity and dread in the territories of Brazil. Could the Brazilians see clearly their own position, unani- mously condemn and prevent the selfish conduct of individuals, emancipate the slaves now in their country, and decidedly prevent the introduction of more, Brazil would commence a career of prosperity, and her population would increase in an unlimited degree. In that immense and most fertile country, distress cannot be caused by numerous inhabitants; food is abundant, and the slight clothing required in so warm a climate is easily procured. The chief, if not the only cause of the slave trade in Brazil, is want of population—want of an industrious population, able as well as willing to clear away primeval forests, and render the soil fit for culture—able to work in the open fields under a hot sun, to cultivate the sugar cane, cotton plants, mandioca, and other productions of tropical climates. While this extensive and most powerful cause exists, selfish, unprincipled owners of immense territories in Brazil, and else- where, will not refrain from importing hundreds, even thou- 62 SLAVERY—CITY. March sands of unhappy wretches, who, once landed, become the helpless instruments of immense gain to their owners: neither can any reasonable number of shipping efficiently blockade the coasts of two great continents. If I am right in these assertions, it appears that there is no method by which the slave trade can be totally suppressed, except by destroying the cause of so abominable a traffic: and that, to this end, a native population should be encouraged in hot climates, who, being gradually inured to work on their native soil, for remuneration from their employers, and a pros- pect of future comfort for themselves and their offspring, would totally supersede the demand for constrained labour. Of course, the only way by which such a result could be obtained—I should say, perhaps, the first step towards so satisfactory a result, would be, that the government of a slave-importing country should declare that trade piratical: and proclaim every human being free; bound to no man, free to do any thing not contrary to religion, or law, from the moment he or she embarked on board a vessel belonging to that country, or placed a foot upon its soil ; which might then indeed be termed, in common with our happy land, a sacred soil. By such a plan as this, individuals would suffer for a time, but the mass of society would be gainers incalculably. Well-known authors have already said so much of Bahia, its spacious harbour, and delightful environs, that it would be impertinent in the writer of a mere narrative to add his hasty remarks to the calmly considered information which their works contain. But I will venture to notice that however pleased a stranger to Bahia may be at the sensations conveyed through his eyes, previous to landing, he will be miserably disap- pointed when he finds himself in the dirty, narrow, crowded, and hot ‘ lower town;’ and that the sooner he gets into a sedan* chair, and desires the almost naked bearers to make the best of their way to the ‘ upper town,’ where he will enjoy * An arm-chair, with a high baek, a foot-board, and curtains to draw round, hung to a pole which rests on the shoulders of two men. vy i Mt 1832. SHOALS—ABROLHOS. 63 fresh air, a pleasing view, and freedom from annoyances, the less his organs will be offended, and his temper tried. We sailed from Bahia on the 18th. The bank which pro- jects from the light-house point had been minutely examined by us, during the Beagle’s stay in port ; on one day, indeed, she went out and anchored at the outer end of the shoal, in order to determine its extent, and assist the boats in sounding ; therefore I did not hesitate to stand across it ; but there is not water enough over the shallower parts for any ship drawing more than fourteen feet, especially if there is a swell. The shoalest spot is near the outer end; ships of any size may pass between the inner extremity and the point of land adjacent to it. There are rocks and dangerous shallows southward of the port, which it is extremely necessary to guard against in approaching it from sea, because the current generally sets towards the south, and ships have got ashore on those shoals in consequence. The land northward of Bahia should be made, and some white sandy patches, looking like linen hung out to dry, should be seen before a ship steers more southerly. After losing sight of the land, our course was shaped to the south-east, towards the eastern limit of the great bank of soundings which extends so far to seaward of the Abrolhos islets. Having reached the parallel of the islands, and being to the eastward of the easternmost soundings laid down in any chart, without finding any ground with three hundred fathoms of line, I began to steer westward—sounding continually, and keeping a sharp look-out at the mast-head. At two in the afternoon of the 26th, we had no bottom, with three hundred fathoms of line; and at the next cast, about an hour afterwards, found only thirty fathoms, without there being the slightest change in the colour of the water, or in its temperature, or any other indication of so sudden a change in the depth. We hauled to the wind directly, worked to the eastward in order to ascer- tain the precise limit of the bank, and lost soundings as sud- denly as we had previously struck them. A grapnel was then put overboard, with two hundred fathoms of line, and we 64 ABROLHOS BANKS AND ISLETS. March again steered westward, till a heavy pull upon the line, and a sudden jerk, showed that we had hooked the bank. The ship was hove-to, and the necessary observations made on the spot. The grapnel, when hauled up, was found to be straightened, a proof, in addition to that afforded by the lead, that the bottom was rocky. Our soundings at this time were thirty-eight fathoms, and thence to the Abrolhos islets we carried a line of soundings, no where exceeding that depth, but extremely irregular, between thirty-six and four fathoms. As far as we had time to examine, the chart of these islands, by the Baron Roussin, appeared to be satisfactory ; but the soundings are so very irregular in the vicinity of the Abrolhos, that little dependence could be placed on the lead. More than once we had four or five fathoms under one side of the vessel, and from fifteen to twenty under the other. These sudden and startling changes, called by the French, ‘ Sauts de sonde,’ are very unpleasant and perplexing. The tide, or rather current, which we found when lying at anchor near the islets, set continually to the southward, vary- ing in strength from half a mile to a mile and a half an hour ; but we had only three days’ experience. I had imagined, from what I had heard, that the rock of which these islets were chiefly composed was coral ; but was sur- prized to find only coralline growing upon gneiss or sandstone. While sounding near the Abrolhos we made a great num- ber of experiments with Massey’s lead, in order to verify its qualities ; and found it agree remarkably well with the com- mon lead, while in less than forty fathoms, but differ from it frequently when the depth of water exceeded seventy fathoms; and wholly fail when used in upwards of one hun- dred and twenty fathoms. The failure, in great depths, was in consequence of the small hollow cylinder, to which the vanes were attached, bursting, or rather, being compressed by the weight of water. Some more remarks upon this instrument will be found in the Appendix. We anchored near the islets, at dusk, on the 28th, after being in frequent anxiety, owing to sudden changes in the 1832. ABROLHOS—BIRDS—FISH. 65 depth of water; and next morning, moved to a better berth at the west side, very near them. ‘They are rather low, but covered with grass, and there is a little scattered brushwood. The highest point rises to about a hundred feet above the sea. Their geological formation, Mr. Darwin told me, is of gneiss and sandstone, in horizontal strata. When our boats landed, immense flights of birds rose simultaneously, and darkened the air. It was the breeding and moulting season ; nests full of eggs, or young unfledged birds, absolutely covered the ground, and in a very short time our boats were laden with their contents. A large black bird, with a pouch like that of a pelican, but of a bright red colour, was very remarkable, as it hovered, or darted among the bright verdure, and at a distance looked handsome ; but when seen close, it at once descended to the level of a carrion-eating cormorant or buzzard. Turtle are to be found at times: we observed the shell and skeleton of an extremely large one lying on a sandy spot at the north side of the northern islet. Some very fine fish, of the cod kind, were caught ; one was so large, that, until hauled on board, it was supposed to be a shark. The anchorage is good, and easy of access: all swell is stopped by the shal- low places, and by the islets themselves. There is no fresh water. If a general reader should honour these pages by his perusal, and find such details about wood, water, fish, birds, &e., at places about which few know, and still fewer care— extremely tiresome, he will of course pass them over; but, in my own exculpation, I must beg to be permitted to remind him that the Beagle was employed by Government, to obtain practical information likely to be useful to shipping ; and that I might neglect my duty by omitting to mention such matters, when speaking of places which are seldom visited, and hitherto but slightly known. By those employed in the coasting trade, the Abrolhos are said to be particularly subject to squalls. If this be true, what is the reason? Have the extensive shallows in their VOL. II. F 66 SQUALLS—SOUNDINGS—CAPE FRIO. vicinity any connection with the fact ? Thinking myself that they have, I would beg the reader to bear this idea in mind, when, at another part of this narrative, the squalls so fre- quent in the dangerous archipelago of the low islands are mentioned.* March 30th. We sailed and sounded in various directions, but such irregular depths I never found elsewhere. Sudden jumps, from thirty to ten, sometimes even to four fathoms, in successive casts of the hand-lead, gave us frequent alarm ; but by keeping a boat a-head, and two leads going briskly, we avoided danger, and giving up exploring, regained before dark the safe channel which runs north and south between the Abrolhos and the main land, and steered to pass near Cape San Tomé, or St. Thomas. Next day we were off that cape, but saw none of the breakers which have been so frequently reported to lie at a dangerous distance from the neighbouring shore; although we looked out for them, and _ steered so as to pass the places where I was informed they would be seen. On the 3d of April, we passed Cape Frio. I wished to visit the cove in which the Lightning and Algerine lay, while recovering the treasure sunk in the unfortunate Thetis, but circumstances were unfavourable. * The Bermuda Islands (‘still vexed Bermoothes”) may also be thought of, as being similarly cireumstanced. CHAPTER IV. Loss of the Thetis— Causes of her wreck—Approach to Rio de Janeiro —Owen Glendower—Disturbance in Rio Harbour—Observations— Chronometers — Return to Bahia— Deaths — Macacu — Malaria — Return to Rio de Janeiro—Meridian Distances—Regatta—Fuegians —Lightning — Leave Rio — Equipment— Santa Martha—W eather— Santa Catharina—Santos—River Plata— Pamperoes—Gales off Buenos Ayres— Monte Video—Point Piedras—Cape San Antonio— River Plata—C urrents—T ides—Barometer—Absence of trees—Cattle. Amone the shipwrecks which have taken place during late years, perhaps none excited so much astonishment, or caused so much trouble and discussion, as the loss of that fine frigate the Thetis. Had any seaman been asked, on what frequented shore there was least probability of a wreck, I almost think he would have answered on that of Cape Frio. Yet, against the high cliffs of that bold and well-known coast did she run ‘ stem m, going nine knots. One may conceive the shock and general consternation as she crashed against the rocky cliff, and all her masts fell inboard. As some who turn over these pages may not have read the proceedings of the Court-martial held after the return of her officers to England, F will msert a short account, derived chiefly from those of old friends and shipmates, who were on board her at the awful time of her wreck. The Thetis sailed from Rio de Janeiro on the 4th of a ber 1830, and worked to the southward all day, against a southerly wind and thick foggy weather. At 1h. 80m. a.m. on the 5th, she saw Raza Island for the last time, bearmg N.W by W., and distant eight or nine miles. The weather was still hazy, indeed at times very thick, and the wind south- east. She stood off on the larboard tack until seven A.M., and then the wind having increased, and a cross sea getting up, she wore to the eastward. Soon afterwards the wind drew to SS.E., and the ship was kept by the wind on. the FQ 68 LOSS OF THE THETIS. December starboard tack until 1h. 30m. p.m., when it was considered that Cape Frio bore about N. 40° E., distant thirty-eight miles. The position at noon, by dead reckoning, gave the Cape bearing N. 43. E., distant forty-one miles; all the cal- culations giving results between that and N. 51. E., fifty-three miles; but by dead reckoning only, as neither sun, moon, or stars had been seen. At 1h. 30m. the wind being scant, the ship was steered E. by N., and at two, a cross sea checking her way through the water, the course was altered to E.N. E. At two, when the course was thus changed, she had run nineteen miles since noon, and at four, twenty more miles had been made on the E.N.E. course; at which time, four p.m. (under the idea that she was almost abreast of Cape Frio, supposed to be then distant about twenty-four miles), seeing a large ship, ‘courses down,’ in-shore of her, steering west or W. by N., with all sail set; and the weather clearing, for an interval, without any land being seen; it was concluded that the Thetis was still further from the shore than had heen estimated, and her course was altered to N.E. by E. At five, the crew was mustered at quarters, after which the reefs were mended, and the fore top-gallant sail, jibs, spanker, and reefed fore top- mast studding-sail were set. From four o’clock to six she ran, by log, twenty-one miles; after six the weather became very thick and rainy : and when the look-out men were relieved at eight o'clock, it was so dark, and rained so fast, that nothing could be distinguished half a ship’s length distant. Soon after eight one of the look-out men, named Robinson, said to ano- ther man on the forecastle,* “ Look how fast that squall is coming” (this was the cliff looming indistinctly through the rain and darkness), and next moment, ‘* Land a-head,” “‘ Hard a-port,” rung in the ears of the startled crew, and were echoed terribly by the crashing bowsprit, and thundering fall of the ponderous masts. The hull did not then strike the rocks, having answered the helm so fast as to be turning off shore when the bowsprit * Borsworthick. Both these mén afterwards sailed with me in the Beagle, 1830. LOSS OF THE THETIs. 69 broke ; but the lee yard-arm irons (boom-irons) actually struck fire from the rocky precipice as they grated harshly against it, the boom ends snapping off like icicles. All three masts fell aft and inward, strewing the deck with killed and wounded men. An immense black barrier impended horribly, against which heavy breakers were dashing with an ominous sound ; but the ship’s hull was still uninjured. Sen- tries were placed over the spirit-room ; a sail was hoisted upon the stump of the main-mast ; the winches were manned ; guns fired; rockets sent up, and blue-lights burned; the quarter- boats were cleared away to be ready for lowering; and an anchor was let go; but the water was so deep, that before she brought up, her stern drifted upon a more shelving part of the rock. Several men then tried to land ; but, in jumping ashore, many slipped, and were drowned in the surf, or crushed against the rocks. The stern and lee quarter boats were dashed to pieces, as the surf hove the ship against the cliff, and no boat was then available ; for the others were either stove, or so covered with wreck, that they could not be used. Finding that the anchor, which had been let go, did no good, but seemed to keep her tailing upon the rocks, the cable was slipped, after which her head fell off to the westward. It was then found that the water was gaining, and the winches were worked. Successive waves threw her starboard quarter upon the rocks ; and the effects of repeatedly striking were soon but too appa- rent, as the water burst open the spirit-room hatches. At this moment a small opening appeared, into which the ship providentially drove. It was at first thought that this was the opening into Cape Frio Harbour ; but it proved to be only a very small cove, or indentation of the rocky cliffs. While drifting close along the rocks into this cove, a hawser was passed ashore, by which afterwards several persons landed. The ship struck heavily in the cove, gave some tremendous yawns, and sunk. As she then lay upon the rocky bottom, each succeeding wave broke over and just covered her. By a violent surge, the rock to which the hawser above-mentioned had been made fast, was torn away; and, for a short time, all “0 = 2 LOSS OF THE THETIS. Dec. hope of further communication with the land was suspended. Every effort that could be made to convey a rope to the shore was attempted in vain, until Mr. Geach, the boatswain, went out on the stump of the bowsprit, and by the help of two belaying-pins, succeeded in throwing the end of a small rope to the rocks, by which a large one was immediately hauled ashore, and then kept as much stretched as the strength of the men who had landed would allow. On this larger rope each man was slung, in his turn, and hauled by the small one through the surf to a rough craggy rock. Mr. Geach and John Langley, the captain of the forecastle, were among the last to leave the ship, having almost exhausted themselves in slinging their shipmates. As day-light broke, the last man was hauled ashore. Many were terribly bruised and lacerated by the fall of the masts, or during these struggles for life, and twenty-five persons perished. Some of the officers made their way to a small village near Cape Frio, and obtained horses, and a guide who conducted them to Rio de Janeiro, where the melancholy news was com- municated to the commander-in-chief. The captain, the other officers, and the crew, remained near the place of the wreck, waiting for assistance. An adequate cause for so great an error in the reckoning of only nineteen hours as that which occasioned the loss of this fine ship and twenty-five souls, besides the personal property of those on board, and a large freight of treasure, is not difficult to find, even without supposing the compasses to have been in error, or affected by local attraction, which, by the way, would in this case have operated in the ship’s favour. The vicinity of Cape Frio, one of the most salient promon- tories on the coast of Brazil, cannot be supposed exempt from currents ; set in motion either by temporary causes, such as strong or lasting winds; or by the varying pressure of the atmosphere upon different portions of the ocean :—or from tidal streams, more or less strong. 1830. ‘LOSS OF THE THETIS. aaa (\ Presuming that the Thetis was carried out of her supposed position, by the former cause, about twenty-four miles ; surely rather more than a mile an hour is no surprising current during nineteen hours. But if a stream of tide also affected her, in that time she would have had one whole tide either in her favour or against her. There was no reason to suspect the existence of much cur- rent near Cape Frio, when the Thetis was lost, except on such general grounds as those just mentioned, because no pilot, as far as I know, was aware of such a fact. With strong southerly winds ships of large size do not often leave Rio de Janeiro— coasting vessels never—therefore few persons could have expe- rienced its effect when sailing from the port; and when approaching Rio in similar weather, vessels sail before a fair wind, steer by sight of the land, and take little notice of the log: besides which, they then employ but three or four hours in passing through that space of sea where the Thetis was detained nineteen. In all probability, such a current as that which drove the Thetis on the rocks is only to be found during southerly winds, and in the summer season of that climate, when the general set of the current is along the coast, towards the south and west. If: a man of war is accidentally lost, a degree of asto- nishment is expressed at the unexpected fate of a fine ship, well found, well manned, and well officered ; and blame is imputed to some one: but before admitting a hastily-formed opinion as fact, much inquiry is necessary. As in the case of the Thetis, an English man-of-war may incur risk in con- sequence of a praiseworthy zeal to avoid delaying in port, as a merchant-ship would probably be obliged to do, from her being unable to beat out against» an adverse wind, and, like that frigate, may be the first to prove the existence of an unsuspected danger. Those who never run any risk ;_ who sail only when the wind is fair; who heave to when approaching land, though perhaps aday’s sail distant ; and who even delay the performance of urgent duties until they can be done easily and quite safely ; are, %2 APPROACH RIO DE JANEIRO. 1819 doubtless, extremely prudent persons: — but rather unlike those officers whose names will never be forgotten while Eng- land has a navy. Of the measures taken for recovering the treasure sunk in the Thetis, much has appeared in print; therefore I will not add a word to that subject of controversy. Weather such as that which caused the loss of the Thetis, is only at times met with off Cape Frio; a clear sky, with a hot sun, and but little wind, is more usual; and as my first approach to Rio de Janeiro, on board H.M.S. Owen Glen- dower, in 1819, made much impression upon me, I will endea- vour to describe it’s circumstances. High blue mountains were seen in the west, just after the sun had set, and with a fair wind we approached the land rapidly. The sea was quite smooth, but a freshening breeze upon our quarter carried us on, nearly thirteen knots an hour. Though dark as any cloudy tropical night, when neither moon nor star relieves the intense blackness—astern of us was a long and perfectly straight line of sparkling light, caused by the ship’s rapid way through the water ; and around the bows, as far forward as the bowsprit end, was dazzling foam, by whose light I read a page of common print. Sheet lightning played incessantly near the western horizon: and sometimes the whole surface of the sea seemed to be illuminated. As the moon rose, and the breeze decreased, the contrasts of light and darkness, of swift change of place and apparent tran- quillity, lost their effect. Next morning we had a dead calm: high land towered over the fog-banks, which were slowly drawn upwards and dispersed by the heat of a powerful sun ; and the sea was smooth as a lake. Numbers of that beautiful fish, the dorado, often called a dolphin, were caught ; and the vivid, various colours displayed, as they lay upon our deck, exceeded description. Well I remember too the trouble we middies had with the sun at noon on that day ; not with the sun above our heads, but with its image reflected by our quadrants. As he was almost vertical over us, we were dispersed round the ship, each thinking he had brought the reflected image down 1819 —32. RIO DE JANEIRO. 73 to the proper point of the horizon, until, startled by hearing < twelve o'clock,’ reported by the master, we found too late, and much to our annoyance, that it would have been wiser to have looked at the compass before observing the altitude. Soon after mid-day black curling ripples stole along the hitherto glassy surface ; sail was made, the sea-breeze fresh- ened, and we steered towards the entrance of that magnificent harbour, Rio de Janeiro. Often as it has been visited and described, I cannot expect any one to require another sketch, but will merely remark that I know no port equal to it in situation, security, capacity, convenience, and abundant supply of every necessary, as well as in picturesque beauty. A day or two after the Owen Glen- dower anchored, a party of her midshipmen were allowed to take a boat and enjoy a day’s excursion in the beautiful har- bour, or rather gulf. We landed on an island, which seemed to me like an immense hot-bed, so luxuriant and aromatic were the shrubs, and so exotical the appearance of every tree and flower. Years since elapsed have not in the least dimi- nished my recollection of the novelty and charm of that first view of tropical vegetation. To return to the Beagle. On the 3d we were near Raza Island, but detained by calms. The light-house lately erected there showed a bright revolving, or rather intermitting light. On the following day, when the sea-breeze set in, we steered for the harbour. The sun shone brightly, and there were enough passing clouds to throw frequent shadows over the wooded heights and across vallies, where, at other times, the brightest tints of varied green were conspicuous: yet I did not think the place half so beautiful as formerly. The charm of novelty being gone, and having anticipated too much, were perhaps the causes ; and it is possible that so much wood has been cleared away in late years, as to have diminished sensibly the rich and picturesque appearance which it certainly once possessed. As we shortened sail under the stern of our flag-ship, I was surprised by finding Sir Thomas Baker, the Commander-in- 74 RIO DE JANEIRO. April chief, giving directions for the positions to be taken forthwith by the ships of his squadron then present, and orders for the boats to be prepared for landing marines. This was in conse- quence of one of those disturbances almost usual in South America, especially in Brazil. Some outrages had been com- mitted in the town, and a mutiny had broken out among the troops. Under old and established governments, revolt and mutiny are events which so seldom occur that their shock is not only felt at the time, but transmits vibrations through suc- ceeding ages. In these unsettled states, however, they recur so frequently, that even on the spot they cause little sensation, and excepting by those personally concerned, are scarcely remem- bered afterwards. Few strangers visit the metropolis of Brazil without being disappointed, if not disgusted. Numbers of almost naked negroes, hastening along narrow streets—offensive sights and smells, an uncivil and ill-looking native population — indis- pose one to be pleased, even with novelty ; but impressions such as these soon wear off. In the environs of the city are many good houses, in beautiful situations ; and while enjoying delightful rides amidst the richest and most varied scenery, or resting in the shade of a veranda, refreshed by the sea-breeze, and overlooking a prospect hardly to be surpassed in the world , the annoyances and the nuisances of the town are forgotten. With respect to astronomical observations, I was extremely unfortunate at Rio de Janeiro, except in those simple ones for time and latitude, which depend upon sextants and artificial horizons. Being the rainy season, but few nights were favour- able for observing the transits of stars with the moon, and those few were too near the full moon to be available. But had the weather been otherwise, I doubt whether I should have obtained satisfactory results, because the transit instrument employed was of an inferior construction, and still more, because I was unaccustomed to its use. So much time was employed, to the prejudice of other duties, in adjusting and re-adjusting this imperfect instrument, and ineffectually watch- ing for intervals of clear sky, that I resolved to set up the transit 1832. OBSERVATIONS—CHRONOMETERS. 15 no more, until I had an interval of leisure, and a prospect of some cloudless nights. Having so many good chronometers on board ; being prac- tised in observations such as they require ; and placing great confidence in their results; I felt inclined to give attention and time to them rather than to perplex myself, and cause much delay in moving from place to place, by attempting series of observations which would give occupation to an astro- nomer, and could not be undertaken by me, while actively engaged in coast-survey, without interfering with other duties. In the Appendix it may be seen how far results obtained by the chronometers agree with those of a higher class, especially with the recent ones of Captain Beechey, to whose determina- tions, resulting from moon-culminating observations, I con- clude that a high value will be attached, because he is a well- practised and able observer. As I found that a difference, exceeding four miles of longitude, existed between the meridian distance from Bahia to Rio, determined by the French expedition under Baron Roussin, and that measured by the Beagle; yet was unable to detect any mistake or oversight on my part; I resolved to return to Bahia, and ascertain whether the Beagle’s measure- ment was incorrect. Such a step was not warranted by my instructions ; but I trusted to the Hydrographer for appre- ciating my motives, and explaining them to the Lords of the Admiralty. Ina letter to Captain Beaufort, I said, ‘I have not the least doubt of our measurement from Bahia; but do not think that any other person would rely on this one measure only, differing widely, as it does, from that of a high authority—the Baron Roussin. By repeating it, if it should be verified, more weight will be given to other measures made by the same instruments and observers.” Wesailed with the ebb-tide and sea-breeze, cleared the port before the land-wind rose, and when it sprung up steered along the coast towards Cape Frio. Most persons prefer sailing from Rio early in the morning, with the land-wind ; but to any well-manned vessel, there is no difficulty whatever in working 16 RETURN TO BAHIA—DEATHS. May out of the port during a fresh sea-breeze, unless the flood-tide should be running in strongly. On this passage one of our seamen died of a fever, contracted when absent from the Beagle with several of her officers, on an excursion to the interior part of the extensive harbour of Rio de Janeiro. One of the ship’s boys, who was in the same party, lay dangerously ill, and young Musters seemed destined to be another victim to this deadly fever. It was while the interior of the Beagle was being painted, and no duty going on except at the little observatory on Ville- gagnon Island, that those officers who could be spared made this excursion to various parts of the harbour. Among other places they were in the river Macacu, and passed a night there. No effect was visible at the time ; the party returned in apparent health, and in high spirits; but two days had not elapsed when the seaman, named Morgan, complained of headach and fever. The boy Jones and Mr. Musters were taken ill, soon after- wards, in a similar manner ; but no serious consequences were then apprehended, and it was thought that a change of air would restore them to health. Vain idea! they gradually be- came worse ; the boy died the day after our arrival in Bahia; and, on the 19th of May, my poor little friend Charles Musters, who had been entrusted by his father to my care, and was a favourite with every one, ended his short career. My chief object in now mentioning these melancholy facts is to warn the few who are not more experienced than I was at that time, how very dangerous the vicinity of rivers may be in hot climates. Upon making more inquiry respecting those streams which run into the great basin of Rio de Janeiro, I found that the Macacu was notorious among the natives as being often the site of pestilential malaria, fatal even to themselves. How the rest of our party escaped, I know not ; for they were eleven or twelve in number, and occupied a day and night in the river. When they left the ship it was not intended that they should go up any river; the object of their excursion being to visit some of the beautiful islets which stud the har- bour. None of us were aware, however, that there was so May 1832. MACACU—=MALARIA. yar4 dangerous a place as the fatal Macacu within reach. I ques- tioned every one of the party, especially the second lieutenant and master, as to what the three who perished had done dif- ferent from the rest ; and discovered that it was believed they had bathed during the heat of the day, against positive orders, and unseen by their companions; and that Morgan had slept in the open air, outside the tent, the night they passed on the bank of the Macacu. As far as I am aware, the risk, in cases such as these, is chiefly encountered by sleeping on shore, exposed to the air on or near the low banks of rivers, in woody or marshy places subject to great solar heat. Those who sleep in boats, or under tents, suffer less than persons sleeping on shore and exposed ; but they are not always exempt, as the murderous mortalities on the coast of Africa prove. Whether the cause of disease is a vapour, or gas, formed at night in such situations, or only a check to perspiration when the body is peculiarly affected by the heat of the climate, are questions not easy to answer, if I may judge from the difficulty I have found in obtaining any satisfactory information on the subject. One or two remarks may be made here, perhaps.—The danger appears to be incurred while sleeping; or when over-heated; not while awake and moderately cool; therefore we may infer that a check to the perspiration which takes place at those times is to be guarded against, rather than the breathing of any peculiar gas, or air, rising from the rivers or hanging over the land, which might have as much effect upon a person awake, as upon a sleeper. Also, to prevent being chilled by night damp, and cold, as well as to purify the air, if vapour or gas should indeed be the cause of fever, it is advisable to keep a large fire burning while the sun is below the horizon. But the subject of malaria has been so fully discussed by medical men, that even this short digression is unnecessary. To return to the narrative. Mr. Bynoe consulted with the best medical advisers at Bahia,and afterwards at Rio de Janeiro, and he and I had the melancholy satisfaction of knowing that the best had been done for his patients. 78 RETURN TO RIO DE JANEIRO. May The affectionate kindness of Mr. Bynoe on this, and indeed every occasion where his skill and attention were required, will never be forgotten by any of his shipmates. In our passage from Rio de Janeiro to Bahia, we passed be- tween the Abrolhos Islands and the main land, having a fresh southerly wind, and cloudy weather, with frequent rain. Of course there was some anxiety until we saw the islands, and it was necessary to keep the lead constantly gomg; but we got into no difficulty, and, assisted by Massey’s log, as well as Massey’s lead, we made a short passage, without an hour’s delay or scant wind. This was favourable for the chronometer mea- surement, and I was deeply gratified by finding, soon after our arrival, that the measure from Rio to Bahia confirmed that previously made, even to a second of time. On the 23d of May, we sailed the seeond time from Bahia, and steered to pass as near as possible to the eastern side of the Abrolhos; but, owing to unfavourable winds, could not approach nearer to them than in fourteen fathoms water. When examining many of the cases of preserved meat* with which the Admiralty had ordered us to be provided, we found that several had burst and caused a most disagreeable smell. This was not the fault of the tin cases, but an unavoidable accident consequent upon their being’ stowed where salt water had occasional access, and corroded the tin. In so small and so crammed a hold as ours, it was not easy to make stowage for every thing that ought to be kept dry, particularly with a hatch-deck, while rolling about in the Bay of Biscay ; but being warned by this first appearance of decay, our internal arrangement was partly changed, and some of the hatches on the lower deck temporarily caulked down. Delayed by southerly winds and a long heavy swell from the southward, we made rather a tedious passage back to Rio, and did not anchor until the night of the 3d of June. Next day (4th) the usual sets of equal altitudes were observed ; and after the chronometer rates were ascertained, I * Prepared by Kilner and Moorsom. June 1832. MERIDIAN DISTANCES—REGATTA. 79 had the satisfaction of finding that this third meridian distance agreed exactly with the first and second. Upon further exami- nation, it was seen that the Abrolhos Islands were laid down correctly in the French chart, with respect to Bahia; but that the meridian distance between those islands and Rio de Janeiro differed more than four miles from that resulting from three measures made by our twenty chronometers. A few weeks afterwards all the data and results of these measurements were given to the French Commander-in-chief on the station, who promised to forward them to the Baron Rous- sin; but I have heard nothing of their having been received. Even those who are disposed to place little reliance on the performance of chronometers, and who doubt the accuracy of distances measured by the transport of time, might be interested by a glance at the particulars of these meridian distances, which are given in the Appendix. They much increased my own confidence in that simple method of ascertaining differences of longitude, and tended to determine my dependence upon a connected chain of meridian distances, in preference to any other mode of finding the precise longitude. While watering, and rating the chronometers, a few compa- ratively leisure days afforded a seasonable opportunity for try- ing the qualities of boats, and exciting fair emulation among their crews. With the Commander-in-chiet’s permission, and the encouragement of the officers of his squadron, then in the port, some good boat-races were arranged ; and knowing how much might afterwards depend upon thequalities of the Beagle’s boats, it was very gratifying to find them excellent. Four of the set were built by Mr. Johns, the well-known boat-builder in Plymouth Dock-yard, and the other two by Mr. May, our carpenter. Captain Talbot, of the Warspite, and Captain Waldegrave, of the Seringapatam, tried their best boats and best men on two successive days, to the encouragement of the boats’ crews and boat-sailers of the squadron, and much to the surprise of the Brazilians, who had never witnessed any thing like a regatta, From our first arrival at Rio de Janeiro, until we were 80 FUEGIANS—=CLIMATE—LIGHTNING. July ready to leave, finally, in July, little Fuegia was staying on shore, at the house of an Englishwoman, near Botafogo bay ; and it is worth noticing, that while there, she was supposed by strangers to be one of the aboriginal natives of Brazil: and that I went with York and Jemmy to see a person (who had been many years resident in the interior of Brazil) who remarked, directly he saw them, “ they are extremely like the Brazilian aborigines !” At this time of year (July) the climate of Rio is compara- tively cool and pleasant. Cloudy skies, southerly winds, and rain, are frequent ; but there is less thunder and lightning than in summer, when not only thunder-storms occur often, but every night there is a continual flashing or reflection of light- ning over the distant Organ mountains. Many ships and buildings have been struck, during late years, still there are but a very few protected by lightning conductors. I was a lieutenant on board the Thetis, when her foremast was shattered by lightning, in Rio Harbour, and shall not easily forget the sensation. Some of the officers were sitting in the gun-room, one very dark evening, while the hea- vens were absolutely black, and the air hot and close, to an oppressive degree, but not a drop of rain falling, when a rattling crash shook the ship. Some thought several guns had been fired together—others, that an explosion of powder had taken place ; but one said—* The ship is struck by lightning !” and that was the case. The top-gallant masts were not aloft ; but the fore-topmast was shivered into a mere collection of splinters; the hoops on the foremast were burst, and the inte- rior, as well as outside of the mast, irreparably injured. From the foremast the electric fluid seemed to have escaped by some conductor, without doing further damage; yet it filled the fore part of the ship with a sulphureous smell, and the men who were there thought something full of gunpowder was blown up. No person received injury: the foremast was taken out afterwards, and replaced by another, purchased from the Brazi- lian government at a great expense, and made by the carpen- 1827-32. LIGHTNING—LEAVE RIO. 81 ters of the Thetis. I should say that the electric fluid shook rather than shattered the fore-topmast, for it did not fall, but resembled a bundle of long splinters, almost like reeds. It twisted round the head of the foremast, instead of descending by the shortest line, went into the centre of the spar, and then out again to the hoops, every one of which, above the deck, was burst asunder. The Thetis was to have sailed in a few days, but was detained by this accident almost two months. She had no conductor in use. Only two or three flashes of lightning were seen afterwards ; they were accompanied by loud peals of thunder, and then heavy rain poured down. Just before the rain began, St. Elmo’s fire was seen at each yard-arm, and at the mast-head. Those who have not seen this light, always a favourite with sailors, because they say it only appears when the worst part of the storm is over, may excuse my saying that it resembles the light of a piece of phosphorus—not being so bright, or so small, as that of a glow-worm, nor yet so large as the flame of a small candle. . I was curious enough to go out to a yard-arm and put my hand on a luminous spot ; but, of course, could feel nothing, and when I moved my hand the spot re- appeared. About the same time of the year in which this happened, the Heron corvette was struck by lightning, and damaged, while lying at anchor off Buenos Ayres, in the river Plata, a locality extremely subject to vivid lightning, yet different in every respect from that of Rio de Janeiro: one being a flat, open country, near a fresh water river, and in latitude 34°; the other a mountainous and woody region, near the sea, and within the tropic of Capricorn. On the 5th of July we sailed from Rio de Janeiro, honoured by a salute, not of guns, but of hearty cheers from H.M.S. Warspite. Strict etiquette might have been offended at such a compliment to a little ten-gun brig, or, indeed, to any vessel unless she were going out to meet an enemy, or were returning into port victorious: but although not about to encounter a foe, our lonely vessel was going to undertake a task laborious, and often dangerous, to the zealous execution VOL. I. G 82 PERMANENT EQUIPMENT. July of which the encouragement of our brother-seamen was no trifling inducement. While in harbour, a few alterations had been made in the disposition of our guns and stores, as well as some slight changes in the sails and rigging ; and as the Beagle’s equipment afterwards remained unaltered, I will here briefly describe it. She was rigged as a bark; her masts were strongly supported by squarer cross-trees and tops, and by larger rigging than usual in vessels of her tonnage.* Chains were used where found to answer, and in no place was a block or a sheave allowed which did not admit the proper rope or chain freely. There were large trysails between the masts, made of stout canvas, with several reefs, and very useful we found them. On the forecastle was a six-pound boat-carronade: before the ches- tree were two brass six-pound guns: close to the bulwark on each side of the waist were the ‘ booms;’ and amidships two boats, on the diagonal principle, one stowed inside the other, and as close to thedeck as possible; being secured by iron cranks, or supports. Abaft the main-mast were four brass guns, two nine-pound, and two six-pound : the skylights were large ; there was no capstan; over the wheel the poop-deck projected, and under it were cabins, extremely small, certainly, though filled in inverse proportion to their size. Below the upper deck her accommodations were similar to, though rather bet- ter than those of vessels of her class. Over the quarter- deck, upon skids, two whale-boats, eight-and-twenty feet long, were carried ; upon each quarter was a whale-boat twenty-five feet in length, and astern was a dinghy. A few leagues southward of the port is a good situation for enjoying a general view of the picturesque mountains in its vicinity. When near the shore one only sees those of an inferior order; and it is not until an offing is gained that the bold and varied outlines of the distant Organ Mountains,+ the sharp * Two hundred and forty-two tons. + So called because they have a number of pinnacles, somewhat like the pipes of an organ. 1832. SANTA MARTHA—CATHARINA. 83 peak of the Corcovado, and the singular heights over Tijuca, can be seen at once. Whimsical allusion has been made to the first Lord Hood in the name by which one of these heights is called by English sailors ; and in their general outline is a fancied resemblance to a huge giant lying on his back. Off Santa Martha, a sort of Cape Spartivento, near which one rarely passes without having a change of wind, if not a storm, we were detained by strong southerly gales, which raised a high sea. This extreme movement and delay I regret- ted much at the time, on account of the chronometers; but the sequel shewed that such motion did not affect them materially, and that alterations of their rates were caused chiefly, if not entirely, by changes of temperature. _ Gales in the latitude of Santa Martha generally commence with north-westerly winds, thick cloudy weather, rain, and lightning. When at their height, the barometer begins to rise (having previously fallen considerably), soon after which the wind flies round, by the west, to south-west, and from that quarter usually blows very hard for several hours. But these, which are the ordinary gales, blow from, or along the land, and do not often raise such a sea as is sometimes found off this coast during a south-east storm. After a tiresome continuance of south-west winds, I became anxious to make Santa Catharina, but before we could reach it the wind changed, and enabled us to steer along the coast towards the south. Having mentioned Santa Catharina, | may as well add a few words to the many lavished in its praise by voyagers of all nations; for it is, excepting Rio de Janeiro, and perhaps Bahia, the best trading port on the east coast of South America; and, considering its situation, capa- bilities, and productions, is a place in which seamen must always have an interest. It enjoys the advantages of a tem- perate climate; an extensive and accessible harbour; a most fertile country, abounding in the necessaries of life; and a mer- cantile position of much importance. The people are more inclined to exert themselves than those in northern Brazil; a difference arising partly, no doubt, from effect of climate ; cQ 84 SANTA CATHARINA—SANTOS. July but chiefly from their having descended from active and enter- prising, though lawless settlers, who were ejected from other places; and from a few respectable colonists induced to emi- grate from the Azores. Before I quit the neighbourhood of frequented ports on this coast, one possessing peculiar interest, Santos, ought to be mentioned; to remind seamen. that they may there also obtain any refreshments, and secure their ships in a sheltered creek, quite easy of access.. For several leagues round Santos there is an extensive flat, covered with thick woods, but intersected by rivers and salt water inlets, whose banks are lined with thickets of mangrove trees. Inland a mountain range abruptly rises to the height of two or three thousand feet, every where clothed with almost impenetrable forests. The climate is, however, unhealthy in December, January, and February ; and during the whole year there is a great deal of rain. Returning to the coast southward of Santa Catharina, I may mention that Cape Santa Martha, and the shores extending northward of it, are high and woody, like the greater part of ' the coast of Brazil; but that on the south side of the promon- tory there is a complete change of character: lofty ranges of mountains sinking into low treeless shores, whose outline is as tame and unvarying as that of the former is bold and pic- turesque. While sailing along the level uninteresting coast just men- tioned, with a fresh breeze off the land, we found it bitterly cold, though the thermometer never was below 40°. Faht: so much does our perception of heat or cold depend upon com- parison. Some of our exaggerated opinions as to the coldness of the southern hemisphere may have arisen from the cireum- stances under which voyagers usually visit high southern lati- tudes, immediately after enduring the heat of the tropics, and without staying long enough to ascertain the real average tem- perature during a whole year. On the 22d of July we were near the river Plata, and as the weather, after sunset, became very dark, with thunder and lightning, though with but little wind, we anchored in the 1832. ENTER RIVER PLATA. 85 vicinity of Cape Sta Maria to avoid being drifted about by irre- gular currents. For upwards of an hour St. Elmo fires were seen at each mast-head, and at some of the yard-arms: the mast-head vane also, fixed horizontally, and framed with cop- per, had an illuminated border round it. Heavy rain, much thunder, and a fresh southerly wind followed ; but as we were prepared for bad weather, and the sea did not rise much, we maintained our position till daylight next morning, notwith- standing an officer of the watch startling me by reporting that we must be very near the land, because he heard bullocks bellowing.* - On the 23d we entered the great estuary of this shallow though wide river, a hundred and twenty miles across at this part, yet averaging less than ten fathoms in depth ; and above fifty miles wide between Monte Video and the opposite point, called Piedras, where the average depth is not more than three fathoms. Very great care is required by vessels navigating the Plata, because of its exceedingly dangerous shoals, its strong and irreeular currents, and the sudden tempests to which it is subject: The shoals and currents may be guarded against by a very careful attention to the lead, and a ground-log ;_ but the fury of a violent pampero} must be endured. The land on each side of the Plata is so low, and those extraordinary plains called pampas, hundreds of miles in extent, are so perfectly free from a single obstacle which might offer any check to the storm, that a pampero sweeps over land and water with the weight of a rushing hurricane. Captain King has already de- scribed one, by which the Beagle suffered severely, in 1829 ;{ but having, to my sorrow, been more immediately concerned, I will endeavour to give a brief account of that disastrous affair, as a warning to others. On the 30th of January 1829, the Beagle was’standing in, _ * These noises must have been the discordant ‘ braying’ of the bird called by seamen ‘ jack-ass penguin.’ f So called because it appears to come from the vast plains called “ pampas.’ ¢ Vol. ie pp. 189, 190, 191. 86 EXTRAORDINARY PAMPERO. 1829. from sea, towards the harbour of Maldonado. . Before mid-day the breeze was fresh from N.N.W., but after noon it became moderate, and there was a gloominess, and a close sultry feel- ing, which seemed to presage thunder and rain. I should men- tion that during three preceding nights banks of clouds had been noticed near the south-west horizon, over which there was a frequent reflection of very distant lightning. The barometer had been falling since the 25th, slowly, but steadily, and on the 30th, at noon, it was at 29.4, and the ther- mometer 78°. I, and those with me, thought little about the fall of the mercury, and still less about the threatening aspect of the south-west horizon. ‘ Heavy rain,” I thought, “ at night, will not signify when we are moored in Maldonado:” and there was then every prospect of our reaching that port before night. Having been often in the river Plata, and once for eight months successively, I had acquired a familiarity with the place, and a disregard for pamperoes, which was not surprising in a young man who had witnessed many, but certainly, as it happened, not one of so serious a nature as to cause any par- ticular impression on his mind. I had not then learned never to despise an enemy. At about three o’clock the wind was light, and veering about from north-west to north-east. There was a heavy bank of clouds in the south-west, and occasionally lightning was visible even in daylight. Myriads of insects, such as butterflies, dragon-flies, and moths, came off from the land; driven, as it appeared, by gusts of heated wind. At four the breeze fresh- ened up from N.N.W., and obliged us to take in all light sails. Maldonado Tower then bore west, and Lobos Island (centre) S.W.b.S. The weather became more unsettled and threatening, though still we had no expectation of any material change before night: but soon after five it became so dark towards the south-west, and the lightning increased so much, that we shortened sail to the reefed topsails and foresail ; still hoping to reach our destination before the pampero began. Shortly before six the upper clouds in the south-west quarter 1829. BEAGLE ALMOST UPSET. 87 assumed a singularly hard, and rolled or tufted appearance, like great bales of black cotton, and altered their forms so rapidly, that I ordered sail to be shortened, and the topsails to be furled, leaving set only a small new foresail. ‘The water was smooth, and, not being deep, there was none of that agitated swell usually noticed before a storm in the great ocean. Gusts of hot wind came off the nearest land, at intervals of about a minute. The fore-topsail was just furled, and the men down from aloft, the main-topsail in the gaskets, but the men still on the yard, when a furious blast from the north-west struck the ship. The helm was put up, and she paid off fast ; yet the wind changed still more quickly, and blew so heavily from south-west, that the foresail split to ribands, and the ship was thrown almost on her beam-ends, and no longer answered her helm. The main-topsail was instantly blown loose out of the men’s hands, whose lives were in imminent danger ; the fore-topsail blew adrift out of the gaskets ; the mainsail blew away out of the gear; the lee hammock-netting was under water; and the vessel apparently capsizing, when topmasts and jib-boom went, close to the caps, and she righted considerably. Both anchors were cut away (for the land was under our lee), and a cable veered upon each, which brought her head to wind, and upright. The heaviest rush of wind had then passed, but it was still blowing a hard gale, and the Beagle was pitching her forecastle into the short high waves which had risen. As the depth of water was small, and the ground tenacious clay, both anchors held firmly, and our utmost exertions were immediately directed towards clearing the wreck, and saving the remains of our broken spars and tattered sails. Had we suffered in no other way, I should have felt joy at having escaped so well, instead of the deep regret occasioned by the loss of two seamen, whose lives, it seemed, might have been spared to this day had I anchored and struck topmasts, instead of keeping under sail in hopes of entering Maldonado before the pampero began. When the main-topsail blew away from the men, who strug- 88 EFFECTS OF PAMPERO. 1829. gled hard to keep it fast, they could scarcely hold on, or get off the yard, and one young man fell from the lee yard-arm into the sea. Poor fellow, he swam well, but in vain: the ship was unmanageable, almost overset, the weather quarter boat stove, and the lee one under water: a grating was thrown to him, and the life-buoy let go, but he was seen no more. Another man was supposed to have been carried overboard with the main-topmast, as he was last seen on the cap. _ The starboard quarter boat was stove by the force of the wind ; and the other was washed away: and so loud was the sound of the tempest, that I did not hear the masts break, though standing, or rather holding, by the mizen rigging. Never before or since that time have I witnessed such strength, or, I may say, weight of wind: thunder, lightning, hail, and rain, came with it, but they were hardly noticed in the presence of so formidable an accompaniment. After seven the clouds had almost all passed away; the wind settled into a steady south-west gale, with a clear sky ; the barometer rose to 29.8, and the thermometer fell to 46°. Lobos Island was set S.E., bearing distant two miles. In this pampero the masts of a vessel, at anchor off Monte Video, were carried away ; and the upper cabin bulkhead of a Brazilian corvette was blown in while lying at anchor, head to wind, with her masts struck. But Maldonado seemed to feel its utmost violence; and there it certainly commenced like a whirlwind. A small boat, belonging to a poor man who carried fruit and vegetables to ships in the bay, was hauled ashore, just above high-water mark, and fastened, by a strong rope, to a large stone. After the storm it was found far from the beach, shattered to pieces, but still fast to the stone, which it had dragged along. Not many days after our disas- ter, while lying in Maldonado bay, repairing damages, another pampero assailed the Beagle ; but though it did her no injury, it blew the boat, stove by its predecessor, away from the place on shore where she was being repaired, and left no trace of her behind. EFFECTS ON THE PLATA. 89 Singular fluctuations occur in the river Plata before and after these pamperoes.* For some days previously the river rises, and it is always higher than usual when the south-west wind begins: but, after a few hours, the water falls rapidly, and ves- sels are left aground : indeed instances have been known of the upper parts of the river, near Buenos Ayres, being so much emptied by strong south-westerly, or westerly winds, that men have rode several miles into its bed, to places where ships usually anchor. I have myself known the water fall, in the outer road, off Buenos Ayres, from six to two fathoms, in less than twelve hour s, in a place where the usual depth was four fathoms. Such a change as this would not be thought remark- able where tides usually rise several fathoms ; but nn the river Plata, where there is very little, if any, tide, where the width of the channel is so great in proportion to its depth, and the confin- ing boundaries are so low, and in many places easily overflowed, a variation of four fathoms cannot take place without causing great difficulties and destruction. In this particular instance,+ a heavy gale from the eastward dammed up the river for some ee ; and then changing, by the south, to the west- ward, emptied it again proportionably. Small craft were left literally scattered about the low country bordering on the river near Buenos Ayres, and many vessels never floated again. By that gale, which blew directly up the river, and raised a heavy sea, every vessel was driven ashore from the inner road of Buenos Ayres, except a schooner. Fourteen English mer- chant vessels lay high and dry upon the shore next day, most of them totally lost. The Owen Glendower, bearing the broad pendant of Sir Thomas Hardy, the Icarus brig, gl two or three merchant vessels, anchored in the outer sth weathered it out with topmasts struck ; but all drove considerably, except the frigate, and she brought both anchors ahead, backed by * Although generally considered by strangers to refer solely to a squall, or storm, the term pampero is applied by the natives of the country to every south-westerly wind, whether moderate or a hurricane. + In the year 1820. 90 LOSS OF A BOAT. ° 1820-32. stream anchors with half a cable on each, and riding with a whole cable on each bower, in four fathoms water, over very soft tenacious ground. Part of her forecastle netting was washed away by the sea, though she was an excellent roadster, and at that time drawing a foot less water than usual. She also lost a boat in a manner so likely to be of future occurrence, that I will yet digress, in hopes of being useful, by relating the incident. Her barge, ably managed by an experienced seaman,* had tried to beat off from the town to the ship, during the com- mencement of the gale, but could get no farther than the leewardmost merchantman in the outer road. Astern of that vessel she was made fast by a strong hawser, and there rode out the gale admirably until the current began to set out of the river: when the boat was carried against the vessel, and knocked to pieces before any thing could be done to save her, as the sea was running high, and the wind still blowing a gale. The Druid frigate, when lying there, would have lost a boat in the same way, had it not been one of those excellent diagonal boats, built by Mr. Johns; for it was taken, by the strong weather current, under the ship’s bot- tom, and kept striking there long enough to have broken any ordinary boat into a thousand pieces; but nevertheless she appeared again with only her gunwales injured, the bottom being still perfectly sound. The Plata has been called by the Spaniards ‘ El Infierno de los marineros ;” sufficient stress has not however been laid on the redeeming qualities which it possesses in having anchoring ground every where, and in soundings, whose nature tells whether you are approaching danger; as on and near the banks the bottom is hard; while in the deeper water it is very soft. I have remarked that before a continuance of southerly winds the water rises considerably in this river; and I may * The first who took a steam-vessel to the West-Indies. + In 1832. LEVEL OF RIVER AND OCEAN. 91 add, that the reverse takes place under opposite circumstances. Some persons attribute this change of level to the horizontal action of wind; but I aminclined to think it occasioned chiefly by vertical pressure of the atmosphere, increased, doubtless, during strong winds by their driving force. Before a pampero, the barometer continues to fall during several days, and invariably the water then rises. ‘The gale commences, the barometer ceases falling and begins to rise, and very soon afterwards the level of the river is found to be sink- ing. For many following days the glass remains high, but the water continues to fall, and, generally speaking, the river is low while the mercury is steady and above the average height, which I should consider to be 29-9inches. In the Plata I never saw the barometer higher than 30-3, nor lower than 29-4.* Iwill not delay here to speak of corresponding ele- vations or depressions of the ocean at other parts of the South American coast, and attempt to trace out the effects of gales in high latitudes, the space through which those winds extend, and. whether they reach or affect places in a low or even middle latitude; but leaving such inquiries for another place, take a few more glances at the vicinity of the Plata, and then con- tinue the narrative. Having already noticed the width and average shallowness of this immense river, and the lowness of its adjacent shores, I need only add, that on the northern side there is a sprinkling of hills, of a granitic structure, scattered amidst extensive plains, while on the south, or right bank, there is neither a hill, a rock, or even a stone.f So low is the land between Point Piedras and Cape San Antonio, that around the great bay, called Sanborombon, it is extremely difficult tosay where the water ends, or the coast line begins. ach difference, of * In estimating weather, or force of wind, by the height of the mer- curial column, due regard should be had to the goodness of the instrument, as some barometers, used in ships, differ from others even tenths of an inch. + Which has not been carried there by man, or by running water. 92 TOSCA——-GRANITE—SOUNDINGS. even a foot, in the height of the water, makes a change of cables’lengths, if not of miles, in the position of the limiting line between water and land. In consequence it is very dangerous for ships to approach that shore; and, although the bottom is in many places soft, often extremely deep mud, there are other spaces in which hard lumps of tosca* are found, almost as injurious toa ship’s bottom as actual rock. I am not aware that there is any granite on the south side of the river Plata, near the shore; and although the name ‘ Piedras’ would incline one to suppose there are rocks or stones near it, I could only find tosca. But towards the northern shore rocks are found, and the dangerous shoal called * Banco Yngles,’ is said to have a granitic foundation. The ridge, of which the English Bank is the north-west extremity, extends eastward, inclining to the south, considerably beyond a line drawn from Cape Santa Maria to Cape San Antonio, and less than ten fathoms water may be found upon it out of sight of land. Northward of the ridge the depth of water varies from ten to thirty fathoms over a very soft bottom of bluish mud; and to the southward of it there are from twelve to three fathoms (diminishing as you approach San Antonio) over a softish bottom of brown or yellow muddy sand.-+ When it is considered that three very large rivers, besides a host of smaller streams, enter the ocean by the estuary whose more remarkable features we are noticing, that two of those rivers are flooded periodically by tropical rains,} and that very heavy gales assist in emptying or filling the shallow wide gulf, in which floods of fresh water contend against the volume of a powerful ocean; not only will frequent * Tosca is a kind of hardened earth, rather than soft stone, about the consistence of slightly baked clay: it is of a dark brown colour, and varies in hardness from that which is almost stony, to the texture of a sound old cheese. + Near Cape San Antonio and Point Tuyu there is very soft mud. } The Paraguay rises so far northward, that (excepting a portage of three miles) a canoe may go from Monte Video to the mouth of the Amazon,, 1832. TIDES—ABSENCE OF TREES. 93 variations in depth be expected, as a natural consequence, but also strong and varying currents. Little or no tide has been hitherto noticed with any degree of accuracy in the estuary of the Plata; but this anomaly may be more apparent than real : for where the depth of water is so fluctuating, and the currents are'so variable, it is difficult to distinguish the precise effects of tides, except by a series of observations far longer than has yet been made. To say much of Maldonado village, the town of Monte Video, or the city of Buenos Ayres, would be to repeat an é oft-told tale. The views attached to this volume will give a tolerably clear idea of a few striking peculiarities which are immediately noticed by the eye of a stranger; and of the inha- bitants themselves I will only venture to say, upon my slight acquaintance with them, that although prejudiced by their erroneous ideas of freedom, and deficient in high principles, they are courteous and agreeable as mere acquaintances, kind to strangers, and extremely hospitable. It is well known that there are very few trees* on either bank of the Plata near its mouth, or on those immense plains, called pampas, excepting here and there an ‘ombu,’+ or some which have been planted near houses; or a few copses of small trees (mostly peach) planted for fuel: but I have not heard any sufficient reason given for this scarcity of wood, in a country covered with a great depth of alluvial soil, and adjoining dis- tricts in which trees are abundant. The only second causes for such a peculiarity, which I can imagine, are the following: the nature of the soil, which may be unsuited to most trees, although very productive of grass and gigantic thistles : the furious storms which sweep along the level expanse, and would demolish tender, unprotected young trees: the general want of water, which in some years is so great as to become a severe drought: and the numerous herds of wild cattle which range * The exceptions are so few, that one might almost say there are no trees which have not been planted. + A kind of elder. 9A DROUGHTS—CATTLE—FERTILITY. 1812. over the plains, and eat up every leaf which retains any mois- ture during the dry heats of summer. Before there were herds of cattle, guanacoes ranged over the country, in great num- bers, as they now do to the southward of the river Negro, where I have seen them grazing in large companies, like flocks of sheep. During the droughts above-mentioned vast num- bers of cattle die for want of water, and perhaps this may be the principal reason why so few trees grow there naturally ; but it cannot be the only one, because they grow where planted, and partially sheltered, though not watered. Most people are aware of the scale upon which the cattle farms of the ‘ Banda Oriental’ and ‘ Republica Argentina’ were carried on: but the civil wars which have succeeded the steady government of Spain have broken up and ruined many of the largest establishments, where from one hundred to two hun- dred thousand head of cattle were owned by one man—where the annual increase was about thirty per cent—and where the animals were, generally speaking, slaughtered for their hides alone. What must be the natural fertility of a country, which, without the slightest assistance from man, can nourish such enormous multitudes of cattle, besides immense droves of horses and flocks of sheep, and yet, except near its few towns, appear almost destitute of inhabitants. To return to our little vessel—entering the Plata in 1832. Unfavourable winds, and currents setting out of the river, delayed our progress, and obliged us to anchor frequently. We arrived at Monte Video on the 26th, and lost no time in making observations for our chronometers, and preparing for surveying the coasts southward of Cape San Antonio: but as I found that it would be advisable to visit Buenos Ayres, in order to communicate with the Government, and obtain information, we sailed from Monte Video on the 31st, and two days afterwards anchored off Buenos Ayres. ‘There, however, we did not remain an hour; for the misconduct of a Buenos Ayrean officer on board a vessel under their colours, and a * vexatious regulation with respect to quarantine, decided my August. BUENOS AYRES—MONTE VIDEO. 95 returning forthwith to Monte Video; and commissioning a capable person to procure for me copies of some original charts, which I thought would be exceedingly useful, and which could only be obtained from the remains of hydrographical in- formation, collected by Spain, but kept in the archives of Buenos Ayres. The Beagle anchored again off Monte Video, on the 3d of August, and as soon as the circumstances which occasioned her return were made known to Captain G. W. Hamilton, commanding the Druid frigate, that ship sailed for Buenos Ayres. Scarcely had the Druid disappeared beneath the horizon, when the chief of the Monte Video police and the captain of the port came on board the Beagle to request assistance in preserving order in the town, and in preventing the aggres- sions of some mutinous negro soldiers. I was also requested by the Consul-general to afford the British residents any pro- tection in my power; and understanding that their lives, as well as property, were endangered by the turbulent mutineers, who were more than a match for the few well-disposed soldiers left in the town, I landed with fifty well-armed men, and remained on shore, garrisoning the principal fort, and thus holding the mutineers in check, until more troops were brought in from the neighbouring country, by whom they were sur- rounded and reduced to subordination. The Beagle’s crew were not on shore more than twenty-four hours, and were not called upon to act in any way ; but I was told by the principal persons whose lives and property were threatened, that the presence of those seamen certainly prevented bloodshed. Some days after this little interruption to our usual avo- cations, we sailed across the river to Point Piedras, anchored there for some hours to determine its position, then went to Cape San Antonio, and from that point (rather than cape) began our survey of the outer coast. To relate many details of so slow and monotonous an occupation as examining any shore, of which the more interesting features have long been known, could answer no good purpose, and would be very tiresome to 96 PLAN OF WRITING. 1832. a general reader; therefore I shall hasten from one place to another, dwelling only, in my way, upon the few incidents, or reflections, which may have interest enough to warrant their being noticed in this abridged narrative, or are absolutely necessary for carrying on the thread of the story. CHAPTER V. Eastern Pampa Coast—Point Medanos—Mar-chiquito—Ranges of Hills —Direction of Inlets, Shoals, and Rivers—Cape Corrientes—Tosca Coast—Blanco Bay—Mount Hermoso—Port Belgrano—Mr. Harris— Ventana Mountain— V iew—Argentina—C ommandant—Major—Situ- ation — Toriano — Indians — Fossils — Animals — Fish — Climate— Pumice — Ashes — Conway — Deliberations—Consequent Decision— Responsibility incurred — Paz — Liebre—Gale—Hunger—Fossils at Hermoso—Fossils at Point Alta—Express sent to Buenos Ayres— Suspicions and absurd alarm—Rodrignez. Ave. 22. From Cape San Antonio (which, though so called, is only a low point) to rather more than half-way towards Cape Corrientes, the sea-coast is sandy and low. Behind the beach are sand-hills, and farther inshore are thickets affording shelter to numbers of jaguars. In sailing along, even with both leads going, we were, for a few minutes, in imminent danger of grounding upon a bank, or ledge, which extends six miles E.S.E. from Point Medanos. The water shoaled so suddenly, and so irregularly, that I could not tell which way to steer ; and as we had been running directly before the wind, it was impossible to retreat by the safest track (that which we had made in approaching): however, by persevering in pushing eastward, away from the land, steering one way or another as the water deepened, we at last got clear. We then stood out to gain an offing, rounded the bank, and hauled close inshore again nearly opposite to a large salt lagoon, called Mar- chiquito, which approaches the sea so closely as to have occa- sioned an idea that, by cutting through the narrow strip of land which separates them, a fine port might be formed. Some persons assert that there is always a communication between the lagoon and the sea; that cattle cannot pass along the isthmus on account of that opening; and that a boat might swim from one to the other. If this is the case, we were much deceived on board the Beagle ; for when she passed so near the spot that the lagoon was overlooked by the officers at her mast- ¥OL. IT. H 98 MAR-CHIQUITO—RANGES OF HILLS. August heads, nothing like an opening could be detected, though the beach was scrutinized with good glasses, as well from the deck as by those who looked down upon it from aloft as we sailed by. I suspect that there has been some confusion of ideas respecting the little river San Pablo, and a supposed entrance to the lagoon: but, be this as it may, very great difficulty would be found in attempting to form a large and permanent communication at a spot so exposed to heavy south-east gales. At Port Valdez (in latitude 42° S.) the entrance is some- times completely blocked up by shingle and sand, during and after a strong south-east gale; and I think it probable that such an effect would be caused here, at times, whether there were a natural or an artificial opening; and as there is no great rise and fall of tide, I much doubt whether the opening would be again cleared, as at Port Valdez, by the mere ebb and flow of water. In the vicinity of Mar-chiquito, the country (campo) is very fertile, and well watered. Sheltered to the south by a range of down-like hills, whence numerous small brooks originate, it gives abundant pasturage to many thousands of cattle, and is considered by the Buenos Ayreans to be the finest district of their territory. This range of hills extends in a west north- west direction for more than fifty leagues, and varies in name at different places. That part next to Cape Corrientes is called Sierra Vuilcan ;* twenty leagues inland is the ridge named. Tandil, and at the western extreme is a height called Cayru. Between Tandil and Cayru there are many hills known by particular names, but they are all part of the range above- mentioned ; and it is a remarkable fact, that not only this range, that nearer to Buenos Ayres called Cerrillada, and that of which the Sierra Ventana forms a part, extend nearly in an east-south-east and west-north-west direction; but that most of the ranges of high land, most of the rivers, and the greater number of inlets, between the Plata and Cape Horn, have a similar direction, not varying from it above one point, or at most two points of the compass. After we became aware * An Indian word, which means ‘ opening,’ or ‘ having openings.’ 1832. CAPE CORRIENTES—TOSCA COAST. 99 of this peculiarity, it was far easier to avoid shoals, as they all lay in a similar direction. On a round-topped hill, near Mar-chiquito, we saw an im- mense herd of cattle, collected together in one dark-coloured mass, which covered many acres of ground. A few men, on horseback, were watching them, who, seeing us anchor, drove the whole multitude away at a gallop, and in a few minutes not one was left behind. Probably they suspected us of ma- rauding inclinations. Cape Corrientes is a bold, cliffy promontory; off which, notwithstanding the name, I could not distinguish any remark- able current. It is said to be hazardous for a boat to go along- shore, near the high cliffs of that cape, because there are rocks under water which sometimes cause sudden and extremely dangerous ‘ blind breakers.’ More than one boat’s crew has been lost there, in pursuit of seals, which are numerous among the rocks and caves at the foot of those cliffs. Hence to Bahia Blanco is a long and dreary line of coast, without an opening fit to receive the smallest sailing vessel, without a remarkable feature, and without a river whose mouth is not fordable. Even the plan of it, on paper, has such a regular figure, that an eye accustomed to charts may doubt its accuracy; so rarely does the outline of an exposed sea-coast extend so far without a break. A heavy swell always sets upon it; there is no safe anchorage near the shore; and, as if to complete its uninviting qualities, in the interior, but verging on this shore, is a desert tract, avoided even by the Indians, and called, in their lan- guage, Huecuvu-mapu (country of the Devil). In explor- ing this exposed coast, southerly winds sometimes obliged us to strugele for an offing; and we lost several anchors in conse- quence of letting them go upon ground which we thought was hard sand lying over clay, but which turned out to be tosca, slightly covered with sand, and full of holes. The lead indi- cated a sandy, though hard bottom; but we found it every where so perforated and so tough, that, drop an anchor where we might, it was sure to hook a rock-like lump-of tosea, which sometimes was torn away, but at others broke the anchor. H2 100 TOSCA—=BLANCO BAY. Sept. Finding this to be the case, I had a stout hawser ‘ bent’ to the ‘crown’ of the anchor, and after shortening in cable, tripped the anchor by the hawser, and then weighed it, uninjured, without much difficulty. Along this extent of sea-coast, half way between the cur- rents in the vicinity of the Plata, and those occasioned by strong tides near Blanco Bay and the river Negro, we found no cur- rent. Whether there was a rise of tide it was not easy to ascer- tain by the lead-line, when at anchor, from the bottom being so uneven ; and to land was impossible, on account of a furious surf. Several kinds of fish were caught at our temporary anchor- ages, and noticed carefully by Mr. Darwin. Anchorage is not a word I should use in this case (where the anchor was only let go for a short time while the ship’s position could be fixed with accuracy, and our triangulation carried on ina satisfactory manner), as it might deceive a stranger to the coast : stopping- place would be better. While examining the positions nearest to Blanco Bay, we had occasional alarms—such as the wind shifting and blowing strong directly towards the land; our soundings shoaling sud- denly to three, or less than three fathoms; or thick weather coming on while a boat was away sounding ;—but these are every-day events in a surveying vessel actively employed. Near Blanco Bay we found the water greatly discoloured, and the soundings were not such as to tempt us onwards; how- ever, it was necessary to proceed. We steered towards a little hill, which I fancied must be Mount Hermoso,* and soon after sun-set, on the 5th, anchored in what we afterwards found to be the roadstead near that hillock, at the head of Blanco Bay, close to the entrance of Port Belgrano, but divided from it by a bank. As the bad apologies for charts of this place, which we pos- sessed at our first visit, left us as much at a loss as if we had * Mount Hermoso is but 140 feet above the sea; yet, on this low coast, it is somewhat remarkable, as being the only peaked hill close to the water; and having under it a low cliffy point, the only one thereabouts. 1832. MOUNT HERMOSO—PORT BELGRANO. 101 none, I set out with the boats next morning to seek for a pas- sage into Port Belgrano.* Our boats were soon stopped by shoal water, and I found, to my vexation, that the Beagle was anchored at the head of an inlet, between the shore and a large bank extending far towards the south-east, and that before going farther west she must retreat eastward, and look for another passage. ‘This was an unexpected dilemma; but our prospect was improved by the appearance of a small schooner running towards us, from Port Belgrano, with a Buenos Ayrean (or Argentine) flag flying. Very soon she came near enough for our boat to reach her, and an Englishman came on board, who offered to pilot the Beagle to a safe anchorage within the port. This was Mr. Harris, owner of the little schooner in which he sailed, (a resi- dent at Del Carmen, on the river Negro, and trading thence along the coast), with whom we had much satisfactory inter- course during the next twelvemonth. By his advice we weighed anchor, stood across the great north bank, in very little more water than we drew, until we got into a channel where there was water enough for any ship, and a soft muddy bottom : there we hauled up west-north-west,+ by his direction, and with a fresh wind sailed rapidly into the extensive and excellent, though then little known harbour, called Port Belgrano; and at dusk anchored near the wells under Anchorstock Hill (or Point Johnson). To give an idea of the general appearance, or almost disap- pearance, of the very low Jand around this spacious port, I will mention, that when the Beagle had crossed the north bank, and hauled up in the fair way, Mount Hermoso was nearly beneath the horizon ; some bushes on the flat land southward -* Often erroneously called Bahia Blanco; a name originally given to the onter bay, in compliment to General Blanco. + So constantly did Mr. Harris give this course, on subsequent occa- sions, that it became quite a joke; but it is nevertheless a strong cor- roboration of what [ stated respecting the general direction of the inlets, and ridges, or ranges of hills. 102 MR. HARRIS*-ARGENTINA. Sept. of us (Zuraita Island) could be just distinguished ; and ahead in the north-west quarter, no land could be made out, except the distant Ventana mountain, which we saw for the first time on that day. In consequence of this extent of water bemg intersected by banks, and having so few marks, it is very difficult of access ; and no place can offer less that is agreeable to the eye, espe- cially when the tide is out, and much of the banks shows above water. A more disagreeable place to survey, or one that would occupy more time, we were not likely to find, I thought, as I looked around from the mast-head ; but upon questioning Mr. Harris, I learned that a succession of similar inlets indented a half-drowned coast, extending hence almost to the Negro ; and that, although the dangers were numerous, tides strong, banks muddy, and the shores every where low, the intervening ports were so safe, and so likely to be useful, that it was abso- lutely necessary to examine them. Sept. '7. Messrs. Darwin, Rowlett, and Harris set out with me to visit the Buenos Ayrean settlement, called Argentina. Mr. Harris undertook to be our guide, but after two hours’ sailing and pulling we found ourselves near the head of a creek, between two soft mud banks, where we could neither row nor turn the boat. We could not land because the mud was too soft to bear our weight, so there we staid till the tide flowed. -About two hours after this stoppage there was water enough for us to cross a large bank, and gain the right channel, from which we had deviated, and then, with a flowing tide, we made rapid progress, until the ‘ Guardia’ was announced to us. This was a small hut near the water side, but to reach it we had to wind along a tortuous canal, between banks of soft mud : and when we arrived at the landing-place seven hours had been passed among rushy mud banks, surrounded by which we were often prevented from seeing any solid land. The water was every where salt, the tide running strongly, and the boat often aground. Waiting to meet us was an assemblage of grotesque figures, which I shall not easily forget—a painter would have been 1832. GROTESQUE GROUP—SUSPICIONS. 103 charmed with them. A dark visaged Quixotic character, partly in uniform, mounted on a large lean horse, and attended by several wild looking, but gaily dressed gauchos,* was nearest tous. Behind him, a little on one side, were a few irregular soldiers, variously armed, and no two dressed alike, but well mounted, and desperate-looking fellows; while on the other side, a group of almost naked Indian prisoners sat devouring the remains of a half roasted horse ; and as they scowled at us savagely, still holding the large bones they had been gnawing, with their rough hair and scanty substitutes for clothing blown about by the wind, I thought I had never beheld a more sin- gular group. The tall man in uniform was the Commandant of the settle- ment, or fortress, called Argentina: he and his soldiers had arrived to welcome us, supposing that we were bringing sup- plies from Buenos Ayres for the needy colony. The Indian prisoners had been brought to work, and assist in carrying the supplies which were expected. Finding that we were neither Buenos Ayreans, nor traders from any other place, it was supposed that we must be spies sent to reconnoitre the place previous to a hostile attack. Neither the explanations nor assertions of Mr. Harris had any weight, for as he was our countryman, they naturally concluded he was in league with us; yet, as the commandant had some idea that we might, by possibility, be what we maintained we were, he disregarded the whispers and suggestions of his people, and offered to carry us to the settlement for a night’s lodging. Leaving the boat’s crew to bivouac, as usual, I accepted a horse offered to me, and took the purser up behind; Mr. Darwin and Harris being also mounted behind two gaucho soldiers, away we went across a flat plain to the settlement. Mr. Darwin was carried off before the rest of the party, to be cross-questioned by an old major, who seemed to be considered the wisest man of the detachment, and he, poor old soul, * Countrymen, employed in keeping and killing cattle, breeding and training horses, hunting, war, &c. 104 FORTALEZA—ARGENTINA. Sept. thought we were very suspicious characters, especially Mr. Darwin, whose objects seemed most mysterious. In consequence, we were watched, though otherwise most hospitably treated; and when I proposed to return, next morning, to the boat, trifling excuses were made about the want of horses and fear of Indians arriving, by which I saw that the commandant wished to detain us, but was unwilling to do so forcibly ; telling him, therefore, I should walk back, and setting out to do so, I elicited an order for horses, maugre the fears and advice of his major, who gave him all sorts of warn- ings about us. However, he sent an escort with us, and a troop of gaucho soldiers were that very morning posted upon the rising grounds nearest to the Beagle, to keep a watch on our movements. We afterwards heard, that the old major’s suspicions had been very much increased by Harris’s explanation of Mr. Darwin’s occupation. ‘ Un naturalista’ was a term unheard of by any person in the settlement, and being unluckily explained by Harris as meaning ‘a man that knows every thing,’ any further attempt to quiet anxiety was useless. As this small settlement has seldom been visited by strangers, I will describe its primitive state. In the midst of a level country, watered by several brooks, and much of it thickly covered with a kind of trefoil, stands a mud-walled erection, dignified with the sounding appellation of ‘ La fortaleza pro- tectora Argentina.’ It is a polygon, 282 yards in diameter, having about twenty-four sides, and surrounded by a narrow ditch. In some places the walls are almost twenty feet high, but in others I was reminded of the brothers’ quarrel at the building of ancient Rome, for there is a mere ditch, over which a man could jump. It is, however, said by the gauchos, that a ditch six feet wide will stop a mounted Indian, and that their houses require no further defence from attacks of the aborigines. How, or why it is that such excellent horse- men do not teach their horses to leap, I cannot understand. Within, and outside the fort, were huts (ranchos) and a few 1832. SITUATION—-ADVANTAGES. 105 small houses :—more were not required for the inhabitants, who, including the garrison, only amounted to four hundred souls. Some half-dozen brass guns were in a serviceable con- dition; and two or three other pieces occupied old carriages, but did not seem to be trustworthy. The fort was commenced in April 1828, by a French engineer, named Parchappe. The first commandant was Es- tomba : his successor, Morel, was killed, with ninety followers, by a party of Indians under Chenil, in 1829. Valle and Rojas succeeded, and the latter was followed by Rodriguez. Placed in the first instance as an advanced post, at which to watch and check the Indians, rather than asa colony likely to increase rapidly, Argentina has scarcely made any progress since its establishment, though it is the beginning of what may here- after be a considerable place. Situated favourably for com- municating with Concepcion—by way of the pass through the Cordillera, near Tucapel—it is also the only port, between 25° S. and Cape Horn, capable of receiving in security any number of the largest ships. There is pasture for cattle near the streams which descend from the ‘ Sierra Ventana:’ large salinas (spaces covered with salt) lie within an easy distance of the settlement : of brush- wood for fuel there is plenty, though there are no large trees: and report says that there are valuable minerals, including coal and iron,* in the Ventanat mountain. The most serious objection to the locality, as an agricul- tural, or even as a mere grazing district, is the want of rain. Two or three years sometimes pass without more than a slight shower; and during summer the heat is great. In winter, there are sharp frosts, sometimes snow; but neither ice nor snow ever lasts through the day. Good fresh water may be generally obtained, independent of the few running streams, by digging wells between four and * I believe there is no good foundation for this report. Mr. Darwin’s opinion is against the supposition. + The name ‘ Ventana’ was given because of an opening, at the south side, resembling a window. ‘ 106 TORIANO—INDIANS. Sept. ten feet deep: and in this way we found no difficulty in obtain- ing an ample supply. Three months before our visit to Argentina, a number of Indians had been surprised and taken prisoners by Rodriguez ; and among them was the famous old cacique, 'Toriano, whose mere namewas a terror to the frontier settlers. The commandant attacked their ‘tolderia’ (encampment) just before sunrise— when the young men were absent on an expedition—and made prisoners of the old men, women, and children. 'Toriano was shot in cold blood; with another cacique, and several Indians of infe- rior note : and his head was afterwards cut off, and preserved for some time at the fort, in order to convince his adherents of his death. Toriano was a noble Araucanian, upwards of seventy years old when surprised asleep and taken prisoner by his mer- ciless enemies. So high was his acknowledged character as a watrior, that his followers supposed him invincible; and until convinced by the melancholy spectacle seen by their spies, they would not believe him gone. Perhaps it is not generally known, that many of the most desperate incursions upon the Buenos Ayrean colonists have been made by flying troops, or hordes of Indians, whose head- quarters are in the Cordillera of the Andes, or even on the west coast, between Concepcion and Valdivia. Mounted upon excellent horses, and acquainted with every mile of the coun- try, they think lightly of a predatory or hostile excursion against a place many hundred miles distant. We returned to the Beagle without another delay among the mud-banks, and found the rising grounds (heights they could not be called), nearest the ship, occupied by the troop of gaucho soldiers. As they did not interfere with us, our surveying operations were begun, and carried on as usual. Mr. Darwin, and those who could be spared from duties afloat, roamed about the country ; and a brisk trade was opened with the soldiers for ostriches and their eggs, for deer, cavies, and armadilloes. My friend’s attention was soon attracted to some low cliffs near Point Alta, where he found some of those huge fossil 1832. FOSSILS—-ANIMALS. 107 bones, described in his work ; and notwithstanding our smiles at the cargoes of apparent rubbish which he frequently brought on board, he and his servant used their pick-axes in earnest, and brought away what have since proved to be most interesting and valuable remains of extinct animals. The soldiers appointed to watch our movements soon relaxed so far as to spend nearly all their time in hunting animals for us. Besides those already mentioned, they one day brought a fine living puma, in hopes I should offer a good price, and embark it alive; but having no wish for so troublesome a companion in our crowded little vessel, I only bargained for its skin. The soldiers made a hearty meal of the flesh, and asserted that it was good, though inferior to that of a horse, which I had seen them eating a day or two previously. Four kinds of armadilloes were described to us by these men, of which we saw but two: the quiriquincha, with nine bands ; the mataca-bola, which rolls up into a ball; the pelu- ~ do, which is large and hairy ; and the molito, of which I heard only the name. Mr. Rowlett saw a black fox, and he was told that there are wolves in the neighbourhood. Two small bur- rowing animals are also found: the zorillo, or skunk; and the tucu-tucu. While speaking of animals, I should say that the commandant (Rodriguez) told me, that he had once seen, in Paraguay, a ‘ gran bestia,’ not many months old, but which then stood about four feet high. It was very fierce, and secured by a chain. Its shape resembled that of a hog, but it had talons on its feet instead of hoofs; the snout was like a hog’s, but much longer. When half-grown, he was told that it would be capable of seizing and carrying away a horse or a bullock. I concluded that he must have seen a tapir or anta; yet as he persisted in asserting that the animal he saw was a beast of prey,* and that it was extremely rare,* I here repeat what he said. (See extract from Falkner.—Appendix—No. 11.) Abundance—I may well say shoals of fish were caught by our men, whenever we hauled the nets at a proper time (the beginning of the flood-tide); and as they were chiefly un- * Neither of which remarks apply to the Anta. 108 CLIMATE—PUMICE. Sept. known to naturalists, Mr. Earle made careful drawings of them, and Mr. Darwin preserved many in spirits. We pro- cured plenty of good fresh water from wells near the beach, and small wood for fuel in their immediate neighbourhood. The climate is delightful, and healthy to the utmost degree, notwithstanding such extensive flats, half-covered with water, and so many large mud-banks. Perhaps the tides, which rise from eight to twelve feet, and run two or three knots an hour, tend to purify the air; indeed, as the whole inlet is of salt water, there may be no cause for such effects as would be expected in similar situations near fresh water. In our rambles over the country, near Port Belgrano, we every where found small pieces of pumice-stone; and till Mr. Darwin examined the Ventana, supposed they had been thrown thence: he has, however, ascertained that it is not volcanic ; and, I believe, concludes that these fragments came from the Cordillera of the Andes.—(See Vol. III. by Mr. Darwin.) Falkner, in whose accounts of what he himself saw I have full faith, has a curious passage illustrative of this supposition ; and it is not impossible—nor even, I think, improbable—that some of the pumice we saw fell at the time mentioned in the following extract :—‘ Being in the Vuilcan, below Cape St. Anthony, I was witness to a vast cloud of ashes being carried by the winds, and darkening the whole sky. It spread over great part of the jurisdiction of Buenos Ayres, passed the river of Plata, and scattered its contents on both sides of the river, insomuch that the grass was covered with ashes. This was caused by the eruption of a volcano near Mendoza, the winds carrying the light ashes to the incredible distance of three hundred leagues or more.”—Falkner, p. 51. As an indisputable, and very recent instance of the distance to which volcanic substances are sometimes carried, I might mention the fact of H.M.S. Conway having passed through quantities of pumice-stone and ashes, in latitude 7° north, and longitude 105° west, being more than seven hundred miles from the nearest land, and eleven hundred from the voleano. near Realejo, whence it is supposed that they proceeded ; but as it is 1832. VENTANA— DELIBERATIONS. 109 possible that those substances might have been thrown out of a volcano in the Galapagos Islands, and drifted on the surface of the sea by currents, which near there run from twenty to eighty miles in twenty-four hours, towards the north-west, one cannot, with certainty, rely upon that fact as evidence of a distance to which pumice has been carried by wind. Captain Eden informed me, that the Conway was sur- rounded by ashes and pumice-stone for a day and a half (on the 5th and 6th of May 1835), and that they were supposed to have been ejected from a volcano near Realejo, at the time of the great earthquake; and an eruption which darkened the air during three days. The aborigines of these regions attach considerable impor- tance to the Ventana,* chiefly on account of its use as a land- mark ; for, rising abruptly to the height of 3,340 feet in a flat country, where there is not another hill of consequence, it is of no small use to them in their wanderings. I was told by Mr. Darwin, that he found it to be chiefly of quartz forma- tion; but I need not risk causing a mistake, by repeating here the information which he gave me, when it is given fully in his own words in the accompanying volume. After a few days’ examination of Port Belgrano, and making inquiries of Harris, as well as those persons at Argentina who knew something of the neighbouring waters and shores, I was convinced that the Beagle alone could not explore them, so far as to make her survey of any real use, unless she were to sacrifice a great deal more time than would be admissible, considering the other objects of her expedition. What then was to be done? Open boats could not explore the seaward limits of those numerous shoals which lie between Blanco Bay and the river Negro, because there are dange- rous § races,’+ and often heavy seas. The Beagle herself, no doubt, could do so, and her boats might explore the inlets ; but, the time that such a proceeding would occupy was * The Puel Indians called the Ventana Casu-hati (high hill); and the Molu-che, Vuta-calel (great bulk.) —Falkner, p. 74. + Tide-races, or ripples. 110 DECISION——-RESPONSIBILITY. Sept. alarming to contemplate. I might run along the outer line of danger in the Beagle, and connect it with the soundings m the offing; but how could an English ship surveying a fre- quented coast overlook six large ports,* only because their examination required time, and was dangerous? At last, after much anxious deliberation, I decided to hire two small schooners —or rather decked boats, schooner-rigged—from Mr. Harris, and employ them in assisting the Beagle and her boats. Mr. ‘Harris was to be in the larger, as pilot to Lieutenant Wick- ham—and his friend Mr. Roberts, also settled at Del Carmen, on the river Negro, was to be Mr. Stokes’s pilot in the smaller vessel. These small craft, of fifteen and nine tons respec- tively, guided by their owners, who had for years frequented this complication of banks, harbours, and tides, seemed to me capable of fulfilling the desired object—under command of such steady and able heads as the officers mentioned—with this great advantage ; that, while the Beagle might be procur- ing supplies at Monte Video, going with the Fuegians on her first trip to the southward, and visiting the Falkland islands, the survey of all those intricacies between Blanco Bay and San Blas might be carried on steadily during the finest time of year. One serious. difficulty, that of my not being autho- rized to hire or purchase assistance on account of the Govern- ment, I did not then dwell upon, for I was anxious and eager, and, it has proved, too sanguine. I made an agree- ment with Mr. Harris,+ on my own individual responsibility, for such payment as seemed to be fair compensation for his: stipulated services, and I did hope that if the results of these arrangements should turn out well, I should stand excused for having presumed to act so freely, and should be reim- bursed for the sum laid out, which I could soill spare. However, I foresaw and was willing to run the risk, and now console: myself for this, and other subsequent mortifications, by the reflection that the service entrusted’ to. me did not suffer. * Blanco Bay and Port Belgrano, False Bay, Green Bay, Brightman Inlet, Union Bay, and San Blas Bay. + See Appendix. 1832. PAZ—LIEBRE—REFIT. 111 The formal agreement with Mr. Harris being duly signed, I despatched him forthwith to the river Negro, in search of his vessels, and sent the purser with him to ascertain the state of things at Del Carmen, especially with a view to future supplies. They went in a small coasting vessel, belonging to another Englishman (H. Elsegood), settled at Del Carmen; for the schooner, from which Mr. Harris came to us near to Mount Hermoso, did not delay, but continued her course towards the river Negro. Our boats were constantly employed while these arrange- ments were pending, and directly they were finished, the Bea- gle got under sail to examine the entrance and outer parts of the port. or several days she was thus engaged, anchoring always at night. Ina week the schooners arrived, bringing our purser and their owners. The Paz, of about fifteen tons burthen, was as ugly and ill-built a craft as I ever saw, covered with dirt, and soaked with rancid oil. The Liebre, of about nine tons burthen, was a frigate’s barge,* raised and decked—oily like the other ; but as both had done their owners good service in procuring seal and sea-elephant oil, I saw no reason to doubt our being able to make them answer our pur- pose. Yet the prospect for those who had so handsomely volunteered to go in any thing, with or without a deck, could not be otherwise than extremely unpleasant; for they did not then foresee how soon a thorough cleansing and complete outfit would be given to both vessels, and how different they would afterwards appear. Lieutenant Wickham, with the sailmaker, armourer, cooper, and a small party, were immediately established under tents, on the banks of a small creek (Arroyo Pareja). The little schooners were hauled ashore for examination and a thorough refit; and then, having left them the stores and other neces- saries which they would require, I went with the Beagle towards Blanco Bay; completed the examination of a narrow though deep channel, by which any ship may * She had been the barge of the Brazilian frigate Piranga. 11% GALE—HUNGER—FOSSILS. Sept. enter Port Belgrano, passed round the great north bank, and again anchored under Mount Hermoso. While some officers and men were on shore there, building a sea-mark on the mount, and otherwise employed for the survey, a gale of wind cameon from S.E., which soon sent so heavy a sea into the road- stead near the mount, that the Beagle was obliged to strike topmasts and veer a long scope of cable upon two anchors, besides having another under foot. Unluckily, our party on shore had only one day’s provisions, so while the gale lasted their situation was sufficiently disagreeable; the keen air and hard exercise sharpening their appetites, while they had nothing to eat after the first day; and having no guns, they had no prospect of procuring anything. Mr. Darwin was also on shore, having been searching for fossils, and he found this trial of hunger quite long enough to satisfy even his love of adventure. Directly it was possible to put a boat on the water, one was sent, with provisions secured in a cask which was thrown overboard at the back of the surf, and soon drifted ashore to the famishing party. This gale lasted several days, and proved to us not only how heavy a sea is thrown into this bight (rincon, Sp.), by a south-east gale; but also, that the holding-ground is sufficiently good to enable a ship to withstand its effects. One of our party on shore (who is not likely to forget building a mark on Mount Hermoso) discovered many curious fossils in some low cliffs under the mount; and judging from what Mr. Darwin then found, future collectors may reap a rich harvest there, as well as at Point Alta. We next returned to the Wells, and while some assisted the outfit of Lieutenant Wickham’s little vessels, others explored the upper parts of the port, quite to its end, and Mr. Darwin took advantage of the opportunity to make some of those interesting excursions which he describes in his volume. At this time there were no soldiers to watch us, neither was there any longer a suspicion of our character ; for it appeared that an express had been sent off to Buenos Ayres, at our first arrival, giving an exaggerated and rather ludicrous account of Oct. 1832. ABSURD ALARMS. 113 our officers, instruments and guns—to which an answer had been immediately returned, desiring the commandant to afford us every facility in his power, and checking the old major rather sharply for his officious and unnecessary caution. Had we not been hastily treated in the roads of Buenos Ayres, when I went there to communicate with the Government, and obtain information, I should doubtless have carried with me orders, or a letter, to this commandant, which would have prevented a moment’s suspicion: but, as it happened, no real delay was occasioned, and no person was much disturbed except the major, who fancied that our brass guns were dis- guised field-pieces, our instruments lately invented engines of extraordinary power, our numerous boats intended expressly for disembarking troops ; and an assertion of mine, that any number of line-of-battle ships might enter the port, a sure indication that the Beagle was sent to find a passage for large ships: which would soon appear, and take possession of the country. Such was the substance of his communication to the Government at Buenos Ayres, and as he acted as secretary— (Rodriguez being a man of action rather than words)—he had free scope for his disturbed imagination. I shall not easily forget his countenance, when I first told him—thinking he would be glad to hear it-—that there was a deep channel leading from Blanco Bay to the Guardia near Argentina, and that a line-of-battle ship could approach within gunshot of the place where I first met the commandant. He certainly thought himself almost taken prisoner ; and I really believe that if he had been commanding officer, we should have been sent in chains to Buenos Ayres, or perhaps still worse treated. Fortunately, Rodriguez the commandant, being a brave man, and a gentleman, contemplated no such measures. VOL. Il. I CHAPTER VI. Beagle sails with Paz and Liebre—Part company—Beagle visits Buenos Ayres—Nautical remarks on the Plata—Sail from Monte Video for San Blas—Lieut. Wickham and tenders—Butterflies—Sail for Tierra del Fuego—W hite-water—Icebergs—Rocks— Cape San Sebastian— Oens-men—Cape San Diego—Good Success Bay—Natives— Guana- coes—Cape Horn-—St. Martin Cove—Gales—Heavy Seas—Nassau Bay—Goree Road—Prepare to land Matthews and the Fuegians. 18th October. No person who had only seen the Paz and Liebre in their former wretched condition, would easily have recognised them after being refitted, and having indeed almost a new equipment. Spars altered, and improved rigging, well-cut sails, fresh paint,* and thorough cleanliness, had transformed the dirty sealing craft into smart little cock-boats : and as they sailed out of Port Belgrano with the Beagle, their appear- ance and behaviour were by no means discouraging. At dusk, Lieutenant Wickham and his small party of ven- turous associates separated from us, and steered into False Bay.t The Beagle anchored for the night, and next day pur- sued her route towards Monte Video, where she arrived on the 26th. Desirous of communicating with the Government at Buenos Ayres, and measuring the difference of meridians between that city and Monte Video, we weighed anchor on the 31st, pro- ceeded up the river, and remained in the outer roadstead, off Buenos Ayres, until the 10th of November. We then em- ployed three days in verifying the positions of some banks, as laid down in Heywood’s and other charts, and returned to Monte Video on the 14th. * Or rather red-ochre, coal-tar, and white-washs + See orders to Lieut. Wickham, in the Appendix. t Ortiz, Chico, and Ensenada. 1832. NAUTICAL REMARKS—SAIL. 115 It is not prudent for any vessel drawing more than ten feet water to remain under sail in this part of the river, while it is dark, unless a good pilot is on board ; and even the best prac- tical experience is not always a sure guide, so uncertain and fluctuating are the currents and depths of water. There are a few simple precautions, useful in such circumstances, of which I may be excused for reminding young sailors. A ground-log ought to be hove frequently, and compared with a common log; there should be a leadsman in each chains, one, at least, of whom should sound constantly : the deep-sea lead* ought to be used now and then, even in shallow water, as a check upon the hand-lead: from the vessel’s draught of water to two fathoms more than that depth, the hand-line should be marked to feet, by alternate marks of dark-coloured hair and small line: strong lanterns should be suspended under the chain-wales, near the water, but close to the ship’s side; while a careful person ought to superintend the leadsman, and occa- sionally take a line into his own hand, so that by ‘ plumbing’ the bottom himself he may ascertain how far reliance is to be placed upon the leadsman’s opinion. In the Plata, as well as in many other pilot-waters, to feel the ground thus is often more useful than knowing the precise depth of water, or even the colour, or nature, of the bottom. 27th Nov. Our arrangements and observations being satis- factorily completed, a sufficient quantity of provision on board to last eight months, at full allowance, and an extra sup- ply of iron and coals for the forge, in case of any serious accident, the Beagle sailed from Monte Video; and, after filling water near Cape Jesu Maria,+ hastened to look after her little assistants, left near Bahia Blanco. In this trip we benefitted by the assistance of Mr. Robert N. Hamond, an early and much esteemed friend of mine, who was lent to the Beagle from H.M.S. Druid, of which he was then a mate. * Massey’s is preferable, + Above Monte Video, on the north shore. 12 116 OFF SAN BLAS. Dec. December $d. Soon after daylight we saw the very low islands, just to the northward of San Blas. I wished to have made Point Rubia, but was set twenty miles northward, during the night, by the flood tide. We stood directly towards the shore, but when eight miles from it found a wide breadth of discoloured water, and the depth shoaled suddenly from ten to three fathoms ina few casts of the lead. Hauling off, we steered southward, with the ebb tide. There was no ripple on the banks, but the water was quite yellow, and at the time we altered our course, in consequence of such shallow water, the nearest land was, at least, eight miles distant. While tracing the outer edge of this bank we descried our cock-boats coming out to meet us, and soon afterwards Mr. Wickham came on board. He gave us gratifying news with little drawback ; but had he been half-roasted his own appearance could hardly have been more changed. Notwith- standing the protection of a huge beard, every part of his face was so scorched and blistered by the sun that he could hardly speak, much less join in the irresistible laugh. at his own expense. His companions were similarly sun-burned, though not to such a degree. ‘Fhey had been much occupied in sounding extensive banks and harbours, under a hot sun, and while a fresh wind kept them constantly wet with spray. But this inconvenience was trifling; one of more importance was excessive sea-sickness, in consequence of the short and violent movements of such small craft under sail among the tide-races and eddies so numerous on that coast. In other respects all had prospered so well, that I deter- mined to give Mr. Wickham fresh orders,* enlarging conside- rably his share of surveying operations, He was desired to continue exploring the coast, even as far as Port Desire, until the Beagle’s return from her visit to Tierra del Fuego and the Falkland Islands. Astheweather promised well, an anchor was dropped where we were, outside the banks, but the schooners sought shelter in the harbour of San Blas. Next day they came out and anchored * See Appendix. 1832. PAZ—LIEBRE—BUTTERFLIES. 117 close to us, in order to receive stores and various supplies which we had brought for them from Buenos Ayres and Monte Video. I was a little uneasy when I saw that the pilot of the Liebre, Mr. Roberts, was one of the largest of men, and that his little vessel looked, by comparison, no bigger than a coffin ; but Mr. Wickham allayed my doubts by assuring me that his moveable weight answered admirably in trimming the craft; and that, when she got a-ground, Mr. Roberts stepped overboard, and heaved her afloat. ‘‘ Certainly,” said Mr. Wick- ham, “he did harm on one day, by going up to look-out, and breaking the mast.” In the afternoon of this day (4th) we weighed anchor and parted company from the Paz and Liebre. ‘They returned to San Blas, and the Beagle steered southward. Secure and capacious as is the port just mentioned, it is one of the most difficult and dangerous to enter on this coast. The best, indeed only approach to it, is called by those sealers and sea- elephant fishers who have hitherto frequented it,—‘ Hell-gate.’ At about four the weather was very hot, the sky cloudless, and varying flaws of wind drove quantities of gossamer, and numbers of insects off from the land. The horizon was strangely distorted by refraction, and I anticipated some vio- lent change. Suddenly myriads of white butterflies surrounded the ship, in such multitudes, that the men exclaimed, ‘‘it is snowing butterflies.” They were driven before a gust from the north-west, which soon increased to a double-reefed topsail breeze, and were as numerous as flakes of snow in the thickest shower. The space they occupied could not have been less than two hundred yards in height, a mile in width, and several miles in length. Our next object was to visit Tierra del Fuego, examine some portions of that country—yet unexplored—and restore the Fuegians to their native places ; but in our passage, strong southerly winds, severe squalls, and cold weather, though it was near midsummer in that hemisphere, caused delay and discom- fort, as they must always in a small and deeply-laden vessel, where little can be done except in fine weather. 118 WHITE WATER—ICEBERGS. Dec. - We passed through a space of sea,* many miles in extent, where the water was of a very much lighter colour than usual ; not of a light-green or muddy hue, such as one sees near land, but of a milky white tint. Being in soundings, one naturally attributed such a change of colour to some peculiarity in the ground ; but I have since thought differently, and am now inclined to believe that the light-coloured water came from a distance, in one of those great, though slow-moving currents, which sweep past the Falkland Islands, and thence northwards : but to what cause its unusual whiteness is to be attributed, I know not. The dissolution of a huge iceberg, or of many ice- bergs, might alter the colour, and certainly would change the temperature of a considerable body of water ; but in this case, a thermometer immersed in the sea did not indicate a degree lower than that of the previous or following day. During the three days, our soundings varied only from fifty to sixty fathoms. The lead certainly brought up fine grey sand while the water was light-coloured, and dark sand at other times ; but I can hardly think that so decided a change— different from any I noticed elsewhere—could have been caused in fifty fathoms water by so small an alteration in the quality of the bottom. Icebergs have been seen in latitude 40° S., and near the lon- gitude of 50° W.; perhaps they are sometimes carried nearer the coast, in which case they would ground, and melt away. — I suspect that some of the rocks, so often, yet so fruitlessly, sought for—and instead of which many persons have supposed dead whales, wrecks, or large trees, were seen—may have been icebergs, against and upon which sea-weed, drift-wood, or other substances, may have lodged temporarily, causing a rock-like appearance. In this way, perhaps, arose the report of a rock said to have been seen by Lieutenant Burdwood ; of the Aigle and Ariel rocks—and even of those islets sought for ineffec- tually by Weddell, a few degrees eastward of the Falkland Islands. + * Lat. 46%S. Long. 63° W. + On this subject there are a few more remarks, under the head—Cur- rents of the ocean,—in the last chapter but one. 1832. TIERRA DEL FUEGO. 119 In the first volume some notice was taken of the supposed Ariel Rocks, and I will avail myself of this opportunity to say that at various times the Beagle passed over and near their asserted position; and that she likewise searched for the reported Aigle shoal or rock, without ever finding the slightest indication of either. On the 15th, we saw the land off Tierra del Fuego, near Cape San Sebastian, and next day closed the shore about Cape Sunday, ran along it past Cape Penas, and anchored off Santa Inez. A group of Indians was collected near Cape Penas, who watched our motions attentively. They were too far off for us to make out more than that they were tall men, on foot, nearly naked, and accompanied by several large dogs. To those who had never seen man in his savage state—one of the most painfully interesting sights to his civilized brother—even this distant glimpse of the aborigines was deeply engaging ; but York Minster and J emmy Button asked me to fire at them, saying that they were “‘ Oens-men—very bad men.” Our Fuegian companions seemed to be much elated at the certainty of being so near their own country ; and the boy was never tired of telling us how excellent his land was—how glad his friends would be to see him—and how well they would treat us in return for our kindness to him. We remained but a few hours at anchor under Cape Santa Inez, for so heavy a swell set in, directly towards the shore, caused probably by a northerly gale at a distance, that our situation was dangerous as well as disagreeable. Our only chance of saving the anchor and chain was by weighing imme- diately ; yet if we did so, there would be a risk of drifting ashore : however, we did weigh, and drifted some distance, roll- ing our nettings in; but a breeze sprung up, freshened rapidly, and soon carried us out of danger. This happened at three in the morning, so my hopes of observations and angles were frus- trated, and I had no choice but to run for the strait of Le Maire. At noon, very high breakers were reported by the mast-head man, off Cape San Diego; at that time the flood-tide was set- 120 GOOD SUCCESS BAY. Dec. ting strongly against a northerly wind and high swell; but when the tide was slack, at one, the breakers disappeared ; and when we passed close to the cape, at two, the water was com- paratively smooth. There is a ledge extending from Cape San Diego, over which the flood-tide, coming from the southward, sometimes breaks with such violence, that a small vessel might be swamped by the ¢ bore’ which it occasions. As we sailed into Good Success Bay, a Fuegian yell echoed among the woody heights, and shout after shout succeeded from a party of natives, posted on a projecting woody emi- nence, at the north head of the bay, who were seen waving skins, and beckoning to us with extreme eagerness. Finding that we did not notice them, they lighted a fire, which instantly sent up a volume of thick white smoke. I have often been astonished at the rapidity with which the Fuegians produce this effect (meant by them as a signal) in their wet climate, where I have been, at times, more than two hours attempting to kindle a fire. Scarcely was our ship secured, when the wind shifted to south-west, and blew strongly, bringing much rain with it ; and we had indeed reason to rejoice at having attained so secure an anchorage. During the night, heavy squalls (williwaws) disturbed our rest very often, but did no injury, the water being quite smooth. 18th. Mr. Darwin, Mr. Hamond and others, went with me ‘to the natives who had so vociferously greeted our arrival ; and deeply indeed was I interested by witnessing the effect caused in their minds by this first meeting with man in such a totally savage state. There were five or six stout men, half-clothed in guanaco- skins, almost like the Patagonians in aspect and stature, being near six feet high, and confident in demeanour. They scarcely bore resemblance to the Fuegians, except in colour and class of features. I can never forget Mr. Hamond’s earnest expression, «< What a pity such fine fellows should be left in such a bar- barous state!” It told me that a desire to benefit these igno- 1832. INTERESTING MEETING, 121 rant, though by no means contemptible human beings, was a natural emotion, and not the effect of individual caprice or erro- neous enthusiasm ; and that his feelings were exactly in unison with those I had experienced on former occasions, which had led to my undertaking the heavy charge of those Fuegians whom I brought to England. Disagreeable, indeed painful, as is even the mental contem- plation of a savage, and unwilling as we may be to consider ourselves even remotely descended from human beings in such a state, the reflection that Caesar found the Britons painted and clothed in skins, like these Fuegians, cannot fail to aug- ment an interest excited by their childish ignorance of matters familiar to civilized man, and by their healthy, independent state of existence. One of these men was just six feet high, and stout in proportion ; the others were rather shorter: their legs were straight and well formed, not cramped and mis- shapen, like those of the natives who go about in canoes; and their bodies were rounded and smooth. They expressed satis- faction or good will by rubbing or patting their own, and then our bodies; and were highly pleased by the antics of a man belonging to the boat’s crew, who danced well and was a good mimic. One of the Fuegians was so like York Minster, that he might well have passed for his brother. He asked eagerly for “ cuchillo.” -About his eyes were circles of white paint, and his upper lip was daubed with red ochre and oil. Another man was rubbed over with black. They were (apparently) very good-humoured, talked and played with the younger ones of our party, danced, stood up back to back with our tallest men to compare heights, and began to try their strength in wrest- ling—but this I stopped. It was amusing and interesting to see their meeting with York and Jemmy, who would not acknowledge them as countrymen, but laughed at and mocked them. It was evident that both of our Fuegians understood much of the language in which the others talked; but they would not try to interpret, alleging that they did not know enough. York betrayed this by bursting into an immoderate fit of laughter at something the oldest man told him, which 122 GUANACOES—CAPE HORN. Dec. he could not resist telling us was, that the old man said he was dirty, and ought to pull out his beard. Now, if their language differed much from that of York Minster, or was indeed other than a dialect of the same original, it is not probable that York could have understood the old man’s meaning so readily when he spoke quietly, without signs. Richard Matthews was with us, but did not appear to be at all discouraged by a close inspection of these natives. He remarked to me, that “they were no worse than he had sup- posed them to be.” 20th. Soon after day-light this morning, some very large guanacoes were seen near the top of Banks Hill.* They walked slowly and heavily, and their tails hung down to their hocks. To me their size seemed double that of the guanacoes about Port Desire. Mr. Darwin and a party set off to ascend the heights, anxious to get a shot at the guanacoes and obtain an extended view, besides making observations. They reached the summit, and saw several large animals, whose long woolly coats and tails added to their real bulk, and gave them an appearance quite distinct from that of the Patagonian animal ; but they could not succeed in shooting one. 21st. Sailed from Good Success Bay. On the 22d we saw Cape Horn, and being favoured with northerly winds, passed close to the southward of it before three o’clock. The wind then shifted to north-west, and began to blow strong. Squalls came over the heights of Hermite Island, and a very violent one, with thick weather, decided my standing out to sea for the night under close-reefed topsails. The weather continued bad and very cold during that night and next day. On the morning of the 24th, being off Cape Spencer, with threatening weather, a high sea, the barometer low, and great heavy-looking white clouds rising in the south-west, indicative . of a gale from that quarter, I determined to seek for an an- chorage, and stood into (the so-calledt) St. Francis Bay. In * So named in remembrance of Sir Joseph Banks’s excursion. + In the first volume doubts are expressed (in a note to page 199) respecting the place named by D’Arquistade, St. Francis Bay; or rather I said’ 1832. ST, MARTIN COVE—CONTRAST. 123 passing Cape Spencer we were assailed by such a furious hail- squall, that for many minutes it was quite impossible to look to windward, or even to see what was a-head of us. We could not venture to wear round, or even heave to, for fear of getting so far to leeward as to lose our chance of obtaining an anchorage ; however, we stood on at hazard, and the squall passed away soon enough to admit of our anchoring in seventeen-fathoms water, quite close to a steep promontory at the south side of St. Martin Cove. After being for some time accustomed to the low barren shores and shallow harbours of the Pampa and Patagonian coasts, our position almost under this black precipice was sin- gularly striking. The decided contrast of abrupt, high, and woody mountains, rising from deep water, had been much remarked in Good Success Bay ; but here it was so great that I could hardly persuade myself that the ship was in security —sufliciently far from the cliff.* 25th. Notwithstanding violent squalls, and cold damp weather, we kept our Christmas merrily; certainly, not the less so, in consequence of feeling that we were in a secure posi- tion, instead of being exposed to the effects of a high sea and heavy gale. I said, that “Ido not think the bay adjacent to Cape Horn is that which was named by D’Arquistade, ‘St. Francis,’ and, if my supposition is correct, Port Maxwell is not the place which was called ‘ St. Bernard’s Cove.’ ” If the modern chart be compared with that issued by the Admiralty a few years ago, published by Faden in 1818, it will be seen that the par- ticular plan of St. Francis Bay, given in Faden’s chart, agrees much better with the west side of Nassau Bay than with any other place ; and that the “remarkable island, like a castle,’ noticed in the plan, is evidently “ Packsaddle Island,” of the modern chart. The rough sketch of land towards the north and east, as far as Cape Horn, on that plan, I take to be the random outline of land seen at a distance by the person who drew the plan, and the name “ Cape Horn,” affixed to the southernmost land then in sight; which must have been Cape Spencer. But it is now too late to remedy the mistake, which is indeed of no consequence. * As the shores of ‘Tierra del Fuego are so much spoken of in other places, I say no more of them here. 124 GALES—DIEGO RAMIREZ. Jan. At sun-set, there was a reddish appearance all over the sky —clouds shot over the summits of the mountains in ragged detached masses—and there was a lurid haze around, which showed a coming storm as surely as a fall of the barometer. The gale increased, and at midnight such furious squalls came down from the heights, that the water was swept up, and clouds of foam were driven along the sea. Although we were close to a weather shore, with our top-gallant masts down and yards braced sharp up, we hardly thought ourselves in secu- rity with three anchors down and plenty of chain cable out.* Dec. 1. Tired and impatient at the delay caused by bad weather, we put to sea again the first day there was a hope of not being driven eastward ; and during a fortnight we tried hard to work our way towards Christmas Sound. My purpose was to land York Minster and Fuegia Basket among their own people, near March Harbour, and return eastward through the Beagle Channel, landing Jemmy Button also with his tribe, the Tekeenica. Part of Whale-boat Sound and the wes- tern arms of the Beagle Channel were to be surveyed : and by this scheme I proposed to combine both objects. Jan. 2d. We were rather too near the Diego Ramirez Islands, during a fresh gale of wind, with much sea; but by carrying a heavy press of sail, our good little ship weathered them cleverly, going from seven and a half to eight knots an hour, under close-reefed topsails and double-reefed courses— the top-gallant-masts being on deck. On the 5th, the same islands were again under our lee—a sufficient evidence that we did not make westing. In fact, no sooner did we get a few reefs out, than we began taking them * During’such sudden, and at times tremendous squalls as these, it is absolutely necessary to have a long scope of cable out, although the ves- sel may be in smooth water, in order that the first fury of the blast may be over before the cable is strained tight ; for otherwise, the chain or anchor might snap. When the violence of the squall is past, the weight of a chain cable sinking down, draws the ship a-head, so far as to admit of her recoiling again at the next williwaw; thus, a kind of elasticity may be given to a chain, in some degree equivalent to that always possessed by a hemp cable. 1833. GALES—CRITICAL TIME. 125 in again; and although every change of wind was turned to account, as far as possible, but little ground was gained. On the 11th we saw that wild-looking height, called York Minster, ‘looming’ among driving clouds, and I flattered my- self we should reach an anchorage ; but after tearing through heavy seas, under all the sail we could carry, darkness and a succession of violent squalls, accompanied by hail and rain, obliged me to stand to seaward, after being within a mile of our port. All the next day we were lying-to in a heavy gale —wearing occasionally. At three in the morning of the 13th, the vessel lurched so deeply, and the main-mast bent and quivered so much, that I reluctantly took in the main-topsail (small as it was when close- reefed), leaving set only the storm-trysails (close-reefed) and fore-staysail.* At ten, there was so continued and heavy a rush of wind, that even the diminutive trysails oppressed the vessel too much, and they were still farther reduced. Soon after one, the sea had risen to a great height, and I was anxiously watching the successive waves, when three huge rollers ap- proached, whose size and steepness at once told me that our sea-boat, good as she was, would be sorely tried. Having steerage way, the vessel met and rose over the first unharmed, but, of course, her way was checked ; the second deadened her way completely, throwing her off the wind; and the third great sea, taking her right a-beam, turned her so far over, that all the lee bulwark, from the cat-head tothe stern davit, was two or three feet under water. For a moment, our position was critical; but, like a cask, she rolled back again, though with some feet of water over the whole deck. Had another sea then struck her, the little ship might have been numbered among the many of her class which have disappeared : but the crisis was past—she shook the sea off her through the ports, and was none the worse—excepting * I have always succeeded in carrying a close-reefed main-topsail (five reefs) in the Beagle, excepting on this and two other occasions ; but were T again under similar circumstances, I think I should try to carry it— even then—for some time longer. 126 GALES—HASTY OPINIONS Jan. the loss of a lee-quarter boat, which, although carried three feet higher than in the former voyage (1826-1830), was dipped under water, and torn away.* From that time the wind abated, and the sea became less high.+ The main-topsail was again set, though with difficulty, and at four o'clock the fore-topsail and double-reefed foresail were helping us towards False Cape Horn, my intention being to anchor in Nassau Bay. When the quarter-boat was torn away, we were between the Ildefonsos and Diego Ramirez : the wind varying from W.S.W. to S.W. This gale was severely felt on all parts of the coast, south of 48°, as I afterwards ascertained from sealing-vessels: and at the Falkland Islands, a French whaler, called Le Magellan, was driven from her anchors and totally wrecked in that land- locked and excellent port, Berkeley Sound. Some persons are disposed to form a very premature opinion of the wind or weather to be met with in particular regions, judging only from what they may themselves have expe- rienced. Happily, extreme cases are not often met with; but one cannot help regretting the haste with which some men (who have sailed round Cape Horn with royals set) incline to cavil at and doubt the description of Anson and other navi- gators, who were not only far less fortunate as to weather, but had to deal with crazy ships, inefficient crews, and unknown shores ; besides hunger, thirst, and disease. Before midnight we anchored under shelter of the land * It was well that all our hatchways were thoroughly secured, and that nothing heavy could break a-drift. But little water found its way to the lower deck, though Mr. Darwin’s collections, in the poop and forecastle cabins on deck, were much injured. Next to keeping a sharp look-out upon the sky, the water, and the barometer, we were always anxious to batten down our hatches in time—especially at night, during a gale, or in very squally weather. + The roller which hove us almost on our beam ends, was the highest and most hollow that I have seen, excepting one in the Bay of Biscay, and one in the Southern Atlantic; yet so easy was our little vessel that nothing was injured besides the boat, the netting (washed away), and one chronometer. 1833. NASSAU BAY—GOREE ROAD. 127 near False Cape Horn; and next morning (14th) crossed Nas- sau Bay in search of a convenient harbour near the Beagle Channel. Having found so much difficulty in getting to the westward by the open sea, I decided to employ boats in the interior passages, and leave the Beagle at a secure anchorage. Furious squalls prevented our effecting this purpose ; and we anchored for the night in Windhond Bay.* The following day (15th) we again tried to get to the head or north-west corner of Nassau Bay, but ineffectually, for repeated squalls opposed us, and at last obliged me to bear up for Goree Road ; one of the most spacious, accessible, and safe anchorages in these regions. Here, to my surprise, York Minster told me that he would rather live with Jemmy Button in the Tekeenica country than go to his own people. This was a complete change in his ideas, and I was very glad of it; because it might be far better that the three, York, Jemmy, and Fuegia, should settle together. I little thought how deep a scheme master York had in contem- plation. 18th. Having moored the Beagle in security, and made arrangements for the occupation of those who were to remain on board, I set out with four boats (yawl and three whale- boats), carrying Matthews and the Fuegians, with all the stock of useful things which had been given to them in England.+ A temporary deck having been put upon the yawl, she carried a large cargo, and was towed by the other boats when the wind was adverse. Matthews showed no sign of hesitation or reluctance ; on the contrary, he was eager to begin the trial to which he had been so long looking forward. Messrs. Darwin, Bynoe, Hamond, Stewart, and Johnson, with twenty-four seamen and marines, completed the party. My intention was to go round the north-east part of Navarin Island, along the eastern arm of the Beagle Channel, through Murray Narrow, to the spot which Jemmy called his country : * So named by the Dutch in 1624, after one of their ships, the Wind- hond. + By far the larger part of their property, including Matthews’s outfit, was sent by Mr. Coates, Secretary of the Church Missionary Society. 128 ARRANGEMENTS. Jan. 1833- there establish the Fuegians, with Matthews :—leave them for a time, while I continued my route westward toex- plore the western arms of the channel, and part of Whale- boat Sound: and at my return thence decide whether Mat- thews should be left among the natives for a longer period, or return with me to the Beagle. But before I briefly relate this attempt to form a temporary settlement among the Fuegians, it may be advisable to give a general sketch of the aborigines who thinly people the south- ernmost regions of South America: including not only the various tribes of Fuegians (as far as we know them), but the Patagonians, and those natives of Western Patagonia wha are supposed to be a remnant of the tribe called Chonos. CHAPTER VII. SOUTHERN ABORIGINES OF SOUTH AMERICA. Or the tribes which scantily people Patagonia and ‘Tierra del Fuego, far less is yet known than might generally be expected. Although frequently seen by white men, and often holding intercourse with them, probably no person even mode- rately educated, excepting Falkner, has staid among them long enough to become acquainted with, and describe their peculiarities. . His description of the aboriginal natives who, in his time (1'740-80), roamed over the fertile ‘ Pampas’ of Buenos Ayres, or the sterile plains of Patagonia; of the western mountaineers ; and of those unconquerable tribes which repulsed the Peruvian Yncas, opposed Spanish conquerors, and are still independent, is so decidedly corroborated by Molina, by many Spanish authors, and by modern testimony, that in attempting to de- scribe the Patagonians, I shall try to unite his account (bear- ing in mind the time elapsed, and consequent changes) to the information which has been obtained during late years. Of the Fuegians, a few notices are to be found in narratives of various voyagers ; but the imperfect description here given is principally derived from the natives who went to England in the Beagle; and from Mr. Low, who has seen more of them in their own country than any other person. About the middle of the last century, the aboriginal inhabi- tants of that portion of South America which lies between the parallels of thirty and forty, formed two principal divisions, more or less separated by the only real barrier existing in that extent of country, the Cordillera of the Andes. Those who lived eastward of the Andes were called ¢ Puel-che,’ signifying VOL. Ii: K 130 SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. east people; and those on the other side were known by the term ‘ Molu-che,’ which signifies war people, or warriors: and these terms are still in habitual use. Numerous subdivisions have perplexed all whose attention has been attracted to the aboriginal population of Southern America. Falkner’s account is the least confused, in every way the most probable, and agrees the best with what is now found to be the condition of that portion of uncivilized man. For our present purpose, I believe, ‘it will be sufficient to remark, that the Puel-che and Molu-che called the tribes who lived towards the south, ‘ T'ehuel-het’* and ‘ Huilli-che,’ both of which terms signify people of the south. The Huilli- che were again divided into Pichi Huilli-che and Vuta Huilli- che ; ‘ pichi,’ meaning little; and ‘vuta,’ great. Both the Tehuel-het and the Vuta Huilli-che lived to the southward of forty degrees of latitude. A branch or tribe of the Tehuel-het who lived farthest towards the south, on the eastern side, had no horses, and that tribe was called ‘ Yacana-kunny,’+ (foot people). Westward of those people, separated from them by a ridge of mountains, was a tribe called Key-uhue, Key-yus, or Key-es ; and northward, the Sehuau-kunny}. Falkner, in his account, rather confuses the habits of the Yacana-kunny with those of the Key-uhue, which is not to be wondered at, as he described those tribes solely from the accounts of others. The Key-uhue have neither ‘bowls,’ or balls (bolas), nor ‘ostriches, (see Falkner, p. 111), in their rugged tempestuous islands: neither do the Yacana-kunny ‘live chiefly on fish” The former live on fish, while the latter kill guanacoes, birds, and seals. Between the Key-uhue and the Chonos tribe were the Poy- yus, or Pey-es, living on the sea-coast. The Chonos inhabited the Archipelago so called, and part of Childe. These three last-mentioned tribes—Key-uhue, Poy-yus, and Chonos—were called ‘ Vuta Huilli-che.’ * Called by themselves ‘ Tehuel-kunny.’ + ‘Che,’ ‘ het,’ and ‘ kunny,’ signify people, in different dialects. { The Sehuau-kunny are a part of the ‘Tehuel-bet. SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. 131 Rather than occupy time in attempting to give an account of the past state of these ever-varying tribes,—whose numbers have been so much altered, and whose locations may be now changed,—I will endeavour to give some idea of the present condition, distribution, and probable numbers of the people called Patagonians; of the natives of Tierra del Fuego, or Fuegians, and of the western tribe called Chonos. By those who have frequented the Strait of Magalhaens or its vicinity, the latter are often called ‘ Canoe Indians;’ and the Patago- nians, ‘ Horse Indians.’ The Patagonians (‘Tehuel-het) travel on horseback over the country between the River Negro and the Strait of Magalhaens; from the Atlantic to the Cordillera of the Andes. They have no boats or canoes of any kind ; and their disposition, habits, and language are very different from those of the Fuegians (Ya- cana-kunny, Key-uhue, and Poy-yus). 'Those who live in the north-eastern part of Tierra del Fuego have neither canoes nor horses. The natives of the southern and western islands, and of the shores of Otway and Skyring waters, also the people who live upon the western islands and coast of Patagonia, have canoes, but no horses. The Patagonians are now divided into four parties, each of which has a separate though ill-defined territory. Each of these parties has a leader, or cacique; but they speak one language, and are evidently subdivisions of one tribe. When mutually convenient, they all assemble in one place: but if food be- comes scarce, or quarrels happen, each party withdraws to its own territory. At such times one body will encroach upon the hunting grounds of another, and a battle is the consequence. About four hundred adults, and a rather large proportion of children, are in each of these parties: the number of women being to that of the men as three to one. Near the Strait of Ma- galhaens about fourteen hundred Patagonians have been lately seen encamped together fora short time ; but usually there is only one horde, of about four hundred grown people, in that neighbourhood. Less is known of the Yacana-kunny than of any other tribe, a4 132 SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. or portion of a tribe. It may consist of about six hundred men and women, besides children. Beyond a range of high mountains to the southward of the Yacana, is the tribe formerly called Key-uhue, now probably the Tekeenica. These are the smallest, and apparently the most wretched of the Fuegians. They inhabit the shores and neigh- bourhood of the Beagle Channel. The number of adults in this tribe may be about five hundred. (Note 1.) To the westward, between the western part of the Beagle Channel and the Strait of Magalhaens, is a tribe now called Alikhoolip (which may be the Poy-yus), whose numbers amount perhaps to four hundred. About the central parts of Magalhaens Strait is a small and very miserable horde, whose name J do not know. Their usual exclamation is ‘ Pecheray !’ ‘ Pecheray !’ whence Bougainville and others called them the Pecherais. For want of a more correct term I shall here use the same word. The number of adults among them is about two hundred. Near Otway and Skyring waters is a tribe, or fraction of a tribe, whose name I could not learn; for the present I shall call them ‘ Huemul’—because they have many skins of a kind of roebuck, which is said to be the animal described by Molina as the ‘ Huemul’ *. Their number may be one hundred, or thereabouts. I am inclined to think that these Huemul Indians are a branch of the Yacana people, whom Falkner describes as living on both sides of the Strait. On the western coast of Patagonia, between the Strait of Ma- galhaens and the Chonos Archipelago, there is now but one. tribe, in which there are not above four hundred grown people. Each of the tribes here specified speaks a language differing from that of any other, though, as I believe, not radically dif- ferent from the aboriginal Chilian. Some words are common to two or more tribes; as may be seen by reference to the frag- ment of a vocabulary in the Appendix ; and differences must increase because neighbouring tribes are seldom at peace. The numbers above stated are mere estimations. The diffi- * See Note 2, at the end of this chapter. SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. 133 culty of obtaining either language or information from the Fuegians can only be well appreciated by those who have had intercourse with them, or with the New Hollanders; whose mimickry of what one says is as perplexing as the same trick is when speaking to the Fuegians. Allowing that the Tehuel-het or Pata- gonians aMount tO .......seseeeeeees 1,600 PAGAN oc te scecacaaiuacteddlocscessiccsiaswas . O00 PR CKCOMIGHC et oe seticageacasnca inn sidonsct ois 500 PAUIGHOOUD, 1. oc: spagsnstiacavees taesasatos 400 IRCCNCEAY ona casts Saciceness adnan deade dyad seats, 200 ERC em: So vessnccattacios Semaccnecscicsonres , LOO and WUNGMOS sas 0 svcedoatdscuneest's etisara'ee Pawlaie 400 Mmertotal will be esi... iida cts cceswoacectesess.g 3,800; which I do not think is five hundred in error: and I should say, in round numbers, that there are about four thousand adults south of the latitude of forty degrees, exclusive of Childe. By Patagonia is meant that part of South America which lies between the River Negro and the Strait of Magalhaens. Eastern Patagonia is the portion of this district which lies eastward of the Cordillera; and Western Patagonia, the part lying between the summits of the Andes and the Pacific Ocean. Tierra del Fuego takes in all the islands southward of the Strait of Magalhaens (including Staten Land), as far as the Diego Ramirez islets. Before entering into a more detailed account of these abori- gines, I will try to give a slight general idea of their personal appearance ; of their horses and canoes; of their houses and country ; in short, an outline sketch of that which is observed at the first glance of a stranger’s eye. The minuter details, which will follow, may be tedious to many readers. Magalhaens first gave the name of Patagones to the natives whom he saw at Port San Julian in 1520. They were of very large (gigantic) stature, and their feet, being wrapped in rough guanaco skin, by way of shoes, were remarked particularly: Probably their footsteps in the sand were noticed, and excited 134 SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. some such exclamation as ‘ que patagones!’ (what great feet !) patagon meaning a very large foot.—(See note 3.) Tierra del Fuego was also named by Magalhaens, because many fires were seen, in the night, upon that land. The aboriginal natives of Eastern Patagonia are a tall and’ extremely stout race of men. Their bodies are bulky, their heads and features large, yet their hands and feet are compa- ratively small. Their limbs are neither so muscular nor so large boned as their height and apparent bulk would induce one to suppose: they are also rounder and smoother than those of white men. Their colour is a rich reddish-brown, between that of rusty iron and clean copper, rather darker than copper, yet not so, dark as good old mahogany.* But every shade of colour between that just mentioned and the lighter hue of a copper kettle, may be seen among individuals of various ages. Excepting among old or sickly people, I did not notice a tinge of yellow: some of the women are lighter coloured— about the tint of pale copper—but none are fair, according to our ideas. Nothing is worn upon the head except their rough, lank, and coarse black hair, which is tied above the temples with a fillet of platted or twisted sinews. A large mantle, made of skins sewed together, loosely gathered about them, hanging from the shoulders to their ankles, adds so much to the bulkiness of their appearance, that one ought not to wonder at their having been called ‘gigantic. I am not aware that a Patagonian has appeared, during late years, exceeding in height six feet and some inches ; but I see no reason to disbelieve Falkner’s account of the Cacique Cangapol, whose height, he says, was seven feet and some inches. When Falkner stood on tiptoe he could not reach the top of Cangapol’s head. It is rather curious, that Byron could only just touch the top of the tallest man’s head * The colour of these aborigines is extremely like that of the Devon- shire breed of cattle. From the window of a room in which I am sitting, I see some oxen of that breed passing through the outskirts of a wood, and the partial glimpses caught of them remind me strongly of the South American red men. SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. 135 whom he saw. Ever restless and wandering, as were the 'Tehuel-het, of which tribes that cacique was chief, might not Byron have measured Cangapol?* Who disbelieves that the Roman Emperor, Maximinus, by birth a Thracian, was more than eight feet in height? yet who, in consequence, expects all Thracians to be giants? At present, among two or three hundred natives of Patagonia, scarcely half-a-dozen men are seen whose height is under five feet nine or ten; and the women are tall in proportion. I have nowhere met an assemblage of men and women whose average height and apparent bulk approached to that of the Patagonians. ‘Tall and athletic as are many of the natives of Otaheite, and other islands in the Pacific Ocean, there are also many among them who are slight, and of low stature. The Patagonians seem high-shouldered—owing perhaps to the habit of folding their arms in their mantles across the chest, and thus increasing their apparent height and_bulk, as the mantles hang loosely, and almost touch the ground. Until actually measured, I could not believe that they were not much taller than was found to be the fact. But little hair shews itself on their faces or bodies. From the former it is studiously removed by two shells, or some kind of pincers. Although they do not augment the coarse- ness of their features by piercing either nose or lips, they dis- figure themselves not a little by red,f black,} or white§ paint, with which they make grotesque ornaments, such as circles around their eyes, or great daubs across their faces. Upon particular occasions, all the upper part of their body, from the waist upwards, is strangely decorated (or disfigured) by paint, awkwardly laid on with very little design. On their feet and legs are boots made out of the skins of horses’ legs. Wooden spurs, if they cannot get iron; sets of balls (bolas), and along tapering lance of bamboo, pointed with iron, complete their equipment. These lances are seldom seen near the Strait of Magalhaens, but the natives are not always without them. The women are dressed and booted like the men, with the i * Byron’s voyage, 1765.—Falkner, 1740-80. + Ochre. ¢ Charcoal and oil. § Felspathic earth and oil. 186 SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. addition of a half petticoat, made of skins, if they cannot pro- cure foreign coarse cloth. They clean their hair, and divide it into two tails, which are platted, and hang down, one on each side. Ornaments of beads, bits of brass, or silver, or any similar trifles, are much prized, and worn in necklaces, or as bracelets; sometimes also as ear-rings, or round their ankles. Mounted upon horses of an inferior size, averaging only about fourteen hands and a half in height, though rather well-bred, the Patagonians seem to be carried no better than the full- accoutred dragoons, who rode eighteen stone upon horses equal to twelve ; yet those horses, so slight in comparison with their masters, carry them at fuil speed in chase of ostriches or guana- coes; and we all know what our dragoon horses have done under their heavily-weighted, but determined riders. With bridles of hide tied to the lower jaw, when there is not a Spanish bit, and a light saddle of wood, covered with some skins and placed upon others, a Patagonian rides hard when there is occasion— but frequently changes his horse. Many large dogs, of a rough, lurcher-like breed, assist them in hunting, and keep an excellent watch at night. (Note at end of Chapter VIII.) The toldos (huts) of these wanderers are in shape not unlike gipsy tents. Poles are stuck in the ground, to which others ave fastened, and skins of animals, sewed together, form the covering, so that an irregular tilt-shaped hut is thus made. Three sides and the top are covered; but the front, turned towards the east,"is open. These toldos are about seven feet high, and ten or twelve feet square; they are lower at the back, or western side, than in front, by several feet. These are their ordinary dwellings; of other rather larger construc- tions a description will be given hereafter. The country inhabited by these Patagonians is open and, generally speaking, rather level, but with occasional hills and some extensive ranges of level-topped heights (steppes). There are very few trees, and water is scarce. 'The eye wanders over an apparently boundless extent of parched, yellow-looking semi-desert, where rain* seldom falls, and the sky is almost * Except during a few days in each year, or perhaps at intervals of two or three years, when it pours down in torrents. ye SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. 137 always clear. The heats of summer are very great; but in winter, though the days are not cold, the frosts at night are severe ; and at all times of the year, in the day-time, strong ~vinds sweep over the plains. Lhe Yacana-kunny, natives of the north-eastern part of Tierra del Fuego, resemble the Patagonians in colour, stature, and clothing.* They seem to be now much in the condition in which the Patagonians must have been before they had horses.-+ With their dogs, with bows and arrows, balls (bolas), slings, lances, and clubs, they kill guanacoes, ostriches, birds, and seals. The north-eastern portion of Tierra del Fuego is a better country than Patagonia. The woody mountains of the south- ' western islands are succeeded, towards this north-east district, by hills of moderate height, partially wooded; northward of which are level expanses, almost free from wood, but covered with herbage adapted to the pasturage of cattle. The climate is a mean between the extremes of wetness and drought, which are so much felt by the neighbouring regions ; and when a settlement is made, at some future day, in that part of the world, San Sebastian Bay, in the Yacana country, ealled by Narborough, King Charles South Land, would be an advantageous position for its site. f The Tekeenica, natives of the south-eastern portion of Tierra del Fuego, are low in stature, ill-looking, and badly proportioned. Their colour is that of very old mahogany, or rather between dark copper, and bronze. The trunk of the body is large, in proportion to their cramped and rather crooked limbs. ‘Their rough, coarse, and extremely dirty black hair half hides yet heightens a villanous expression of the worst description of savage features. Passing so much time in low wigwams, or cramped in small * Excepting boots. t See Magalhaens’ first interview. Burney, vol.i. p. 34. { Falkner says (p. 93, speaking of this country), “ It is evident that this place has the conveniences of wood, water, and soil; and, if there could be found a tolerable harbour, it would be much more convenient for a colony, and have a better command of the passage to the South Sea than Falkland’s Islands.” 138 SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. canoes, injures the shape and size of their legs, and causes them to move about in a stooping manner, with the knees much bent ; yet they are very nimble, and rather strong. They suffer very little hair to grow, excepting on their heads. Even their eyebrows are almost eradicated — two muscle- shells serving for pincers. This aversion to the smaller tufts of hair does not extend to the thatch-like covering of their ugly heads, which is lank, covered with dirt, hanging about their ears, and almost over their faces. Just above their eyes it is jagged away by a broken shell, if they have not a piece of iron hoop for a knife, the pieces cut off being scrupulously burned. In height varying from four feet ten to five feet six, yet in the size of their bodies equalling men of six feet, of course they look clumsy and ill-proportioned ; but their hands and feet are rather small with respect to the size of their bodies, though not so in proportion to their limbs and joints, which, excepting the knees, are small. Their knees are all strained, and their legs injured in shape, by the habit of squatting upon their heels. Awkward and difficult as such a posture appears to us, it is to them a position of easy rest. Sometimes these satires upon mankind wear a part of the skin of a guanaco or a seal-skin upon their backs, and perhaps the skin of a penguin or a bit of hide hangs in front ; but often there is nothing, either to hide their nakedness or to preserve warmth, excepting a scrap of hide, which is tied to the side or back of the body, by a string round the waist. Even this is only for a pocket, in which they may carry stones for their slings, and hide what they pick up or pilfer. A man always carries his sling around his neck or waist, wherever he goes. Women wear rather more clothing, that is, they have nearly a whole skin of a guanaco, or seal, wrapped about them, and usually a diminutive apron. The upper part of the wrapper, above a string which is tied around the waist, serves to carry an infant. Neither men nor women have any substitute for shoes. No ornaments are worn in the nose, ears, or lips, nor on the fingers; but of necklaces, and bracelets, such as they are, the women are very fond. With small shells, or pieces of the bones SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. 139 of birds, strung upon lines made of sinews, these necklaces and bracelets are made, when nothing preferable is to be found ; but beads, buttons, pieces of broken glass, or bits of fractured crockery-ware are most highly esteemed. The hair of the women is longer, less coarse, and certainly cleaner than that of the men. It is combed with the jaw of a porpoise, but neither platted nor tied ; and none is cut away, excepting from over their eyes. They are short, with bodies largely out of proportion to their height; their features, especially those of the old, are scarcely less disagreeable than the repulsive ones of the men. About four feet and some inches is the stature of these she-Fuegians—by courtesy called women. They never walk upright: a stooping posture, and awkward movement, is their natural gait. They may be fit mates for such uncouth men ; but to civilized people their ap- pearance is disgusting. Very few exceptions were noticed. The colour of the women is similar to that of the men. As they are just as much exposed, and do harder work, this is a natural consequence: besides, while children, they run about quite naked, picking up shell-fish, carrying wood, or bringing water. In the colour of the older people there is a tinge of yellow, which is not noticed in the middle-aged or young. Both sexes oil themselves, or rub their bodies with grease ; and daub their faces and bodies with red, black, or white. A fillet is often worn round the head, which upon ordinary occasions is simply a string, made of sinews; but if going to war, or dressed for show, the fillet is ornamented with white down, white feathers, or pieces of cloth, if they have obtained any from shipping. Small lances, headed with wood ; others, pointed with bone; bows, and arrows headed with obsidian, agate, or jasper; clubs; and slings ; are the weapons used. by the Tekeenica. The smoke of wood fires, confined in small wigwams, hurts their eyes so much, that they are red and watery ; the effects of their oiling, or greasing themselves, and then rub- bing ochre, clay, or charcoal, over their bodies ; of their often feeding upon the most offensive substances, sometimes in a 140 SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. state of putridity ; and of other vile habits, may readily be imagined. As a Tekeenica is seldom out of sight of his canoe or a wig- wam, a slight idea of these—his only constructions—should be given with this sketch. The canoe is made of several large pieces of bark, sewed together ; its shape is nearly that which would be taken by the strong bark of the trunk of a tree (twelve to twenty feet in length, and a foot, or two feet, in diameter), separated from the solid wood, in one piece. If this piece of bark were drawn together at the ends, and kept open by sticks in the middle, it would look rather like a Fuegian canoe. A Tekeenica wigwam is of a conical form, made of a number of large poles, or young trees, placed touching one another in a circle, with the small ends meeting. Sometimes, bunches of grass or pieces of bark are thrown upon the side which is exposed to the prevailing winds. No Fuegians, ex- cept the Tekeenica, make their huts in this manner. The country of this people may be briefly described by say- ing that deep but narrow arms of the sea intersect high moun- tainous islands, many of whose summits are covered with snow, while the lee or eastern sides of their steep and rocky shores are more than partially covered with evergreen woods. Between projecting rocky points are sandy or stony beaches, fronting very small spaces of level land, on which the huts of the natives are generally placed. Almost throughout the year, cloudy weather, rain, and much wind prevail ; indeed, really fine days are very rare. Being so near the level of that great climate agent, the ocean, frost and snow are far less frequent than might be expected in a high latitude, among snow-covered mountains, of which the sight alone inclines one to shiver. The men of the Alikhoolip tribe are the stoutest and har- diest, and the women the least ill-looking of the Fuegians. Though not very dissimilar, they are superior to the Tekeenica ; but they are inferior to the Yacana, and far below the natives of Patagonia. Their canoes are rather better than those of the Tekeenica, made, however, in the same manner. Dak r . \ i ee ’ . = y 2 ' | ~) 1 5 fa a SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. 141 The wigwams of the Alikhoolip, and indeed of all the Fuegians, except the Tekeenica (and perhaps some of the Yacana, whom we have not seen), are shaped like bee-hives. Their height is not above four or five feet above the ground ; but an excavation is usually made within, which gives another foot, making about five feet and a-half of height, inside, and they are two, three, or four yards in diameter. Branches of trees stuck in the ground, bent together towards the top, form the structure, upon which skins, pieces of bark, and bunches of coarse grass are roughly fastened. Of course, neither these nor the Tekeenica wigwams are wind or water tight, neither does the smoke need a chimney. The country and climate of the Alikhoolip are similar to the Tekeenica, though wetter, more windy, and more disa- greeable. Both men and women are better covered with seal or otter skins than the Tekeenica and Pecheray tribes. When surprised, or sure that they would not be plundered, the women of this tribe were always seen wrapped in large otter or seal skins. The natives of the central parts of Magalhaens Strait appear to be almost as miserable a race as the Tekeenica. As in nothing but language, and the construction of their wigwams, is there any difference which has yet been found out (though probably existing), I shall say no more of them in this place. Their climate is nearly the same as that of the Alikhoolip ; and the country is similar, though more wooded in many places, because more sheltered. Those whom I have hitherto called Huemul, who live near the Otway and Skyring Waters, seem to be a mixed breed, rather resembling the Yacana, of which tribe they are probably a branch. In habits, as well as in appearance, they partake of some of the peculiarities of Patagonians as well as Fuegians. Their country is like the Yacana—Tierra del Fuego blending or sinking into Patagonia, sharing the qualities of each region, and therefore preferable to either. They have very few canoes ; and no horses: but large dogs are used by them in hunting the huemul and guanaco. 142 SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. The tribe mentioned in a following page, which was met by Mr. Low at the north side of Fitz-Roy Passage, must have been chiefly composed of slaves (zapallos). The Huemul tribe is not numerous, and having plenty of land, with abun- dance of food, would hardly quit their own territory to submit to a Patagonian Cacique. These natives are neither inclined to serve a master, nor to learn new habits: besides, being separated from the Horse Indians by a little channel, they could not easily be caught, and obliged to remain with the Patagonians, as some persons have supposed. The Chonos, who live on the western shores and islands of Patagonia, are rather like the Alikhoolip, but not quite so stout or so daring. In general they are less savage than the Fuegians; and though their habits of life are similar, traces are visible of former intercourse with the Spaniards, which doubtless has tended to improve their character. Prior to the Spanish conquest, the Chonos Indians inhabited Childe and the Chonos Archipelago; but that now they are all south of Cape Tres Montes, there is good reason to sup- pose, though certainly no positive proof. The canoes of these Chonos Indians are made of planks, sewed together; and they are rowed with oars. Generally there is a cross at one end of the canoe, or rather boat. Their wigwams are like those already mentioned of the bee-hive form. The climate of Western Patagonia is so disagreeable that the country is almost uninhabitable. Clouds, wind, and rain are continual in their annoyance. Perhaps there are not ten days in the year on which rain does not fall; and not thirty on which the wind does not blow strongly ; yet the air is mild, and the temperature surprisingly uniform throughout the year. The country is like the worst part of Tierra del Fuego—a range of mountains, half sunk in ocean; barren to seaward, impenetrably wooded towards the mainland, and always drenched with the waters of frequent rain, which are never dried up by evaporation before fresh showers fall. Having thus endeavoured to give a slight general idea of the more obvious peculiarities of these, the most southern abori- SOUTHERN ABORIGINES. 143 gines on the globe, I will enter into rather more detail, even at the risk of being prolix. As there is much similarity in the habits of all the tribes above-mentioned who use canoes, and we know little of the Yacana, I shall speak of the Horse Indians, generally, in the first place; and of the Canoe Indians, as one body, in the second. Nore 1.—There is so much difficulty in deciding upon the orthogra- phy of words whose sounds are variously given by individuals even of the same tribe, and which, caught by ears of varying acuteness, are written down according to the pronunciation of different languages, that one may trace some connexion between the names Key-es, Key-yus; Keyuhues, or Keyuhue; Kekenica, or Tekeenica, and Kenneka. This last term is taken from Van Noort. (Burney, vol ii. p.215.) Perhaps the country there called ‘ Coin’ may be that inhabited by Jemmy Button’s Oens-men. 2. Molina’s description of the Huemul is said by naturalists to be un- satisfactory and inconclusive ; therefore, whether it is an animal hitherto unnoticed (except by him), or the ‘ kind of roebuck,’ mentioned in page 132, remains to be decided. See Molina, vol. i. p. 364. 3. Pennant, in his ‘ Literary Life,’ quotes Cavendish’s as well as Brou- wer’s measurement of footsteps eighteen inches long! As Pennant was personally acquainted with Falkner, and collected much information respecting the Patagonians from other sources likewise, I have inserted a short extract from his work in the Appendix to this volume. The original book is now becoming scarce, and some of the notices contained in it are very interesting in connexion with this subject. While I was revising my manuscript journal, Sir Woodbine Parish had the kindness to lend me ‘ Viedma’s Diary,’ with permission to make use of it: and, finding some interesting notices of the Patagonians which were quite new to me, I have added to the appendix of this volume a verbatim extract from Viedma, which I think will repay the curious reader, especially where their ideas of the transmigration of souls are mentioned. CHAPTER VIII. HORSE INDIANS OF PATAGONIA. Head — Physiognomy — Stature —Wanderings — Clothing —Armour— Arms—Food—Chase —Property—Huts— W izards —Marriage—Chil- dren — Health — I]Iness —Death — Burial —W ar — Horsemanship — Gambling —Caciques— Superstitions— W arfare —Morality—Disposi- tion—Chups—Zapallos. Tue head of a Patagonian is rather broad, but not high; and, except in a few instances, the forehead is small and low. His hair hangs loosely : it is black, coarse, and very dirty. A fillet which is worn around the top of the head may be intended as an ornament, for it is certainly of no use. ‘The brow is prominent: the eyes are rather small, black, and ever restless. Deficiency of eyebrow adds to the peculiar expression of their eyes; and a mixture of simplicity and shrewdness, daring and timidity, with that singular wild look which is never seen in civilized man, is very conspicuous in the Patagonians. Its immediate effect is to remind one of the necessity of being always on guard while within reach: yet of all savage nations, perhaps the Patagonians are least inclined to attack or deceive strangers. In general, the women’s stature, physiognomy, and dress, so much resemble those of the men, that, except by their hair, it is difficult for a stranger to distinguish them. By nature they have but little hair on either face or body, and that little they try to eradicate. Their faces are roundish, and the width or projection of the cheek-bones makes them look unusually wide. The nose is a little depressed, narrow between the eyes, but broad and fleshy about the. nostrils, which are rather large. The mouth is large and coarsely formed, with thick lips. Their teeth are often very good, though rather large ; and those in front have the peculiarity, which will be discussed when speaking of the Fuegians, of being flattened, solid, and shewing an inner substance. The chin is CONFIDENCE —STATURE—WANDERINGS. 145 usually broad and prominent: all the features, indeed, are large, excepting the eyes. The expression of their countenances is open and honest (compared with other savages), and their intrepid, contented look is rather prepossessing. ‘The unhe- sitating manner in which, unarmed, they trust themselves among strangers whom they never before saw, or venture on board ship, even under sail in the offing (if they can obtain a pas- sage in the boat), and go voluntarily from place to place with their white acquaintances, is very remarkable. Of the stature and bulk of these Indians I have already spoken. It appears to me that those who now live on the northern side of Magalhaens’ Strait are descendants of the Pata- gonians whose size excited so much surprise and discussion ; and that, occasionally, individuals have exceeded the common height. Speaking of Cangapol, whose chief resort was the vicinity of the river Negro, though he and his tribe were rest- less wanderers, Falkner says—‘‘ This chief, who was called by the Spaniards the ‘ Cacique bravo,’ was very tall and well pro- portioned. He must have been seven feet and some inches in height, because, on tiptoe, I could not reach to the top of his head. I was very well acquainted with him, and went some journeys in his company. I do not recollect ever to have seen an Indian that was above an inch or two taller than Cangapol. His brother, Sausimian, was but about six feet high. The Patagonians are a large-bodied people; but I never heard of that gigantic race which others have mentioned, though I have seen persons of all the different tribes of southern Indians.” . In another place he says, “ there is not a part of all this extremity of the continent that some of these wandering nations do not travel over frequently.” Of their wanderings, many persons besides myself and those with me can bear witness. Patago- nians, who were personally known by officers of the Beagle, were seen by them at the Spanish (now the Buenos Ayrean) settlement, Del Carmen, near the mouth of the river Negro, in September 1832; and by Mr. Low, at their usual abode, near the Strait of Magalhaens, in February 1833. The individual who was then most noticed, a half-breed Indian woman, named VOL. 11, L 146 CLOTHING—ARMOUR. Maria,* once persuaded some of her companions to go with her to the Falkland islands, in a vessel commanded by Mr. Matthew Brisbane. They went, staid there some weeks, and returned in the same vessel, highly delighted by all the novelties, excepting sea-sickness. The chief wizard of the tribe was one of the party. Maria was then a person of much consequence, being almost their only interpreter, and the wife of a principal person. Her own history must be curious: she was born at Asuncion, in Paraguay ; and has a son who is a cacique. The mantles are curiously painted, usually on one side only, but some have had the hair rubbed off and are painted on both sides. They are very neatly sewed together with thread made out of the split sinews of ostriches, which is the strongest and most durable material they can procure. Making mantles is one of the occupations of the women. The paint used is found on the hills: it is an earthy substance, of various colours. Moistened with water, and made into the shape of crayons, pieces of this substance are dried in the sun; and when used, one end of the crayon is dipped in water and rubbed on the part to be coloured. These mantles are tied about the neck, and usually round the middle, by sinew cords. Often the upper part is dropped, and the body left quite exposed above the waist, and while in active exercise on horseback, this is usually the case, if the mantle is not then entirely discarded. This substantial substitute for clothing is made with skins of the animals of their country ; and among those of guanaco, puma, fox, skunk (a kind of weasel or polecat), cavy, dog, otter, seal, and colt, the most esteemed are the small grey fox skins. A kind of ‘maro’ is sometimes worn by the men; and their boots, I have already said, are made out of the hock part of the skins of mares’ and colts’ legs. After being cleaned from fat, or membranous substances, dried, and then made pliable with grease, these ready-shaped boots require neither sewing nor soles. Wooden substitutes for spurs are worn, if iron can- not be procured. For warlike purposes the men clothe themselves in three of * Frequently mentioned by Captain King in vol. i. ARMOUR—ARMS. 147 their thickest mantles: the two outer ones have no hair, but are gaily painted: all three are worn like ponchos. On their heads they then wear conical caps, made of hide; and sur- mounted by a tuft of ostrich feathers. Another kind of armour, worn by those who can get it, is a broad-brimmed hat, or helmet, made of a doubled bull’s hide: and a tunic, or frock, with a high collar, and short sleeves, made of several hides sewed toge- ther; sometimes of anta skins, but always of the thickest and most solid they can procure. It is very heavy, strong enough to resist arrows or lances, and to deaden the blow of a stone ball (bola perdida); but it will not turn the bullet fired from amusket. Some say that it will do so, but that which I saw had been pierced through, in the thickest part, by the musket- ball which killed the wearer. When obliged to fight on foot, they use a shield made of hides sewed together (clypeus sep- templex). ' Their arms are balls (bolas), lances, bows and arrows, clubs, and swords when they can get them. But in hasty, unfore- seen skirmishes, they engage in as light order as the more northern Indians, without head-cover or mantle, stripped to ' their spurs, and armed only with lances and balls ; which latter they are never without. The balls, bowls, or bolas, called by themselves ¢ s6mai,’ are two or three round stones, lumps of earth hardened, iron or copper ore, or lead. If made of earth or clay, the material is enclosed in small bags of green (fresh) hide, which, placed in the sun, contract so much, that they become like stones in hardness ; but these clay balls are not used by the Patagonians so much as by the Pampa Indians, in whose country stones or metals are so scarce that there probably the last-mentioned balls were invented. Two balls, connected by a thong of hide, two, three, or four yards in length, are called ¢ s6mai.’ Three such balls, connected by thongs, equal to one another in length, with their inner ends united, are called ‘achico.” Taking one ball in the right hand, the other two are whirled around several times, and the whole then thrown at the object to be entangled. There are also balls of less weight and size, made of marble, u 2 148 BALLS—LANCE. lead, or metallic ore, with shorter cords or thongs, which are for small animals. Sometimes two small balls, each of which has a cord about a yard in length, are fastened to the thong of the larger set. This is to entangle the victim more effectually. They do not try to strike objects with these balls, but endeavour to throw them so that the thong shall hit a prominent part ; and then, of course, the balls swing around in different directions, and the thongs become so ‘laid up’ (or twisted), that struggling only makes the captive more secure. They can throw them so dexterously, as to fasten a man to his horse, or catch a horse without bruising him. If an animal is to be caught without being thrown down suddenly—an inevitable consequence of these balls swinging round his legs while at full speed—a somai is thrown at his neck. The two balls hang down, and perplex him so much by dangling about his fore-legs, that his speed is much checked ; and another set of balls, or a lasso, may be used, to secure, without throwing him down. The lasso is not much used, so adroit are they with the balls. A formidable missile weapon is the single ball, called by the Spaniards ‘ bola perdida.’ This is similar to the other in size and substance, but attached to a slighter rope, about a yard long. Whirling this ball, about a pound in weight, with the utmost swiftness around their heads, they dash it at their adver- sary with almost the force of a shot. At close quarters, it is used, with a shorter scope of cord, as an efficient head-breaker. Several of these original, and not trifling offensive weapons, are kept in readiness by each individual ; and many a Spa- niard, armed with steel and gunpowder, has acknowledged their effect. The lance (chuza) is a long bamboo cane, from twelve to twenty-four feet long, headed with iron or steel. The great length and tapering slightness of these spears makes them for- midable to any adversaries, but often fatal to those who are unskilful or timorous, because their vibration, artfully increased to the utmost by the holders, makes it extremely difficult to parry the advance of their point ; but, once parried thev are ARMS—WOMEN'S DRESS. 149 useless—perhaps become encumbrances to their owners, who, if they do not turn and dash off at full speed, have recourse to their balls or to swords. Some have swords obtained from white men ; others fasten long blades (knife-blades, perhaps, or pieces of iron hoop, straightened and sharpened) to handles three or four feet in length. 'Their bows are three or four feet long ; and the arrows, about two feet in length, are headed with small triangular pieces of agate, jasper, obsidian, or even bone. But bows, arrows, shields, clubs, and heavy armour are daily less used; and may we not infer, that arms and armour, suited to foot encounters—such as arrows, heavy clubs or maces, shields, and many-fold tunics—have been laid aside by degrees, as horses have multiplied in the country? Fighting on foot is now seldom practised, except in personal quarrels. Falkner says, they used to envenom the points of their arrows with a species of poison, which destroyed so slowly, that the wounded person lingered for two or three months, till, reduced to a skeleton, he at last expired; but I have not heard of such a practice among the southern aborigines in these days. Those Indians who have felt the effects of fire-arms, and own abundance of horses, the men of Araucania, who are the terror of the Pampa tribes, have long abolished armour and the arms of former wars—wars so well sung by Ercilla, in which they gained unfading honour in maintaining the free- dom of their country. Naked on their horses, armed with lances, swords, and balls, those men now rush like the whirl- wind—destroy—and are gone ! The women of Patagonia wear nothing on their heads ;_ their hair, parted before and behind, is gathered into two large tresses, one on each side. Ear-ornaments, necklaces, bracelets, and -anklets, made of beads, pieces of brass, silver, or gold, are much esteemed. Their mantles are similar to those of the men; but they are pinned across the breast by a wooden skewer, or a metal pin, and are gathered about the waist, hanging loosely almost to their ankles. A short apron, or half-petticoat, made with skins of small animals, or coarse cloth, is tied about their waist, under the mantle. It only covers them in front, and reaches to the knee. Boots, similar to those 150 FOOD—CHASE. of the men, and additional clothes, are worn when they ride distances ; sitting astride, upon a heap of skins, which serve at night for bedding. The principal subsistence of these Indians is the flesh of mares, ostriches, cavies, or guanacoes; but though they are not particular, and eat almost anything that they catch, the flesh of young mares is preferred to any other. They broil their meat, and eat it with a lump of fat, and salt. The fat of mares and that of ostriches are boiled together and put into;bladders ; but the fat of guanacoes is eaten raw, being preferred in that state. There are two roots which they eat, one called tus, the other chalds. The tus is a bulbous root, growing wild, which when cleaned and baked, or rather roasted, becomes mealy, like a yam. They use it sometimes with their meat, but not often. The chalis is a long, white root, about the size of a goose-quill. It is either roasted in the embers or put into broth, which they make for women and sick people. When on the sea-coast, limpets and muscles are gathered by the women and children; but fish or seals are seldom obtained. Dogs are not eaten, neither are horses, unless disabled by an accident. / Cattle are yet scarce in the southern regions, because pasture- land is rather deficient ; but about the lately-discovered river, Chupat, (lat. 43.21. S.) which, though small, is supposed to cross the continent, they are rather numerous, but their flesh is not thought equal to that of mares. The only prepared drink which they use, besides the decoc- tion of chalas, is the juice of barberries, mixed with water, and drank in its natural state. ‘They have no fermented liquor. Hunting is both amusing and necessary to the men. They go out to the chase in parties, more or less numerous, accord- ing to the strength of the tribe, the scarcity of food, and the supply of horses. An extent of country is enclosed by the horsemen ; then drawing together, they drive before them all the animals ; till, when tolerably collected together, the cacique, or leading man of the party rides at an animal and throws it down with his balls. All then set to work, and ball away in every direction. They do not stop because one animal falls, CHASE—WEALTH—HUTsS, 151 since not one in a hundred escapes by his own exertions when once entangled ; but another and another become the victims of a good hunter, before the collection escapes out of his reach. All their sets of balls being employed, and the game dispersed, they begin to kill and divide. Each animal is knocked on the head with a ball, skinned, and cut into pieces, where it fell, and the pieces are then carried on horseback to their huts. After reaching their settlement, the produce of the chase is brought together, and divided among the different families, in proportion to their respective numbers. If one family has eater its share sooner than others, some one of that hungry house goes to any party which has meat left, and cuts off what is wanted, without a question. A number of large dogs assist in the hunt: whether they scent the game I know not, but probably they run by eye, as so many animals are a-foot at once. Each regular hunter has a spare horse at hand ; the best horses being carefully reserved for war and the chase. Upon others they travel, place the women and children, and their property. The method of hunting abovementioned is that employed on set occasions; but if only a few men are together, they surprise and chase, as they can. Sometimes they ride together, and chase whatever they see, whether ostrich, skunk, guanaco, fox, or puma. The wealth of these Indians consists chiefly in horses and dogs, the richer individuals having forty or fifty horses, and a large number of dogs ; the poorer, only one or two horses, and but one dog. The tents or huts called by themselves ‘ cow,’ and by the Spaniards and their descendants, toldos (tolderia is the place of toldos, or Indian village, in Spanish), have already been partly described. Made of skins, sewed together and supported by poles, a tilt-like construction, open towards the east, is their hastily-formed dwelling. The top slopes towards the west side, which is not above two feet in height. The front is about six or seven feet high; and the inside space about twelve feet by nine. Both poles and skins are carried with them when 152 DWELLINGS—MARRIAGES. they migrate from place to place. Water does not lodge on the hide covering, neither does wind penetrate ; and as east winds ar2 very rare in Patagonia, a temporary screen, such as a few skins, suffices for protection against them. Two or three families sleep in one hut, unless it is the dwell- ing of a cacique, or person who has many wives. Poor people have but one wife. Those who are rich, and able to maintain them, bave several wives—three, four, five, or even more. In places where some of the tribe stay constantly, and which are considered the head-quarters, or central rendezvous of a tribe, there are larger huts, almost deserving the name of houses. Some of these are for the cacique and his wives ; others are for the wizards, who, in their three-fold capacity of priests, magi- cians and doctors, have great influence over the superstitious minds of their countrymen. ‘These larger dwellings are made with poles and skins, put together so as to form an oblong shed, with a sloping roof, shaped like a small cottage. The substi- tutes for walls are about five feet in height, and the roof is in the middle about eight feet from the ground. Some of these houses are four or five yards in width, and eight, ten, or twelve in length. I have never seen one myself; but those who gave me other information, which I found true, said that there were such houses in the interior, and described them minutely to me. At night, skins are spread upon the ground to sleep on; two or three rolled up, along the length of the back part of the tent or hut, form a pillow for the whole party, on which each family has its place, and the dogs lie at their feet. The children have a little square place to themselves, in one corner. Infants in the cradle (a piece of hide with a thong fast to its four corners, by which it is suspended from the roof of the dwelling), are placed near their mother, Marriages are made by sale more frequently than by mutual agreement. Instead of receiving a dowry with his wife, a man pays a large price to her nearest relations. Sometimes girls are betrothed while very young, and a part of the stipulated price paid to the relations. Mutual inclination may sometimes determine the choice; but payment must in every case be MARRIAGES—SLAVES. 153 made, in proportion to the supposed value of the damsel, and the property of her purchaser. If a girl dislikes a match made for her, she resists, and although dragged forcibly to the hut of her lawful owner, plagues him so much by her contumacy, that he at last turns her away, or sells her to the person on whom she has fixed her affections; but he seldom beats her, or treats her ill. Perhaps she does not wait to be so disposed of, but elopes and takes her choice of a protector; who, if more powerful than the husband, obliges him to submit to the double loss, unless a cacique, or a powerful friend of the losing party, forces the gallant to restore her, or compromise the matter, and these affairs are in general easy to settle. It has been already mentioned that each man who possesses any property has usually more than one wife; and that some few men, who have forty or fifty horses, and other riches in proportion, maintain four or five wives. *¢ Women who have accepted their husbands with good-will are in general very faithful and laborious,” says Falkner ; ‘their lives are but one continued scene of labour ; for, besides nursing and bringing up children, they are obliged to do much drudgery.” Except hunting, providing food, and fighting, all work is done by the women. Indeed they sometimes aid in battle. Some families have slaves who do household work ; but if they should have no slaves, not even the wives of a cacique are exempt from every-day labour. Men do not marry before they are about twenty years of age. Girls are married earlier: from fourteen or fifteen they are considered to be marketable commodities. Falkner says, ** When once the parties are agreed, and have children, they seldom forsake each other, even in extreme old age. The hus- ‘band protects his wife from all injuries, and always takes her ‘part, even if she is in the wrong, which occasions frequent quarrels and bloodshed ; but this partiality does not prevent him from reprimanding her, in private, for engaging him in these disputes. “* He very seldom beats her; if she 1s found unfaithful he lays blame on the gallant, and, if able, punishes him severely ; 154 CHILDREN—INDIAN DISPOSITION. unless the delinquent atones by some valuable gift. Some- times, at the command of a wizard, a man orders his wife to go to an appointed place, usually a wood, and abandon herself to the first person she meets. Yet there are women who refuse to comply with such orders.” When it does happen that a man and his wife quarrel, the woman is sometimes punished by having her two tails rather savagely pulled. I have been told that the husband scarcely ever beats her, except in the height of passion. Children are left to take care of themselves soon after they can walk. With sets of little balls (bolas) they annoy the dogs not a little, practising their future occupation. While very young they climb upon old, or quiet, horses’ backs. If a young guanaco is caught and tamed, or a bird with its wings clipped hops about the tolderia, the little ones have fine sport. While infants are suckling, the mothers use frames or cradles in which their charges are carried about: they are made of flat pieces of wood, with a few semi-circular guards of lath, or thin branches, whose ends are fixed into holes in the wood. In such frames, between pieces of guanaco skin, the babies are placed; and while travelling, these cradles are hung at the mothers’ saddle-bows. The children are much indulged. Falkner says, “‘ The old people frequently change their ha- bitations to humour the caprices of their children. If an Indian, even a cacique, wish to change his abode, and the tribe with whom he is living do not choose to part with him, it is customary to take one of his children, and pretend such a fondness for it, that they cannot part with the little favourite. The father, fond of his child, and pleased that it is so much liked, is induced to remain.” Yet with all this apparent goodness of disposition, in moments of passion, these Indians have been seen to be like other savages, disgraced by the worst barbarity. Neither man, woman, wife, nor even a smiling innocent child, is safe from that tiger in human shape—a savage in arage. ‘ Nunca, nunca fiarse de los Indios,” is a Spanish maxim, as well founded as it is common. HEALTH—ILLNESS—DEATH, 155 . Education, and the beneficial effects of the opinions of others, an influence fully felt only in civilized society, have so tamed and diminished the naturally strong passion of anger, with its sequel, immediate violence, or hatred and revenge, that ima- gination must be called to the assistance of those who, hap- pily, have never seen a furious savage. Who can read that instance of child murder, related so well by Byron, in his narrative of the Wager’s wreck, without a shudder? yet the man who, in a moment of passion, dashed his own child against the rocks, would, at any other time, have been the most daring, the most enduring, and the most self-devoted in its support and defence! (Appendix No. 14.) Generally speaking, the Patagonians are extremely healthy. Their constitutions are so good that wounds heal rapidly: but they are not ignorant of the healing properties of some herbs ; nor of the purgative qualities of others. They know the effect of bleeding, and can adroitly open a vein with a sharp piece of shell or flinty stone. When sick, the chal¥s root, pounded and mixed with water, is a favourite specific. Should this, or the few other remedies which they think they know, fail, the wizard (who is also doctor) performs some absurd ceremonies, and then rattles toge- ther two pieces of dry bladder, in which are some loose stones, in order to frighten away the ¢ Valichu,’ or evil spirits, who are opposing their art, and tormenting the unlucky patient. The diabolical noise caused by rattling these dried bladders, is con- tinued until the disease takes a favourable turn, or the sufferer dies. If death ends the scene, the body is wrapped in the best mantle of the deceased, placed on his favourite horse, and car- ried to the burying-place of the tribe. ‘The wizard rattles, and the other people howl over the corpse as it is carried to the sepulchre. Ina square pit, about six feet deep, and two or three feet wide, where many others have been deposited, the corpse is placed in a sitting posture, adorned with mantles, _plumes of feathers, and beads. The spurs, sword, balls, and other such property belonging to the deceased, are laid beside him; and the pit is then covered over with branches of 156 BURIAL—CEREMONIES. trees, upon which earth is laid. His favourite horse is after- wards killed. It is held at the grave while a man knocks it on the head with one of the balls of the deceased. When dead, it is skinned and stuffed, then, supported by sticks (or set up) upon its legs, with the head propped up, as if looking at the grave. Sometimes more horses than one are killed. At the funeral of a cacique four horses are sacrificed, and one is set up at each corner of the burial place. The clothes and other effects belonging to the deceased are burned: and to finish all, a feast is made of the horses’ flesh. But there are also other modes of disposing of dead bodies : and as I am certain that at least two of them are practised by the Patagonians of the present day, and we are assured by Falkner that other methods, one of which was carrying them into the desert by the sea-coast, were customary in his time, I shall here repeat what he says on the subject (p. 118). ‘*'The burial of the dead and the superstitious reverence paid to their memory, are attended with great ceremony. When an Indian dies, one of the most distinguished women among them is immediately chosen to make a skeleton of his body ; which is done by cutting out the entrails, which they burn to ashes, dissecting the flesh from the bones as clean as possible, and then burying them under ground till the remaining flesh is entirely rotted off, or till they are removed (which must be within a year after the interment, but is sometimes within two months) to the proper burial-place of their ancestors. “ This custom is strictly observed by the Molu-che, Taluhet, and Diuihet,* but the Chechehet and Tehuelhet, or Patago- ‘nians, place the bones on high, upon canes or twigs woven together, to dry and whiten with the sun and rain. “‘ During the time that the ceremony of making the skeleton lasts, the Indians, covered with long mantles of skins, and their faces blackened with soot, walk round the tent, with long poles or lances in their hands, singing in a mournful tone of voice, and striking the ground, to frighten away the Valichus, * The Taluhet, Chechehet, and Diuihet, were tribes of Puel-che. MOURNING—BURIAL. 157 or evil spirits. Some go to visit and console the widow, or widows, and other relations of the dead, that is, if there is any thing to be got ; for nothing is done but with a view of interest. During this visit of condolence they cry, howl, and sing in the most dismal manner; straining out tears, and pricking their arms and thighs with sharp thorns, to make them bleed. For this shew of grief they are paid with glass beads, brass casca- bels and such like baubles, which are in high estimation among them. The horses of the dead are also immediately killed, that he may have wherewithal to ride upon in the ‘alhue mapu,’ or country of the dead, reserving only a few to grace the last funeral pomp, and to carry the relics to their proper sepulchres. “When they remove the bones of their dead, they pack them up together in a hide, and place them upon one of the deceased’s favourite horses, kept alive for that purpose, which they adorn after their best fashion, with mantles, feathers, &c., and travel in this manner, though it be to the distance of three hundred leagues, till they arrive at the proper burial-place, where they perform the last ceremony. “The Molu-che, Taluhet, and Diuihet, bury their dead in large square pits, about a fathom deep. ‘The bones are put together, and secured by tying each in its proper place, then clothed with all the best robes they can get, adorned with beads, plumes, &c., all of which they cleanse or change once a year. They are placed in a row, sitting, with the sword, lance, bow and arrows, bowls, and whatever else the deceased had while alive. These pits are covered over with trees, canes, or branches woven together, upon which they put earth. An old matron is chosen out of each tribe, to take care of these graves, and on account of her employment is held in great veneration. Her office is to open every year these dreary habitations, and to clothe and clean the skeletons. Besides all this they every year pour upon these graves some bowls of their first made chicha, and drink some of it themselves to the good health of the dead. (N.B. Not the Tehuelhet.) “‘ These burying places are, in general, not far distant from 158 METHODS OF BURIAL. their ordinary habitations; and they place, all around, the bodies of their dead horses, raised upon their feet and supported with sticks. “The Tehuelhet, or more southern Patagonians, differ in some respects from the other Indians. After having dried the bones of their dead, they carry them to a great distance from their habitations, into the desert by the sea-coast ; and after placing them in their proper form, and adorning them in the manner before described, they set them in order above ground, under a hut or tent erected for that purpose, with the skeletons of their dead horses placed around them. ** In the expedition of the year 1746, some Spanish soldiers, with one of the missionaries, travelling about thirty leagues within land, to the west of Port San Julian, found one of these Indian sepulchres, containing three skeletons, and having as many dead horses propped up around it.” In the expeditions of the Adventure and Beagle, between 1826 and 1834, a few burial places of another kind were exa- mined. These were piles of stones, upon the summits of the highest hills, on the eastern sea-coast. Some had been thrown down and ransacked ; probably by the crews of sealing vessels: others there was no opportunity of visiting: only one untouched pile was found: and that one was examined by Lieutenant Wickham. It was on a height, near Cape Dos Bahias, in latitude forty-five south. Only bones were found, in a much decayed state, under a pile of stones about four feet high; and from the remains of the bones Mr. Bynoe ascertained that they had belonged to a woman of the ordinary stature. A pile of stones on a neighbouring height had been pulled down by the crew of a sealing vessel: under it were fragments of decayed bones, which were thought too much injured by time and weather to be worth removing; indeed they crumbled to the touch. Under similar heaps of stones the ‘ gigantic skeletons’ which some voyagers have described, were said to have been found. Doubtless these several methods of disposing of the dead are not those of one horde only, but of various tribes. But I prefer mentioning all that is yet known of the subject, as MOURNING—WAR— EXERCISE. 159 far as I am aware,* and leaving it for better-informed persons to decide upon the particular habits of each subdivision. Would any one tribe bury each of the five following persons in a simi- lar manner, and in the same place? A powerful cacique—a wizard—a woman—an ordinary man—a child ? «The widow or widows of the dead are obliged to mourn and fast for a whole year after the death of their husband. This consists in keeping themselves close shut up in their huts, without having communication with any one, or stirring out, except for the common necessaries of life; in not washing their faces or hands, but being blackened with soot, and having their garments of a mournful appearance ; in abstaining from horse’s and cow’s flesh, and, within land where they are plenty, from the flesh of ostriches and guanacoes; but they may eat any thing else. During the year of mourning, they are forbidden tomarry, and if, within this time, a widow is discovered to have had any communication with a man, the relations of her dead husband will kill them both, unless it appears that there has been violence. But I did not discover that the men were obliged to any such kind of mourning on the death of their wives.” (Falkner, p. 119.) Manslaughter is not infrequent. When quarrels arise, the parties draw their knives, or take such weapons as are at hand, and fight, if not parted, till one is killed. War often occurs between the smaller tribes, but does not last long. When the small tribes unite against another nation, such as the Molu-che, or the Puel-che of the north, their pre- parations are more serious, and their hostilities of far longer duration. When at war, or expecting an attack, the Patagonians exer- cise on horseback, in their armour, every other evening. F're- quently the occasion of hostility is an encroachment upon the territories of a neighbouring tribe, either for hunting or plun- der. War is, in such case, instantly declared by the insulted * Except about the tomb which is described by Captain King in the first volume. 160 HORSEMANSHIP—RACING—GAMBLING. party. In armour, and upon their best horses, they sally forth to meet the intruders. Having met, they ask why their land has been invaded, and desire the strangers to return to the place whence they came. The non-compliance of the intruders is a signal for action; they close—fight—and one party, being vanquished, loses all its property. ‘The manner of fighting has already been mentioned. The horsemanship of the Patagonians is not equal to that of the northern Indians: yet it is not indifferent. From their weight, and the openness of their country, they do not habi- tually ride so hard, or practise so many manceuvres as the Araucanian,* who can hang at the side of his horse while at speed, directing him by voice and rein; or even while going through a wood can cling quite beneath his belly for a short time, still urging on and directing him; but such feats, per- formed by naked men, who are almost centaurs, surpass the powers, or rather the dexterity, of the bulky, well-fed, and heavily-clothed Patagonian. The Patagonians are very fond of racing. At almost every leisure hour either horses or play engage their attention, for they are also great gamblers. Race-courses are regularly marked out, but they are very short, not a quarter of a mile in length. These short bursts at the utmost speed seem absurd, till one considers that in hunting wild animals, attacking or escaping from the sudden attack of an adversary, such short starts are of the utmost importance. They bet upon the horses, and sometimes stake even their wives and their children. Payment is faithfully made, even to the uttermost. The ecards with which they play are pieces of skin, with figures * The Araucanian hangs at one side of his horse to shelter himself from the lances, balls, or shot of his adversaries, or to avoid trees. At a distance, a troop of these Indians advancing irregularly, might seem to an inexperienced eye merely loose horses, of which so many are seen in the Pampas; but to another Indian, or to a trained gaucho, the attempt to conceal themselves would avail them nothing, because the horses’ action, and manner of going, would, at a glance, show him that they were guided by riders. ' SUPERSTITIONS. 161 painted upon them: perhaps rough imitations of the cards used by the Spaniards; but this may be doubted. According to Falkner, the native of Patagonia is a super- stitious polytheist. I cannot add to, nor have I reason to doubt his account; and shall therefore repeat what he says on this subject, abridging it slightly. ‘* The Indians imagine that there is a multiplicity of deities, some good, others evil. At the head of the good deities is Guayara-kunny, or the lord of the dead. The chief evil agent is called Atskannakanatz, or Valichu. This latter name is applied to every evil demon.* *¢ They think that the good deities have habitations in vast caverns under the earth, and that when an Indian dies his soul goes to live with the deity who presides over his particular family. “‘ They believe that their good deities made the world, and that they first created the Indians in the subterranean caverns above mentioned; gave them the lance, the bow and arrows, and the balls, to fight and hunt with, and then turned them out to shift for themselves. 'They imagine that the deities of the Spaniards created them in a similar manner, but that, instead of lances, bows, &c., they gave them guns and swords. ‘They say that when the beasts, birds, and lesser animals were ereated, those of the more nimble kind came immediately out of the caverns ; but that the bulls and cows being the last, the Indians were so frightened at the sight of their horns, that they stopped the entrances of their caves with great stones. This is the grave reason they give why they had no black cattle in their country, till the Spaniards brought them over ; who, more wisely, had let them out of their caves. * The Patagonians call the good deity the Creator of all things, but consider him as one who afterwards has no concern about them. He is styled by some Soucha, or chief in the land of strong drink; by others, Guayara-kunny, or lord of the dead. The evil principle is called Hue- covoe, or the wanderer without. Other spirits are supposed to take care of particular people—protect their own and injure others: they are called Valichu.—Pennant, p. 61. VOL. II. M 162 SUPERSTITIONS. *‘ Some say that the stars are old Indians; that the milky way is the field where the old Indians hunt ostriches, and that the Magellan clouds are the feathers of the ostriches which they kill. They have an opinion that the creation is not yet exhausted ; nor all of it yet come out to the daylight of this upper world. The wizards, beating their drums, and rattling their hide-bags full of shells, or stones, pretend to see into other regions under the earth. Each wizard is supposed to have familiar spirits in attendance, who give supernatural in- formation, and execute the conjuror’s will. They believe that the souls of their wizards, after death, are of the number of these demons, called Valichu, to whom every evil, or unplea- sant event is attributed. “‘ Their religious worship is entirely directed to the powers of evil; except in some particular ceremonies made use of in reverence to the dead. “To perform their worship they assemble together in the tent of the wizard, who is shut up from the sight of the rest inacorner. In this seclusion he has a small drum, one or two round calabashes or bags of dry hide, with small sea shells in them, and some square bags of painted hide in which he keeps his spells. He begins the ceremony by making a strange noise. with his drum and rattle-bags ; after which he feigns a fit, or struggle with the evil spirit, who it is then supposed has entered into him; keeps his eyes turned up, distorts his face, foams at the mouth, screws up his joints, and, after many vio- lent and distorting motions, remains stiff and motionless, resem- bling a man seized with an epilepsy. After some time he comes to himself, as having overcome the demon’s influence ; next he feigns, behind his screen, a faint, shrill, mournful voice, as of the evil spirit, who, by this dismal cry, is sup- posed to acknowledge himself subdued; and then the wizard, from a kind of tripod, answers all questions that are put to him. “Whether his answers are true or false, is of very little consequence; because, if his intelligence should prove false, it is the fault of the demon, or Valichu. On all these occasions the wizard is well paid. SUPERSTITIONS. 163 “ The profession of the wizards is very dangerous, notwith- standing the respect that is sometimes paid to them; for it often happens, when an Indian chief dies, that some of the wizards are killed; especially if they had any dispute with the deceased just before his death; the Indians, in this case, attributing the loss of their cacique to the wizards and their demons. In cases also of pestilence and epidemic disorders, when great numbers are carried off, the wizards often suffer. ** On account of the small-pox, which almost destroyed the Chechehet tribe, Cangapol ordered all the wizards to be killed, to see, if by such means, the distemper would cease. “There are wizards and witches. The former are obliged to dress in female apparel, and are not allowed to marry. The latter are not restricted. Wizards are generally chosen when children ; and a preference is always shewn to those who, at that time of life, discover an effeminate disposition. 'They are clothed very early in female attire, and presented with the drum and rattles belonging to the profession which they are to follow. Those who are seized with fits of the falling sickness, or the « Chorea Sancti Viti’ (St. Vitus’s dance), are immediately chosen for this employment, as selected by the demons them- selves; whom they suppose to possess them, and to cause all those convulsions and distortions common in epileptic pa- roxysms.” The Patagonians, and indeed all the South-American aborigines, have faith in witchcraft. They all believe that the wizards or witches can imjure whom they choose, even to deprivation of life, if they ean possess themselves of some part of their intended victim’s body, or that which has proceeded thence—such as hair, pieces of nails, &c. ; and this superstition is the more curious from its exact accordance with that so pre- valent in Polynesia. The tribe, or subdivision of the Tehuelhet who generally live near Magalhaens’ Strait, have learned to pay a sort of homage (perhaps it may be termed worship) to an image of wood, cut into the figure of a man’s head and body, and called Cristo ; this image they rarely produce to strangers, or even amongst M2 164 GOVERNMENT—CACIQUES. themselves, except at deaths, or on very particular occasions. This attempt at an outward demonstration of faith in customs of the Romish church, appears to have been caused by a Cap- tain Pelippa, who visited the Strait of Magalhaens some time before the Adventure and Beagle. Who or what he was, I could not discover. There is a particular kind of tree, which is esteemed sacred, and never burned. It is like a thorn; a resinous gum issues from the knotty, close-grained stem, which has a pleasant aromatic smell, if put into the fire. Regular government, or any forms and rules approaching to what may be called a civil constitution, no one would expect to find among tribes of wandering savages; but amongst the Araucanian tribes of Moluche, who do not wander, and have advanced towards civilization, there are regular laws, support- ing a settled form of government ; and their ideas have been communicated to the southern tribes, and have slightly influ- enced them. Thus, in many cases, offenders are tried by an assembly of the older people, and their sentence pronounced, after mature deliberation, instead of being at once dealt with as the cacique may, at first thought, deem expedient. The caciques or chiefs are hereditary. Those who possess much property and have many followers are highly respected ; but their authority, though absolute in some instances, is little exerted in the common occurrences of life. When meetings are held for the purpose. of deciding upon any question, the cacique presides—that is, he is considered the principal per- son present ; certainly he looks the most solemn, and is the least active. He gives orders to hunting parties, or to those who exercise for war: and if men quarrel, he sometimes causes them to be parted. In time of war he leads his tribe, and in pro- portion to his enterprise and success is his actual authority while the war lasts. Each person has a particular name, im- plying a quality or some peculiarity ; sometimes a particu- lar place. ** All the sons of a cacique,” says Falkner, ‘have a right to assume the dignity, if they. can get any persons to follow them ; CACIQUES. 165 but, on account of the small utility of the rank of cacique, it is often resigned.” Falkner’s account of the caciques ought to be, and is, no doubt, one of the best ; it is as follows :— **'The cacique has the power of protecting as many as apply to him ; of composing or silencing any difference ; or delivering over the offending party to be punished with death, without being accountable for it. In these respects, his will is the law. He is generally too apt to take bribes, delivering up his vassals, and even his relations, when well paid for it. According to his orders, the Indians encamp, march, or travel from one place to another, to hunt or make war. He frequently sum- mons them to his tent, and harangues them upon their behla- viour; the exigencies of the time; the injuries they have received ; the measures to be taken, &c. In these harangues, he always extols his own prowess and personal merit. When eloquent, he is greatly esteemed; and when a cacique is not endowed with that accomplishment, he generally has an orator, who supplies his place” (as in Polynesia). << In cases of importance he calls a council of the principal Indians and wizards, with whom he consults about the mea- sures to be taken, to defend himself or attack his enemies. In a general war, when many nations unite against a common enemy, as in the great alliances against the Spaniards, they choose a commander-in-chief, called Apo (or Toqui), from among the oldest or most celebrated caciques ; but this honour though properly elective, has for many years been hereditary in the family of Cangapol. (Written in 1780.) “ The caciques have not the power to raise taxes, or to take away any thing from their vassals ; nor can they oblige them to serve in the least employment, without paying them. They are obliged to treat their vassals with great humanity and mildness, and oftentimes to relieve their wants, or they will seek the protection of some other chief. For this reason, many of those who are born caciques refuse to have any vas- sals, as they cost them dear, and yield but little profit. No Indian, or body of Indians, can live without the protection of 166 INJURIES—WARFARE. some cacique, according to their law of nations ; and if any of them attempted to do so, they would undoubtedly be killed, or carried away as slaves, as soon as they were discovered. “© In case of any injury, notwithstanding the authority of the cacique, the party aggrieved often endeavours to do him- self justice to the best of his power. They know of no punish- ment or satisfaction, but that of paying or redeeming the injury or damage done with something of value. If the offence is not very great, and the offender is poor, the injured party perhaps beats him with his balls on the back and ribs; but, in general, they do not chastise, except by death. When the offender is too powerful, they let him alone; unless the cacique interferes, and obliges him to make satisfaction.” A curious plant is found in Patagonia (and at the Falkland Islands), somewhat like a very large and very solid cauli- flower. It is greenish, or yellowish-green, tough, and very abundant. It grows upon and close to the ground, forming a lump like a large ant-hill overgrown with moss and grass. From the succulent stalks of this plant a balsamic juice or sap exudes, which is particularly good for healing wounds. Battles between tribes are carried on similarly to their wars against a nation ; but, of course, on a smaller scale. The attack- ing party halts at a great distance from the enemy, and sends out scouts to reconnoitre. These emissaries hide during the day, but at night examine every detail most minutely, and return to the camp with a full account of their opponent’s strength and position. When the moon is near, or a little past the full, showing good light for their work, they advance to the attack. A few hours after midnight they make the assault, kill all the men who resist, and carry away the women and children for slaves. Sometimes the Indian women follow their husbands, and share in the booty. Laden with plunder, they all retreat as hastily as possible, resting neither night nor day, till they are at a great distance, and out of the reach of their enemies. Sometimes they ride more than a hundred leagues from the place of attack before stopping to rest, and divide the booty. HORSES—MORAL RESTRAINT. 167 On such occasions, if fearful of pursuit, or hard pressed by pursuers, they stop very little by the way—light no fire—eat but little food, and that raw—and some are even able to change horses without checking their speed, or touching the ground. A troop of loose horses is always driven along before the party : and when an Indian, at such a time, wants to change, he rides along-side of a loose horse, jumps on his back, bridle in hand, and in an instant, the bit is transferred from one to the other, Saddle they care not for, when thus pressed. In guiding and managing their horses, the Indians use the voice with very good effect. ‘The best of those animals are exceedingly well trained; and the owners are as reluctant to part with them as Arabs are to sell their steeds. The natives of Patagonia breed their own horses as well as dogs: but their constant practice of killing the horses of men who die tends to prevent their being numerous. Upon such occasions, all, excepting the few which had been assigned to his children (generally one or two to each child at its birth), are killed. Dogs have a similar fate. With such laws, aman need not fear being put out of the way for the sake of his pro- perty ; nor, while the women are enjoined to go through such a mourning ordeal, is it likely they would enter into or favour any combination made against their husbands, however harshly they might be treated by them. _ Excepting that of the caciques, I believe there is no supe- riority of one person over another among the Patagonians. Those who have more property than others, or who are related to the chief, have influence over the rest, but are not considered by them to be their superiors. The moral restraints of these people seem to be very slight. Each man is at liberty to do very much as he feels inclined 5 and, if he does not injure or offend his neighbour, is not inter- fered with by others. Their social habits are those handed down by their ancestors, and adapted to the life they are com- pelled to lead. Ideas of improvement do not trouble them. Contented with their fine climate—plenty of wholesome food, and an extensive range of country—they rather pity white 168 ANECDOTES—TRAFFIC. people, who seem to them always in want of provisions, and tossed about at sea. These natives have a great dislike to the motion of a ship ; yet, for novelty, they will go afloat when opportunity offers. In landing at Gregory Bay, Mr. Low has had much trouble in preventing the natives from crowding into his boat, all being anxious to see the vessel. Once, when many strange Indians (of another tribe) were present, he was obliged to affect to quarrel with them; and afterwards they behaved better and were quite civil, but he never allowed his boat to be grounded. Having left a Dutchman as boat-keeper, the natives teased him into a quarrel, and then dragged him out of the water, boat and all, with their lassoes, leaving him among the bushes, frightened and spluttering, while they galloped off, laughing heartily. The Dutchman hastened to Mr. Low; but while he was gone, the boat was put into the water by the authors of the trick, who then dashed off at full speed, highly amused at their feat. Mr. Low gave one of the women a gay gown; it was the first she had seen; and wishing to suckle her infant, she put it under the skirt of the gown, and, with some difficulty, forced the little thing upwards to her breast. When the Patagonians meet white men, their inclinations are almost always friendly ; but if they find themselves able to dictate to the strangers, a tribute of tobacco, bread, muskets, powder, ball, or such articles as they see and fancy, is often imposed. A trading schooner called at Gregory Bay (in the Strait of Magalhaens) in 1834. Her mate landed, and was asked for various things which he could not or did not wish to give. The natives detained him as a prisoner; sent his boat away; and kept him till his ransom (tobacco and bread) was sent ashore. Considerable traffic for knives, swords, muskets, ammunition, tobacco, bread, and, latterly, spirits, has been kept up between the southern Patagonians and the vessels which have touched on their shores (especially at Gregory Bay) in going through the Strait. Their returns have been mantles, skins, and fresh guanaco meat. : SAN LEON—SUBDIVISIONS. 169 During late years, several persons, run-away seamen and others, have passed many months—some, indeed, have passed years—in their company,—living as they live. In 1833-34, one of the most influential individuals among them was a Chilian, named San Leon, who had been carried to Patagonia by Mr. Brisbane, for the purpose of trading with the Indians for horses. He ran away from the vessel (1830-82), and has since lived with the tribe who are generally found near Gregory Bay. His wife isthe daughter of an old native who possesses much property (according to their ideas); she speaks a little Spanish, and interprets for strangers better than her husband, whose knowledge of the Indian language is very slight. Bred in Chile, San Leon is a good horseman, and considered by the Indians to be an excellent hunter. Mr. Low thinks that the natives would encourage and be friendly to a settlement of white people, made in Patagonia. They profess to like white men, and to wish some to live with them : when old Maria (the woman previously mentioned) was at the Falkland Islands, Mr. Low told her that he intended to build a house at Gregory Bay, and carry white people with him to live there, at which she and her party (including the wizard) seemed to be much pleased. Mr. Low considers that those natives who live eastward and northward of the First Narrow are not of the same tribe as those who are generally about Gregory Bay, with whom, he says, they are frequently at war. He also thinks that those who live farther westward, near Otway and Skyring Waters, form another subdivision. The following notices, written from his dictation,will show that what I have already stated respect- ing these minor tribes, considered as subdivisions of one large body or nation, cannot be very far wrong :— During the stay of the Unicorn (Mr. Low’s vessel) in the channel between Otway and Skyring Waters, a fire was made, as a signal to the Indians. They soon began to arrive in small detached parties, some of whom were known to Mr. Low, whose acquaintance with them had been formed at Gre- gory Bay. They travelled in small parties, therefore were not, 170 CAPITAN CHUPS. in all probability, on bad terms with their neighbours at that time. Those who first arrived were invited on board; but declined going, because their chief was expected: and with the last party came a boy, about nine years’ old, fantastically decked with ornaments of copper and brass, with beads, and with a new mantle. A tall, fine-looking man, of the Gregory Bay tribe, accompanied this young cacique, and made him known to Mr. Low, by the name of ‘ Capitan Chups.’ These natives have adopted the word ‘ capitan,’ and now always use it when addressing white men who they suppose have authority. When some Patagonians of the Gregory Bay party came on board the Beagle, in 1834, seeing a larger number of officers than is usual in small vessels, one of the first questions asked, in broken Spanish, was, “‘ Quanto capitanes abordo ?” Little Capitan Chups seemed to have no small idea of his own consequence, and tried to affect much dignity. He wil- lingly went on board the Unicorn; but not a native would enter the boat until the young chief was seated, when there was a most inconsistent scramble, which nearly swamped it. However, after pushing out a few of the intruders, the party reached the vessel in safety. On board her was a Patagonian boy, who had been four months with Mr. Low, and had been clothed at Monte Video. He had recognized Capitan Chups at a distance, said who he was, and showed by his manner that he considered him a person of high distinction. The little cacique called this boy, asked him many questions, and examined every part of his dress. Afterwards the boy joined some of his own family, who were present. He had before refused to go to the party at Gregory Bay, while there in the vessel, alleging that they were not his people. Mr. Low said, that the tribe on the banks of this channel were mixed, being partly horse and partly canoe Indians. They were entirely under the dominion of the Gregory Bay party, who appointed their chiefs. Maria’s son, called ‘Capitan Chico,’ was their ruler, until the arrival of Capitan Chups. < at 7 a , * i \ ‘ ‘ ‘ . i ht BA a ie ‘a . a i ' f als } Mi Ao i ai % é iu) et, 1338 sure: , Greet Marlborough Henry Calbern by Publhahed CHICO—SLAVE TRADE. 171 Yet Mr. Low did not. think that the little capitan belonged to any of the families residing near Gregory Bay, but to some part of the same tribe who live far inland. Maria’s son, Chico, was subsequently cacique, or acting as cacique of the Gregory Bay party. Had this western tribe been under the dominion of the Gregory Bay party, would the successor to Chico have been taken from a tribe who live far inland ? The apparent mixture of horse and canoe Indians appears - to me to have been an accidental consequence of the fire made as a signal, which called to the spot horsemen from the north and canoes from the south. The novelty of a vessel anchoring in a place never before disturbed by such a visitor, might well suspend hostilities between neighbouring tribes, even had they been at war; but there is every reason to conclude that the canoe men of the south side of those waters have frequent and even amicable intercourse with the horsemen of Patagonia. A part though of that amicable intercourse consists in selling their children to the Patagonians for slaves. The following incident led to the discovery of this slave-trade: Mr. Low heard Maria talking of ¢ zapallos,’* and asked her if she could get some for him—and how many? He thought she meant pumpkins (for which zapallos is Spanish); Maria replied, ** two boat loads,” and to show of what, pointed to a young slave, lately purchased from the Fuegians. When there are more zapallos among them than are wanted for slaves, or than suits their convenience, what becomes of them? While young, they may be more useful than when they grow old; and a wandering people, subsisting by hunting, would not in all probability take the trouble of providing for useless slaves, who might maintain themselves. The Patagonians are not so bar- barous as to kill them; then what becomes of those zapallos ? If they are not sent to the borders of the Skyring and Otway Waters, there to shift for themselves, with perhaps a few old horses, and even some young men who help them to hunt, the employment of their later years is unexplained. * *Zapallos,’ or some word of similar sound. 172 . COUNTING—RESPECT TO AGE. The canoe Indians are in reality despised by the Patago- nians ; but, for the sake of trade, are generally kept upon half- friendly terms. For dogs, old horses, guanaco meat, and old mantles, the former give pieces of iron pyrites (used for striking fire), their captives, or their children. Patagonians have a great antipathy to negroes. As soon as they see a black man, they shout, hoot, hiss, and make faces at him. No signs of hieroglyphics or writing have been noticed among the Patagonians. They can reckon as far as thousands. 'Time is counted by years and moons, days and nights. There are parti- cular words denoting the various phases of the moon, the sea- sons of the year, and the times of day and night. In counting, the fingers and toes are used, as well as words expressing num-— bers, especially when trying to make their meaning clear to strangers. Once, when Mr. Low was leaving Gregory Bay, he gave Maria to understand that he would return again in four moons, and asked her to have some guanaco meat ready for him when he should arrive. He returned a fortnight before his time. No meat was ready. Maria said he was too soon, explaining herself by holding three fingers up, and the fourth bent half down. ‘The few words of their language which have been collected by me are mentioned in the Appendix. The Patagonians pay respect to old people, taking great care of them; they seldom move about on ordinary occasions, but remain near the tolderia (village or encampment) with the herds of mares. It has been mentioned that the Patagonians have lately taken a liking to spirits. When intoxicated, they are very noisy, but not quarrelsome. They are very fond of tobacco ; and use some sort of pipe, frequently ornamented with brass and tassels: it is passed round from one to the other. They neither work, nor use any metal but what is obtained from white men. There is no kind of pottery made by them: wooden vessels, or bladders, being used for containing water. Many of them now have iron kettles, in which meat is some- times boiled, but their usual mode of cookery is roasting; a WOMEN—GRATITUDE. 173 piece of meat being put upon a wooden skewer, which is stuck into the ground near their fire. The conduct of the women does not correspond to their cha- racter drawn by Falkner; but their ideas of propriety may have been altered by the visits of licentious strangers. Both at Gregory Bay (on the north shore of Magalhaens Strait), and at the River Negro, the Patagonian women are now thought to be unfaithful to their husbands, and to care little about chas- tity. The men appear to give themselves no anxiety on the subject. Spirits, provisions, and (to them) valuable articles of hardware, or clothing which they receive, occupy much more of their attention. These Indians do not appear very sensible of heat or cold, if one may judge from their habits of life, and from their cloth- ing; in the latter, the only difference made during the coldest part of winter is wearing horse-hide boots more constantly. In summer, their feet and legs are generally naked. Both men and women wash themselves occasionally, neither regularly nor often; but the women are rather less uncleanly than the men. I have elsewhere mentioned that they comb their hair with the jawbone of a porpoise (obtained from the zapallos). They have also a small brush, made of coarse grass, twigs, or rushes, with which their toilet is assisted. When Mr. Low was returning from Monte Video, with the boy on board who has been spoken of as recognizing Capitan Chups, some natives were seen on Elizabeth Island (Strait of Magalhaens). A boat was sent, with the boy in her, to trade with them for skins. When near enough to distinguish per- sons, he seemed extremely frightened—clung to the thwarts of the boat—and begged not to be landed. 'These were canoe Indians, but of what tribe was not ascertained: he said they would certainly kill him. Some time after this boy had rejoined his family, Mr. Low was informed, by the Gregory Bay people, that he had collected seal-skins for ‘ Capitan Low,’ which he would not part with to any other person, as he knew they were the object of his friend’s trading voyages. This instance of gratitude for kind treatment speaks well for both 174 PATAGONIAN DOGS. parties : but, indeed, every white man who has passed any time among the Patagonian Indians agrees in giving a favourable account of the treatment experienced. The ‘ Basket-maker,’ however, would fare better than the ‘Scholar,’ I fancy, with these, as well as with most other tribes of savages, until ideas could be communicated clearly.* The dogs now found in the southern part of Patagonia have a wolfish appearance—their size, colour, hair, ears, nose, tail, and form being in general much like those of a wolf; though some black or spotted dogs are also seen. The roof of the mouth is black: the ears are always erect, and the nose sharp-pointed. I should say that their usual height is about that of a large fox- hound. Generally the coat is harsh or wiry, and rather short ; but there are some dogs among them which have thick woolly coats, like those of Newfoundland or large shepherd's dogs, which some resemble; others being more like lurchers ; but all have a wild wolf-like look, not at all prepossessing. I had a fine dog of this kind, rather like a Newfoundland, except in physiognomy, but his habits were so savage that he came to an untimely end. These dogs hunt by sight, without giving tongue; but they growl or bark loudly at the approach of strangers. As to attachment to their masters, the dogs we had could hardly give fair testimony, having been taken (bought) from them ; but to strangers they were always snappish. * With reference to what has been already mentioned about their migratory inclinations, I will here annex an omitted date:—Maria and her companions were at Gregory Bay in November 183]: at the River Negro in September 1832: and again at Gregory Bay,-in the Strait of Magalhaens, in March 1833. CHAPTER IX. Features—Form—Paint—Disposition—F ood—Doctor—Religious ideas Superstitions — Marriage — Death—Burial—C annibalism—W eapons ~ —Women’s occupation—Training—Obtaining food—Fire—Language —Sagacity and local knowledge —Battles — Ceremony — Natives in Trinidad Gulf—Obstruction Sound—Potatoes—Dogs. THE most remarkable traits in the countenance of a Fue- gian are his extremely small, low forehead; his prominent brow ; small eyes (suffering from smoke) ; wide cheek-bones ; wide and open nostrils; large mouth,.and thick lips. Their eyes are small, sunken, black, and as restless as those of savages in general. Their eyelids are made red and watery by the wood smoke in their wigwams. The chin varies much; that of a Tekeenica is smaller and less prominent than that of an Alikhoolip, in whom it is large and rather projecting, but there is much variety. The nose is always narrow between the eyes, and, except in a few curious instances, is hollow, in profile out- line, or almost flat. The mouth is coarsely formed (I speak of them in their savage state, and not of those who were in England, whose features were much improved by altered habits, and by education); their teeth are very peculiar: no canine, or eye-teeth, project beyond the rest, or appear more pointed than those; the front teeth are solid, and often flat-topped like those of a horse eight years old, and enamelled only at the sides: the interior substance of each tooth is then seen as plainly, in proportion to its size, as in that of a horse. Their hair is black, coarse, and lank, excepting the few instances mentioned in the next page. It grows by single hairs, not by piles, or by little bunches like very small camel-hair pencils. It does not fall off, nor does it turn gray until they are very old. Little, if any, hair is seen on the eye-brow. They would have a strag- gling beard, but scrupulously pull out every hair with tweezers made of muscle-shells. 176 HAIR—FEATURES—FoORM. As exceptions to the general appearance of these people, it ought to be said that, among the Fuegians, I have seen several individuals, both men and women, with curly or frizzled hair (like that of some of the Polynesians or Malays), with rather high foreheads, straight or aquiline noses; and in other fea- tures allied to the natives of New Zealand rather than to their countrymen of Tierra del Fuego. I was much struck by those exceptions, and, at the time, conjectured that they might be descendants of the Spanish colonists at Port Famine: but since then, having seen the Polynesians, I have been led to think otherwise; as will be mentioned in a future page relating to New Zealand. Phrenological remarks on the forms of their heads are added in the Appendix: some were made on the spot by Mr. Wilson, the former surgeon of the Beagle, and others by a person in London. Mr. Wilson’s paper also contains anatomical remarks and measurements. In this place it will be sufficient to remark that their heads are remarkably low, but wide; and full from the ears backward. The neck of a Fuegian is short and strong. His shoulders are syuare, but high; his chest and body are very large. The trunk is long, compared to the limbs and head. His arms and legs are rounder, and less sinewy, than those of Europeans; his joints are smaller, and his extre- mities are likewise comparatively less. ‘The hands are shaped like those of Europeans, but the feet, from always going bare- footed, are square at the toes, and would, by some persons, be considered of the Papua form. Most of them are rather bow- legged, and they turn their feet a little inwards in walking. The knee is strained by the custom of sitting so long on their heels, so that, when straightened, there are considerable folds or wrinkles of loose skin above and below the joint. The muscles of their thighs are large, but those of the legs, small. Little children are nearly of the same hue as their parents’ skin is when cleaned; but infants are, for a few days, rather lighter coloured. As I have already said, a small fillet is all that is worn around the head. Usually this is a mere string, made of the SIGNS—-PAINT—SHYNESS. LOT sinews of birds or animals; but, to make a show, they some- times stick feathers, bits of cloth, or any trash given to them, into these head-bands. White feathers, or white down, on the fillet, is a sign of hostility, or of being prepared for war. Red is the favourite colour, denoting peace, or friendly intentions, and much admired as ornamental. Red paint, made with ochre, is profusely used. Their white* paint is added to the red when preparing for war; but the marks made are mere daubs, of the rudest, if of any design. Black is the mourning colour. After the death of a friend, or near relation, they blacken themselves with charcoal, and oil or grease. Any sort of clay is used, if their paint is scarce, to preserve warmth rather than as an improvement to their appearance. When discovered by strangers, the instant impulse of a Fuegian family is to run off into the wood with their children, and such things as they can carry with them. After a short time, if nothing hostile is attempted by the intruders, and if they are not too numerous, the men return cautiously, making friendly signs, waving pieces of skins, rubbing and patting their bellies, and shouting. If all goes on quietly, the women fre- quently return, bringing with them the children; but they always leave the most valuable skins hidden in the bushes. This hasty concealment of seal or otter skins is the result of visits from sealers, who frequently robbed Fuegian families of every skin in their possession, before the natives understood the mo- tives of their expeditions in boats into the interior waters of Tierra del Fuego. Sometimes nothing will induce a single indi- vidual of the family to appear; men, women, and children hide in the thick woods, where it would be almost impossible to find them, and do not show themselves again until the strangers are gone: but during the whole time of their conceal- ment a watchful look-out is kept by them upon the motions of their unwelcome visitors. Scarcity of food, and the facility with which they move from one place to another in their canoes, are, no doubt, the reasons * Aluminous earth, indarated pipe clay, or decomposed feldspar. VOL, II. N 178 FOOD—DbocrTon. why the Fuegians are always so dispersed among the islands in small family parties, why they never remain long in one place, and why a large number are not seen many days in society. They never attempt to make use of the soil by any kind of culture ; seals, birds, fish, and particularly shell-fish, being their principal subsistence; any one place, therefore, soon ceases to supply the wants of even one family ; hence they are always migratory. In a few places, where the meeting of tides causes a constant supply of fish, especially porpoises, and where the land is broken into multitudes of irregular islets and rocks, whose shores afford an almost inexhaustible quantity of shell-fish, a few families may be found at one time, numbering altogether among them from twenty to forty souls; but even those approaches towards association are rare, and those very families are so migratory by nature, that they do not remain many months in such a spot, however productive it may be, but go wandering away among the numerous secluded inlets or sounds of their country, or repair to the outer sea-coast in search of seals, a dead whale, or fragments of some wrecked ship. During the summer they prefer the coast, as they then obtain a great quantity of eggs and young birds, besides seal, which come ashore to breed-at that season; and in the winter they retire more into the interior waters in search of shell-fish, and the small but numerous and excellent fish which they catch among the sea-weed (kelp). The substitutes for clothing, the arms, canoes, and dwell- ings of the Fuegians have been so often described already, that I will not tire the reader by a repetition. Some of their customs, hitherto not related, may be more interesting. There is no superiority of one over another, among the Fuegians, except that acquired gradually by age, sagacity, and daring conduct; but the ‘ doctor-wizard’ of each party has much influence over his companions. Being one of the most cun- ning, as well as the most deceitful of his tribe, it was not surpris- ing that we should always have found the ‘doctor’ concerned in all mischief and every trouble arising out of our intercourse ~ IDEAS OF RELIGION. 179 with these natives. It became a saying among us, that such a person was as troublesome as a Fuegian doctor. In each family the word of an old man is accepted as law by the young people; they never dispute his authority. War- fare, though nearly continual, is so desultory, and on so small a scale among them, that the restraint and direction of their elders, advised as they are by the doctors, is sufficient. Ideas of a spiritual existence—of beneficent and evil powers —they certainly have ; but I never witnessed or heard of any act of a decidedly religious nature, neither could I satisfy myself of their having any idea of the immortality of the soul. The fact of their believing that the evil spirit torments them in this world, if they do wrong, by storms, hail, snow, &c., is one rea- son why I am inclined to think that they have no thought of a future retribution. The only act I have heard of which could be supposed devotional, is the following. When Matthews was left alone with them for several days, he sometimes heard a great howling, or lamentation, about sun-rise in the morn- ing; and upon asking Jemmy Button what occasioned this outcry, he could obtain no satisfactory answer; the boy only saying, “ people very sad, cry very much.” Upon one occa- sion, when some canoes were alongside the Beagle, at a subsequent visit to the Beagle Channel (in 1834), a sudden howl from one of the Fuegians aroused several others who were near, and at the opposite side of the vessel, when a ge- neral howl of lamentation took place, which was ended by a low growling noise. By this, as well as by pulling their hair, and beating their breasts, while tears streamed down their faces, they evinced their sorrow for the fate of some friends who had perished, some days before the Beagle’s arrival, by the upsetting of a loaded canoe.* There was no regular weeping, nor any thing at all like the downright cry of a civilized being ; it was a noise which seemed to be peculiar to a savage. This howling was mostly among the men, only one young woman was similarly affected. Now whether the noises heard by * The bottom of a Fuegian canoe is full of mud, or clay, for the fire- place. n 2 180 SUPERSTITIONS. Matthews were occasioned by similar feelings, or by those of a devotional nature, I cannot pretend to say. The natives whom I carried to England often amused us by their superstitious ideas, which showed, nevertheless, that their ideas were not limited by the visible world. If any thing was said or done that was wrong, in their opinion it was certain to cause bad weather. Even shooting young birds, before they were able to fly, was thought a heinous offence. I remember York Minster saying one day to Mr. Bynoe, when he had shot some young ducks with the old bird—* Oh, Mr. Bynoe, very bad to shoot little duck—come wind—come rain—blow—very much blow.” . A great black man is supposed to be always wandering about the woods and mountains, who is certain of knowing every word and every action ; who cannot be escaped, and who influences the weather according to men’s conduct. York related a curi- ous story of his own brother, who had committed a murder. “In woods of my country,” said he, “some men go about alone; very wild men—have no belly (meaning probably that they were very thin), live by stealing from other men.” He then went on to say, that his brother had been getting birds out of acliff, and, on coming down, hid them among some long rushes, and went away. Soon afterwards he returned, and, see- ing feathers blown away by the wind from the spot, suspected what was going on; so taking a large stone in his hand, he crept stealthily towards the place, and there saw one of these wild men plucking a bird which he had got out of the cliff. Without saying a word, he dashed the stone at the wild man’s head, and killed him on the spot. Afterwards York’s bro- ther was very sorry for what he had done, particularly when it began to blow very hard. York said, in telling the story, “rain come down—snow come down—hail come down—wind blow—blow—very much blow. Very bad to kill man. Big man in woods no like it, he very angry.” At the word ‘blow,’ York imitated the sound of a strong wind; and he told the whole story in a very low tone of voice, and with a mysterious manner; considering it an extremely serious affair. DEATH— BURIAL. 181 Jemmy Button was also very superstitious, and a great believer in omens and dreams. He would not talk of a dead person, saying, with a grave shake of the head, “‘ no good, no good talk ; my country never talk of dead man.” While at sea, on board the Beagle, about the middle of the year 1832, he said one morning to Mr. Bynoe, that in the night some man came to the side of his hammock, and whispered in his ear that his father was dead. Mr. Bynoe tried to laugh him out of the idea, but ineffectually. He fully believed that such was the case, and maintained his opinion up to the time of finding his relations in the Beagle Channel, when, I regret to say, he found that his father had died some months previously. He did not forget to remind Mr. Bynoe (his most confidential friend) of their former conversation, and, with a significant shake of the head said, it was ‘‘ bad—very bad.” Yet those simple words, as Mr. Bynoe remarked, seemed to express the extent of his sorrow, for after that time he said no more about his father. This subsequent silence, however, might have been caused by the habit already noticed, of never mentioning the dead. When a person dies, his family wrap the body in skins, and carry it a long way into the woods; there they place it upon broken boughs, or pieces of solid wood, and then pile a great quantity of branches over the corpse. ‘This is the case among the Tekeenica and Alikhoolip tribes, as well as the Pecheray ; but how the others dispose of their dead, I know not, excepting that, on the west coast, some large caves have been found, in which were many humafi bodies in a dried state. One of these caves is mentioned in Byron’s narrative of the wreck of the Wager: and another was seen by Mr. Low, which will be spoken of in describing the natives of the western coast of Patagonia (the Chonos Indians), who from their intercourse with the Spaniards may be supposed to have acquired ideas somewhat more enlarged than those of the southernmost regions —the Alikhoolip and 'Tekeenica. I prefer relating all that I know of these tribes, in consequence of the intercourse earried on with them by the Beagle’s officers and myself, and the visit 182 MARRIAGE. of York, Jemmy, and Fuegia to England, before any of Mr. Low’s account is given ; because, as his intercourse was chiefly with the Chonos tribe, and was quite unconnected with the Beagle’s visit, it will be more satisfactory to the reader to be enabled to compare accounts from different sources, which in some points are so strikingly similar, that their agreement gives great weight to the whole. i The Fuegians marry young. As soon as a youth is able to maintain a wife, by his exertions in fishing or bird-catching, he obtains the consent of her relations, and does some piece of work, such as helping to make a canoe, or prepare seal-skins, &c. for her parents. Having built or stolen a canoe for himself, he watches for an opportunity, and carries off his bride. If she is unwilling, she hides herself in the woods until her ad- mirer is heartily tired of looking for her, and gives up the pur- suit; but this seldom happens. Although this is undoubt- edly the custom among many of them, we had some reason to think there were parties who lived in a promiscuous manner—a few women being with many men. It is, however, hardly fair to judge from what we saw during our short visit, when the ordi- nary habits of their life were certainly much altered. We observed, while at Woollya, a disproportionately small num- ber of females ; but it ought to be remembered, that the people whom we then saw came to look at us from a distance, and that the greater part of their women and children were pro- bably left in security at various places, as were the women and children of those who stole our boat in the former voyage (vol. i. p. 394) whom we found in a retired nook, far out of ordinary observation. Jemmy Button often talked of his father, mother, brothers, and sisters, also of uncles* and aunts, after he knew enough of our language to understand distinctly the relationship. Now this could not have been the case had not his father and mother lived together permanently as man and wife, according to the clear account which he himself always gave of their custom in this respect. * It was an uncle who gave him to me for some buttons. CANNIBALISM. 183 From the concurring testimony of the three Fuegians above- mentioned, obtained from them at various times and by many different persons, it is proved that they eat human flesh upon particular occasions, namely, when excited by revenge or extremely pressed by hunger. Almost always at war with adjoining tribes, they seldom meet but a hostile encounter is the result; and then those who are vanquished and taken, if not already dead, are killed and eaten by the conquerors. ‘The arms and breast are eaten by the women ; the men eat the legs ; and the trunk is thrown into the sea. During a severe winter, when hard frost and deep snow prevent their obtaining food as usual, and famine is staring them in the face, extreme hun- ger impels them to lay violent hands on the oldest woman of their party, hold her head over a thick smoke, made by burn- ing green wood, and pinching her throat, choke her. They then devour every particle of the flesh, not excepting the trunk, as in the former case. Jemmy Button, in telling this horrible story as a great secret, seemed to be much ashamed of his coun- trymen, and said, he never would do so—he would rather eat his own hands. When asked why the dogs were not eaten, he said “ Dog catch iappo” (iappo means otter). York told me that they always eat enemies whom they killed in battle ; and I have no doubt that he told me the truth. When the Dutch fleet were in Nassau Bay (1624), a boat’s crew were attacked by the natives, murdered and partly eaten. But previous to this (in 1599), Oliver Van Noort had attacked some Fuegians in a cave near acape, then called Nassau, where he killed several men, and took four boys and two girls pri- soners. Jemmy Button told me that there are two tribes of Te- keenica, differing only in situation, who go to war sometimes with one another, though usually at peace; they live east and west, respectively, of some islets in the Beagle Channel, a short distance north-eastward of Woollya. With these two tribes or subdivisions of the Tekeenica there is constant war made by the Yacana, called by Jemmy ‘ Oens-men ;’ but they (the Tekeenica) are sometimes at peace with the Alikhoolip. 184 FOOD—WEAPONS. The food of the Fuegians has been mentioned so often in the preceding pages of this or the former volume, that I will only add here a few remarks which have not hitherto been made. When there is time, the natives roast their shell-fish, and_half-roast any other food that is of a solid nature; but when in haste, they eat fish, as well as meat, in a raw state. A seal is considered to be a grand prize; for, besides the flesh, they feast on the oil; and a porpoise is much valued, for a similar reason. Seal are often killed on the rocks, by striking them on the nose with a club, or large stick : and rather than let a seal go, which has been intercepted by getting between it and the water, they will risk having a severe bite by attacking it with a stone in hand. Both seal and porpoises are speared by them from their canoes. When struck, the fish usually run into the kelp, with the spear floating on the water, being attached by a short line to a moveable barb; and there the men follow with their canoe, seize the spear, and tow by it till the fish is dead. To them, the taking of a seal or porpoise is a matter of as much consequence as the capture of a whale is to our countrymen. On moonlight nights, birds are caught when roosting, not only by the men but by their dogs, which are sent out to seize them while asleep upon the rocks or beach ; and so well are these dogs trained, that they bring all they catch safely to their masters, without making any noise, and then return for another mouthful. Birds are also frequently killed with arrows,* or by stones slung at them with unerring aim. Eggs are eagerly sought for by the natives; indeed, I may say that they eat any thing and every thing that is eatable, without being particular as to its state of freshness, or as to its having been near the fire. Penguins are much prized ; the otter is also valued, excepting the body part, which they seldom * These arrows are of hard wood, well polished, and quite straight. They are about two feet in length, and in a notch at the point haye a sharp triangular piece of agate, obsidian, or broken glass; which is not permanently fixed, and therefore remains in a wound, though the shaft may be drawn out. The bow is from three to four feet long, quite plain, with a string made of twisted sinews. FOOD—DRINK—WOMEN. 185 eat unless hard pressed by hunger. Sometimes they spear fine fish, like cod-fish—fifteen or twenty pounds in weight. Small fish are caught in abundance by the method formerly de- scribed,* and they are the staple article of food among the Tekeenica. The fins of a dead whale are esteemed; but if other food is to be had, they do not eat the blubber. In the Tekeenica country, near the Beagle Channel, there are many small animals, about the size of a cat, which they some- times take and eat. These, I think, are nutria; for, on one occasion, a fresh nutria skin was obtained from them, the only sign I ever found of a small animal in that neighbourhood. Of vegetable food they have very little: a few berries, cran- berries, and those which grow on the arbutus, and a kind of fungus, which is found on the birch-tree, being the only sorts used. This fungus is very plentiful in some places: it grows upon the birch-tree much as the oak-apple upon an oak-tree. Mr. Darwin describes it fully in his journal (vol. iii). There is also another much larger kind of fungus, which is sometimes eaten. On what tree it grows, I know not, but it was mentioned to me as being about two feet in circumference. The Fuegians drink only pure water, but often, and in large quantities. The women or children fetch it in small buckets, made of birch- bark ; and two or three times in the course of a night they wake to eat and drink. In the day-time also they eat and drink very frequently. The men procure food of the larger kind, such as seal, otter, porpoises, &c.; they break or cut wood and bark for fuel, as well as for building the wigwams and canoes. They go out at night to get birds; they train the dogs, and of course under- take all hunting or warlike excursions. The women nurse their children, attend the fire (feeding it with dead wood, rather than green, on account of the smoke), make baskets and water-buckets, fishing-lines and necklaces,+ go out to catch small fish in their canoes, gather shell-fish, dive for sea-eggs, take care of the canoes, upon ordinary occa- sions paddle their masters about while they sit idle ;—and do any other drudgery. * See vol. i. p. 428, + See note at end of chapter. 186 SWIMMING—TRAINING. Swimming is a favourite amusement of the Fuegians during summer ; but the unfortunate women are obliged to go out into rather deep water, and dive for sea-eggs in the depth of win- ter as often asin summer. Men, women, and children are excel- lent swimmers; but they all swim like dogs. Directly they come out of the water they run to the fire, and rub their bodies all over with oil or grease and ochreous earth, to keep out the cold. Swinging between branches of trees, as our children do, is also a favourite pastime, the ropes being made of strips of seal- skin. Frequently the men are lowered down by such ropes over the faces of high cliffs in search of eggs and young birds, or to attack the seal which herd in caves washed by the surf, and inaccessible to man from seaward. When ill, however seriously, they know of no remedies but rubbing the body with oil, drinking cold water, and causing perspiration by lying near the fire, wrapped up in skins. Both men and women are remarkably fond of the little chil- dren, and were always much pleased at any notice taken of them by our parties, when they felt sufficient confidence in us to bring the children forward. Much respect is said to be paid to age; yet we never saw either man or woman who appeared to be very old—certainly no one was decrepit. It is rather curious that usually each of these natives is trained to a particular pursuit: thus, one becomes an adept with the spear; another with the sling; another with a bow and arrows; but this excellence in one line does not hinder their attaining a considerable proficiency in all the others.* Hostilities are usually carried on with slings and stones rather than by close encounters; yet occasional surprises happen, especially when the Oens-men make an attack, and then there is savage work with clubs, stones in the hand, and spears. In the winter, when snow lies deep on the ground, the Tekeenica people assemble to hunt the guanaco, which then comes down from the bigh lands to seek for pasture near the sea. 'The long legs of the animal stick deeply into the snow and soft boggy ground, disabling him from escape, while the * Mr. Low has seen Fuegians with balls (bolas) in the northern part of their country. GUANACOES—FIRE. 187 Fuegians and their dogs hem him in on every side, and quickly make him their prey. Jemmy Button’s division of the Tekeenica, living westward of Murray Narrow, never obtain guanacoes; but the other division, who live eastward of that small passage, often kill them in winter; and at other times of the year they sometimes get them by lying in wait, and shooting them with arrows, or by getting into a tree near their track, and spearing them as they pass beneath the branches. An arrow was shewn to Low, which was marked with blood two-thirds of its length in wounding a guanaco, afterwards caught by dogs. Low held out his jacket, making signs that the arrow would not penetrate it : upon which the native pointed to his eye. Some of the families of this eastern division of the Tekeenica have no canoes, living entirely at a distance from the shore, and subsisting upon berries, birch-fungus, guanacoes, and birds. The bows and arrows of those men are longer and better, and they have some very fine dogs, which are trained to search for and bring home food. These dogs often surprise the larger birds, while feeding on the ground, as well as when they are at roost, so quietly do they steal upon their prey. Byron men- tions that the Chonos Indians send their dogs away to fish, and that they assist their owners in fishing, by swimming about, and driving the fish into a corner. 'This I have not witnessed or heard of among the Fuegians; but their dogs assist in a similar manner when in pursuit of an otter, by swimming and diving after it with the utmost eagerness. Fire, that essential necessary to man in every state and every climate, is always kept alive by these savages wherever they go, either in their canoes, in their wigwams, or even in their hand, by a piece of burning wood ; but they are at no loss to rekindle it, should any accident happen. With two stones (usually iron pyrites) they procure a spark, which received among tinder, and then whisked round in the air, soon kindles into a flame. The tinder used is the inner down of birds, well dried; very fine dry moss; or a dry kind of fungus found on the under side of half-rotten trees. Where the pyrites is 188 LANGUAGE— CAUTIONS. usually obtained, I do not know ; but it cannot be plentiful in the 'l'ekeenica country, since every woman keeps small pieces by her, in the basket which holds their paint and ornaments, and will not easily be prevailed upon to part with them. Some of the sealers have fancied these pieces of pyrites were silver or gold ore, and have eagerly sought for the mines whence they came. One person finding a large quantity in a rock some- where near the Gulf of Trinidad, employed his crew and him- self for many days in loading his ship with it, being quite sure it was gold. Of the Fuegian language we know but little, although three of the natives were so many months with us. f found great difficulty in obtaining words, excepting names for things which could be shown to them, and which they had in their own country ; however, the few which I have collected are given in the Appendix to this volume, and I can assure the reader that the utmost pains were taken to spell each word so as to ensure having the correct sound when pronounced by other persons; and to place the marks of accent, as well as quantity, with precision. All the Fuegian sounds are imitable by using our letters, excepting one, a curious sort of ‘ cluck, meaning ‘no.’ Many of their words are exceedingly guttural in their pronunciation, yet I have twice heard their women sing, and not disagreeably. Weddell, in his narrative (p. 173), gives some Fuegian words, and endeavours to trace a simila- rity to the Hebrew language. Molina also, in his vocabulary of the Araucanian language, which appears to be related to the Fuegian, traces some singular correspondences. Mr. Low, who has had more intercourse with the Fuegians than perhaps any other individual, gave me much information about them. He says that, generally speaking, they appear to be friendly when meeting strangers, but that their subsequent conduct depends entirely upon their relative numbers. ‘They ought never to be trusted, however, as they have hasty tempers, and are extremely revengeful. They show much hardiness and daring, being always ready to defend their own property, or resent any ill treatment; and they are enterprising thieves. CANNIBALISM. 189 When the intentions of the natives are hostile, the women and children are kept out of the way; the men are quite naked, their bodies painted more than usual, and the leader of the party hasa band of white feathers around his head. Mr. Low had a Fuegian boy on board the Adeona, who learned to speak English very tolerably, during eighteen months that he staid on board as a pilot and interpreter. This boy, whose name, among the sealers, was Bob, was one of the Chonos tribe, and had never been south of Magalhaens Strait before he embarked with Mr. Low. He said, that in cases of extreme distress, caused by hunger, human flesh was eaten, and that when they had recourse to such food, the oldest women inva- riably suffered. The poor creatures escaped to the woods, if possible, at such a time, but were soon found and brought back by force. They were killed by suffocation, their heads being held over the thick smoke of a fire made of green wood, and their throats squeezed by the merciless hands of their own relations. This boy imitated the piercing cries of the miserable victims whom he had seen sacrificed. He also men- tioned that the breasts, belly, hands, and feet, were most liked. When first questioned on this subject, he showed no reluctance in answering any questions about it; but after a time, perceiv- ing how much shocked his English companions were at the story, and how much disgust it excited among the crew of the vessel, he refused to talk of it again. The different tribes of canoe Indians are generally upon hostile terms with each other, as well as with the horse Indians. This may be more particularly noticed about the western entrance of Magalhaens Strait, where the tribes which inhabit opposite sides* are particularly inveterate in their hostility. On the west coast of Patagonia, from the Strait of Magal- haens to Cape Tres Montes, Mr. Low found that the natives seemed to be of one tribe, and upon friendly terms with one another. A man, whose native name was Niqueaccas, was taken on board Mr. Low’s vessel, near Cape Victory, as a pilot, * Chonos and Alikhoolip. 190 RELIGIOUS IDEAS.. and he afterwards proved to be acquainted with all the natives met with along the coast as far north as the parallel of 47°. He was always glad to see the various parties of Indians whom they met, and was invariably well received by them. Per- fectly acquainted with every part of the coast, he was able to point out excellent harbours, as well as the best seal ‘ rooke- ries.’ Niqueaccas and the boy Bob were of the same tribe; but whenever he was spoken to about eating people, he became sullen, and not a word could be obtained from him. He spoke English very fairly before leaving the vessel in his own country, after being with Mr. Low fourteen months. The people of this tribe* are by no means without ideas of a superior Being. They have great faith in a good spirit, whom they call Yerri Yuppon, and consider to be the author of all good: him they invoke in time of distress or danger. They also believe in an evil spirit, called Yaccy-ma, who they think is able to do all kinds of mischief, cause bad weather, famine, illness, &c.: he is supposed to be like an immense black man. After being hard pressed for food, and then obtaining a good quantity, much form is observed in dis- tributing the first supplies. Mr. Low witnessed a ceremony of this kind, during which the greatest order prevailed. The whole tribe was seated round a fire, and the oldest man gave each individual a share, repeatedly muttering a short prayer, and looking upwards. Not one of the party, although nearly starved, attempted to touch the food, a large seal, until this ceremony was ended: one share was offered to Mr. Low. At another time, on Madre de Dios Island, after having been detained in port upwards of three months, owing to very bad weather, during which time the natives were almost famished, being unable to reach the outer rocks in quest of food, Mr. Low went with his boats and procured a few seals, taking an Indian in each boat. At his return the carcasses of the seals were sent ashore, but not one of the natives, ravenous as they were, attempted to touch a morsel until all was landed, till the * Chonos. See page 194. 4 BURIAL PLACES—CUBBA. 191 ceremony above-mentioned had been duly performed, and till the natives who had been in the boats had chosen what they pleased for their share. This tribe appears to have regular places for depositing their dead; as on a small out-lying island, a little southward of Madre de Dios, Mr. Low found a cave which had been used for such a purpose : it was strewed with human bones, and the body of a native child was found in a state of putrefaction. The bodies seemed to have been placed in shallow graves, about a foot deep, which had been dug along the sides of the cave, and covered with twigs and leaves. Slips of a peculiar plant, resembling box, had been carefully planted along the outer sides of each grave, and those near the mouth of the cave had taken root and were growing, but all those in the interior had decayed. One evening, while at sea, Mr. Low called the boy to him, and said, “ Bob, look at the sun; it is going to be drowned.” The boy shook his head, saying, ‘‘ No, no drown ; to-morrow morning get up again. Sun go round earth; come again to- morrow.” The natives of this tribe* suppose that all white people originally came from the moon; they call them “* cubba;” and often make use of an expression with reference to them which means “ White men of the Moon.” These Indians, in com- mon with those of the other southern tribes, are exceedingly superstitious, implicitly believing omens, signs, and dreams, as well as the ‘wise men’ among them, who are thought infal- lible as prophets, doctors, and magicians. Once, when Mr. Low was detained about three weeks by contrary winds and bad weather, his crew became discontented, and attributed their ill-luck to a native who was detained on board against his will. To pacify those who were, in this instance, every bit as superstitious as the aborigines themselves, a fire was made on shore, to invite the Indians to approach ; and when they came he delivered their countryman to them, explaining at the same * Chonos. 192 SAGACITY. time that he would depart as soon as the wind became fair. An old Indian, then, in a very ceremonious and mysterious manner, gave Low what he understood to be a charm, with strict injunctions not to look at it until next morning ; when, at sunrise, there would be a fair wind, and the vessel might sail. Notwithstanding the old man’s orders, he was no sooner out of sight than Low opened the mysterious packet, which appeared to contain human hair, mixed with the scrapings of the shaft of an arrow. Next morning, however, at sunrise, a fair (easterly) wind sprung up, and the vessel sailed. How the old man foreknew the change—whether he judged by the sky, the tides, or other indications, did not transpire; but this was by no means a singular instance of extraordinary accuracy shown by the natives in foretelling changes of weather. The sagacity and extensive local knowledge of these people is very surprising; Niqueaccas was so well acquainted with all the coast between 47° and the Strait of Magalhaens, that, upon being taken toa high hill, immediately after landing from a cruise, in which they had been far out of sight of land, he pointed out the best harbours and places for seal then visible ; and in one direction, a long way off (pointing towards Eyre Sound, then far out of sight), he said there were great numbers of fur seals. The boy Bob also described that same place, when he was with Mr. Low at the Galapagos Islands. On a calm day, while there was nothing going on, he made a chart with chalk upon the vessel’s deck, reaching from the windlass to the taff- rail, and Mr. Low has since felt quite certain that the boy meant Eyre Sound, though at that time these interior waters on the west coast of Patagonia had not been explored by any white man. Niqueaccas was always anxious and timid about taking the Adeona through a passage where he knew danger existed, and proportionably pleased when the dangers were safely passed, and the vessel anchored in a safe position. The boy Bob, when only ten years old, was on board the Adeona at sea. As the vessel approached land, Low asked LOCAL KNOWLEDGE—WaAR. 193 him where a harbour could be found? As soon as he under- stood what was meant, which was an affair of some difficulty, for he then could speak but very little English, he got up on the vessel’s bulwark, and looked anxiously around. After some hesitation, he pointed to a place where the ship might go, and then went to the lead-line, and made signs to Mr. Low that he must sound as he approached the land. The cove was found to have a shoal and narrow entrance, but was safe and sufficiently spacious within. Such knowledge at so early an age is an extraordinary proof of the degree in which the perceptive and retentive faculties are enjoyed by these savages. Whenever the advice of Niqueaccas or any of his tribe was, 2jected, much sullenness and displeasure were shown. Upon one occasion his services were refused, and a harbour tried against his advice, which proved to be a bad one; it was left to seek for that which he had previously recommended, and his sullenness suddenly changed into delight; but when his harbour was pronounced excellent, and he was duly praised, his joy knew no bounds. Generally speaking, both Niqueaccas and the boy Bob were well-behaved and good-tempered ; but the boy was sometimes inclined to be mischievous, and would hide the people’s clothes, or put salt into their mouths while asleep. When much annoyed, he would use both teeth and nails, and attack any one, however superior to himself in size and strength. Battles between parties of the same tribe seem to occur occasionally, as this boy showed Mr. Low two spots where quarrels had been decided. Both were open spaces, clear of trees, and near them were the remains of wigwams. One of those battles occurred in consequence of one party wishing to take some seal-skins away from the other; but it did not distinctly appear from the boy’s account whether these encoun- ters were between parties of his tribe, or whether an encroach- ment upon their territory, with a view to plunder, had been made by some other tribe. That parties occasionally cross overland from Skyring Water to Obstruction Sound is evident from Mr. Bynoe’s account (page 198), and that people of the VOL. II. ; o 194 SIGNAL OF WAR. tribe to which Niqueaccas belonged either make excursions themselves southward of the Strait of Magalhaens, or that the Alikhoolip invade their territory and take away canoes, is evident from the fact of plank canoes* having been seen in and about the Barbara Channel. The arms used are similar to those of the Alikhoolip already described. A method of declaring war, ascertained by the following cir- cumstance, is rather curious. The boy Bob had been taken on board the Adeona, in consequence of some dispute with the natives, who had stolen things from the vessel. Mr. Low intended to keep him as a hostage until the missing pro- perty should be restored; but the tribe decamped, and as Low was obliged to sail, he carried the boy away with him. At the return of the vessel, about eight months afterwards, the boy saw something on shore, at the entrance of the harbour, which he looked at for some time very earnestly, and then gave Mr. Low to understand that the natives had declared war against him and his ship, and intended to attack her at her return. No natives being visible, Low went ashore with the boy, to see what it was that had attracted his attention, and found a number of spears, arrows, and clubs, roughly cut out of wood, painted red, and stuck into the ground, across a point of the island, and having in the middle a large block of wood, roughly carved into a strange figure (said by the boy to be that of their evil spirit) curiously painted, with long red teeth, and having a short halter of hide (seal-skin) round the part intended to represent a neck. Notwithstanding this outward demonstration of anger and intent to revenge, not a native was seen in the neighbourhood during the many months which Low passed there, and in consequence he had no opportunity of restoring the boy to his own tribe; but he was afterwards kindly received, and treated as Low’s son, among the Patago- nians of Gregory Bay. The natives of Niqueaccas’ tribe (Chonos) are less dishonest «and deceitful than those of the southernmost islands. Mr. Low * Plank canoes are used on the west coast. See page 142. REMARKABLE CONDUCT. 195 has sometimes left his vessel, while he was away sealing, with only two men on board; and although in one instance, at Madre de Dios, there were about a hundred and fifty natives assem- bled, no hostile or predatory attempt whatever was made by them in his absence : indeed so careful were they to prevent any cause for misunderstanding, that in no instance did more than two of their party go on board the vessel during the absence of the boats; though, after their return with Low, they went to her as usual in great numbers. This tribe was in extreme distress for want of food; the whole party looked thin and miserable. Continual gales had prevented the rocks from being uncovered at low water, and no canoe could be launched on account of the surf, therefore they could get neither shell-fish nor seal. A small party were observed going away, as if on an excursion, and the others who remained explained to Low, by signs, that in four sleeps they would return with food. On the fifth day they were met by Low, returning, but almost dead with fatigue, each man having two or three great pieces of whale-blubber, shaped like a poncho with a hole in the middle, on his shoulders. The blubber was half putrid, and looked as if it had been buried under ground. When they entered the largest wigwam, an old man cut very thin slices off one piece, broiled each successively, and distributed to the party in rota- tion; but before doing so, he muttered a few words over each piece in a mysterious manner, while strict silence was kept by the by-standers. One slice was offered to Low. The boy Bob once noticed marks where a whale had been cast ashore; taking a sharp stick, he probed the sand in several places, and found many large pieces of blubber, which were taken on board and boiled down for oil. One of the men of this tribe, seeing two long powder-horns on board the Adeona, placed them to his head and made a noise like the bellowing of cattle ; but he and his tribe were much frightened by sheep and pigs. They would not land on a small island where some pigs were turned loose, and when talking of them, made signs that they had very big noses which alarmed them. When a pig was killed by the crew 02 196 REMARKABLE CONDUCT. and part of it cooked, the natives refused even to taste the meat. One day several of these people had gone on board the Adeona with some old axes and pieces of iron, which they wished to have ground at her grindstone (a favour which had often been granted) ; but in consequence of something having gone wrong in the vessel, which had ruffled Low’s temper, he rather roughly refused to let them stay on board. They went away quietly, but left their axes, &c. behind; and while returning were met by the mate of the vessel, who asked if they had ground them ; they replied negatively, and gave the mate to understand that the captain’s face was too long, but that they would come again when it was shorter. This occurred before either Niqueaccas or the boy had been taken on board the Adeona. Mr. Low remarked to me that the conduct of these Indians on this occasion of his harshly refusing to comply with a slight request, was quite different from that which the Fuegians would have shown under similar circumstances: they would have been angry, and in all probability have returned his ill-temper with a display of their own, evinced by a shower of stones. Once, when Low was in the Magdalen Channel, he desired some Fuegians who were on board to leave the vessel while his men were below at dinner. They refused to comply, and offered resistance ; but being obliged to go, went in their canoes to a short distance a-head, and there remained slinging large stones on board, which broke several windows. ‘To drive them away muskets were used, though without injuring any of their party. Next day the hardy fellows came alongside again, as unconcernedly as ever. When the Fuegians are inclined to attack an enemy with stones, they generally try to raise a breastwork of boughs or logs; but no such preparation was ever noticed among the natives of the western coast of Patagonia. While the Adelaide tender was examining the inner pas- sages and sounds of the western shores of Patagonia, under Lieutenant Skyring, some interesting remarks were made by TRINIDAD NATIVES. 197 Mr. Bynoe, which do not appear in the narrative of that cruise given in the preceding volume. I shall here insert them in his own words :— “ We entered the Gulf of Trinidad, and while surveying thereabouts met two large canoes, which were thought to be whale-boats when first seen at a distance ; but as we concluded that some sealing vessel was in theneigh bourhood, and that these were her boats, little notice was taken of them until they had approached very near, when, to our astonishment they proved to be large plank canoes, pulled with oars, and full of fine stout Indians. Just within hail they stopped, lay on their oars, halloed to us most vociferously, and waved skins above their heads. One man was very conspicuous, having on his head a tall leathern cap, tapering to a point, which was orna- mented with feathers of various gaudy colours; and around the brim of this high conical hat there was also a fringe of feathers. This singular character was painted black all over from head to foot, except a circle of white round each eye, and a few white dots upon his cheeks. By signs we succeeded in tempting them to come alongside the schooner, and were then still more struck by their appearance: they were far superior to any Fuegians I had seen, being a taller race, more upright, and better proportioned ; their limbs were better formed, more muscular, rounder, and fuller than those of any canoe Indians of the Strait of Magalhaens or Barbara Channel; and their skins were cleaner as well as clearer, which was probably the reason why we thought them lighter coloured than the others whom we had seen. The length of back, so remarkable in a Fuegian, was not very discernible in these people, neither were they by any means so ugly as the former; indeed a rather pleasing smile was sometimes noticed on the younger faces. None among them were much smoke-dried, nor did their eyes look red and watery. ‘There did not appear to be one of the party above a middle age, and most of them were young. Three of the men had lost each an upper incisor tooth, and one had a long though not deep scar upon the breast. We all pro- nounced these people to belong to a finer race than we had 198 TRINIDAD NATIVES. seen on the water, and the size of their canoes was quite beyond anything hitherto noticed : they were near thirty feet in length and seven feet broad, with proportionate depth, being made of planks sewn together with strips of twisted bark and rushes: the bow and stern were flat, and nearly upright. Six round pieces of wood formed the thwarts, which were fastened to the gunwale by ropes of twisted rushes; and there were six short oars on each side. ‘These oars were about seven feet long, the blade being a flat piece of wood about sixteen inches in length, fastened to the handle by rush rope passed through two holes in the blade. Of such burthen were these boats (rather than canoes), that two men standing on one gunwale did not bring it down to the water. Each was steered by an old woman, who sat silently abaft with a paddle. All the party were quite naked excepting the old women. ‘From one of the old women a small bag was obtained, in exchange for a shirt and some woollen stuff, which proved to contain white dust, feathers, parrots’ heads, hawks’ feet, white earth, and red ochre. One of the men had an old hatchet, and made signs that he wanted to sharpen it at our grindstone: of course we complied with his request, and allowed a man and a young lad to come on board for that purpose. The lad turned the stone, while the man held the axe; and extremely well it was sharpened. The spears and slings were similar to those seen in other places. “ Although these natives seemed to be remarkably well dis- posed, it was not quite pleasant to see thirty of them looking over the schooner’s bulwark, while our boats were away and only five or six men left on board: however, they made no attempt to do any thing improper, and before sunset left us peaceably, striking up a song as they paddled away.” Mr. Bynoe remarked, that in the neighbourhood of Easter Bay (Obstruction Sound), the country had much the appear- ance of English park scenery ; large clumps of trees growing straight and tall, with intervening spaces of clear ground co- vered with long grass. In this place he found great numbers of wigwams and deserted canoes. Some of the former were of OBSTRUCTION SOUND. 199 large dimensions, and various shapes: two were like inverted whale-boats, each of which might hold forty or fifty people ; and in the long ones (six feet high), Mr. Bynoe could walk upright. All of them were built of slight materials, such as branches of trees covered with long grass. Five or six large wigwams stood together in each place; and near them canoes had evidently been built, for many trees had been felled and barked close by. The traces of fire were visible, which had been trained around the roots of the trees; and many large pieces of bark were lying about, partly sewed together. Four good canoes were found in one place, one of the four being quite new : and there were many old or broken ones. They also saw on nearly every sandy point a neatly-constructed small wigwam, about two feet high, at the entrance of which was a platted rush noose, intended as a snare to catch swans pro- bably, which were numerous about the adjoining grounds, and generally roost on those sandy points. Many deer, like a kind of roebuck, were seen by Mr. Bynoe, but he did not suceeed in shooting one. Horse tracks were seen near the upper part of Obstruction Sound; showing that the eastern Patagonians occasionally visit this part of the western coast. Mr. Bynoe suggested the possibility of the natives of Skyring Water tra- velling overland, building canoes, and then going northward along the west coast ; but I do not myself think it so likely as that the Chonos Indians should select such a spot, abounding in food, to pass their winter in, or to stay at for a considerable time while building canoes. Probably, when Mr. Bynoe was there (being summer-time) the tribe, whose winter quarters it had been, were dispersed along the sea-coast in search of seal, eggs, and young birds. In support of his idea Mr. By- noe says, “ I only met one canoe, and that of the bark kind, in the Mesier Channel: whence could that one have come? None of the bark canoes have been seen by us on the west coast, excepting in that instance, and in Obstruction Sound. The distance from Skyring Water to the head of Obstruction Sound is small, though sufficiently difficult to traverse to prevent transporting canoes, because of low prickly brushwood. 200 POTATOES. How can_we account for the numerous canoes stranded in Ob- struction Sound, excepting by a supposition that the natives, after using them in a north-westerly excursion, left them behind at their return, as they may have left others on the shores of Skyring Water? These canoes were all of bark, and rather smaller than those usually made by the southern Fuegians.” Should this be the case, there can no longer be any doubt of the non-existence of a direct passage between Skyring Water and the Smyth Channel (leading northwards from Magalhaens Strait). Perhaps the horse Indians sometimes stay in the neighbourhood of Obstruction Sound, and oblige their slaves (zapallos) to build canoes and swan-traps, to fish for them, and even make excursions for seal. Mr. Bynoe saw many nutria among the islands of Western Patagonia, anda great number of otters. Brant-geese, swans, ducks, and rock-geese were also plentiful in particular places, but not generally. Besides the wild potato, found on the Guaianaco islands (mentioned in the first volume), Mr. Bynoe noticed, in the Gulf of Peas, an abundance of the plant called * pangue,’ which grows also in Childe, and is so much liked by the Chilotes. Mr. Low said that natives whom he met in the Gulf of Tri- uidad relished potatoes which he gave them, and asked for more. They pointed towards the north and used the word ‘ aquinas,’ which he recognized as being the term used for potatoes by the aborigines at the south of Childe. A native who was on board the Adeona in one of her excur- sions among the western islands of Patagonia induced Low to take long walks in search of potatoes, which never were found ; and afterwards, in the Mesier Channel, he persuaded him to go about in quest of seals, until an opportunity offered for escap- ing toa small party of his own tribe whom he met there. When taxed by the crew with deceiving Mr. Low about the potatoes, he fell into (or affected) a violent passion, and sprung at the nearest man, grappling him in a most determined and malicious manner. Having now mentioned all that I know respecting the Canoe DOGS. 201 Indians (excepting some facts related by Capt. King in vol. .), I will add a few words about their constant and faithful com- panion, the dog: and then continue the narrative. The dog of a Fuegian or Chonos Indian is small, active, and wiry, like a terrier with a cross of fox. His hair is usually rough, and dusky, or dark-coloured ; but there are many dogs among the Fuegians almost white, or prettily spotted, some of which have fine smooth hair. All that were examined had the roof of their mouth black, the ears erect, large, and pointed ; the nose sharp, like that of a fox; the tail drooping, and rather inclined to be bushy. They are exceedingly vigilant and faithful. Their sagacity is shown in many ways, some of which I have already noticed ; and not least, in their providing for themselves, each low-water, by cunningly detaching limpets from the rocks, or by breaking muscle and other shells, and then eating the fish. These dogs bark at strangers with much fury: and they give tongue eagerly when hunting the otter.* * Byron says they do so likewise when driving fish into corners. Norse to page 185.—The Fuegian necklaces show some ingenuity in those who make them, being composed of small shells, perforated very neatly, and fastened together on strings of sinews or gut, so finely divided and platted, that one is, at first, inclined to doubt their being the manu- facture of such uncouth savages. CHAPTER X. Set out to land Matthews and the Fuegians—Their meeting with Natives —Supposed Voleano—Dream—Oens-men—Scene—Arrival at W oollya —Encampment—Concourse of Natives—Jemmy’s Family—Wigwams —Gardens—Distrust—Experiment— Westward Exploration—Remove Matthews—Revisit Woollya—Gale—Sail for the Falkland Islands. Ar the end of Chapter v1., I described our preparations for landing the Fuegians, who had been in England, among their own countrymen; and now, having attempted to give a fuller idea of those people, the narrative of our proceedings shall be continued. Jan. 19, 1833. The yawl, being heavily laden, was towed by the other three boats, and, while her sails were set, went almost as fast as they did; but after passing Cape Rees, and altering our course to the westward, we were obliged to drag her along by strength of arm against wind and current. The first day no natives were seen, though we passed along thirty miles of coast, and reached Cutfinger Cove. (This name was given because one of our party, Robinson by name, almost deprived himself of two fingers by an axe slipping with which he was cutting wood.) At this place, or rather from a hill above it, the view was striking. Close to us was a mass of very lofty heights, shutting out the cold southerly winds, and collecting a few rays of sunshine which contrived to struggle through the frequent clouds of Tierra del Fuego. Opposite, beyond a deep arm of the sea, five miles wide, appeared an extensive range of mountains, whose extremes the eye could not trace; and to the westward we saw an immense canal, looking like a work of gigantic art, extending between parallel ranges of mountains, of which the summits were capped with snow, though their sides were covered by endless forests. This sin- gular canal-like passage is almost straight and of nearly an MEET NATIVES—VOLCANO. 203 uniform width (overlooking minute details) for one hundred and twenty miles. 20th. We passed the clay cliffs, spoken of in the former volume, first visited by Mr. Murray. They narrow the channel to less than a mile, but, being low, were beneath the horizon of our eye at Cutfinger Cove :—westward of them the chan- nel widens again to its usual breadth of two miles. Several natives were seen in this day’s pull; but as Jemmy told us they were not his friends, and often made war upon his people, we held very little intercourse with them. York laughed heartily at the first we saw, calling them large monkeys; and Jemmy assured us they were not at all like his people, who were very good and very clean. Fuegia was shocked and ashamed; she hid herself, and would not look at them a second time. It was interesting to observe the change which three years only had made in their ideas, and to notice how completely they had forgotten the appearance and habits of their former associates ; for it turned out that Jemmy’s own tribe was as inferior in every way as the worst of those whom he and York called ** monkeys—dirty—fools—not men.” We gave these ‘ Yapoos,’ as York called them, some pre- sents, and crossed over to the north side of the channel to be free from their importunities; but they followed us speedily, and obliged us to go on further westward than was at all agreeable, considering the labour required to make way against a breeze and a tide of a mile an hour. When we at last landed to pass the night, we found that the forests on the sides of the mountains had been burned for many leagues ; and as we were not far from the place where a volcano was supposed to exist, in consequence of flames having been seen by a ship passing Cape Horn, it occurred to me that some conflagration, like that of which we found the signs, might have caused appear- ances resembling the eruption of a distant volcano: and I have since been confirmed in this idea, from having witnessed a volcano in eruption ; and, not long afterwards, a conflagration, devouring many miles of mountain forest ; both of which, at a distance, shewed lines of fire, fitful flashes, and sudden gleams. 204 CONFLAGRATION—DREAM. Jan. Persons who have witnessed a forest burning on the side of a mountain, will easily perceive how, when seen from a distance, it may resemble the eruption of a volcano; but to those who have not seen fire on such a scale, I may remark that each gust of wind, or temporary calm; each thick wood, or comparatively barren space ; augments or deadens the flames so suddenly, as the fire sweeps along the mountain side, that, at a distance of fifty miles or more, the deception may be complete. 22d. Favoured by beautiful weather, we passed along a tract of country where no natives were seen. Jemmy told us it was ‘land between bad people and his friends ;”’ (neutral-ground probably). This evening we reached a cove near the Murray Narrow; and from a small party of Tekeenica natives, Jemmy’s friends, whom we found there, he heard of his mother and brothers, but found that his father was dead. Poor Jemmy looked very grave and mysterious at the news, but showed no other symptom of sorrow. He reminded Bennett* of the dream (related in the previous chapter), and then went for some green branches, which he burned, watching them with a solemn look : after which he talked and laughed as usual, never once, of his own accord, recurring to the subject of his father’s decease. The language of this small party, who were the first of Jemmy’s own tribe whom we met, seemed softer and less guttural than those of the “ bad men” whom we had passed near the clay cliffs ; and the people themselves seemed much better disposed, though as abject and degraded in outward appearance as any Fuegians I had ever seen. There were three men and two women : when first we were seen they all ran away, but upon two of our party landing and advancing quietly, the men returned and were soon at their ease. Jemmy and York then tried to speak to them; but to our surprise, and much to my sorrow, we found that Jemmy had almost forgotten his native language, and that, of the two, York, although belonging to another tribe, was rather the best interpreter. In a few minutes the natives comprehended that we should do them no harm ; and they then called back their women, who were hiding in the * My coxswain. 1833. JEALOUSY—OENS-MEN. 205 woods, and established themselves, very confidently, in a wig= wam within a hundred yards of our tents. During this and the preceding day, we found the weather, by comparison, so mild, even warm, that several of our party bathed ; yet the ther- mometer ranged only to 53° in the shade, and at night fell to 40°. The temperature of the sea was 48°. Being within a few hours’ pull (row) of Jemmy’s ‘ own land,’ which he called Wooll¥a, we all felt eager, though anxious, and I was much gratified by seeing that Matthews still looked at his hazardous undertaking as steadily as ever, betraying no symptom of hesitation. ‘The attentions which York paid to his intended wife, Fuegia, afforded much amusement to our party. He had long shewn himself attached to her, and had gradually become excessively jealous of her good-will. If any one spoke to her, he watched every word ; if he was not sitting by her side, he grumbled sulkily; but if he was accidentally separated, and obliged to go in a different boat, his behaviour became sullen and morose. This evening he was quizzed so much about her that he became seriously angry, and I was obliged to interpose to prevent a quarrel between him and one of his’steadiest friends. On this and previous evenings, as we sat round the blaz- ing piles, which our men seemed to think could never be large enough, we heard many long stories from Jemmy about the Oens, or Coin men, who live beyond the mountains at the north side of the Beagle Channel, and almost every year make despe- rate inroads upon the Tekeenica tribe, carrying off women and children, dogs, arrows, spears, and canoes; and killing the men whom they succeed in making prisoners. He told us that these Oens-men made their annual excursions at the time of ‘red leaf ;’ that is in April or May, when the leaves of deci- duous trees are changing colour and beginning to fall; just the time of year also when the mountains are least difficult to pass. At that period these invaders sometimes come down to the shores of the Beagle Channel in parties of from fifty to a hun- dred; seize upon canoes belonging to the Yapoo division of 206 OENS-MEN—ARRIVALS. Jan. the Tekeenica tribe, cross over to Navarin Island, and thence sometimes to others, driving the smaller and much inferior Tekeenica people before them in every direction. By Jemmy’s own account, however, there are hard battles sometimes, and the Oens tribe lose men; but as they always contrive to carry away their dead, it seems that the advantage of strength is on their side. These periodical invasions of a tribe whose abode is in the north-eastern quarter of 'Tierra del Fuego are not to be con- founded with the frequent disputes and skirmishes which take place between the two Tekeenica tribes; and it is interesting to compare what we thus heard with the account obtained by Oliver Van Noort in 1589: who learnt that the people lived in caves dug in the earth, * and that there were five tribes—four of ordinary stature and one of gigantic size. These giants, called Tiremenen, lived in * Coin.’ The other tribes were called Enoo, Kemenites, Karaike, and Kenneka. 23d. While embarking our tents and cooking utensils, seve- ral natives came running over the hills towards us, breathless with haste, perspiring violently, and bleeding at the nose. Startled at their appearance, we thought they had been fight- ing; but it appeared in a few moments, that having heard of our arrival, they lost not a moment in hurrying across the hills from a place near Wooll¥a, and that the bloody noses which had surprised us were caused by the exertion of running. This effect has been noticed among the New Hollanders, I believe the islanders of the Pacific Ocean, as well as the Esquimaux, and probably others; but to our party it was then a novelty, and rather alarming. Scarcely had we stowed the boats and embarked, before canoes began to appear in every direction, in each of which was a stentor hailing us at the top of his voice. Faint sounds of deep voices were heard in the distance, and around us echoes to the shouts of our nearer friends began to reverberate, and warned me to hasten away before our movements should be- * The ground within a wigwam is scooped out considerably. yl ateeh lhe HOSTAGE—SCENE—NOISE. 207 come impeded by ‘he number of canoes which I knew would soon throng around us. Although now among natives who seemed to be friendly, and to whom Jemmy and York con- trived to explain the motives of our visit, it was still highly necessary to be on our guard. Of those men and boys who ran over the hills to us, all were of Jemmy’s tribe excepting onc man, whom he called an Oens-man; but it was evident, from his own description, that the man belonged to the Yapoo, or eastern Tekeenica tribe, and was living in safety among his ‘usual enemies, as a hostage for the security of a man belonging to Jemmy’s tribe who was staying among the eastern people. As we steered out of the cove in which our boats had been sheltered, a striking scene opened: beyond a lake-like expanse of deep blue water, mountains rose abruptly to a great height, and on their icy summits the sun’s early rays glittered as if on a mirror. Immediately round us were mountainous emi- nences, and dark cliffy precipices which cast a very deep shadow over the still water beneath them. In the distant west, an opening appeared where no land could be seen; and to the south was a cheerful sunny woodland, sloping gradually down to the Murray Narrow, at that moment almost undis- tinguishable. As our boats became visible to the natives, who were eagerly paddling towards the cove from every direction, hoarse shouts arose, and, echoed about by the cliffs, seemed to be a continual cheer. In a very short time there were thirty or forty canoes in our train, each full of natives, each with a column of blue smoke rising from the fire amidships, and almost all the men in them shouting at the full power of their deep sonorous voices. As we pursued a winding course around the bases of high rocks or between islets covered with wood, continual additions were made to our attendants; and the day being very fine, without a breeze to ruffle the water, it was a scene which carried one’s thoughts to the South Sea Islands, but in Tierra del Fuego almost appeared like a dream. After afew hours (pulling hard to keep a-head of our train) we reached Woollya, and selected a clear space favourably situated for our encampment, landed, marked a boundary-line, 208 WOOLLYA—ENCAMP. placed sentries, and made the various arrangements necessary for receiving the anticipated visits of some hundred natives. We had time to do all this quietly, as our boats had distanced their pursuers several miles, while running from the Murray Narrow before a favourable breeze which sprung up, and, to our joy, filled every sail. We were much pleased by the situation of Woollya, and Jemmy was very proud of the praises bestowed upon his land. Rising gently from the water-side, there are considerable spaces of clear pasture land, well watered by brooks, and backed by hills of moderate height, where we afterwards found woods of the finest timber trees in the country. Rich grass and some beautiful flowers, which none of us had ever seen, pleased us when we landed, and augured well for the growth of our garden seeds. At our first approach, only a few natives appeared, who were not of Jemmy’s family. ‘The women ran away and hid themselves, but Jemmy and York contrived (with difficulty) to make the men comprehend the reason of our visit; and their awkward explanation, helped by a few presents, gradually put them at ease. They soon understood our meaning when we pointed to the boundary-line which they were not to pass. This line was on the shore between our tents and the grass- land ; immediately behind the tents was a good landing-place, always sheltered, where our boats were kept in readiness in case of any sudden necessity. Soon after our arrangements were made, the canoes which had been following us began to arrive; but, much to my satis- faction, the natives landed in coves at some distance from us, where the women remained with the canoes while the men and boys came overland to our little camp. This was very favourable for us, because it divided their numbers and left our boats undisturbed. We had only to guard our front, instead of being obliged to look out all round, as I had expected ; and really it would have been no trifling -affair to watch the pilfering hands and feet of some hundred natives, while many of our own party (altogether only thirty in num- FAMILY ARRIVE. 209 ber) were occupied at a distance, cutting wood, digging ground for a garden, or making wigwams for Matthews, York, and Jemmy. As the natives thronged to our boundary-line (a mere mark made with a spade on the ground), it was at first difficult to keep them back without using force; but by good temper on the part of our men, by distributing several presents, and by the broken Fuegian explanations of our dark-coloured ship- mates, we succeeded in getting the natives squatted on their hams around the line, and obtaining influence enough over them to prevent their encroaching. Canoes continued to arrive ; their owners hauled them ashore on the beach, sent the women and children to old wigwams at a little distance, and hastened themselves to see the strangers. While I was engaged in watching the proceedings at our encampment, and poor Jemmy was getting out of temper at the quizzing he had to endure on account of his countrymen, whom he had extolled so highly until in sight, a deep voice was heard shouting from a canoe more than a mile distant : up started Jemmy from a bag full of nails and tools which he was distributing, leaving them to be scrambled for by those nearest, and, upon a repetition of the shout, exclaimed “ My brother!” He then told me that it was his eldest brother’s voice, and perched himself on a large stone to watch the canoe, which approached slowly, being small and loaded with several people. When it arrived, instead of an eager meeting, there was a cautious circumspection which astonished us. Jemmy walked slowly to meet the party, consisting of his mother, two sisters, and four brothers. The old woman hardly looked at him before she hastened away to secure her canoe and hide her property, all she possessed—a basket containing tinder, fire- stone, paint, &c., and a bundle of fish. The girls ran off with her without even looking at Jemmy; and the brothers (a man and three boys) stood still, stared, walked up to Jemmy, and all round him, without uttering a word. Animals when they meet show far more animation and anxiety than was displayed at this meeting. Jemmy was evidently much morti- VOL. Il. P 210 MAKE WIGWAMS-—GARDENS. Jan. fied, and to add to his confusion and disappointment, as well as my own, he was unable to talk to his brothers, except by broken sentences, in which English predominated. After a few minutes had elapsed, his elder brother began to talk to him ; but although Jemmy understood what was said, he could not reply. York and Fuegia were able to understand some words, but could not or did not choose to speak. This first evening of our stay at Woollya was rather an anxious one; for although the natives seemed inclined to be quite friendly, and they all left us at sunset, according to their invariable practice, it was hard to say what mischief might not be planned by so numerous a party, fancying, as they probably would, that we were inferior to them in strength, because so few in number. Jemmy passed the evening with his mother and brothers, in their wigwam, but returned to us to sleep. York, also, and Fuegia were going about among the natives at their wigwams, and the good effect of their inter- course and explanations, such as they were, was visible next day (24th) in the confident, familiar manner of the throng which surrounded us while we began to dig ground for gar- dens, as well as cut wood for large wigwams, in which Mat- thews and his party were to be established. Canoes still arrived, but their owners seemed as well-disposed as the rest of the natives, many of whom assisted us in carrying wood, and bringing bundles of grass or rushes to thatch the wig- wams which they saw we were making, in a pleasant shel- tered spot, near a brook of excellent water. One wigwam was for Matthews, another for Jemmy, and a third for York and Fuegia. York told me that Jemmy’s brother was “very much friend,” that the country was “very good land,” and that he wished to stay with Jemmy and Matthews. A small plot of ground was selected near the wigwams, and, during our stay, dug, planted and sowed with potatoes, carrots, turnips, beans, peas, lettuce, onions, leeks, and cabbages. Jemmy soon clothed his mother and brothers, by the assis- tance of his friends. For a garment which I sent the old woman she returned me a large quantity of fish, all she had to offer ; 1833. WASHING—DOCTOR. 211 and when she was dressed, Jemmy brought her to see me. His brothers speedily became rich in old clothes, nails and _ tools, and the eldest were soon known among the seamen as Tommy Button and Harry Button, but the younger ones usually staid at their wigwams, which were about a quarter of a mile distant. So quietly did affairs proceed, that the following day (25th) a few of our people went on the hills in search of guanacoes : many were seen, but they were too wild to approach. An old man arrived, who was said to be Jemmy’s uncle, his father’s bro- ther ; and many strangers came, who seemed to belong to the Yapoo Tekeenica tribe. J emmy did not like their visit ; he said they were bad people, ‘no friends.’ 26th. While some of my party were washing in a stream, stripped to the waist, several natives collected round, and were much amused at the white skins, as well as at the act of washing, so new probably to them. One of them ran to the nearest wigwams, and a troop of curious gazers collected, whose hands, however, were soon so actively employed in abstracting the handkerchiefs, shoes, &c., which had been laid on the bank, that a stop was put to the ablutions. We discovered that Jemmy’s eldest brother was a ‘ doctor, and though young for his occupation of conjuring and pre- tending to cure illness, he was held in high estimation among his own tribe. I never could distinctly ascertain whether the eldest man, or the doctor of a tribe had the most influence; but from what little I could learn, it appeared to me that the elder of a family or tribe had a sort of executive authority, while the doctor gave advice, not only in domestic affairs, but with respect to most transactions. In all savage nations, I believe there is a person of this description—a pretended prophet— conjuror—and, to a certain degree,—doctor. This evening our party were employed for a short time in firing at a mark, with the three-fold object of keeping our arms in order—exercising the men—and aweing, without frightening, thenatives. While this was going on, the Fuegians sat about on their hams, watching our proceedings, and often eagerly talk- ing to each other, as successful shots were made at the target, PQ 212 SCOUT—DEPARTURE. Jan. which was intentionally placed so that they could see the effect of the balls. At sunset they went away as usual, but looking very grave, and talking earnestly. About an hour after dark, the sentry saw something moving along the ground near our tents, within the boundary line, which he thought was a wild animal, and had just levelled his musket to fire at it, when he discovered it was aman, who instantly darted off, and was lost in the darkness. Some native had doubtless stolen to the tents, to see what we were doing ; perhaps with a view to surprise us, if asleep, perhaps only to steal. 27th. While a few of our party were completing the thatch of the last wigwam, and others were digging in the garden which was made, I was much surprised to see that all the natives were preparing to depart; and very soon afterwards every canoe was set in motion,—not half a dozen natives remaining. Even Jemmy’s own family, his mother and bro- thers, left us; and as he could give no explanation of this sudden departure, I was in much doubt as to the cause. Whether an attack was meditated, and they were removing the women and children, previous to a general assembly of the men, or whether they had been frightened by our display on the preceding evening, and feared that we intended to attack them, I could not ascertain; but deeming the latter by far the most probable, I decided to take the opportunity of their departure to give Matthews his first trial of passing a night at the new wigwams. Some among us thought that the natives intended to make a secret attack, on account of the great temptation our pro- perty offered ; and in consequence of serious offence which had been taken by two or three old men, who tried to force them- selves into our encampment, while I was at a little distance ; one of whom, when resisted by the sentry, spit in his face ; and went off in a violent passion, muttering to himself, and every now and then turning round to make faces and angry ges- tures at the man who had very quietly, though firmly, pre- vented his encroachment. In consequence of this incident, and other symptoms of a 1833. STRANGERS—MATTHEWS. 213 disposition to try their strength, having more than three hun- dred men, while we were but thirty, I had thought it ad- visable, as I mentioned, to give them some idea of the wea- pons we had at command, if obliged to use them, by firing at a mark. Probably two-thirds of the natives around us at that time had never seen a gun fired, being strangers, coming from the Beagle Channel and its neighbourhood, where no ves- sel had been ; and although our exercise might have frightened them more than I wished, so much, indeed, as to have induced them to leave the place, it is not improbable that, without some such demonstration, they might have obliged us to fire at them instead of the target. So many strangers had arrived during the few days we remained, I mean strangers to Jemmy’s family —men of the eastern tribe, which he called Yapoo—that his brothers and mother had no longer any influence over the majority, who cared for them as little as they did for us, and were intent only upon plunder. Finding this the case, I con- clude that Jemmy’s friends thought it wise to retreat to a neighbouring island before any attack commenced; but why they did not tell Jemmy their reasons for going, I know not, neither could he tell me more than that they said they were going to fish, and would return at night. This, however, they did not do. In the evening, Matthews and his party—Jemmy, York, and Fuegia—went to their abode in the three new wigwams. In that made for Matthews, Jemmy also took up his quarters at first: it was high and roomy for such a construction; the space overhead was divided by a floor of boards, brought from the ship, and there most of Matthews’ stores were placed ; but the most valuable articles were deposited in a box, which was hid in the ground underneath the wigwam, where fire could not reach. Matthews was steady, and as willing as ever; neither Y ork nor Jemmy had the slightest doubt of their being all well- treated; so trusting that Matthews, in his honest intention to do good, would obtain that assistance in which he confided, I decided to leave him for a few days. ‘The absence of the 214 PILFERING—TRIAL. Jan. natives, every one of whom had decamped at this time, gave a good opportunity for landing the larger tools belonging to Matthews and our Fuegians, and placing them within or beneath his wigwam, unseen by any one except ourselves ; and at dusk, all that we could do for them being completed, we left the place and sailed some miles to the southward. During the four days in which we had so many natives about us, of course some thefts were committed, but nothing of consequence was stolen. I saw one man talking to Jemmy Button, while another picked his pocket of a knife, and even the wary York lost something, but from Fuegia they did not take a single article; on the contrary, their kindness to her was remarkable, and among the women she was quite a pet. Our people lost a few trifles, in consequence of their own carelessness. Had they themselves been left among gold and diamonds, would they all have refrained from indulging their acquisitive inclinations ? Notwithstanding the decision into which I had reasoned myself respecting the natives, I could not help being exceed- ingly anxious about Matthews, and early next morning our boats were again steered towards Woollja. My own anxiety was increased by hearing the remarks made from time to time by the rest of the party, some of whom thought we should not again see him alive; and it was with no slight joy that I caught sight of him, as my boat rounded a point of land, car- rying a kettle to the fire near his wigwam.. We landed and ascertained that nothing had occurred to damp his spirits, or in any way check his inclination to make a fair trial. Some natives had returned to the place, among them one of Jemmy’s brothers ; but so far were they from showing the slightest ill- will, that nothing could be more friendly than their behaviour. Jemmy told us that these people, who arrived at daylight that morning were his friends, that his own family would come in the course of the day, and that the ‘bad men,’ the stran- gers, were all gone away to their own country. A further trial was now determined upon. The yawl, with one whale-boat, was sent back to the Beagle, and I set out on 1833. WESTWARD EXPLORATION. 215 a westward excursion, accompanied by Messrs. Darwin and Hamond, in the other two boats: my intention being to com- plete the exploration of Whale-boat Sound, and the north-west arm of the Beagle Channel; then revisit Wooll¥a, either leave or remove Matthews, as might appear advisable, and repair to our ship in Goree Road. With a fair and fresh wind my boat and Mr. Hamond’s passed the Murray Narrow, and sailed far along the channel towards the west, favoured, unusually, by an easterly breeze. Just as we had landed, and set up our tent for the night, some canoes were seen approaching ; so rather than be obliged to watch their movements all night, we at once embarked our tent and half-cooked supper, and pulled along the shore some miles further, knowing that they would not willingly follow us in the dark. About midnight, we landed and slept undisturbed. Next day we made little progress, the wind having changed, and landed, earlier than usual, on the north side of the channel, at Shingle Point. Some natives soon appeared, and though few in number, were in- clined to give trouble. It was evident they did not know the effect of fire-arms; for if a musket were pointed at them, and threatening gestures used, they only made faces at us, and mocked whatever we did. Finding them more and more inso- lent and troublesome, I preferred leaving them to risking a struggle, in which it might become necessary to fire, at the hazard of destroying life. ‘Twelve armed men, therefore, gave way to six unarmed, naked savages, and went on to ano- ther cove, where these annoying, because ignorant natives could not see us. On the 29th we reached Devil Island, and found the large wigwam still standing, which in 1830 my boat’s crew called the ‘Parliament House’ Never, in any part of Tierra del Fuego, have I noticed the remains of a wigwam which seemed to have been burned or pulled down ; probably there is some feeling on the subject, and in consequence the natives allow them to decay naturally, but never wilfully destroy them. We enjoyed a grand view of the lofty mountain, now called Darwin, with its immense glaciers extending far and wide. Whether 216 ICE CLIFFS—GLACIERS. Jan. this mountain is equal to Sarmiento in height, I am not cer- tain, as the measurements obtained did not rest upon satisfactory data; but the result of those measures gave 6,800 feet for its elevation above the sea. This, as an abstract height, is small, but taking into consideration that it rises abruptly from the sea, which washes its base, and that only a short space intervenes between the salt water and the lofty frozen summit, the effect upon an observer’s eye is extremely grand, and equal, probably, to that of far higher mountains which are situated at a distance inland, and generally rise from an elevated district. We stopped to cook and eat our hasty meal upon a low point of land, immediately in front of a noble precipice of solid ice; the cliffy face of a huge glacier, which seemed to cover the side of a mountain, and completely filled a valley several leagues in extent. Wherever these enormous glaciers were seen, we remarked the most beautiful light blue or sea green tints in portions of the solid ice, caused by varied transmission, or reflection of light. Blue was the prevailing colour, and the contrast which its extremely delicate hue, with the dazzling white of other ice, afforded to the dark green foliage, the almost black pre- cipices, and the deep, indigo blue water, was very remarkable. Miniature icebergs surrounded us; fragments of the cliff, which from time to time fall into a deep and gloomy basin beneath the precipice, and are floated out into the channel by a slow tidal stream. In the first volume the frequent falling of these masses of ice is noticed by Captain King in the Strait of Magalhaens, and in the narrative of my first exploring visit to this arm of the Beagle Channel ; therefore I will add no fur- ther remark upon the subject. Our boats were hauled up out of the water upon the sandy point, and we were sitting round a fire about two hundred yards from them, when a thundering crash shook us—down came the whole front of the icy cliff—and the sea surged up in a vast heap of foam. Reverberating echoes sounded in every direction, from the lofty mountains which hemmed us in; but our whole attention was immediately called to great rolling waves 1833. HAZARD—DARWIN SOUND. 217 which came so rapidly that there was scarcely time for the most active of our party to run and seize the boats before they were tossed along the beach like empty calabashes. By the exer- tions of those who grappled them or seized their ropes, they were hauled up again out of reach of a second and third roller ; and indeed we had good reason to rejoice that they were just saved intime; for had not Mr. Darwin, and two or three of the men, run to them instantly, they would have been swept away from us irrecoverably. Wind and tide would soon have drifted them beyond the distance a man could swim; and then, what prizes they would have been for the Fuegians, even if we had escaped by possessing ourselves of canoes. At the extre- mity of the sandy point on which we stood, there were many large blocks of stone, which seemed to have been transported from the adjacent mountains, either upon masses of ice, or by the force of waves such as those which we witnessed. Had our boats struck those blocks, instead of soft sand, our dilemma would not have been much less than if they had been at once swept away. Embarking, we proceeded along a narrow passage, more like a river than an arm of the sea, till the setting sun warned us to seek a resting-place for the night ; when, selecting a beach very far from any glacier, we again hauled our boats on shore. Long after the sun had disappeared from our view, his setting rays shone so brightly upon the gilded icy sides of the summits above us, that twilight lasted an unusual time, and a fine clear evening enabled us to watch every varying tint till even the highest peak became like a dark shadow, whose outline only could be distinguished. No doubt such scenes are familiar to many, but to us, surrounded even as we so often were by their materials, they were rare; because clouds continually hang over the heights, or obscure the little sunshine which falls to the lot of Tierra del Fuego. The following day (30th) we passed into a large expanse of water, which I named Darwin Sound—after my messmate, who so willingly encountered the discomfort and risk of a long cruise in a small loaded boat. Desirous of finding an opening 218 DESOLATION—SARMIENTO. Feb. northwards, I traced the northern shore of this sound, mile by mile, leaving all islands to the southward until we entered Whale-boat Sound, and I recognized Cape Desolation in the distance, as well as a number of minor points which had become familiar to me during the search after our lost boat in the former voyage (1830). Feb. 2. Having done what was necessary and attainable for the purposes of the survey, we traversed Whale-boat Sound, and stopped for a time at an old bivouac, used by me twice before, on an islet near the east extremity of the largest Stew- art Island. While the boat’s crew were occupied in preparing our meal, I went to Stewart Island, and from a small eminence saw Mount Sarmiento quite distinctly. We next steered east- ward, along the north side of the Londonderry Islands, and passed the night in a narrow passage. On the 3d we got to the open sea at the south side of Darwin Sound, and entered the south-west arm of the Beagle Channel rather too late, for it had become so dark we could distinguish no place fit to receive us; however, after much scrutiny and anxious sounding, to ascertain if our boats could approach without danger of being stove, we were guided by the sound of a cascade to a shel- tered cove, where the beach was smooth. Excepting for the novelty and excitement of exploring unknown places, however uninteresting they may be, there was little in this trip worthy of general notice, considering how much has already been said of these unprofitable regions. Even to a professed naturalist, there was scarcely anything to repay the time and trouble, as it was impossible to delay long enough in any one place to give time for more than a most cursory examination. I need hardly say that the survey of such places as were visited in this hasty manner is little more than an eye-sketch, corrected by frequent bearings, occasional latitudes by sun, moon, or stars, and meridian distances, measured by two chro- nometers, which were always kept in a large box and treated very carefully. To have attempted more, to have hoped for such an accurate delineation of these shores, at present almost useless to civilized man, as is absolutely necessary where ship- 1838. SOUTH-WEST ARM—FIRE. 219 ping may resort, would have been wrong, while so many other objects demanded immediate attention. 4th. We sailed along the passage very. rapidly, a fresh wind and strong tide favouring us. The flood-tide stream set two or three knots an hour through this south-west arm of the Beagle Channel, but the ebb was scarcely noticed: certainly its strength did not, even in the narrowest places, exceed one knot an hour. A few Alikhoolip Fuegians were seen in a cove on the south shore, ten miles west of Point Divide; the only natives, except a very small party in Darwin Sound, that had been met in the excursion since we left the Tekeenica people. Near Point Divide we saw a large fire, and approached the spot guardedly, supposing that a number of Fuegians must be there. No one appeared; but still the fire burned brightly, and we began to think there might be an ambush, or that the natives who had been there had fled, but were still in the neighbourhood. Approaching nearer, we found that the fire was in a large tree, whose trunk it had almost consumed. Judging from the slow rate at which the tree burned while we were present, I should say it had been on fire two or three days, and that the frequent heavy rain had prevented the flames from making head. Had the weather been some time dry, the adjoining woodland would have blazed, and, as the mountain side is steep and covered with trees, the conflagration would have been immense. At Point Divide the slate rock seemed to be of excellent quality, fit for roofing; but when will roofing slates be required in Tierra del Fuego? Perhaps though sooner than we suppose ; for the accidental discovery of a valuable mine might effect great changes. On the south shore, nearly opposite to Shingle Point, we met a large party of natives, among whom those who disturbed us at that place as we passed westward were recognized. All of them appeared in full dress, being bedaubed with red and white paint, and ornamented, after their fashion, with feathers and the down of geese. One of their women was noticed by several among us as being far from ill-looking: her features were regular, and, excepting a deficiency of hair on the eyebrow, 220 NATIVES—WOOLLYA. Feb. and rather thick lips, the contour of her face was sufficiently good to have been mistaken for that of a handsome gipsy. What her figure might be, a loose linen garment, evidently one that had belonged to Fuegia Basket, prevented our noticing. The sight of this piece of linen, several bits of ribbon, and some scraps of red cloth, apparently quite recently obtained, made me feel very anxious about Matthews and his party: there was also an air of almost defiance among these people, which looked as if they knew that harm had been done, and that they were ready to stand on the defensive if any such attack as they expected were put into execution. Passing therefore hastily on, we went as far as the light admitted, and at daybreak next morning (6th) were again hastening towards Woollya. As we shot through the Murray Narrow several parties of natives were seen, who were ornamented with strips of tartan cloth or white linen, which we well knew were ob- tained from our poor friends. No questions were asked ; we thought our progress slow, though wind and tide favoured us : but, hurrying on, at noon reached Woolly¥a. Several canoes were on the beach, and as many natives seemed to be assembled as were there two days before we left the place. All were much painted, and ornamented with rags of English clothing, which we concluded to be the last remnants of our friends’ stock. Our boats touched the shore; the natives came halloo- ing and jumping about us, and then, to my extreme relief, Matthews appeared, dressed and looking as usual. After him came Jemmy and York, also dressed and looking well : Fuegia, they said, was in a wigwam. Taking Matthews into my boat, we pushed out a short distance to be free from interruption, and remained till I had heard the principal parts of his story: the other boat took Jemmy on board, and York waited on the beach. Nearly all the Fuegians squatted down on their hams to watch our pro- ceedings, reminding me of a pack of hounds waiting for a fox to be unearthed. Matthews gave a bad account of the prospect which he saw before him, and told me, that he did not think himself 1833. CONDUCT TO MATTHEWS. Q91 safe among such a set of utter savages as he found them to be, notwithstanding Jemmy’s assurances to the contrary. No violence had been committed beyond holding down his head by force, as if in contempt of his strength; but he had been harshly threatened by several men, and from the signs used by them, he felt convinced they would take his life. During the last few days, his time had been altogether occupied in watch- ing his property. At first there were only a few quiet natives about him, who were inoffensive; but three days after our departure several canoes full of strangers to Jemmy’s family arrived, and from that time Matthews had had no peace by day, and very little rest at night. Some of them were always on the look-out for an opportunity to snatch up and run off with some tool or article of clothing, and others spent the greater part of each day in his wigwam, asking for every thing they saw, and often threatening him when he refused to comply with their wishes. More than one man went out in a rage, and returned immediately with a large stone in his hand, making signs that he would kill Matthews if he did not give him what was demanded. Sometimes.a party of them gathered round Matthews, and, if he had nothing to give them, teased him by pulling the hair of his face, pushing him about, and making mouths at him. His only partizans were the women; now and then he left Jemmy to guard the hut, and went to the natives’ wigwams, where the women always received him kindly, making room for him by their fire, and giving him a share of whatever food they had, without asking for any thing in return. The men never took the trouble of going with him on these visits (which, however, ceased when so many strangers ar- rived), their attention being engrossed by the tools, clothes, and crockeryware at our shipmate’s quarters. Fortunately, the most valuable part of Matthews’ own things were under- ground, in a cave unsuspected by the natives, and other large tools were hidden overhead in the roof of his hut. York and Fuegia fared very well; they lost nothing; but Jemmy was sadly plundered, even by his own family. Our garden, upon which much labour had been bestowed, had been trampled 292 MATTHEWS RE-EMBARKS. Feb. over repeatedly, although Jemmy had done his best to explain its object and prevent people from walking there. When questioned about it, he looked very sorrowful, and, with a slow shake of the head, said, “My people very bad; great fool ; know nothing at all; very great fool.” It was soon decided that Matthews should not remain. I considered that he had already undergone a severe trial, and ought not to be again exposed to such savages, however willing he might be to try them farther if I thought it right. The next difficulty was how to get Matthews’ chest and the remainder of his property safely into our boats, in the face of a hundred Fuegians, who would of course understand our object, and be much more than a match for us on land; but the less hesitation shown, the less time they would have to think of what we were about; so, dividing our party, and spreading about a little to create confidence—at a favourable moment the wigwam was quickly cleared, the cave emptied, and the contents safely placed in our boats. As I stood watching the proceedings, a few anxious moments passed, for any kind of skirmish would have been ‘so detrimental to the three who were still to remain. When the last man was embarked, I distributed several useful articles, such as axes, saws, gimblets, knives and nails, among the natives, then bade Jemmy and York farewell, promising to see them again in a few days, and departed from the wondering throng assem- bled on the beach. When fairly out of sight of Wooll¥a, sailing with a fair wind towards the Beagle, Matthews must have felt almost like a man reprieved, excepting that he enjoyed the feelings always sure to reward those who try to do their duty, in addition to those excited by a sudden certainty of his life being out of jeopardy. We slept that night in a cove under Webley Head ; sailed early the following morning (7th) along the north side of Nassau Bay, and about an hour after dark reached the Beagle—found all well, the surveying work about Goree Road done, the ship refitted, and quite ready for her next trip. A day or two was required for observations and arrange- ments, after which (10th) we'beat to windward across Nassau 1833. PONSONBY SOUND. 223 Bay, and on the 11th anchored in Scotchwell Bay. A rough night was passed under sail between Wollaston and Navarin Islands, in which we pretty well proved the clearness of that passage, as it blew fresh and we made a great many boards. Next day I set out to examine the western part of Ponsonby Sound and revisit Woollja. In my absence one party was to go westward, overland, to look at the outer coast between False Cape and Cape Weddell, and another was to examine and make a plan of the bay or harbour in which the Beagle lay. In 1830, Mr. Stokes had laid down its shores with accuracy on a small scale, but there was not then time to take many soundings; and as I conceived that Orange Bay and this harbour were likely to be useful ports, it was worth making a particular plan of each. 12th. With one boat I crossed Tekeenica Sound, and ex- plored the western part of Ponsonby Sound. Natives were seen here and there, but we had little intercourse with them. Some curious effects of volcanic action were obsevred, besides masses of conglomerate, such as I had not noticed in any other part of Tierra del Fuego. On one islet I was placed in an awkward predicament for half an hour ; it was a very steep, precipitous hill, which TI ‘had ‘ascended by climbing or creeping through ravines and among trees; but, wishing to return to the boat’s crew, after taking a few angles and bearings from its sum- mit, I could ‘find no place by which it appeared possible to descend. The ravine up which I crawled was hidden by wood, and night was at hand. I went to and fro, like a dog on a wall, unable to descend, till one of the boat’s crew who ‘was wandering about heard me call, and, ascending at the only accessible place, showed me where to plunge into the wood with a prospect of emerging again in a proper direction. This night we had dry beautiful weather, the leaves and sticks . on the ground crackling under our feet as we walked, while at the ship, only sixty miles distant, rain poured down inces- ‘santly. | The night of the 13th was passed on Button Island. This 224 WOOLLY A—HOPES. Feb. also was quite fine, without a drop of rain, while at the ship, in Packsaddle Bay, it rained frequently. I mention these instances to show how different the climate may be even in places so near one another as Packsaddle Bay and Woollya. 14th. With considerable anxiety I crossed over from Button Island to Woollya. Several canoes were out fishing, women only being in them, who did not cease their occupation as we passed : this augured well; and in a few minutes after we saw Jemmy, York, and Fuegia, in their usual dress. But few natives were about them, and those few seemed quiet and well disposed. Jemmy complained that the people had stolen many of his things, but York and Fuegia had contrived to take better care of theirs. I went to their wigwams and found very little change. Fuegia looked clean and tidily dressed, and by her wigwam was a canoe, which York was building out of planks left for him by our party. The garden was uninjured, and some of the vegetables already sprouting. Jemmy told us that strangers had been there, with whom he and his people had ‘very much jaw,’ that they fought, threw ‘great many stone,’ and stole two women (in exchange for whom Jemmy’s party stole one), but were obliged to retreat. Jemmy’s mother came down to the boat to see us; she was decently clothed, by her son’s care. He said that his brothers were all friendly, and that he should get on very well now that the ‘ strange men’ were driven away. I advised Jemmy to take his mother and younger brother to his own wigwam, which he promised to do, and then, finding that they were all quite contented and apparently very happy, I left the place, with rather sanguine hopes of their effecting among their country- men some change for the better. Jemmy’s occupation was hollowing out the trunk of a large tree, in order to make such a canoe as he had seen at Rio de Janeiro. I hoped that through their means our motives in taking them to England would become understood and appreciated among their associates, and that a future visit might find them so - favourably disposed towards us, that Matthews might then 1833. GOREE ROAD—SUCCESS BAY. 225 undertake, with a far better prospect of success, that enter- prise which circumstances had obliged him to defer, though not to abandon altogether. Having completed our work in Packsaddle Bay on the 18th, the Beagle went to the inlet originally called Windhond Bay, a deep place full of islets: thence, on the 19th, she moved to Gretton Bay, on the north side of Wollaston Island, and to Middle Cove. On the 20th, it was blowing a gale of wind from the south-west, but we pushed across before it to Goree Road, knowing that we should there find secure anchorage, and be unmolested by the furious williwaws which whirled over the high peaks of Wollaston Island. We weighed from Goree Road on the 21st, and ran under close-reefed topsails to Good Success Bay, where our anchors were dropped in the evening. The night of the 22d was one of the most stormy I ever witnessed. Although close to a weather shore in a snug cove, upon good holding ground, with masts struck and yards braced as sharp as possible, the wind was so furious that both bowers were brought a-head with a cable on each, and the sheet anchor (having been let go early) had half a cable on it, the depth of water being only ten fathoms. During some of the blasts, our fore-yard bent so much that I watched it with anxiety, thinking it would be sprung. The storm being from the westward, threw no sea into the cove, but I several times expected to be driven out of our place of refuge, if not shelter. During part of the time we waited in Good Success Bay for an interval of tolerable wea- ther, in which we might cross to the Falkland Islands without being molested by a gale, there was so much surf on the shore that our boats could not land, even while the wind was mode- rate in the bay. While we were prisoners on board, some fish were caught, among which was a skate, four feet in length and three feet _ wide. Several fine cod-fish, of the same kind as those off Cape Fairweather, were also hooked, and much relished. On the 26th we sailed, passed through a most disagreeable swell off Cape San Diego, and ran before a fresh gale towards VOL. II. Q 996 SOUNDING—CURRENT. Feb. the Falkland Islands. Towards evening we rounded to for soundings, but the sea was so high and short, that a man* at the jib-boom-end was pitched more than a fathom under water. He held on manfully, both to the boom and the lead-line, and as he rose above the wave, blowing and dripping, hove the lead forward as steadily as ever.+ My own feelings at seeing him disappear may be imagined :—it was some time before we sounded again. This heavy though short sea seemed to be caused by the flood tide, coming from the southward, and meeting waves raised by strong north-west winds, The stream of tide set us a mile each hour north-eastward. At eight the wind and sea were too much for us to run with ; therefore, watching an opportunity, we rounded to { under close-reefed main-topsail, trysails, and fore-staysail. Next morning (27th) we bore up, though the sea was still heavy, and steered to pass south of the Falklands. Our observations at noon showed that since leaving Good Success Bay we had been set more than thirty miles to the north-east. This effect, whe- ther caused by the flood tide-stream, or by a current indepen- dent of the tide, would be dangerous to ships endeavouring to pass westward of the Falklands during bad weather, and in all probability caused the embayment of H.M.S. Eden, Captain W.F.W. Owen, when she was saved by his skill: also of a French storeship, the Durance ; and of several other vessels. At noon, on the 28th, we found that the current or stream of tide had set us more towards the east than to the northward, during the preceding twenty-four hours, while we were at the south side of the islands. , At daylight on the Ist of March (having passed the pre- ceding night standing off and on under easy sail), we made Cape Pembroke, at the eastern extremity of the Falklands. The weather was very cold and raw, with frequent hail-squalls, * Nicholas White. + Two men in the staysail netting were also dipped under water, at a second plunge, from which White escaped. } The barometer was below 29 inches. See Meteorological Journal in Appendix. ae 1833. FALKLAND {SLANDS. 997% although in the month corresponding to September of our hemisphere ; and while working to windward into Berkeley Sound, the gusts of wind were sometimes strong enough to oblige us to shorten all sail. I did not then know of Port William—so close to us, and so easy of access. The aspect of the Falklands rather surprised me : instead of a low, level, barren country, like Patagonia, or a high woody region, like Tierra del Fuego, we saw ridges of rocky hills, about a thousand feet in height, traversing extensive tracts of sombre-looking moorland, unenlivened by a tree. A black, low, and rocky coast, on which the surf raged violently, and the strong wind against which we were contending, did not tend to improve our first impressions of those unfortunate islands—scene of feud and assassination, and the cause of angry discussion among nations. In a cove (called Johnson Harbour) at the north side of Berkeley Sound, was a wrecked ship, with her masts standing, and in other places were the remains of two more wrecks. We anchored near the beach on which Freycinet ran the Uranie, after she struck on a rock off Volunteer Point, at the entrance of Berkeley Sound; and from a French boat which came alongside learned that the Magellan, French whaler, had been driven from her anchors during the tremendous storm of January 12-13; that her crew were living on shore under tents, having saved every thing; that tnere were only a few colonists left at the almost ruined settlement of Port Louis ; and that the British flag had been re-hoisted on the islands by H.M.S. Tyne and Clio. VOL. IT. a2 CHAPTER XI. HISTORICAL SKETCH OF THE FALKLAND ISLANDS. Tue Falkland Islands, lying between the parallels of 51° and 53° S., and extending from near 57° almost to 62° W., are in number about two hundred, but only two are of considerable size. Between these latter, called East, and West Falkland, is the channel to which our countryman, Strong, gave the name of Falkland Sound, he himself calling the adjacent country Hawkins’ Land. Plausible assertions have been made by parties anxious to disprove the claim of Great Britain to these islands, and so few persons, excepting those immediately concerned, have inclina- tion to refer to original documents, that I may be pardoned for recalling to the recollection of those to whom the subject is still interesting, a few well-known facts, which, if fairly con- sidered, place the question above dispute. It has been asserted, that Americus Vespucius saw these islands in 1502,* but if the account of Americus himself is authentic,+- he could not have explored farther south than the right bank of La Plata. In 1501-2 Americus Vespucius, then * Il me paroft qu’onen peut attribuer la premitre découverte au célébre Améric Vespuce, qui, dans son troisitme voyage pour la découverte de VYAmérique, en parcourut la cdte du nord au mois d’Avril 1502. I1 ignoroit a la vérité si elle appartenoit a une fle, ou si elle faisoit partie du continent ; mais il est facile de conclure de la route qu’il avoit suivie, de la latitude a laquelle il étoit arrivé, de la description méme qu’il donne de cette cdte, que c’étoit celle des Malouines. J’assurerais, avec non moins de fondement, que Beauchesne Goiiin, revenant de la mer du Sud en 1700, a mouillé dans la partie orientale des Malouines, croyant étre aux Sebaldes.— Voyage de Bougainville, 2d édit. 1772, tom. i. p. 63. + Letters of Americus Vespucius, in Ramusio’s Collection, vol. i. fol. 128. FALKLAND ISLANDS. 229 employed by the King of Portugal, sailed 600 leagues south and 150 leagues west from Cape San Agostinho (lat. 8° 20’ S.) along the coast of a country then named Terra Sancte Crucis.* His account of longitude may be very erroneous, but how could his latitude have erred thirteen degrees in this his southernmost voyage ? The south shore of the Plata is low, and appears to be woody, though it is not ; the depth of water off it is moderate, and the currents are strong—all which peculiarities have been remarked on the northern coasts of the Falklands; therefore the ¢ description’ alluded to by De Bougainville would apply equally well to the right bank of the Plata. The late Mr- Dalrymple published an extract from a chart printed at Rome, in 1508, in which it is said, that ships of Portugal dis- covered a continuation of land as far south as fifty degrees, which did not there terminate. In that chart the name Ame- rica is not to be found. Brazil is there called Terrat Sancte Crucis. If the Portuguese or any other people actually traced or even discovered portions of coast south of the Plata before 1512, it appears strange that so remarkable an estuary, one hundred and twenty miles across, should have been overlooked ; especially as soundings extend two hundred miles seaward of its entrance :—and that the world should have no clear record of its having been discovered prior to the voyage of Juan de Solis, in 1512. Vespucius has already robbed Columbus and his predecessor, Cabot, of the great honour of affixing their names to the New World—shall he also be tacitly permitted to claim * The name America was not given before the year 1507. (Herrera, Dec. 1,7, 5.) + The Falklands are beyond fifty-one degrees of south latitude. t In 1507 (the admiral Christopher Columbus being dead), Americus Vespucius was taken into the service of the King of Spain, with the title of ‘ Pilote mayor,’ and was employed in making charts of the new disco- veries, which gave him an opportunity to affix his own name to the land of South America. (Herrera, Dec. 1, 7, 5.) ; 230 FALKLAND ISLANDS. even the trifling distinction of discovering the Falklands, when it is evident that he could not have seen them ? * On the 14th of August 1592, John Davis, who sailed with Cavendish on his second voyage, but separated from him in May 1592, discovered the islands now called Falkland. In Mr. John Jane’s relation of Davis’s voyage (Hakluyt, vol. iii. p. 846), there is the following simple, but distinct account of this dis- covery: “Aug. 14, 1792. We were driven in among certain isles, never before discovered by any known relation, lying fifty leagues or better from the shore, east and northerly from the Strait” (of Magalhaens). At this time Davis was striving to enter the Strait of Magal- haens, but had been long at sea, and driven far by tempests. His bearing is correct, though the distance (by estimation only) is too small. In 1683-4, Dampier and Cowley saw three islands in lat. 51° to 51° 20’ S., which they (correctly) supposed to be those seen and named by Sebald de Weert. However, the editor of Cow- ley’s narrative, one William Hack, published a different lati- tude for the land they saw, and called it Pepys Island, in com- pliment to the then Secretary of the Admiralty, intending that it should be supposed a new discovery. The false latitude given by Hack was 47°S.: in his drawing of the island he did not omit the insertion of an Admiralty Bay and a Secretary Point. Hawkins sailed along the northern shores of these islands in 1594, and he, ignorant of Davis’s discovery, named them Haw- kins’s Maiden Land. His account appearing first, and promi- nently, before the public, procured for them the name by which they were known until Strong, in 1690, sailed through and anchored in the channel which he named Falkland Sound. The Welfare’s journal, written by Strong, is in the British Museum, together with Observations made during a South Sea Voyage, written by Richard Simson, who sailed in the * Could the constructor of the chart, published at Rome in 1508, have been misinformed, owing to a mistake of 5 for 3 (50 for 30)? Such errors occur frequently in modern compilations. ce FALKLAND ISLANDS. 931 same ship; but a few sentences in each are so relevant to the present subject, that I shall quote them verbatim :—‘** 1690. Monday 27th January. We saw the land ; when within three or four leagues, we had thirty-six fathoms. It is a large land, and lieth east and west nearest. There are several quays that lie among the shore. We sent our boat to one, and she brought on board abundance of penguins, and other fowls, and seals. We steered along shore E. by N., and at eight at night we saw the land run eastward as far as we could discern. Lat. 51° 3’ 8. “ Tuesday 28th. This morning at four o’clock we saw a rock that lieth from the main island four or five leagues. It maketh like a sail.* At six, we stood into a sound that lies about twenty leagues from the westernmost land we had seen. The sound lieth south and north nearest. There is twenty- four fathoms depth at the entrance, which is four leagues wide. We came to an anchor six or seven leagues within, in fourteen fathoms water. Here are many good harbours. We found fresh water in plenty, and killed abundance of geese and ducks. As for wood, there is none. “‘ On the 31st we weighed from this harbour, with the wind at W.S.W. We sent our long-boat a-head of the ship, to sound before us. At eight o’clock in the evening, we anchored in nine fathoms. The next morning we weighed, and sent our boat before us. At ten, we were clear out of the sound. At twelve, we set the west cape bearing N.N.E., which we named Cape Farewell. This sound, Falkland Sound as I named it, is about seventeen leagues long ; the first entrance lies S. by E., and afterwards S. by W.” How it happened that the name Falkland, originally given to the sound alone, obliterated Hawkins, and has never yielded to Davis, is now a matter of very trifling importance. I may be permitted to remark particularly, that Hawkins and Strong not only saw both East and West Falkland, but that in 1690 Strong anchored repeatedly between them, and landed : and I do so, because stress has been laid upon the fact * This rock was seen by Hawkins, and named by him ‘ White Con- duit.’ Now it is called Eddystone. 232 FALKLAND ISLANDS. of Beauchesne Goiiin having anchored in 1700 on their eastern coast. In the year 1600, the islands now called Jasons, Salvages, or Sebaldines, at the north-west extremity of the Falklands, were seen and named by Sebald de Weert ; and during the next two centuries many other navigators, sailing to or from the Pacific, saw the Falklands ; but it does not appear that any further landing was effected, or even that any vessel anchored there, after Beauchesne, except the Saint Louis, of St. Malo, until M. de Bougainville landed to form his settlement, in February 1764. Several ships of St. Malo passed near the Eastern Falklands between the years 1706 and 1714, from whose accounts M. Frezier compiled his chart, published in 1717; and in com- pliment to the owners of one of them (the Saint Louis), her commander, M. Fouquet, named the cluster of islets near which he anchored, the Anican Isles. In consequence of the visits of these ships of St. Malo, the French named the islands Les Malouines; but this was not till after 1716, when Frezier compiled the chart in which he called them ‘Isles Nouvelles,’ although in his own narrative (p. 512, Amsterdam edition, 1717), he says, ‘* Ces isles sont sans doute les mémes que celles que le Chevalier Richard Hawkins découvrit en 1593.” The Spaniards adopted the French name, slightly altered, by changing Malouines into Malvinas: even now the term * Maloon,’ a corruption of Malouine, * is sometimes used by English or Americans instead of island, in writing as well as in speaking. During the early part of the last century, France maintained a lucrative commerce with Chile and Peru, by way of Cape Horn, and the advantages which might be derived from a port of refuge and supply at the eastern extremity of the Falklands did not escape her active discernment. De Bougainville says, ‘Cependant leur position heureuse * “ Fortunately, it is on this maloon,.or island, that bullocks and horses are found running wild,”—(Weddell, p. 97.) ia FALKLAND ISLANDS. 233 pour servir de relache aux vaisseaux qui vont dans la mer du sud, et d’échelle pour la découverte des terres Australes, avoit frappé les navigateurs de toutes les nations. Au commence- ment de année 1763, la cour de France résolut de former un établissement dans ces iles. Je proposai au ministere de le com- mencer a mes frais, et secondé par MM. de Nerville et d’Ar- boulin, Pun mon cousin-germain et l’autre mon oncle, je fis sur le champ construire et armer 4 Saint Malo, par les soins de M. Duclos Guyot, aujour@hui mon second, lAigle de vinget canons, et le Sphinx de douze, que je munis de tout ce qui étoit propre pour une pareille expédition. J’embarquai plusieurs familles Acadiennes, espéce d’hommes laborieuse, intelligente, et qui doit étre chére 4 la France par l'inviolable attachement que lui ont prouvé ces honnétes et infortunés citoyens. «* A’ Monte Video nous primes beaucoup de chevaux, et de bétes & corne,—nous atterrames sur les iles Sébaldes le 31 Janvier 1764. “La méme illusion qui avoit fait croire & Hawkins, a Woodes Rogers, et aux autres, que ces iles étoient couvertes de bois, agit aussi sur mes compagnons de voyage, et sur moi. Nous vimes avec surprise, en débarquant, que ce que nous avions pris pour du bois en cinglant le long de la céte, n’étoit autre chose que des touffes de jonc fort élevées et fort rappro- chées les unes des autres. Leur pied, en se desséchant recoit la couleur @herbe morte jusqu’a une toise environ de hauteur ; et de 1a sort une touffe de joncs* d’un beau verd qui couronne ce pied; de sorte que, dans l’éloignement, les tiges réunies présentent l’aspect d’un bois de médiocre hauteur. Ces jones ne croissent qu’au bord de la mer, et sur les petites iles ; les montagnes de la grande terre sont, dans quelques endroits, couvertes entiérement de bruyéres, qu’on prend aisément de loin pour du taillis."—(Voyage autour du Monde, 1766-69, séconde édition, 1772, tom. i. p. 66-69.) On the 17th of March De Bougainville decided to place his * Now called Tussac by the sealers and colonists. 934 FALKLAND ISLANDS. establishment on the spot where the present settlement stands, and forthwith disembarked to commence the laborious under- taking of founding a colony. In the year 1764, a squadron was sent to the South Seas by George III., in whose instructions, dated June 17th, 1764, it is said, ‘‘ And whereas his Majesty’s islands, called Pepys Island and Falkland Islands, lying within the said track,” (the track between the Cape of Good Hope and the Strait of Magalhaens), “ notwithstanding their having been first disco- vered and visited by British navigators, have never yet been so sufficiently surveyed, as that an accurate judgment may be formed of their coasts and product, his Majesty, taking the premises into consideration, and conceiving no junction so pro- per for enterprises of this nature as a time of profound peace, which his kingdoms at present happily enjoy, has thought fit that it should now be undertaken.” On the 23d January 1765, Commodore Byron went on shore at these islands, with the captains and principal officers of his squadron, “ when the Union Jack being erected on a _ high staff, and spread, the commodore took possession of the harbour and all the neighbouring islands for his Majesty King George III., his heirs, and successors, by the name of Falkland Islands. When the colours were spread, a salute was fired from the ship.” In consequence of Byron’s favourable report, Captain Mac- bride was sent out in H.M.S. Jason to begin their colonization. He arrived in January 1766. Spain, hearing of the French settlement, immediately laid claim to the islands, as forming a part of her American posses- sions ; and France, influenced by various considerations, agreed to deliver up to Spain her newly-formed colony, upon condi- tion that the projectors and colonists should be indemnified for their losses: an agreement honourably fulfilled by Spain. On the Ist of April 1767, De Bougainville gave up posses- sion to the Spanish officer appointed to take charge ; the stan- dard of Spain was hoisted, and royal salutes fired by the ves- FALKLAND ISLANDS. 235 sels present. Some of the French colonists remained, but the greater part preferred returning to France, and passages were given to them on board Spanish ships. In 1770, a Spanish armament attacked the British colony at Port Egmont, and obliged its small garrison to surrender to an overpowering force, and quit the place. England, indig- nant at the insult, armed for war, and demanded satisfaction from Spain for the injury inflicted. At first Spain argued and temporized ; but finding that Great Britain continued firm, and that the English people were even more disposed for action than their Government, she relinquished her views—disavowed the act of her officer—and restored Port Egmont. England was satisfied—or rather, the court party professed to be satis- fied; but ‘the opposers of government angrily declared that Spain had not done enough; and that, though compelled to make restitution, her insult was unatoned for. In 1774, finding the establishment at the Falklands expen- sive, and almost useless,* England quietly withdrew it; but the marks and signals of possession and property were left upon the islands, and when the governor departed, the British flag remained flying, and various formalities were observed, intended to indicate the right of possession, as well as to show that the occupation of them might be resumed. The reports made by officers employed at Port Egmont were of such a discouraging tendency, that no person at that time entertained the least wish to have any further concern with the islands—and for years they were unnoticed—though not forgotten by England. Spain, however, jealous of im- terference with her colonial possessions, and regarding the Falklands as a vantage-ground, from which those in the south might be suddenly or secretly invaded, maintained a small garrison at the eastern extremity of the Archipelago, where hér ships occasionally touched, and from time to time recon- noitred the adjacent ports, in order to ascertain whether any visitors were there. At what precise time the Spaniards with- * The fact was, it was injudiciously situated, and therefore seldom visited, except by a few fishermen. 236 FALKLAND ISLANDS. drew this small garrison, and left the Falkland archipelago uninhabited by man, I am not certain; but it must have been early in this century, because from 1810 to 1820 there was no person upon those islands who claimed even a shadow of authority over any of them. In 1820, a ship of war was sent from Buenos Ayres to Port Louis; her captain, Jewitt, hoisted the Argentine flag, and saluted it with twenty-one guns; notifying, at the same time, to the sealing and whaling vessels present, that he was “‘ com- missioned by the Supreme Government of the United Provinces of South America to take possession of these islands in the name of the country to which they naturally appertain.”— (Weddell, p. 103.) This act of the Buenos Ayrean Govern- ment was scarcely known in Europe for many years; and not until 1829 was it noticed formally by Great Britain. After reading this short statement of facts, one may pause to consider what nation is at this inoment the legitimate owner of the Falklands. Do the discovery, prior occupation, and settlement of new and uninhabited countries give a right to possession? Ifso, Great Britain is the legal owner of those islands. Davis first discovered them; Hawkins first named them; Strong first landed on them; and (excepting the French), Byron first took formal possession of them; and (again excepting the French), Macbride first colonized them. Respecting the French claim, depending only upon first settle- ment, not discovering, naming, or landing; whatever validity any one may be disposed to allow it, that value must be destroyed, when it is remembered that Spain asserted her superior claim, and that France actually admitted it, resigning for ever her pretensions to those islands. Whatever France might have been induced to do for political reasons, of which the most apparent now is the continuance of the trade she then carried on with Chile and Peru, England never admitted that the Spanish claim was valid: and France having with- drawn, the question is solely between Spain and Great Britain. Spaniards neither discovered, landed upon, nor settled in the Falklands before Englishmen ; and their only claim rests upon x FALKLAND ISLANDS. 937 the unstable foundation of a papal bull, by virtue of which Spain might just as well claim Otaheite, the Sandwich Islands, or New Zealand. As to the pretensions of Buenos Ayres, I shall only re- mark, that in a paper transmitted by her government to Mr. Baylies, chargé-d’affaires of the United States of North Ame- rica, on the 14th August 1832, the advocate of her claims asserts, that “it is a political absurdity to pretend that a colony which emancipates itself, inherits the other territories which the metropolis may possess. If that singular doctrine were to be found in the code of nations, the Low Countries, for example, on their independence being acknowledged, in 1648, would have succeeded to Spain in her rights to America ; and in the same manner, the United States would have appro- priated to themselves the British possessions in the East-Indies. Inheritance, indeed! the United States did not inherit the rights of England in Newfoundland, notwithstanding its con- tiguity ; and are they to inherit those which she may have to the Malvinas, at the southern extremity of the continent, and in the opposite hemisphere.”* The writer of the preceding sentences, in his haste to attack the United States of America for an assertion made by one of their journalists, to the effect that the United States inherited from Great Britain a claim to fish around the Falklands, must have overlooked the simple fact, that his arguments were even more applicable to Buenos Ayres than they were to the United States of North America. When Captain Jewitt arrived at the Falklands, he found more than thirty sail of vessels engaged there in the seal fishery, besides others which were recruiting the health of their crews after whaling or sealing voyages in the antarctic regions. By the crews of these ships numbers of cattle and pigs were killed, as well as horses, the wild descendants of those taken there by Bougainville and his successors. * Papers relative to the origin and present state of the questions pend- ing with the United States of America on the subject of the Malvinas (Falkland Islands). Translated and printed at Buenos Ayres in 1832. 238 FALKLAND ISLANDS. In 1823, the Buenos Ayrean Government took another step, in the appointment of a ‘ comandante de las Malvinas ;’ and in the same year, Lewis Vernet, by birth a German, in concert with his friends at Buenos Ayres, “ solicited and obtained from the Government the use of the fishery and of the cattle on the Eastern Malvina, and likewise tracts of land thereon, in order to provide for the subsistence of the settlement.* This under- taking did not prosper; but the next year Mr. Vernet pre- pared a second expedition, in which he himself sailed. His own words (translated) are: + ‘ After many sacrifices, I was enabled to surmount great obstables; but still that which we expected to effect in one year was not realized before the expi- ration of five. My partners lost all hope, and sold me their shares. I bought successively three vessels, and lost them; I chartered five, one of which was lost. Each blow produced dismay in the colonists, who several times resolved to leave that ungrateful region, but were restrained by their affection for me, which I had known how to win, and by the example of constaney and patience which my family and myself held out to them.” In 1828, the Government of Buenos Ayres granted to Mr. Vernet (with certain exceptions) the right of property in the Falkland Islands—and in Staten Land! ‘It also conceded to the colony exemption from taxation for twenty years, and for the same period the exclusive right to the fishery in all the Malvinas, and on the coast of the continent to the southward of the Rio Negro, under the condition that within three years I (Vernet) should have established the colony.” { About this time merchant-vessels of all nations visited the Falkland Islands, both in their outward voyage and when returning from the Pacific; but advantageous as their visits were, those of numerous sealers had a very different effect : for, instead of frequenting the settlement, their crews killed the seal indiscriminately at all seasons, and slaughtered great numbers of wild cattle. ‘* For this reason,” says Vernet, “I * See note in preceding page. + Idem. t Idem. FALKLAND ISLANDS. 239 requested the Government to furnish me with a vessel of war, to enable me to cause the rights of the colony to be respected. The Government was aware of the necessity of the measure ; but not being then able to place a vessel at my disposal, it resolved to invest me with a public and official character, and for that purpose issued the two decrees of the 10th of June: the one re-establishing the governorship of the Malvinas and Tierra del Fuego; and the other nominating me to fulfil that office.” * In 1829, Vernet warned off some North American sealers ; and in 1831, upon their repeating the sealing excursion of which he had complained, he detained them by force. This act, and various circumstances arising out of it, drew upon him and his unfortunate colony the hasty indignation of Captain Silas Duncan, of the United States corvette Lexington, who, on his own responsibility, without waiting to communicate with his Government, sailed from the Plata to the Falkland Islands, surprised, assaulted, and made prisoners of many unoffending people, and unwarrantably destroyed both property and build- ings. Mr. Brisbane and several others were put into confine- ment, and carried away, on board the Lexington, to Buenos Ayres, where they were delivered up to the Buenos Ayrean Government, in February 1832. The United States supported their officer, and immediately despatched a chargé-d’affaires to Buenos Ayres, with instructions to demand compensation for the injury done to North American trade, and full reparation to all North American citizens for personal wrongs. While the United States and Buenos Ayres were discussing the questions at issue, Great Britain, following up the solemn warnings she had given Buenos Ayres (especially in the pro- test addressed to that Government by Mr. Parish, in November 1829), issued orders to her Commander-in-chief on the South American station, to send a vessel of war to re-hoist the British flag upon the Falkland Islands; to assert her right of sove- reignty, and to cause every thing belonging to the Buenos Ayrean Government to be embarked and sent away. * See note, page 236. 240 FALKLAND ISLANDS. On the 2d of January 1833, H.M.S. Clio anchored in Berke- ley Sound, to carry these orders into effect; H.M.S. Tyne, about the same time, anchoring in Port Egmont. In each place the British colours were hoisted and saluted: the small Buenos Ayrean garrison at Port Louis quietly withdrew, and sailed for the Plata in an armed schooner, belonging to Buenos Ayres: and from that time those unhappy islands have been more ostensibly British, though but little has yet been done to draw forth the resources, and demonstrate the advantages which they unquestionably possess. When the Tyne and Clio sailed, after a very short stay at the islands, no authority was left there, but the colours were entrusted to an Irishman, who had been Mr. Vernet’s storekeeper.* In 1834, a lieutenant in the navy, with a boat’s crew, was sent to reside at Port Louis, and since that time various small ships of war have succeeded each other in visiting and exploring the numerous islands and harbours of that archipe- lago. Those who may wish for more historical information on this subject—for further details of former negociations between Spain and England, or of the late discussions between North America and Buenos Ayres—should refer to Dr. Johnson’s “Thoughts respecting the Falkland Islands” (Johnson’s Works, vol. viii. p. 96, Murphy’s Edition, 1816) ; to Junius’s 42d Letter ; and to papers published at Buenos Ayres in 1832; in addition to general history. * Not long before the Clio arrived, there had been a mutiny in the gar- rison, and the Buenos Ayrean commanding officer had been barbareusly murdered. In the early part of 1834, Mr. Brisbane fell a victim to treachery. These fatal occurrences will be mentioned again in the course of my narrative. CHAPTER XII. First. Appearance — Tides —Currents — W inds— Lightning —Seasons— Temperature — Rain—Health—Dangers —Cautions — View — Settle- ment—Animals—Foxes— V arieties—Seal—W hales—Fish and Fishery —Birds—Brushwood—Peat—Pasture—P otash—Orchilla—Grazing— Corn—Fruit—V egetables—Trees—Plants—Land —Situation of prin- cipal Settlement — Prospective advantages —Suggestions —Vernet’s Establishment—Reflections. In the appearance of the Falkland Islands, there is very little either remarkable or interesting. About the greater part of the archipelago, barren hills, sloping towards low and broken ground, or rocky surf-beat shores, are the only objects which meet the eye. On the West Falkland, and some small islands near it, there are high precipitous cliffs in a few parts exposed to the western seas; but. other places, and especially the southern portions of East Falkland, are so low that they cannot be seen from the deck of a vessel five miles distant. The average height of the western island is greater than that of the eastern, although the highest hills seem to be in the latter, where they rise to about thirteen hundred feet above the sea level. Around the islands, especially toward the south-eastern and north-western extremes, there are numerous islets and rocks, whose distance from shores, where tides run strongly and winds are violent as well as sudden, makes them exceedingly dange- rous ; more particularly near the north-west extremity of the group: and as seamen require information on these matters before entering a port, I will notice the tides, winds, and cli- mate previous to other subjects. The tides differ much as to strength and direction in dif- ferent parts of the archipelago, but the times of syzigial high water only vary from five to eight o’clock ; and the rise of tide ~ is almost similar every where, about four feet at neap, and eight VOL, IL R 242 TIDES—CURRENTS. feet at spring tides. The principal swell of the ocean, which causes the tidal streams about these islands, comes from the south-east. Scarcely any stream is perceptible on the south-east coast of East Falkland ; but along the north, south, and west shores it increases in strength, until among the Jason Islands it runs six miles an hour, causing heavy and dangerous races. Off Berkeley Sound, across the entrance, and near Cape Carysfort, the tide runs about two knots, at its greatest strength; and thence westward it increases gradually. Into Falkland Sound the tide flows from both openings, and meets near the Swan Islands; shewing, I apprehend, that the principal wave or swell impinges upon the coast considerably eastward of south. The tidal currents are stronger along the northern shores of the archipelago than they are along the south coasts; and the stream of flood is stronger than the ebb. At Port William, the easternmost harbour, the time of high water at full moon is five; and thence westward, the times increase gradually to half-past eight, at New Island, which is nearly the western- most of the group. Generally speaking, the sea is much deeper near the south- ern and western shores than it is near those of the north; and to those local differences I attribute the varying velocity of the minor tide streams. ) Besides these movements of the surrounding waters, there is a current setting past the islands from south-west to north- east: a current which continually brings drift wood to their southern coasts, and has brought Fuegian canoes. On all parts of the southern shores that are open to the south-west, the beaches or rocks are covered with trees, which have drifted from Staten Land or Tierra del Fuego. Great quantities of this driftwood may be found between Cape Orford and Cape Mere- dith ; upon the Arch, Speedwell, George, and Barren Islands : indeed, there are few places between Cape Orford and Choi- seul Bay where a vessel may not find a good supply of fuel. On Long Island, and in the bay behind the Sea-Lion Islands, portions of Fuegian canoes have often been found; one con- sisted of an entire side (pieces of bark sewed together), which — WINDS—STORMS. 943 could not have been made many years. At sea, when north- eastward of the Falklands, great quantities of drift kelp* are seen, besides water-worn trunks and branches of trees, near which there are generally fish, and numbers of birds. These sure indications of a current from the south-west have been met with upwards of two hundred miles to the northward of Berke- ley Sound. There is not, however, reason to think that this current ever runs more than two knots an hour, under any cir- cumstances, and in all probability its usual set is even less than one knot. Wind is the principal evil at the Falklands: a region more exposed to storms, both in summer and winter, it would be difficult to mention. The winds are variable; seldom at rest, while the sun is above the horizon, and very violent at times ; during the summer acalm day is an extraordinary event. Generally speaking, the nights are less windy than the days, but neither by nightnor by day, nor at any season of the year, are these islands exempt from sudden and very severe squalls ; or from gales which blow heavily, though they do not usually last many hours. It has been stated by Bougainville and others that in sum- mer the wind generally freshens as the sun rises, and dies away about sunset: also, that the nights are clear and starlight. The information I have received, with what I have myself wit- nessed, induces me to agree to the first of these statements in its most general sense, and to a certain degree I can admit the second; but, at the same time, it is true that there are many cloudy and very many windy nights in the course of each year, I might almost say month. The Magellan was driven from her anchors, though close to a weather shore in the narrowest part of Berkeley Sound, and totally wrecked in Johnson Har- bour about midnight of the 12th of J anuary} 1833. The prevalent direction of the wind is westerly. Gales, in general, commence in the north-west, and draw or fly round to the south-west; and it may be remarked, that when rain * Sea-weed detached from the rocks and drifting with the current. + The month which, in that hemisphere, corresponds to July in ours. RQ 24.4 WINDS—LIGHTNING. accompanies a north-west wind it soon shifts into the south- west quarter, and blows hard. Northerly winds bring cloudy weather; and when very light, they are often accompanied by a thick fog: it is also worth notice that they almost always occur about the full and change of the moon. North-east and northerly winds bring gloomy overcast weather, with much rain; sometimes they blow hard and hang in the N.N.E., but it is more common for them to draw round to the westward. South-easterly winds also bring much rain, they are not frequent, but they blow hard, and as the gale increases it hauls southward. During winter the winds are chiefly from the north-west, and in summer they are more frequently south-west. Though fogs occur with light easterly or northerly winds, they do not often last through the day. Gales of wind, as well as squalls, are more sudden, and blow more furiously from the southern quarter, between south-west and south-east, than from other directions. Wind from the east is rarely lasting, or strong ; it generally brings fine weather, and may be expected in April, May, June, and July, rather than at other times, but intervals of fine weather (short indeed), with light breezes from E.S.E. to E.N.E., occur occasionally throughout the year. Neither lightning nor thunder are at all common, but when the former occurs easterly wind is expected to follow. If lightning should be seen in the south-east while the barometer is low,* a hard gale from that quarter may be expected. South- east and southerly gales last longer than those from the west- ward, and they throw a very heavy sea upon the southern shores. In the winter there is not, generally, so much wind as in the summer, and in the former season the weather, though colder, is more settled, and considerably drier. * A seaman may naturally ask here, and at other passages where refe- rence is made to the barometer, “‘ W hat is considered low for that place ?” and as a reply may be obtained more satisfactorily by consulting the Meteorological Journal, in the appendix, than by receiving an answer in figures (barometers and direction of wind varying so much), I will beg him to look at that Journal. SEASONS—TEMPERATURE. Q45 In different years seasons vary so much, that those who have been longest about the islands hardly venture to predict what weather will be found during any particular month. All they say is, that January, February, and March, though warmest, are the windiest months, and that May, June, and July, though cold, are much less stormy.* I must here add one word in favour of the barometer, or sympiesometer. Every material change in the weather is fore- told by these invaluable instruments, if their movements are tolerably understood by those who consult them, and if they are frequently observed. Mr. Low said to me, ‘“ The baro- meter is worth any thing in these countries” (alluding to Tierra del Fuego, as well as the Falklands) ; “some say they dislike it because it is always so low, and foretelling bad weather ; but how often do we have any other?” They must, somehow, think the barometer ominous, and overlook the use of the omen. The temperature may be considered equable; it is never hot, neither is it ever very cold; but the average is low, and in consequence of frequent rain and wind, a really moderate degree of cold is much more noticed than would probably be the case if the weather were dry and serene. Since 1825 Fahrenheit’s thermometer has only ence been observed so low as 22° in the shade, at mid-day, and it has been but once above 80° in the shade. Its ordinary range is between 30° and 50° in the winter, and from 40° to 65° in the summer. Ice has not been known to exceed an inch in thickness; snow seldom lies upon the low lands, or at any period exceeds two inches in depth. Although rain is so frequent, it does not continue falling for any considerable time; and as evaporation is rapid, in consequence of so much wind, there are no un- wholesome exhalations; indeed, the climate is exceedingly healthy, and no disease whatever has been hitherto contracted, in consequence of its influence, excepting ordinary colds and coughs, or rheumatic affections, brought on by unusual expo- * Mr. Low scarcely ever found two succeeding years alike, as to wind and weather, during the corresponding seasons. 246 DANGERS—KELP. sure to weather. It is said by those who have had the most experience there, that the climate of West Falkland is milder than that of the Eastern large island. Probably the west winds are chilled in passing over the heights, and upon reaching Port Louis are several degrees colder than when they first strike upon the western islands. In Tierra del Fuego, and many other places, the case is similar, the western regions having a milder climate than is found about the central or eastern districts. _Excellent harbours, easy of access, affording good shelter, with the very best holding ground, abound among these islands, and, with due care, offer ample protection from the frequent gales. In approaching the land, and especially while entering a harbour, a careful look-out should be kept for ‘fixed kelp,’ the seaweed growing on every rock in those places, which is covered by the sea, and not very far beneath its surface. Lying upon the water, the upper leaves and stalks show, almost as well as a buoy, where there is a possibility of hidden danger. Long stems, with leaves, lying regularly along the surface of the sea, are generally attached to rocky places, or else to large stones. Occasionally a few straggling stalks of kelp are seen in deep water, even in thirty fathoms: many of which are attached to stones, and so firmly, that their long stems will sometimes weigh the stone adhering to their roots. Such scattered plants as these need not be minded by a ship; but in passing to windward of patches or beds of kelp, or rather in passing on that side from which the stems stream away with the current, care should be taken to give the place a wide berth, because the only part which shows, when the tide is strong, lies on one side of, not over the rocks. Where the stream of tide is very strong this kelp is quite “run under,’ or kept down out of sight, and can no longer be depended on asa warning. When a clear spot is seen in the middle of a thick patch of fixed kelp, one may expect to find there the least water. Drift kelp, or that which is floating on the surface of the ” sea, unattached to any rock or stone, of course need not be CAUTIONS—VIEW. I47 avoided ; it may be known at a glance, by the irregular hud- dled look which it has. Off the south-east shores of the Falk- lands there are several rocky shallows, on which the sea breaks heavily during south-east gales, though not at other times: all those shallows are marked by kelp, and in one place, thus indicated, not more suspicious in appearance than others, a rock was found, almost ‘awash’ at low water. Many wrecks have occurred, even on the land-locked shores of harbours themselves, and in 1833-4, some of their remains served as a warning to strangers to moor their ships securely : but with good ground tackle, properly disposed, and the usual precautions, a vessel will lie in absolute safety, as the holding- ground is excellent : indeed, in many places so tenacious, that it is exceedingly difficult to weigh an anchor which has been some time down. Particular directions for making the land, approaching and entering harbours, and taking advantageous berths, will be found in another place: generally speaking, the local pilotage is very simple. The country is remarkably easy of access to persons on foot ; but half-concealed rivulets and numerous bogs, oblige a mounted traveller to be very cautious. ‘There are no trees any where, but a small bush is plentiful in many vallies. Scarcely any view can be more dismal than that from the heights: moor- land and black bog extend as far as eye can discern, intersected by innumerable streams, and pools of yellowish brown water. But this appearance is deceptive ; much of what seems to be a barren moor, is solid sandy clay soil, covered by a thin layer of vegetable mould, on which grow shrubby bushes and a: coarse grass, affording ample nourishment to cattle ; besides which, one does not see into many of the vallies where there is good soil and pasture. Some tracts of land, especially those at the south of East Falkland, differ in character, being low, level, and abundantly productive of excellent herbage. Mr. Darwin’s volume will doubtless afford information as to the geological formation of the Eastern Falkland. He did not visit the western island, but obtained many notices of it from 248 PEAT—ANIMALS. those who were there. The more elevated parts of East Falk- land are quartz rock ; clay-slate prevails in the intermediate districts. Sandstone, in which are beautifully perfect impres- sions of shells, occurs in beds within the slate formation : and upon the slate is a layer of clay, fit for making bricks. Near the surface, where this clay is of a lighter quality, and mixed with vegetable remains, it is good soil, fit for cultivation. In some places, a great extent of clay is covered by a layer of very solid peat, varying in depth from two to ten feet. The solidity of this peat is surprising; it burns well, and is an excellent substitute for other fuel. To the clay and to the solid peat may be attributed the numerous bogs and pools of water, rather than to the total amount of rain. Is the peat now growing, or was the whole mass formed ages ago ? The settlement, now consisting only of a few huts, some cot- tages, and a ruinous house or two, occupies the place originally selected by Bougainville, close to Port Louis, at the head of Berkeley Sound. Standing in an exposed situation, scattered over half a mile of rising ground, without a tree or even a shrub near it, the unfortunate village has a bleak and desolate appearance, ominous of its sad history. Previous, however, to entering upon the affairs of the settlement, I will continue my sketch of the islands and their present produce, independent of the settlers now there. By the French, and afterwards by the Spanish colonists, a number of black cattle, horses, pigs, and rabbits, were turned loose upon East Falkland; and, by considerate persons, en- gaged in whale or seal-fishery, both goats and pigs have been left upon smaller islands near West Falkland. These animals have multiplied exceedingly; and, although they have been killed indiscriminately by the crews of vessels, as well as by | the settlers, there are still many thousand head of cattle, and some thousand horses, besides droves of pigs, perfectly wild, upon the eastern large island: while upon Carcass Island, Saunders Island, and others, there are numbers of goats and pigs. In 1884, the smallest estimate exceeded twelve thou- eo. BULLS—HORSES—FOXES. 249 sand cattle, and four thousand horses; but there were no means of ascertaining their number, except by comparing the accounts of the gaucho colonists, who were accustomed to pursue them, not only for ordinary food or for their hides, but even for their tongues alone, not taking the trouble to carry off more of the animal so wantonly slaughtered.* The wild cattle are very large and very fat, and the bulls are really for- midable animals, perhaps among the largest and most savage of their race. At Buenos Ayres, the ordinary weight of a bull’s hide is less than fifty pounds, but the weight of such hides in the East Falkland has exceeded eighty pounds. ‘The horses look well while galloping about wild, but the gauchos say they are not of a good breed, and will not bear the fatigue of an ordinary day’s work, such as a horse at Buenos Ayres "will gothrough without difficulty. Perhaps their ‘ softness,’ as it is there called, may be owing to the food they get, as well as to the breed. The wild pigs on East Falkland are of a long- legged, ugly kind ; but some of those on Saunders Island and other places about West Falkland are derived from short- legged Chinese pigs. The only quadruped apparently indige- nous is a large fox, and as about this animal there has been much discussion among naturalists, and thespecimens now in the British Museum were deposited there by me, I am induced to make a few remarks upon it. * “The settlers, when they abandoned the eastern island, left behind them several horses and horned cattle, which have increased so much, that, on going a few miles into the country, droves of both animals may be seen. I have taken several of the bullocks by shooting them. They are generally ferocious, and will attack a single person; and thus, those who hunt them are enabled to get within pistol-shot of them by the fol- lowing stratagem. Four or five men advance in a line upon the animal, and, by appearing only as one person, it stands ready to attack, till within one hundred yards, when the hunters spread themselves, and fire, endea- vouring to shoot the bullock either in the head or in the fore-shoulder. The horses will also attack asingle person, and their mode of doing so is by forming a circle round him, and prancing upon him; but by means of a musquet they may be readily dispersed.”,—Weddell’s Voyage, pp- 102, 103. 250 FOXES—SIMSON. It has been said, that there are two varieties of this ‘ wolf- fox,’ as it has been called,* one being rather the smaller, and of a redder brown; but the fact is, that no other difference exists between the two apparent varieties, and as the darker coloured larger animal is found on the East Falkland, while the other is confined to the western island, the darker colour and rather thicker furry coat may be attributed to the influence of a some- what colder climate. The fox of West Falkland approaches nearer the large fox of Patagonia, both in colour and size, than its companion of East Falkland does; but allowing that there is one shade of difference between the foxes of East and West Falkland, there are but two, or at most three shades between the animal of West Falkland and the large fox of Port Famine. In Strong’s voyage (1690), Simson describes these foxes as being twice as large as an English fox, but he does not say upon which island. * “Te loup-renard, ainsi nommé parce qu’il se creuse un terrier, et que sa queue est plus longue et plus fournie de poil que celle du loup, habite dans les dunes sur le bord dela mer. TI] suit le gibier et se fait des routes avec intelligence, toujours par le plus court chemin d’une baie al’autre; Anotre premiére descente a terre, nous ne doutémes point que ce ne fussent des sentiers d’habitans. Il y a apparence que cet animal jefine une partie de l’année, tant il est maigre et rare. II est de la taille dun chien ordinaire dont il a aussi l’aboiement, mais foible. Comment a-t-il été transporté sur les fles?”—Voyage de Bougainville, seconde édition, tome i. p. 113. + “They saw foxes on this land, which, Simson says, ‘ were twice as big as those in England. Having brought greyhounds with us, we caught a young fox alive, which we kept on board some months, but on the first firing our great guns in the South Sea, he was frighted overboard, as were also some St. Jago monkies. As to the antiquity of these foxes, as they cannot fly, and it is not likely they should swim so far as from America, nor again is it probable that any would be at the pains of bringing a breed of foxes so far as Hawkins’ Island is from any other land, it will follow that there have either been two distinct creations, or that America and this land have been formerly the same continent.’ There are means more within the common course of nature than those which occurred to Simson, by which foxes may have become inhabitants of this land. Islands of ice are met at sea in much lower southern lati- tudes, FOXES— WOLVES. Q51 All who have seen these animals alive have been struck by their eager ferocity and disregard of man’s power. Byron says, ‘ Four creatures of great fierceness, resembling wolves, ran up to their bellies in the water to attack the boat !” also, “* When any of these creatures got sight of our people, though at ever so great a distance, they ran directly at them.”—* They were always called wolves by the ship’s company 5 but except in their size and the shape of the tail, I think they bore a greater resemblance to a fox. They are as big as a middle-sized mastiff, and their fangs are remarkably long and sharp.” “ They burrow in the ground, like a fox.” The Beagle’s offi- cers, when employed in surveying the Falklands, were often annoyed, as well as amused, by the intrusion of these fearless animals. In size, the larger ones are about twice as bulky as an English fox, and they stand nearly twice as high upon their legs.* Their heads are coarser, and their fur is not only thicker as well as longer, but it is of a woolly nature. Referring again to a resemblance between the Falkland and Patagonian foxes, I may remark, that there is as much difference in size, in coat, and in tail, between the guanaco of Port Desire and that of Navarin Island (near Cape Horn), as there is be- tween the fox of West Falkland and that of Port Famine. What the Patagonian animal is which the Blanco Bay people called ¢ wolf,-+ or to which Pigafetta alluded in his vocabulary of words used by the Patagonians at Port San Julian, as equi- valent to ‘ani, I cannot say: Iwas inclined to suspect an equivoque arising out of the word ‘lobo,’ which means seal as well as wolf; but Lieut. Wickham says he saw a wolf near the Colorado River. § The Falkland foxes feed upon birds, rab- tudes, many of which, no doubt, are formed in the bays and rivers of the continent. Seals and sea-birds repose on the edge of the shore, whether it is ice or land, and foxes, or other animals, in search of prey, will fre- quently be carried away on the large pieces of ice which break off and are driven out to sea.”’—Burney, vol. iv, pp. 331-332. * The country they range over being open, without trees, does not require them to steal along under branches, like the foxes of a woody country. + Page 107 of this volume. ¢ Burney, vol. 1. p. 37. § Page 296. 2523 CHANGES IN ANIMALS. bits, rats and mice, eggs, seals, &c., and to their habits of attacking king-penguins, if not seal, while alive, I presume that a part of their unhesitating approach to man may be traced. Naturalists say that these foxes are peculiar to this archipe- lago, and they find difficulty in accounting for their presence in that quarter only.* ‘That they are now peculiar cannot be doubted ; but how long they have been so is a very different question. As I know that three hairy sheep, brought to Eng- land from Sierra Leone in Africa, became woolly in a few years, and that woolly sheep soon become hairy in a hot coun- try (besides that their outward form alters considerably after a few generations) ; and as I have both seen and heard of wild cats, known to have been born in a domestic state, whose size surpassed that of their parents so much as to be remarkable ; whose coats had become long and rough; and whose phy- slognomies were quite different from those of their race who were still domestic; I can see nothing extraordinary in foxes carried from Tierra del Fuego to Falkland Island becoming longer-legged, more bulky, and differently coated. But how were they carried there? In this manner :—In page 242, the current was mentioned which always sets from Staten Land towards the southern shores of the Falklands—icebergs or trees * Forster, as an exception, saw no difficulty in accounting for their involuntary migration. “M. Forster, Anglais, de la Société Royale, qui a fait a cet ouvrage l’honneur de le traduire, a accompagné sa traduction de plusieurs notes.” —“ Je dois dire que toutes ses notes ne sont pas égale- ment justes; par exemple, dans le chapitre de l’Histoire Naturelle des Tles Malouines, il est surpris de ce que je le suis d’avoir trouvé sur ces fles un animal quadrupéde, et de mon embarras sur la maniére dont il a été transporté. 1 ajoute qu’ayant passé comme je l’ai fait plusieurs années en Canada, j’aurois di savoir que des quadrupédes terrestres se trouvant sur de grandes glaces au moment ov elles sont détachées des terres, sont emportées a la haute mer, et abordent a des cétes fort éloi- gnées de leur pays natal, sur lesquelles ces masses de glace viennent échouer. Je sais ce fait; mais M. Forster ne sait pas que jamais les voyageurs n’ont rencontré de glaces flottantes dans les environs des fles Malouines, et que dans ces contrées il ne s’y en peut pas former, n’y ayant ni grand fleuve ni méme aucune riviére un peu considérable.—-V oyage We Bougainville, séconde édition, tom. i. pp. xiv. et xv. (note). TRANSPORT OF ANIMALS. 953 drifted by that current and westerly winds afford the means of transport; and I appeal to the quotations already made from Forster’s and Bougainville’s works for proof that animals may be so carried. Because we do not know that there are foxes at this time upon Staten Land, it does not follow that there are none, or that they have never been there ; and as guanacoes, pumas, and foxes are now found on Eastern Tierra del Fuego, why might not foxes have been carried to Staten Land and thence to the Falklands, or, which is still more probable, drifted from Eas- tern Tierra del Fuego direct. I have heard somewhere, though I cannot recollect the authority, that aman in North America hauled a large old tree to the bank of a river in which it was floating towards the sea, and proceeded to secure it on the bank, when to his astonishment, out of a hole in the tree jumped.a fine fox. Clusters of trees are often found floating, which have fallen off a cliff, or have been carried out of a river ; and once in the ocean, they are drifted along partly by currents and partly by wind acting upon their branches or exposed surfaces. Rats and mice were probably taken to the Falklands by the earlier navigators who landed there, whose ships were often plagued with their numbers.* That they have varied from the original stock in sharpness of nose, length of tail, colour, or size, is to be expected, because we find that every animal varies more or less in outward form and appearance, in consequence of altered climate, food, or habits; and that when a certain * In Viedma’s Diary of an Expedition to Port San Julian in 1780, he says, “ El Bergantin San Francisco de Paula entrd en el riachuelo para deseargarlo y dar humazo a las ratas.” (The brig San Francisco de Paulo went into the creek to be unloaded and smoked, to kill the rats (or mice, ratas signifying either). In Magalhaens’ voyage (1520) “ Juan (a Patagonian) seeing the Spaniards throwing mice into the sea, desired he might have them for food; and those that were afterwards taken being given to him, he carried them on shore.” —Burney, vol. i. p. 34. Perhaps some of those mice reached land alive, as the ships lay close to the shore. Many other vessels, however, afterwards staid some time in Port San Julian, particularly those of Drake. 254 VARIETIES OF ANIMALS. change, whatever it may be, is once effected, the race no longer varies while under similar circumstances; but to fancy that every kind of mouse which differs externally from the mouse of another country is a distinct species, is to me as difficult to believe as that every variety of dog and every variety of the human race constitute a distinct species. I think that naturalists who assert the contrary are bound to examine the comparative anatomy of all these varieties more fully, and to tell us how far they differ. My own opinion is, judging from what I have gathered on the subject from various sources, that their ana- tomical arrangement is as uniformly similar as that of the dogs and of the varieties of man. On East Falkland there are numbers of rabbits, whose stock is derived from those carried there by Bougainville or the Spa- niards. Among them were some black ones (when I was there), which had been pronounced indigenous, or, at all events, not brought from Europe. A specimen of these pseudo-indigenous animals has been carefully examined by those to whom a new species is a treasure, but it turns out to be a common rabbit. Sea-elephant and seal (both hair and fur-seal) were abundant along the shores of the archipelago in former years, and by management they might soon be encouraged to frequent them again ;* but now they are annually becoming scarcer, and if means are not taken to prevent indiscriminate slaughter, at any time of year, one of the most profitable sources of reyenue at the Falklands will be destroyed. Whales frequent the surrounding waters at particular sea- sons, and they are still to be found along the coasts of Pata- gonia and Tierra del Fuego (within easy reach from the Falk- lands), though their numbers are very much diminished by the annual attacks of so many whale-ships, both large and small, which have made the Falklands their head-quarters during the last twenty years. A valuable source of daily supply, and by salting, of foreign * On the little island ‘ Lobos,’ in the river Plata, passed and there- fore to a certain degree disturbed daily by shipping, seals are numerous ; being preserved like game, and destroyed only at intervals. FISHERY—BIRDS. 955 export, is the inexhaustible quantity of fish which swarm in every harbour during the summer. The description which most abounds is a kind of bass, from two to three feet long, and six inches in depth: it takes salt well, and has been ex- ported by cargoes to the river Plata* and to Rio de Janeiro ; and there are delicious small fish in such shoals, that our boats’ crews were sometimes obliged to let a large portion escape from the net before they could haul it ashore without tearing. Mr. Vernet said, “* We have a great abundance of fish in all the bays, where they come at the beginning of spring to spawn. In the winter season they retire. They enter regularly twice in the twenty-four hours, at about half-flood. They are caught in such numbers, that ten or twelve men salted about sixty tons in less than a month. Generally, they are caught with a net, but they will also take the hook ; they are of a species be- tween the mullet and the salmon, and become very fat towards the end of the summer. They are very good eating, and when salted, some prefer them to the cod-fish."—Vernet, MS. 1831. In the fresh-water ponds, so numerous on the large islands, there is a very delicate fish, somewhat resembling a trout, which may be caught by angling. The shell-fish are chiefly muscles and clams, both of which are very abundant, and easily ga- thered at low water. It may here be remarked that the cod-fishery off Patagonia and Tierra del Fuego might be turned to very good account by settlers at the Falklands. Of the feathered tribe there are numbers, but not much variety has been found—a natural consequence of the absence of trees. Three or four kinds of geese,t two kinds of snipe, several varieties of the duck, occasionally wild swans of two * Where fish, though plentiful, does not take salt well. + Many tons have been taken at a haul. t One kind of goose, that which has erroneously been called a bustard, arrives in a tame condition, about April or May, with easterly winds. Perhaps these birds come from Sandwich Land, or even Enderby Land. Their tameness may be a consequence of being ignorant of man, or of the half-tired state in which they arrive. 256 ERUSHWOOD—PEAT— GRASS. kinds, a sort of quail (like that of Tierra del Fuego), carrion- hawks or vultures, albatrosses, gulls, petrel, penguins, sea- hens, shags, rooks, curlew, sandpipers, rock-hoppers, and a very few land-birds, are found about most of the islands. * Although there are no trees, a useful kind of brushwood grows abundantly in vallies, to the height of three or four feet, and thickly set together. Over level plains it is but thinly scattered. The settlers use this brushwood for lighting their peat-fires. There are three kinds of bushes : one grows straight, from two to five feet high, with a stem from half an inch to an inch and half in diameter: this kind is found abundantly in most of the vallies. Another is common about the southern parts of the islands, and has a crooked trunk, as thick as a man’s arm, growing to about three feet in height. The third is smaller still, being little better than heather; it grows almost every where, though scantily. Peat is inexhaustible; and, if properly managed, answers every common purpose of fuel, not only as a substitute, but pleasantly. It will not, however, in its natural state, answer for a forge; but if dried and subjected to heavy pressure for some time before use, a much greater heat might be derived from it. There is but little difference in the quality of the grass, either on high or low land ; but in sheltered valleys it is longer, softer, and greener, than elsewhere. ‘The whole face of the country is covered with it; and in some places, especially over a peaty soil, its growth becomes hard and rank. In the * ‘Birds’ eggs are so numerous at the proper season, that “ eight men gathered at one place alone, in four or five days, upwards of sixty thou- sand eggs, and might have collected twice that number had they re- mained a few days longer.”—Vernet, MS. 1831. +“ The want of wood on these islands would be a great inconvenience, were it not that good peat is very abundant. I have burned many tons, and found it an excellent substitute for coal. In order to get it dry, it is necessary to pull it from the sides of the pit, not very deep ; and as there are several peat-holes, by working them alternately, the material may be procured in a state fit for use.”—-Weddell’s Voyage, p. 88. GRASS—SOIL—POT ASH. Q57 southern half of East Falkland, where, as I mentioned, the soil is good, there is abundance of long, but brownish grass over all the country, and at the roots of it there are sweet tender shoots, sheltered from the wind, much liked by cattle. In that district there are several varieties of grass growing on fine dark-coloured earth, mixed with light white sand; and, although, from never being cut, it has a rugged and brown appearance, its nutritive properties must be considerable, as the finest cattle are found feeding there. Mr. Bynoe remarked to me, that wherever the surface of the ground had been broken by cattle, he found a very dark-coloured earth mixed with sand or clay, or else clay mixed with gravel and sand. That the clay is good for bricks has been mentioned; but I have not said that there is stone of two or three kinds suitable for building, and that any quantity of lime may be obtained by burning fossil shells brought from the coast of Patagonia, where the cliffs are full of them, or by collecting the shells scattered upon the Falkland shores. Another natural produc- tion, of more value than it has hitherto been considered, is the common sea-weed or kelp ;* and I am told by Sir Woodbine Parish that the archil or orchilla weed was obtained there by the Spaniards. It is to be remarked, that the soil of East Falkland has been very much improved in the neighbourhood of the settlement, as well as around the estancia, or farm, where the tame cattle are kept, in consequence of the treading and manuring it has * The manner of extracting potash from sea-weed is as follows :— When a sufficient quantity of kelp has been collected, it is spread out in a place where it will be dried by the sun and wind, and when dry enough to burn, a hollow is dug in the ground three or four feet wide; round its margin are laid stones, on which ‘the weed is placed and set on fire. Quantities of this fuel being continually heaped upon the circle, there is in the centre a constant flame, from which a liquid substance, like melted metal, drops into the hollow beneath. This substance is worked, or stirred, with iron rakes, and brought to an uniform consistence while in a state of fusion; and when cool, it consolidates into a heavy, dark- coloured alkaline substance, which undergoes in the glass-houses a second vitrification, and then assumes a perfect transparency. VOL. I1. s 258 WOOL—GRAZING—CORN. received. The grass is there as short and as sweet as horses could desire; and does not this show, that by folding, on a large scale, any extent of pasture land might, by degrees, be brought to a similar condition? Why sheep have not been carried there in greater numbers I am not aware, but judging from the climate, and the fur of the foxes, I- should suppose that the long-woolled sheep would do well, and perhaps improve the staple of its wool, as the merino sheep has done in an oppo- site manner—by transportation to Australia. Pigs have in- creased in great numbers on the small islands, where their young are safer from the foxes, and where there is abundance of the sedgy grass called tussac, the roots and stalks of which are much liked by them. The size and fatness of the wild cattle is a clear proof that the country is adapted for grazing. Of twenty wild bulls which were killed during one excursion of the settlers, shortly before the Beagle’s arrival, the average weight of each hide was above seventy, and a few weighed eighty pounds. Some of these animals are so fat and heavy, that the gauchos say they cannot drive them across the marshy grounds which are passed by the other cattle, as well as by men on horseback. It has been also ascertained that meat takes salt remarkably well in that climate; and as salt of excellent quality, as well as salt- petre, abounds on the coast of Patagonia, there is no reason why large quantities of salt meat and salt fish should not be prepared there, and exported to the Brazils, to the East, to Chile, and Peru, besides supplying a number of the ships which would touch there. But there are alleged disadvantages to contend against, which must not be overlooked for a moment. It is very doubtful whether corn will ripen. Fruit, which requires much sun, certainly will not, and culinary vegetables have been said to run to stalk and become watery. Nevertheless, Mr. Brisbane assured me that wheat had been tried in Vernet’s garden, and that there it grew well, producing a full ear and large grain. The garden was small, slightly manured, and defended from wind by high turf fences. Potatoes, he said, VEGETABLES——FRUIT—TREES. 259 grew large, though watery ; but it was easy to see that justice had not been done to them, whole potatoes having been put into holes and left to take their chance, upon a soil by no means so suitable for them as might have been found. Planted even in this rough way, Mr. Bynoe collected three pounds weight of potatoes from one root. By proper management, I think that they, as well as turnips, carrots, cabbage, lettuce, and other esculent plants, might be brought to great perfec- tion, particularly on sheltered banks sloping towards the north-east. The turnips which I saw and tasted were large and well-flavoured: the largest seen there weighed eight pounds and a-half. Flax has been tried in a garden, and suc- ceeded. Mr. Bynoe saw some of it. Hemp has never yet been tried. Currant bushes (ribes antartica) have been transported from Tierra del Fuego, and tried near the settlement, but their fruit did not ripen properly. It ought, however, to be remembered that those currants are wild, a bad sort of black eurrant, and that when ripe in Tierra del Fuego they are scarcely eatable. We read in Bougainville and Wallis, that thousands of young trees were taken up by the roots in the Strait of Magalhaens, and carried to the Falkland Islands; but no traces of them are now visible either at Port Egmont or Port Louis. Perhaps they were taken out of their native soil at an improper period, exposed to frost or salt water, while their roots were uncovered, and afterwards planted by men who knew more of the main brace than of gardening. Bougainville, however, had industrious ‘ familles Acadiennes’ with him, under whose care the young trees ought to have fared better than under the charge of Wallis’s boatswain. Mr. Brisbane told me that he had brought over some young trees from Tierra del Fuego for Mr. Vernet; that some had died, but others (which he showed me) were growing well in his garden. From the opinions I have collected on the subject, and from what has been effected on waste lands, downs, and exposed hills in England and Scotland, by planting thousands at once instead of tens, I have no doubt whatever that trees may be 52 o 260 TREES—PLANTS—BALSAM. grown upon either Falkland, and that the more are planted the better they would grow—assisting and sheltering each other. At first, young plants or trees should have banks of earth raised near them, to break the fury of south-west storms, and the most sheltered situations, with a north-east aspect, should be chosen for a beginning. Anti-scorbutic plants are plentiful in a wild state, such as celery, scurvy-grass, sorrel, &c.; there are also cranberries,* and what the settlers call strawberries, a small red fruit, growing like the strawberry, but in appearance and taste more like a half-ripe blackberry. I must not omit the ‘tea-plant,’ made from which I have drank many cups of good tea, and the settlers use it frequently. It has a peculiar effect at first upon some people, which is of no consequence, and soon goes off.t This little plant grows like a heath in many parts of the Falk- lands as well as in Tierra del Fuego, and has long been known and used by sealers. The large round gum plant ( Hydrocelice gummifere), common in Patagonia and Tierra del Fuego, is abundantly found, and, when dried, is useful for kindling fires, being extremely combustible. The gum which exudes from its stalks when cut or broken, is called by the settlers ‘balsam,’ and they use it quite fresh for wounds; at the least it answers the purpose of sticking-plaister. In summer it may be collected in considerable quantities, without injuring the plants, as it then oozes out spontaneously ; even while green, the whole plant is very inflammable. The gauchos, when in the interior of the islands, tear it asunder, set it on fire, and roast their beef before it. Within the stems of the tall sedgy grass, called tussac, is a white sweetish substance, something like the kernel of an unripe nut; this is often eaten by the set- * One reason for the arrival of flights of geese during April and May may be, that the cranberries are then ripe, of which they are very fond. + At my own table I have seen it drank by the officers without their detecting the difference: yet the only tea I used at other times was the best that could be obtained at Rio de Janeiro. PU m ciens. § It produces a small berry, of very pleasant taste, which when ripe is eaten as fruit. IMPROVEMENTS—SETYLEMENT. 961 tlers, and is so much relished by cattle, horses, and pigs, that the plant itself is greatly diminished in quantity, and now can only be found in its former luxuriance upon islands where cattle or hogs have not access. These flags or rushes are more than six feet high; they make good thatch and a soft bed. There is a shrub, or rather creeper, of which the French made a kind of beer, thought to be wholesome and anti-scorbutic ; and there are other vegetable productions which are of little consequence, perhaps, except to botanists,* and as most of them were long ago well described by Bougainville, I may beg the reader to refer to his fourth chapter (Details sur l’his- toire naturelle des Iles Malouines) for a very faithful and well- written account, to every statement in which, as far as my own knowledge goes, I can bear testimony. Having mentioned the principal productions, it remains to say what more may be effected and what improvements may be made by an industrious colony. Land, which is now in a state of nature, might be surprisingly improved by ploughing and manuring with burned peat or with kelp, which is so abundant on every part of the shore. Walls, or rather mounds of turf, a few feet in height, would assist the slopes of the ground in sheltering cultivated soil from south-west winds, and where stones, as well as turf, are so plentiful, it would be worth while to make a number of small enclosures for fields as well as gar- dens, taking care always to select the sides of hills, or rather sloping grounds which incline towards the north-east. Fresh water being abundant everywhere, and the islands being so much cut into by the sea, that water carriage could be obtained to within a very few miles of any place, there can be no great preference for one locality rather than another, with a view to agriculture alone ; but of course the principal settlement must be near the eastern extremity of the archipelago, because that part is most accessible to shipping, and even now frequently visited. A colony planted near Port William, or at Port Louis, with a small establishment to supply the wants of ship- *“On a spot, twelve feet square, chosen indiscriminately on the rising grounds in the interior, twenty-seven different plants were counted.” — (Vernet, MS.) 262 PROSPECTIVE ADVANTAGES. ping at Port William, could not fail to prosper, if a free port were offered there to ships of all nations. Homeward-bound ships from our rapidly growing colonies in Australia, as well as those from Mexico, Peru, and Chile, are often in want of a port to which they can resort about the middle of their voy- age. The River Plata is out of the way and dangerous; Santa Catharina is almost as much out of reach, and deficient in many articles of supply ; Rio de Janeiro and Bahia are also out of the line and very expensive, though they are often resorted to ; St. Helena is too far east, scantily supplied, and more expensive than the Brazils. But almost every one of those ships ‘sight’ the eastern end of the Falklands as they pass by, to correct or verify their longitude, and how very little delay then would they experience, if the course were shaped so as to pass a little nearer Port William, and there heave to under the lee of the land, or let go an anchor, as might be most suitable. Water and fresh provisions might be speedily pro- cured, at a price now moderate, and if a colony were once well organized, in a short time as low as in any part of the world. A few small vessels should be attached to the colony, and two small men of war, one of which should be always about the chief harbour, and the other visiting the various ports of the archipelago. I have alluded more than once to the fact of excellent fresh water being plentiful every where, and I may here add, that if a sailing tank-vessel were kept at Port Wil- liam in readiness to supply ships without delay, that one con- venience only, when generally known, would ensure the visits of almost every Australian and Mexican trader, besides many others. No one making a long voyage hesitates to take in an additional supply of good water during his passage, if he can do so without delay (of consequence) and without danger. It is the natural unwillingness to get in with the land—to be delayed in port—to pay heavy port dues, and to risk losing men—that generally induces seamen in command of vessels to avoid every port excepting that to which they are bound ; but if you could ensure to a ship loading at Sydney a safe ¢ half-way house’ at the Falklands, she would hardly prefer carrying a quantity of EXPORTS—SUGGESTIONS. 263 water, no longer necessary, to the proportion of cargo that might be stowed in its place. Local circumstances, such as the relative position of the land, the set of the tides and currents, the prevailing winds, and the accessibility of Port William or Berkeley Sound, con- tribute to make the easternmost part of the’ Falklands safer and more easy te approach than almost any place that 1 am acquainted with. With the supply of shipping, and the establishment of a fre- quented free port in view, as the first source of prosperity, colo- nists should augment the number of animals, birds, and vege- tables, which they see thrive so well there,and take little thought about corn, except for home consumption (unless indeed oats should be found to grow well). They should assiduously increase their stock of cattle, sheep, pigs, and poultry, make butter and cheese, rear calves, and breed horses; they should salt meat and fish; bring wood and lime from Tierra del Fuego and Patagonia, and turn their thoughts to supplying ships with water, fuel (perhaps dried peat), and provisions, in the quickest ° and cheapest manner. Hides, pig-skins, goat-skins, sheep-skins, wool, foxes’ fur, rabbit-skins, bird-skins and down, horns, salt meat, salt butter, cheese, potash, orchilla weed, potatoes, salt-fish, seal-skins, seal-oil, whale-oil, and whale-bone, would form no indifferent return cargo for vessels carrying there implements of husbandry, stores of various kinds, flour and biscuit, clothing, lumber, furniture, crockery-ware, glass, cut- lery, and household utensils. North American vessels, laden with flour or lumber, might make very profitable voyages. I have always thought the Falklands an admirable place for a penal establishment, a thorough convict colony. A healthy, temperate climate, far removed from civilized countries, and (if used for such a purpose only) incapable of being injured by the presence of bad characters, as our mixed settlements have been—fully supplied with necessaries, yet without any luxuries—sufficiently extensive to maintain a large population, though small enough to be kept under the strictest martial law, and inspeeted every where, by water as well as by land— 264 CATTLE—DEPOT—PRODUCE. it seems to me the very best situation for locating those bad characters who are unfit to remain at home. But to whomso- ever it may happen to colonize these islands, there can be no doubt that industry will be well rewarded, that health, safety, and a frequent communication with the mother country, will be as certain as in any other colony, and that the only draw- backs to be anticipated are those likely to be caused by wind and deficiency of solar heat. Animals increase rapidly, and the quality of their hides or fur improves. Cows give a large quantity of excellent milk, from which good butter and cheese may be made. Not long since, a letter was received from the Hon. George Grey, Cap- tain of H.M.S. Cleopatra, in which he said that the milk and butter at Howick was not superior to that which he tasted at the Falklands. In the event of steamers engaging in the navi- gation of those seas,* a port of supply and repair, in short, a maritime depdt would be required, in or near Tierra del Fuego; but no such establishment could easily be formed there without a military force, and occasional hostilities with the natives, whereas, at the Falklands, the only native opponents would be foxes, horses, and bulls. This immense advantage over most habitable and fertile countries—the having no abo- riginal population—should be duly considered by those who may contemplate planting a colony there. Weddell says, ‘A settlement at this point of the South Atlantic would evidently afford great facilities to navigation. The extensive tracts of ground, well clothed with grass, and the quantity of fine cattle running wild on the island, are sufficient proofs of its being a country that might be settled to advantage. The win- ters are mild, the temperature being seldom so low as the freezing point. Several of my crew, indeed, went without * From Concepcion (37° §.) to Elizabeth Island, near the eastern entrance of Magalhaens Strait, there is every where abundance of wood fuel for steamers. 4 + It is very dangerous for persons on foot to approach the wild horses or cattle, especially the bulls, unless they are armed with rifles or balls (bolas); and even then, no one ought to venture alone. FREE PORT OF REFUGE. 265 stockings during the greater part of the winters we spent there. The south wind, however, is cold and stormy, but it is not frequent ; the prevailing winds are between S.W. and N.W., which, blowing from the coast of Patagonia, are com- fortably temperate. This climate appears to be in general much more temperate now than it was forty years ago, the cause of which may probably be, that immense bodies of ice were then annually found in the latitude of 50°; this ice, between the Falkland Islands and South Georgia, would necessarily lower the temperature of both air and water, and consequently an unfavourable opinion of the climate was pro- duced.” —Weddell’s Voyage, pages 94-95. For much of the produce of the islands, such as salt-meat and fish, potatoes, oil, butter, cheese, tallow, &c. a ready market would always be found on the coasts of South Ame- rica, while other articles, previously mentioned, would have a free sale in Europe and North America. Should any accident happen to a vessel in doubling Cape Horn, obliging her to make for the nearest port at which she can obtain supplies, where can she now go? Tothe River Plata on one side, or to Childe on the other—either of which is twelve hundred miles from Cape Horn ! A great temptation to shipping would be, the certainty of supplies, and freedom from harbour dues as well as pilotage. Twenty years after the first establishment of a colony would be quite soon enough to think of any port charges, and till that time, every encouragement ought to be given to vessels, by piloting them gratis, and charging for nothing but the sup- plies which they may choose to purchase, and for those, upon the lowest possible terms. As to pilotage, indeed, I may say that none is required, if a stranger has the chart now published by the Admiralty, for there is no danger in any of the Falkland harbours that is not distinctly buoyed by kelp. A few rocks in the offing are indeed to be guarded against, such as the Uranie Rock, and those near the Jason Isles; but a ship must have passed all those before a pilot could board her, under ordinary circumstances, and afterwards there would be no 266 PORTS—WOOL—VERNET. danger, if a vigilant look-out and common skill were exer- cised. Berkeley Sound (besides many other ports) would contain a large fleet in security, while around it are coves and basins in which any repairs might be carried on. Probably some intercourse might be opened with the Pata- gonians, and, by them, with other roving tribes on the conti- nent, who would exchange guanacoes, horses, cattle, poultry, hides, horns, tallow, and hair, for hardware, clothing, cutlery, ornaments, saddles, spurs, bridles, &c.; and as the guanaco is’ so warmly clothed in the high southern latitudes, and is capable of being domesticated,* it might be found a valuable animal to encourage among sheep and cattle at the Falklands. Mr. Bris- bane told me, that some wool, sent by Mr. Vernet from East Falkland to Liverpool, sold for nearly double the price of Buenos Ayres wool ; and this was the produce of sheep which had only been a few years on the island, of the Buenos Ayrean stock, unmixed with any superior breed. To show how well the little colony, established by Mr. Vernet, was succeeding, prior to its harsh and unnecessary ruin by Captain Silas Dun- can, I will give an extract of a letter received from a brother officer who visited Port Louis. ** 'The settlement is situated half round a small cove, which has a narrow entrance from the sound; this entrance, in the time of the Spaniards, was commanded by two forts, botl now lying in ruins, the only use made of one being to confine the wild cattle in its circular wall when newly brought in from the interior. The governor, Louis Vernet, received me with cordiality. He possesses much information, and speaks several languages. His house is long and low, of one story, with very thick walls of stone. I found in it a good library, of Spanish, German, and English works. A lively conversation passed at dinner, the party consisting of Mr. Vernet and his wife, Mr. *“Magalhaens, in his voyage, saw Patagonians who had with them four young guanacoes, led about with a kind of halter.”,—Burney, vol. i. p.34, anno 1520.—And others on which they placed their wives. Pennant. At Mocha the natives had tame guanacoes, or alpacoes, in 1598. In Peru, the Nama has been a domestic animal as long as we have any record. ESTABLISHMENT—DELUSION. 267 Brisbane, and others; in the evening we had music and dancing. In the room was a grand piano-forte ; Mrs. Vernet, a Buenos Ayrean lady, gave us some excellent singing, which sounded not a little strange at the Falkland Isles, where we expected to find only a few sealers. “Mr. Vernet’s establishment consisted of about fifteen slaves, bought by him from the Buenos Ayrean Government, on the condition of teaching them some useful employment, and having their services for a certain number of years, after which they were to be freed.. They seemed generally to be from fifteen to twenty years of age, and appeared contented and happy. ‘‘ The total number of persons on the island consisted of about one hundred, including twenty-five gauchos and five Indians. There were two Dutch families (the women of which milked the cows and made butter) ; two or three Englishmen ; a German family ; and the remainder were Spaniards and Por- tuguese, pretending to follow some trade, but doing little or nothing, The gauchos were chiefly Buenos Ayreans; but their capataz or leader was a Frenchman.” Such was the state of Vernet’s settlement a few months before the Lexington’s visit; and there was then every reason for the settlers to anticipate success, as they, poor deluded people, never dreamed of having no business there without having obtained the permission of the British Government. They thought, naturally enough, that the Buenos Ayrean Government could not have sold the islands to Mr. Vernet, unless the state of La Plata had a right to them; they believed that the purchase-money had been paid ;* but they were not aware that the British Government had protested formally against the pretended claim of Buenos Ayres, so quiet was that fact kept by the Argentine Government, although the solemn protest was made by Mr. Parish, the British consul- general, in November 1829. * It is said that officers in the Buenos Ayrean army, relations of Mrs, Vernet, had claims upon their Government, which they agreed should be liquidated by receiving certain sums of money from Mr. Vernet; in con- sideration of which the Government made over to him their pretended right of property in the Falklands and Staten Land. 268 CONDUCT—REFLECTIONS. However unjustifiably Mr. Vernet may, in fact, have behaved towards vessels belonging to the United States of North America, it must be remembered that he had a commission from the Buenos Ayrean Government, empowering him to act as civil and military governor of the Falklands; that he believed the Buenos Ayrean authority valid; and had no doubt in his own mind that he was doing right. Mr. Vernet, therefore, was no robber—no pirate—as he was termed by Cap- tain Duncan, because he tried to uphold his situation, and pre- vent his settlement being robbed by people who had no claim whatever upon any of the islands. However wrong Vernet’s actions may have been, he was responsible to his Government for them ; and those who acted under his order, he having a legal commission, certainly did not deserve to be seized as pirates, put into irons, and so carried to the Plata! Neither was it just (setting mercy quite aside) to destroy the infant colony, break open or tear down doors and windows, search houses, drawers, and chests, trample over gardens, break through fences, and ill-use the helpless, unarmed settlers to such a degree, that for many months afterwards whenever a man-of-war was seen approaching, the frightened inhabitants at once fled to the interior, not knowing how they might be treated. Poor Brisbane (of whom frequent mention has already been made, and of whom I have yet to speak), was taken, with others, in irons to Monte Video, where the British consul obtained his release ; he had joined Vernet in a contract to take seal upon the Falklands, and was left in charge of the settle- ment at the period of Captain Duncan’s hostility. At that time Vernet himself was absent, having gone with his family to Buenos Ayres, in order that he might attend at the ensuing trial of those sealing vessels which had been detained by him for repeatedly taking seal upon the Falkland Islands, after he had duly warned them off. I have heard much of Mr. Vernet and his proceedings, from various quarters—from enemies as well as friends—and although I never met him, and therefore cannot be partial from friendship, I do sincerely pity his misfortunes ; and it is my belief that he has been much misrepresented. CHAPTER XIII. Anchor in Berkeley Sound—Le Magellan—British flag hoisted— Ruined Settlement—Mr. Hellyer drowned—Burial—French Whalers—Uni- corn—A dventure—Squall—Flashes—F ossils—Killing Wild Cattle— Sail from Falklands— River Negro— Maldonado — Constitucion— Heave down, copper and refit Adventure—Signs of weather—Sound banks—Los Cesares—Settle with Harris and part company—Blanco Bay—Return to Maldonado—Monte Video. March 1. The Beagle anchored at the south side of Berke- ley Sound (near the beach where Freycinet was obliged to run PUranie ashore, in 1820, after striking on the detached rock off Volunteer Point), and remained there till I had ascertained the state of affairs on shore: for seeing a French flag flying near some tents behind Johnson Cove or harbour, and know- ing that, in 1831, the flag of Buenos Ayres was hoisted at a settlement in the sound, it was evident a change of some kind had occurred. Directly our anchor had dropped, a whale-boat belonging to the wrecked whale-ship, ‘ Le Magellan,’ came alongside ; and from her chief mate (who was also whaling- master), we learned that his ship had parted from her anchors during a tremendous squall on the night of the 12th of January, and was totally wrecked. He then informed me that the British colours had been hoisted on these islands by H.M.S. Clio; and that H.M.S. Tyne had since visited the port and saluted the flag; that the white flag was hoisted at the French tents only as a signal to us; and that he was sent by M. le Dilly, his captain, to entreat us to render them assist- ance. 'T'wo of our boats were forthwith manned; one was sent to the settlement at Port Louis, and in the other I went to the Frenchmen at Johnson Cove. I found them very comfortably established in large tents made from the sails of their lost ship ; but they manifested extreme impatience to get away from the islands, even at the risk of abandoning the vessel and cargo. After due inquiry, I promised to carry as many of them as I 270 WRECK—PROCEEDINGS. March could to Monte Video, and to interest myself in procuring a _assage for the rest. Their ship was lying upon a sandy beach, one bilge stove in, and her hold full of sand and water; but as there was no surf, and at high spring-tide the sea rose only to her deck, all the stores and provisions, if not the ship herself, might have been saved by energetic application of proper means soon after she was stranded. When I saw her it was not too late, but I had too many urgent duties to fulfil to admit of my helping those who would not help themselves. Returning on board, I met Mr. Chaffers, who had been to Port Louis, and heard that there was no constituted authority whatever resident on the islands, but that the British flag had been left by Captain Onslow in charge of an Irishman, who had been Mr. Vernet’s storekeeper. This man at first declined answering Mr. Chaffers’s questions, because his uniform buttons were (as he thought) different from those of the Tyne’s officers ; however, being a simple character, he soon became more loquacious than was wished. He told Mr. Chaffers that he was ordered to ‘ hoist the flag up and down’ when vessels arrived, and every Sunday: that there was ‘plenty of beef, and as for rabbits and geese, only the ‘ poor people eat them.’ 2d. Weighed and shifted our berth to Johnson Cove. 3d. We got on board all the new rope, bread, salt meat, and small stores, which the Frenchmen had saved and wished us to em- bark for the benefit of their owners. Meanwhile, surveying operations were begun, and an officer despatched to the settle- ment, who informed me of the arrival of a merchant schooner (Rapid), fourteen days from Buenos Ayres, with Mr. Brisbane on board (as Vernet’s agent as well as partner), who was de- lighted to meet our officer, finding in him one of those who helped to save his life when wrecked in the Saxe Cobourg in 1827. No sooner had Mr. Brisbane landed than the master and crew of the Rapid hastened to make themselves drunk, as an indemnification for the fatigues of their exceedingly long and hazardous voyage : and in that state they were found by the 1833. RUINED SETTLEMENT. O71 Beagle’s officer. Next morning Brisbane came on board with his papers, and I was quite satisfied with their tenor, and the ex- planation which he gave me of his business. Some misappre- hension having since arisen about his being authorized by Ver- net to act in his stead, I may here mention again (though no longer of any material consequence), that Brisbane’s instruc- tions from Vernet authorized him to act as his private agent only, to look after the remains of his private property, and that they had. not the slightest reference to civil or military authority. This settled, I went to Port Louis, but was indeed disappointed. Instead of the cheerful little village I once anti- cipated finding—a few half-ruined stone cottages ; some strag- gling huts built of turf; two or three stove boats; some broken ground where gardens had been, and where a few cabbages or potatoes still grew ; some sheep and goats; a few long-legged pigs; some horses and cows; with here and there a miserable- looking human being,—were scattered over the fore-ground of a view which had dark clouds, ragged-topped hills, and a wild waste of moorland to fill up the distance. ** How is this?” said I, in astonishment, to Mr. Brisbane ; “J thought Mr. Vernet’s colony was a thriving and happy set- tlement. Where are the inhabitants ? the place seems deserted as well as ruined.” “Indeed, Sir, it was flourishing,” said he, “but the Lexington ruined it: Captain Duncan’s men did such harm to the houses and gardens. I was myself treated as a pirate—rowed stern foremost on board the Lexington—abused on her quarter-deck most violently by Captain Duncan— treated by him more like a wild beast than a human being— and from that time guarded as a felon, until I was released by order of Commodore Rogers.” “ But,” I said, “ where are the rest of the settlers? I see but half a dozen, of whom two are old black women; where are the gauchos who kill the cattle?” “Sir, they are all in the country. They have been so much alarmed by what has occurred, and they dread the appearance of a ship of war so much, that they keep out of the way till they know what she is going to do.” I afterwards interrogated an old German, while Brisbane was out of sight, Q72 LOSS OF MR. HELLYER. March and after him a young native of Buenos Ayres, who both cor- roborated Brisbane’s account.* At my return on board, I was shocked by the sad informa- tion that Mr. Hellyer was drowned. He had walked about a mile along the shore of a creek near the ship, with one of the Frenchmen, who then left him+ (having recollected that he would be wanted for a particular purpose). Mr. Hellyer, anxious to shoot some ducks of a kind he had not before seen, walked on with his gun, saying he would return in half an hour. About an hour after this, the capataz of the gauchos, Jean Simon by name, riding towards the French tents to learn the news, saw clothes, a gun, and a watch, lying by the water side ; but, as no person was in sight, he thought they must have be- longed to some one in the boats which were surveying, so rode on quietly ; and not until another hour had elapsed, did he even casually mention to the Frenchmen what he had seen. They, of course, were instantly alarmed and hastened to the spot, with those of our party who were within reach. Some rode or ran along the shore, while others pulled in whale-boats to the fatal spot, and there, after much searching, the body was discovered under water, but so entangled by kelp that it could not be extricated without cutting away the weed. Mr. Bynoe was one of those who found it, and every means that he and the French surgeon could devise for restoring animation was tried in vain. A duck was found dead in the kelp not far from the body, and his gun was lying on the beach, discharged, with which the bird had been shot. To me this was as severe a blow as to his own messmates ; for Mr. Hellyer had been much with me, both as my clerk and because I liked his company, being a gentlemanly, sensible young man. I also felt that the motive which urged him to strip and swim after the bird he had shot, was probably a * The German told me, among other things, that he had collected rabbit-skins at his leisure hours, and had made, at different times, above two hundred dollars by them. + It was a positive order on board the Beagle, that no one should make any excursion, in such places, alone. 1833. UNICORN—GALES—WRECKS. 273 desire to get it for my collection. Being alone and finding the water cold, he may have become alarmed, then accidentally entangling his legs in the sea-weed, lost his presence of mind, and by struggling hastily was only more confused. The rising tide must have considerably augmented his distress, and hastened the fatal result. 5th. This day we buried the body of our lamented young friend, on arising ground near Johnson Cove, in sight of our ship. All the French attended the melancholy ceremony, as well as all our own party, excepting the very few who were obliged to stay on board. 6th. An agreement was brought about, and witnessed by me, between M. le Dilly and the master of the Rapid schooner, by which the latter bound himself to convey to Monte Video those of the Magellan’s crew whom the Beagle could not carry: and next day another French whaler arrived (the fourth we had lately seen), belonging to the owners of the Magellan, so there was no longer any want of help for M. le Dilly. A few days afterwards a sealing schooner, the Unicorn, arrived, Mr. William Low being sealing master and part owner; and, although considered to be the most enterprizing and intel- ligent sealer on those shores, perhaps anywhere, the weather had been so much against him that he returned from his six months cruise a ruined man, with an empty ship. All his means had been employed to forward the purchase and outfit of the fine vessel in which he sailed ; but having had, as he assured me, a continued succession of gales during sixty-seven days, and, tak- ing it altogether, the worst season he had known during twenty years’ experience, he had been prevented from taking seal, and was ruined. Passengers with him were the master and crew of a North American sealing schooner, the Transport, which had been wrecked on the south-west coast of Tierra del Fuego, in Hope Harbour; and he told me of two other wrecks, all occasioned by the gale of January 12-13th. At this time I had become more fully convinced than ever that the Beagle could not execute her allotted task before she, and those in her, would be so much in need of repair and rest, VOL. Il. T Q74 CONSIDER ATIONS—PURCHASE. March that the most interesting part of her voyage—the carrying a chain of meridian distances around the globe—must eventually be sacrificed to the tedious, although not less useful, details of coast surveying. Our working ground lay so far from ports at which supplies could be obtained, that we were obliged to occupy whole months in making passages merely to get provisions, and then overload our little vessel to a most inconvenient degree, as may be supposed, when I say that eight months’ provisions was our usual stock at starting, and that we sailed twice with ten months’ supply on board.* I had often anxiously longed for a consort, adapted for car- rying cargoes, rigged so as to be easily worked with few hands, and able to keep company with the Beagle; but when I saw the Unicorn, and heard how well she had behaved as a sea- boat, my wish to purchase her was unconquerable. A fitter vessel [ could hardly have met with, one hundred and seventy tons burthen, oak built, and copper fastened throughout, very roomy, a good sailer, extremely handy, and a first-rate sea- boat; her only deficiencies were such as I could supply, namely, a few sheets of copper, and an outfit of canvas and rope. .A few days elapsed, in which she was surveyed very carefully by Mr. May, and my mind fully made up, before I decided to buy her, and I then agreed to give six thousand dollars (nearly £1,300) for immediate possession. Being part owner, and authorized by the other owners to do as he thought best with the vessel in case of failure, Mr. Low sold her to me, payment to be made into his partners’ hands at Monte Video. ‘Some of his crew being ‘ upon the lay,’ that is, having agreed to be paid for their work by a small proportion of the cargo obtained, preferred remaining at the Falklands to seek for employment in other vessels, others procured a passage in the Rapid, and a few were engaged by me to serve in their own vessel which, to keep up old associations, I named ¢ Adven- ture.’ Mr. Chaffers and others immediately volunteered to go * Excepting water, of which we only carried six weeks. 1833. SCHOONER—STORES—SQUALL. Q75 in her temporarily (for I intended to place Mr. Wickham in her if he should be willing to undertake the responsibility), and no time was lost in cleaning her out thoroughly, loading her with stores purchased by me from M. le Dilly and from Mr. Bray (lately master of the Transport), and despatching her to Maldonado, to be prepared for her future employment. This schooner was built at Rochester as a yacht for Mr. Perkins, and, as I have reason to believe, cost at least six thousand pounds in building and first outfit. Soon afterwards, she was armed and used by Lord Cochrane in the Mediter- ranean ; then she was fitted out by a merchant to break the blockade of Buenos Ayres; but, taken by a Brazilian man-of- war, and carried into Monte Video, she was condemned as a prize and sold to Mr. Hood, the British Consul, who went to England and back again in her with his family ; after which, she was fitted out for the sealing expedition I have mentioned. At the time of my purchase she was in want of a thorough refit, and her internal arrangements required alteration ; but it happened that Mr. Bray and M. le Dilly had each saved enough from their respective vessels to enable me to load the Adven- ture on the spot with all that she would require; from the former I bought anchors, cables, and other stores, amounting to £216: and from M. le Dilly rope, canvas, and small spars, for which £187 were paid. Those who were conversant in such matters, the master, boatswain, and carpenter of the Beagle, as well as others, assured me that these articles were thus obtained for less than a third of their market prices in frequented ports. While the Beagle lay in Johnson Cove, we witnessed a memorable instance of the strength with which squalls some- times sweep across the Falklands. Our ship was moored with a cable each way in a land-locked cove, not a mile across, and to the south-westward of her, three cables’ length distant, was a point of land which, under ordinary circumstances, would have protected her from sea, if not from wind. Our largest boat, the yawl, was moored near our eastern anchor, with a long scope of small chain. At six in the evening of a stormy Tae 276 UNSETTLED STATE—LIGHTS. March J day (10th March), the wind increased suddenly from the strength of a fresh gale to that of a hurricane, and in a few minutes the Beagle brought both anchors ahead, and was pitch- ing her forecastle into the sea. Topgallant-masts were on deck, and yards braced sharp up all day; but we were obliged to let go a third anchor, and even then had some anxiety for the result. Till this squall came, the water had been smooth, though of course covered with white crests (‘horses’); but it was then changed into a short sea, such as I should have been slow to believe wind could have raised in that confined cove. The yawl, an excellent sea-boat, and quite light, was swamped. at her moorings; but I think that the chief cause of her filling was a quantity of kelp which drifted athwart hawse and hin- dered her rising easily to the sea. During the month we remained in Berkeley Sound, I had much trouble with the crews of whaling or small sealing ves- sels, as well as with the settlers, who all seemed to fancy that because the British flag was re-hoisted on the Falklands, they were at liberty to do what they pleased with Mr. Vernet’s pri- vate property, as well as with the wild cattle and horses. The gauchos wished to leave the place, and return to the Plata, but as they were the only useful labourers on the islands, in fact, the only people on whom any dependance could be placed for a regular supply of fresh beef, I interested myself as much as possible to induce them to remain, and with partial success, for seven staid out of twelve. While walking the deck after dark, I sometimes saw flashes of light on the distant hills, which it was difficult to account for as ‘ignes fatui,’ because they were seen only on the heights, and momentarily, long intervals intervening between each faint flash. I once remarked similar instantaneous glimpses of feeble light, like the flashing of a distant pistol, near Pecket Harbour, in Magalhaens Strait, during a rainy night, but on the hills, at the south side of Berkeley Sound, I witnessed such lights repeatedly. They were never bright or lasting—merely a faint sudden glimmer—exactly as I have said, like the flash of a pistol, fired at a great distance. It has 1833. MOUNTAIN TOPS—BONES. QT since occurred to me, that the phosphoric light spoken of by Bougainville in the following passage may be of a nature simi- lar to that which I saw, and that those momentary flashes might have been caused by the occasional fall of stones among ravines, near the summits of hills. ‘‘ Des voyages entrepris Jusqu’ au sommet des montagnes (pour chercher des calcaires), n’en (de pierre) ont fait voir que d’une nature de quartz et de grés non friable, produisant des étincelles, et méme une lumiére phosphorique, accompagnée dune odeur sulphureuse.” —(Bougainville, Voyage autour du Monde, 1766-69, tome I., p- 100). The shattered state of most summits of mountains in these regions* has often struck me, many of them being mere heaps of rocks and stones, over which it is extremely difficult to climb. Mount Skyring may be cited as one remarkable instance ; there, the stones gave out a very sulphureous smell when struck together, and were strongly magnetic.¢ Light- ning, electricity, and magnetism being intimately related, one is led to think that, if the above conjecture is incorrect, there may be some connexion between these sudden glimpses of faint light and the transmission of the electric fluid. This much I am. certain of, that they were not lights made by man, and that they were different from the will-o’-the-wisp, or ignis fatuus. My own employment obliged me to remain near the ship, but some of the officers made excursions into the interior, and to them and Mr. Brisbane I am indebted for most of the fol- lowing notices of these islands. Some very large bones were seen a long way from the sea- shore, and some hundred feet above the level of high water, near St. Salvador Bay. How they got there had often puz- zled Mr. Vernet, and Brisbane also, who had examined them with attention; Brisbane told me they were whale’s bones.t The rocky summits of all the hills are amazingly broken up, * Falklands and Tierra del Fuego. + Vol. 1., p.382. } Bougainville says, “ D’autres ossemens enormes, placés bien avant dans les terres, et que la fureur des flots n’a jamais été capable de porter si loin, prouvent que la mer a baissé, ou que les terres se sont elevées.”— Vol. I., pp. 112-113. 278 FOSSILS—GAUCHOS—-SEAMEN. March, like those of far higher elevations in Tierra del Fuego, and the fragments—some very large—have rolled down the near- est ravines, so that they look like the beds of dried-up tor- rents. The sand-stone, which is abundant, offers beautifully perfect impressions of shells, many of which were brought to England. In these fossils the minutest portions of delicate shells are preserved, as in a plaster of Paris cast, though the stone isnow very hard. There are fine stalactites in some large caverns, but they are known only to a few sealers. The large muscles produce pearls of considerable size, though inferior quality, perhaps; Mr. Brisbane had a small bottle full. In one of the cottages I saw a heap of good whalebone, and was informed that some hundred pounds worth had been picked up on the coasts, and sold to whalers for a tenth part of its Euro- pean value, in exchange for clothes, spirits, ammunition, and biscuit. On West Falkland there are beautiful pebbles, and on the heights fine crystals have been found. Although the climate is so much colder than that of Buenos Ayres, the gauchos sleep in the open air, when in the inte- rior, under their saddles, just as they do in the latitude of 35°. While idling at the settlement they gamble, quarrel, and fight with long knives, giving each other severe wounds. With their loose ponchos, slouched hats, long hair, dark com- plexions, and Indian eyes, they are characters fitter for the pencil of an artist than for the quiet hearth of an industrious settler. Besides these gauchos, we saw five Indians (p. 267), who had been taken by the Buenos Ayrean troops, or their allies, and allowed to leave prison on condition of going with Mr. Vernet to the Falklands. Including the crews of some thirty whale-ships, hovering about or at anchor among the islands; the men of several American vessels, all armed with rifles; the English sealers with their clubs, if not also provided with rifles; these cut-throat looking gauchos; the discontented, downcast Indian prisoners, and the crews of several French whalers—who could not or would not see why they had not as good a right to the islands as Englishmen— there was no lack of the elements of discord; and it was with a April 1833. WILD CATTLE HUNT. 279 heavy heart and gloomy forebodings that I looked forward to the months which might elapse without the presence of a man- of-war, or the semblance of any regular authority. Our tender, the Adventure, sailed on the 4th of April, under the charge of Mr. Chaffers, who was desired to call off the River Negro, and thence go to Maldonado, moor his vessel close to Gorriti Island, land every thing, and commence her thorough refit. About this time one of the officers went to see some wild cattle taken. After riding far beyond the hills seen from Port Louis, a black speck was discerned in the distance—instantly the three gauchos stopped, adjusted their saddle-gear, lassoes, and balls, and then cantered off in different directions. While stopping, my shipmate saw that the black spot moved and doubled its size. Directly afterwards, he perceived five other black things, and taking it for granted they were cattle, asked no questions of his taciturn, though eager, companions, but watched their movements and galleasatic on with the capataz (Jean Simon), | the other two making a détour round some hills. Having got down wind of the herd, Simon slackened his pace, and, lying along his horse’s back, gradually ascended a slight eminence, beyond which the cattle were feeding. For a moment he stop- ped to look round :—there was a monstrous bull within a hun- dred yards of him; three hundred yards further, were about twenty cows; and in a valley beyond, was a large herd of wild cattle. Just then the heads of the other two men were seen a quarter of a mile on one side, also to leeward of the cattle, which were still feeding unsuspiciously. With a sudden dash onwards, such as those horses are trained to make, Simon was within twenty yards of the overgrown, but far from unwieldy brute, before he could ‘ get way on.” Whirling the balls around his head, Simon hurled them so truly at the bull’s fore-legs, that down he came, with a blow that made the earth tremble, and rolled over and over. Away went Simon at full gallop after a fine cow; and at the same time, each of the other men were in full chase of their animals. The herd galloped off almost as fast as horses ; but in a few moments, another bull was bel- 280 SLAUGHTER OF CATTLE. April lowing in impotent rage, and two cows were held tightly by lassoes—one being caught by Simon alone, and the other by his two companions. One of the men jumped off, and fastened his cow’s legs together so securely, that she could only limp along a few inches at a time; his horse meanwhile keeping the second lasso tight, as effectually as if his master had been on his back. Both lassoes were then shaken off, and one thrown over Simon’s cow, which had been trying in all kinds of ways to escape from or gore her active enemy, who—go which way she would—always kept the lasso tight ; and often, by check- ing her suddenly, half overset and thoroughly frightened her. Leaving his horse as soon as the cow was secure, Simon ham- strung the bulls, and left them where they fell, roaring with pain and rage. He then remounted, and all four cantered back towards the ‘ estancia’ (or farm), where the tame cattle are kept. Simon was asked to kill the poor brutes before he left them; but he shook his head, with a sneer, and remarked, that their hides would come off easier next day! At daybreak, the following morning, half-a-dozen tame cattle were driven out to the place of slaughter, and with them the frightened and already half-tamed cows (which had been left tied in a place where they had nothing to eat), were easily driven in to the farm. The two bulls were at last killed, skinned, cut up, and the best parts of their carcases carried to the settlement. The hides of those two animals weighed seventy-three and eighty-one pounds. Speaking to Simon myself one day about the indiscriminate slaughter of cattle which I had heard took place occasionally, he told me that the gauchos used sometimes to kill them for their tongues only, and, perhaps, a steak or two, for ‘ asado’ (meat roasted on a stick), without taking the trouble to skin them; being too great epicures in their way to feast twice upon the same animal. In 1834, while surveying the sea-coast of these islands, in the Adventure, Lieutenant Wickham, Mr. Low, and Mr. Johnson had many a bull hunt; but though there was as much or more risk in their encounters, being on foot, with 1833. HUNTING—DANGERS. 281 rifles, assisted only by a good dog, their adventures were indi- vidually rather than generally interesting. ‘They used to land in unfrequented harbours, very near herds of wild cattle or horses, creep quietly along behind tussac or bushes, till they got within rifle-shot, take good aim at the fattest, and after firing, do their best to kill the animal, in general only wounded by a first shot. They had an excellent dog, who always seized the creatures by the lower lip, and diverted their attention from Mr. Johnson or Low, who otherwise might have lost their lives, on more than two occasions. The report of a gun usually alarmed the whole herd of cows, and off they went at a gallop; but the lordly bulls were not to be hurried, they would stand and face their enemies, often charge them; when a precipitate retreat behind a rock, or to the boat, or across a boggy place, which the bull would not try, was the only resource, if their hardy dog was not by, to seize the angry animal, and give time for a well-directed shot. In those excursions, also, while ashore at night in small tents, the foxes used to plague them continually, poking their un- pleasant heads into the opening of the tent (while the man on watch was by the fire), stealing their provisions, and breaking their rest, after a fatiguing day’s work. What with the foxes, the wild bulls, and the wild horses, it is thoroughly unsafe for a person to walk alone about the unfrequented parts of the Falkland Islands—even with the best weapons for self-defence against either man or beast. Several unfortunate people have been missed there, who wandered away from their parties. April 6.—Having embarked M. le Dilly, with some of his officers and crew, and lumbered our little ship with the spars and stores purchased from him, we sailed from the Falklands. Our passage to within sight of the river Negro was short, though stormy, a south-east gale driving us before it, under a close-reefed fore-topsail. As the sea ran high, it might have been more prudent to have ‘ hove-to ;? but time was precious, and our vessel’s qualities as a sea-boat, scudding as well as ‘by the wind,’ were well known. 282 ADVENTURE— WILLIAMS. April Early on the 12th, we were off the river Negro; but baf- fling winds and a heavy swell (raised by the late gale), pre- vented our anchoring near the bar, or sending in a boat. Soon after noon on the 14th, while standing off and on, wait- ing for the swell to go down, and allow of a boat crossing the bar, a sail seen in the horizon was made out to be the Adven- ture. We steered for and spoke her, found all well, sent her on to Maldonado, and again stood towards the bar. Our tender, as I mentioned, sailed from Berkeley Sound on the 4th; but was obliged to heave-to during the gale in which we were able to scud. Next day (15th), a decked boat, like the Paz, with some difficulty crossed the bar, and brought me letters from Lieu- tenant Wickham, by which I learned that he and his party had sailed from the river, intending to visit the Gulf of San Matias, only a few days before we arrived, having previously examined all the coast, from Port Desire to Valdes Creek.* I was sorry to hear that Corporal Williams, a very worthy man, in every sense of the words, had been drowned in the river Negro. Williams had been in two polar voyages, and under Captain King, in H.M.S. Adventure, from 1825 to 1830. The rest of the party were well, and making rapid pro- gress with their task. Wind favouring, we made all sail for the Bay of San José, hoping to meet the little vessels under Lieutenant Wickham, but could not find them ;+- so concluding that they had run further south than was intended at their departure from the Negro, we steered out of the Gulf of San Matias, and made sail for the Plata. At daylight on the 26th, land was seen near Maldonado, and at two, we anchored off Monte Video. In a few hours the French passengers were landed; next day our anchor was again weighed, and at noon on the 28th we moored the Beagle in Maldonado Bay, close to the little island of Gorriti. Our tender, the Adventure, had arrived on the 23d. My thoughts * Or port, as it has been called, though improperly, because it is at times almost blocked up by a bar. + They were in Port San Antonio. May 1838. PLANS—FUTURE VIEWS. 283 were at this time occupied by arrangements connected with her, besides the usual routine observations. I was extremely anxious to fit the schooner properly, and to set her to work, but at the same time to keep all our other operations in active progress. A decked boat was lying in Maldonado, just built, which her owner, Don Francisco Aguilar, offered to lend me for two months, if I would rig her for him, and this proposal exactly suited my views, as it would enable me to send for Lieutenant Wickham, and supply his place by Mr. Usborne, leaving Mr. Stokes to continue the survey about San Blas and the Colorado. Accordingly, the Constitucion, as this little craft was named by her owner, was hauled alongside, and Mr. Usborne with a party, set to work in preparing her for a trip to the River Negro. On the lst May Mr. Usborne sailed, having with him Mr. Forsyth and five men; he was to go to the River Negro, join and assist Mr. Stokes, and inform Lieutenant Wickham that he was wanted at Maldonado, to take charge of the Adventure. The Constitucion was about the size of the Liebre, a craft I should hardly have thought fit for such a voyage had I not heard so much from Mr. Harris and his companion, Roberts, of the capital weather those decked boats make in a gale. With their hatches secured, tiller unshipped, a storm try-sail—or no sail at all set, and nobody on deck, they tumble about like hollow casks, without caring for wind or sea. Next day (2d) the Beagle returned to Monte Video, to procure carpenters, plank, and copper for the Adventure. I found that she was so fine a vessel, and so sound, that it was well worth while to copper her entirely afresh, with a view to her future operations among islands in the Pacific, where worms would soon eat through places on a vessel’s bot- tom from which sheets of copper had been torn away. At this time the Adventure’s copper was complete, but thin, and as the carpenters said it would not last above two years more with certainty, I determined to copper her forthwith, and make one substantial refit do for all. Here, to my great regret, Mr. 284 REFITTING—HEAVING DOWN. May Hamond decided to return to England,* and we consequently Jost a valuable member of our small society. On the 17th, having engaged men and purchased plank, copper, provisions and other necessaries, we sailed from Monte Video, and next morning anchored in Maldonado. As soon as a part of our cargo was landed—all that was then wanted by the working party on Gorriti, under Mr. Chaffers—we pro- ceeded up the river to fill water, anchored again off Monte Video for a short time, and returned to our future consort at Gorriti (24th). Preparations were then commenced for heaving the schooner down to copper her. We hauled her alongside, and on the 28th hove her ‘keel out,’ for a few hours, and righted her again at dark. While standing on her keel, examining the state of her copper and planking, I saw a sail in the offing, which was soon made out to be the Constitucion, and just after we righted the schooner Lieut. Wickham came along- side. He brought good tidings— without drawback—and those who know what it is to feel anxiety for the safety of friends whose lives are risked by their willingness to follow up the plans of their commanding officer—however critical those plans may be—will understand my sensations that night. The Con- stitucion anchored off the Negro on the 11th, entered it next day, found the Paz and Liebre there, and on the 17th sailed again. Six knots and a-half an hour was the most she could accomplish under any circumstances, yet her passages were very good, considering the distance. During June we re- mained in Maldonado, employed about the Adventure, and refitting as well as painting our own ship. Meanwhile Mr. Darwin was living on shore, sometimes at the village of Mal- donado, sometimes making excursions into the country to a considerable distance; and my own time was fully occu- pied by calculations and chart-work, while the officers attended to heaving down the Adventure. This process, in a place partly exposed to south-west winds, was extremely tedious, * Provided that the Commander-in-Chief approved of his doing so— a sanction which I had no doubt of his receiving. June 1833. SIGNS OF WKATHER. 285 and had it not been for the great advantages Maldonado and Gorriti offered in other respects, the situation might have been deemed exceedingly ill-chosen for such a purpose. Only when there was no swell could we haul her alongside and heave her down (an operation under any circumstances difficult, as she was one hundred and seventy tons in burthen, and we were but two hundred and thirty-five) and many days some- times intervened on which no progress could be made. Every morning, at dawn of day, Lieut. Sulivan and I used to watch the sky most anxiously, in order to know whether it would be worth while unmooring, and warping the vessels together, and as the indications we looked for never deceived us, I will here mention them. Though familiar to all who lead a country or sea- faring life, and often rise before the sun, they may be of use to others, whose attention has not been drawn to ‘weather wisdom.” When the first streak of light appeared close to the horizon, and the sun’s rising was preceded by a glow of faint red, not extending far, a fine day succeeded, whether the sky were then overcast or clear; but if the first gleam of light appeared high above the horizon, behind clouds, and there was much red, not only near the sun, but visible on clouds even near the zenith, wind, if not rain, was sure to follow. Between the extremes of course there may be many varieties of appearance as well as of succeeding weather; but as I have found such signs followed by similar weather, in most parts of the world, and as I have often profited by them, with reference to mak- ing or shortening sail, &c.; I do not like to pass over this occasion for a hint to the inexperienced. I have always found that a high dawn (explained above) and a very red sky, fore- told wind—usually a gale; that a low dawn and pale sun-rise indicated fine weather; that the sun setting behind a bank of clouds, with a yellow look, was a sign of wind, if not rain, and that the sun setting in a clear horizon, glowing with red, was an unfailing indication of a coming fine day. I have already said (page 50), that hard-edged, oily-looking clouds, foretell, if they do not accompany wind, and that soft clouds—clouds which have a watery rather than an oily look—are signs of 286 ENGLISH BANK—SAN BLAS BANKS. July rain; and if ragged, or streaky, of wind also. Light foggy clouds, rising early, often called the ‘pride of the morning,’ are certain forerunners of a fine day. On the 8th of July the Beagle sailed from Maldonado, and anchored off Monte Video for a few days, waiting for the arrival of a packet from England. Directly the letters were received she returned to Maldonado. On the 18th, my survey work being finished, and our help no longer required at Gorriti, we sailed to sound eastward in the latitude of the English Bank, and then returned to make a few arrangements with Lieutenant Wickham, and obtain ob- servations for the chronometers, previous to making an excur- sion towards the south. On the 24th we sailed to Cape San Antonio, and thence along the coast, close by Cape Corrientes, and skirting the San Blas banks, till we anchored off the river Negro. There we found the Paz and Liebre just returned from their exami- nation of those intricacies which surround the ports between Blanco Bay and San Blas. The Liebre came out to meet us with a satisfactory report of progress, as well as health; and, at her return, Mr. Darwin took the opportunity of going into the river, with the view of crossing overland to Buenos Ayres, by way of Argentina: after which, he proposed to make a long excursion from Buenos Ayres into the interior, while the Beagle would be employed in surveying operations along sea- coasts uninteresting to him. We then got under sail and began our next employment, which was sounding about the outer banks off San Blas and Union Bays, and examining those parts of Ports San Antonio and San José which the Paz and Liebre had been prevented doing by wind and sea; besides which, I wished to see them myself, for many reasons, more closely than hitherto. The accumulation of banks about San Blas, and near, though southward of the river Colorado, is an object of interest when viewed in connection with the present position of the mouth of that long, though not large, river, which tra- verses the continent from near Mendoza, and which may have contributed to their formation; at least, so think geologists. 1833 ANEGADA BAY—LOS CESARES. 287 Be this as it may, there is now a mass of banks extending far to seaward, which make the coast from Blanco Bay to San Blas extremely dangerous; more particularly, as the adjoining shore is almost a dead flat, and so low, that in many parts it can only be seen when the observer is among, or upon, the shoals. The space between Union Bay and San Blas was very appropriately named by the Spaniards Bahia Anegada (dried up bay), because it is so shallow, and the inner parts are rather drowned land than actual water, being only covered at half tide. Falkner says (p.'77), that a Spanish vessel was lost in this bay, the crew of which “ saved themselves in one of the boats, and sailing up the river arrived at Mendoza.” Whether this ship was called ‘Los Cesares’ I am not aware, but as there is an islet in the ‘Bahia Anegada’ named in the old Spanish charts, ‘ Isla de los Cesares,’ I suspect that such was the fact, and incline to connect this story with the many rumours of a settlement, ‘de los Cesares,? somewhere in the interior of Patagonia. Falkner says, that ‘“ the crew saved themselves in one of the boats ;”* but there were few Spanish vessels about that coast in the early part of the eighteenth century whose whole crew could have been saved in one of their boats. If the remainder had formed even a temporary encampment about San Blas, or near the river Negro, it would have been described, with much exaggeration, by Indians of the west, as well as by those of the East country. A few men might have been admitted into a tribe of Indians who improved their habits and dwellings, so far as to have given rise to the curious reports so much circulated in South America, during the last century and even in this—of a colony of white people, with houses and gardens, in the interior of the continent, some- where about the latitude of forty degrees ; according to some * “Tn the year 1734, or thereabouts (within how many years after or before that time ?), the masts and part of the hulk were seen,”’ (Falkner, p- 77.) The so-called ‘ Isla de los Cesares’ is closely attached to, if not a part of the main land at the west side of Anegada Bay. + Reports of the Cesares began to be circulated in the early part of the eighteenth century, 988 PAZ AND LIEBRE—HARRIS. August between two ranges of the Cordillera ; others said it was in the plains; but all appeared to think there was no doubt of the existence of such a settlement. In Villarino’s Diary of his Exploration of Anegada Bay, I find that he was much assisted by horses and mules, which he carried on board his vessels, and landed as often as he had occasion to make a journey by land. At the river Negro I heard that some of these animals became so tame, and accus- tomed to landing and embarkation, that they would leap quietly into or out of the boats, when required.* On the 19th of August, we anchored near the bar of the Negro, to meet the Paz and Liebre, take our officers and men on board, and pay Mr. Harris the money to which he was entitled, not only by contract, but by the uniform attention, activity, and thorough kindness, which he and his partner had shown to their temporary companions ; by their know- ledge as pilots, and by the useful information which they had readily given, to the full extent of their abilities. The complete success of that enterprize was greatly owing to the conduct of those two worthy men. Before dark all was settled, our party was safely on board; we quitted Harris and Roberts, with their useful little craft, mutually satisfied ; and made sail for Blanco Bay, where there was still work to be done; intending to add to our already numerous soundings, while following the seaward edges of the banks. On the 24th, we moored off the Wells, in Port Belgrano, Next day, Lieutenant Sulivan went with a party to explore the furthest extreme of the inlet, while others were occupied, as usual, in the various duties always necessary on board a ship, in addition to those of a survey. Mr. Darwin was at Argentina, and hearing of our arrival, rode to the Wells. He had met General Rosas on the Colo- rado, who treated him very kindly ; and he was enjoying his shore-roving without any annoyance, the old major being no longer afraid of a ‘ naturalista. * Viedma and other Spaniards were similarly assisted in their expe- ditions. Sept!1833. PRECAUTIONS—H.M.S. SNAKE. 289 On the ‘7th of September, we finally left Blanco Bay ;* but again sounded along the dangerous banks of Anegada Bay, determined to do our utmost to prevent vessels from getting ashore there in future, as many have done already, especially during the blockade of Buenos Ayres, when several prizes, which had been taken from the Brazilians, were wrecked and totally lost. In these surveying trips along-shore we always anchored when we could, in order to preserve our station and connect triangles ; but, of course, we were often obliged to weigh again at short notice, during the night; therefore every preparation was made for any change of wind or weather, and a careful look-out always kept upon the deep-sea lead (invariably attended throughout the night), as well as upon the sympie- someter, the sky, and the water. I mention the deep-sea lead particularly, because however shallow the water may be, mis- takes are often made with the hand-lead, especially at night, when a tide or current is running, in consequence of the lead being drifted by the action of the water upon it and the line, and deceiving even a moderate leads-man; who sometimes thinks the water much deeper than it really is—sometimes the reverse ; and never can tell exactly, under such circumstances, how a ship is moving over the ground, or whether she is drag- ging her anchors. Off Starve Island we were obliged to weigh in a hurry, one night, owing to a gale coming on from the south-east, and during the 10th and 11th, we carried a press of sail, to get off the land ; the wind then drew round by the south, and a succession of baffling weather ensued, which prevented our doing any thing on the coast, and also hindered our reaching the Plata until the 16th, on which day we ran up to Monte Video, and anchored. On the 18th we weighed, hearing that H.M.S. Snake had brought stores and letters for us, and was at Maldonado, but had hardly lost sight of the town, when the Snake hove in * Mr. Darwin had previously departed on his road to Buenos Ayres. VOL. II. 10s 290 REMARKS ON SHIPS. Sept- sight. Knowing her to be one of thé new build, I altered course, to sail a few miles with her, and see how much she would beat us; but, to my surprize, she gained on us but little while running free with a fresh breeze, just carrying top- mast studding-sails ; and I was afterwards told by her officers, that though she sailed uncommonly well on a wind, and worked to windward wonderfully, she did nothing remarkable with a flowing sheet. I did not like her upper works; they ‘ tumbled home’ too much (like some old French corvettes) ; narrowing her upper deck, giving less spread to the rigging, and offering a bad form to the stroke of a heavy sea, whether when plunging her bow into it, or receiving it abeam. However good such a form may be for large ships, which carry two or three tier of guns, I cannot think it advantageous for flush-decked vessels or small frigates, and am quite certain that it is bad for boats. T here allude particularly to that ‘tumbling home’ of the upper works, which some persons approved of a few years ago. This is not the place, however, for a discussion upon naval architec- ture (even if I were qualified to deal with the subject, which assuredly I am not); but I cannot pass over an opportunity of adding my mite of praise to the genius and moral courage of Sir William Symonds and Captain Hayes, who, undeterred by opposition, and difficulties of every description, have suc- ceeded in infusing (if the metaphor may be allowed) so large a portion of Arab blood into the somewhat heavy, though stal- wart coursers of our native breed. Amidst the natural conten- tion of eager candidates for an honourable position, to which they have been accustomed to aspire, and for which some are doubtless admirably qualified, it is not surprising that due credit has not always been given to that originality and justi- fiable daring, of which the merits are attested by the Vanguard and Inconstant. Neither has it always been recollected, how- ever men may have differed in their opinions of this or that individual, as a naval architect, that the two best ships built of late years were constructed by naval officers, self-educated chiefly during the practice of their profession. JI am quite aware, that some of those eminent architects who have con- 1833. COMPARISONS—QUALITIES. 291 Pa) structed good ships since 1810—Sir Robert Seppings, Profes- sor Inman, Mr. Roberts, and Mr. Fincham, were very much restricted as to dimensions allowed with respect to guns to be carried ; and that, therefore, no one can pretend to say what degree of excellence the ships might have attained, had their architects been unshackled; but taking things as they are —not as they might have been—to Symonds and Hayes (if not chiefly to the former) belongs the merit of having improved our navy materially. We are so apt to forget, during the heat of controversy, that even an approach to perfection is unattain- able, and the utmost any one can hope for is to have fewer faults than his rivals—that we should not hastily condemn, in any case, only because we can detect deficiencies or errors. Many persons have remarked, that notwithstanding all the competition, all the trials of sailing, and all the reported improvements, which have taken place since the peace, our fastest ships have not excelled some of those built by France, England, or other countries, during the war. My own know- ledge of those ships is only derived from the descriptions of persons who sailed in or chased them: but the conclusion I am led to draw from their accounts is that, with few ex ceptions,* those ships were very slightly built, often of unseasoned timber, and that their rapid rate of sailing only lasted so long as their frames would yield to the fluid, and were not water-sodden. Recently launched, light, and elastic, confined by few beams, knees, or riders, held together by trunnions more than by metal, and intended only to sail swiftly—for a short existence —those greyhound vessels were as different in their construc- tion from the solid, heavy, durable ships of this day, as a light, active youth is from a well-set man trained to labour. A man-of-war requires strength, solidity, capacity ; great * The Malta (Guillaume Tell), Norge, and a few others, were splendid exceptions, but even in the construction of those ships far less iron and copper were used than is now customary in vessels of their class. By substituting so much metal in place of wood, for knees, braces, and bolts, solidity, strength, and capacity are acquired in modern ships at the ex- pense, in most instances, of elasticity, and swift sailing. u 2 : 999 TUYU—CAPE CORRIENTES. Sept. Oct. buoyancy for supporting her heavy metal, durability, and tena- city ; besides easiness as a sea-boat, and superiority of sailing. Vessels may easily be built to excel in any of these qualifica- tions; but to excel in all is the climax, only to be obtained by genius, aided by extraordinary study and experience. ' After running a few miles with the Snake, and finding that she steered towards Buenos Ayres, we altered our course to re- sume our easterly route, and early next morning were anchored alongside the Adventure. As it was evident that another month must elapse before the schooner would be ready for her work, notwithstanding the zea- lous exertions of Lieut. Wickham and his crew, I decided to finish myself the survey, which I had intended he should begin with, namely, of the south shore of the Plata and a reported bank off Cape Corrientes—and defer the second visit to Tierra del Fuego until December or January. Accordingly, the Beagle sailed on the 23d, and after a close examination of Cape San Antonio and the great mud-bank, called Tuyu, which lies within it, we went to the neighbourhood of Cape Corrientes, and there looked about and sounded in every direction, but could find no shoal. We then returned to the river, and sounded Sanborombon Bay, laying its shores down on the chart as accu- rately as we could, considering that the water was every where so shoal, that even a boat could not get within half a mile of the land, except at particular times, for which we could not wait. The distance at which the Beagle was obliged to keep, varied from four miles to three (seldom less), and then she was sailing in about a foot more water than she drew.* On the 6th of October we returned to Maldonado ; to pre- pare for a long excursion southward, and to hasten the equip- ment of the Adventure. By the 19th she was almost ready, so we weighed in company, ran up the river to water, and on the 21st moored off Monte Video, to take in our final supplies pre- vious to quitting the River Plata for the last time. Here, to my surprise, I found people talking about the English having * The Beagle’s draught of water was eleven feet and a half forward, and thirteen feet aft, when in ordinary loaded trim. 1833. ABSURD REPORTS—FLAG. 293 taken possession of the island of Gorriti, and built houses upon it. This, I knew, must in some way have arisen out of the temporary encampment of the Adventure’s crew ; and en- quiring further, I found that columns of the Monte Video newspapers had been filled with discussions on the subject.* The local authorities at Maldonado having been told (incorrectly) that the English had hoisted British colours upon the island— had repaired several old buildings—and had erected a house with glass windows, for the commanding officer’s residence— became alarmed ; and as stories seldom lose by repetition, the good people of Monte Video were soon in commotion. How- ever, the affair was easily explained; but not without many a laugh at the absurdity of my little observatory (made of ninety small pieces of wood, so as to be stowed in a boat), hav- ing ‘loomed’ so large. Had our colours ever been displayed on shore, there might have been some foundation for their alarm; but it so happened that the only flag that was on the “ Monte Video, Octubre 22 de 1833. *« E] infrascripto Ministro Secretario de Estado en el departamento de Relaciones Exteriores, tiene érden del Gobierno para dirigirse al Sr. Cénsul General de S.M.B. y manifestarle, que 4 consecuencia de varios sucesos que han tenido lugar en la Isla de Gorriti, donde se halla la tri- pulacion de la Escuna de 8.M. Adventure, los cuales constan de los documentos que en copia autorizada se acompaiian ; y deseoso el Gobi- erno de satisfacer la ansiedad publica que han producido aquellos sucesos, y quitar todo pretexto de interpretaciones, espera que el Sr. Consul tendra 4 bien manifestarle los motivos que dieron mérito 4 que los individuos pertenecientes 4 aquel Buque pasasen 4 la Isla, como igualmente las cau- sales de su permanencia en ella. “El Ministro que subscribe reitera al Sr. Consul General de S.M.B. los sentimientos de su mayor consideracion y aprecio. (Firmado) “ Francisco LuAmsBi.” “ Monte Video, Octubre 28 de 1803. “ El abajo firmado Cénsul General de 8.M.B. cerca de la Reptblica Oriental del Uruguay ha tenido el honor de transmitir al Sr, Fitz-Roy, comandante de la barca descubridora de 8.M.B. Beagle, la comunicacion y copias 294. CAUTION—MONTE VIDEO. Oct.—Dec. 1833. island, at any time while our party was there, was an old Monte Video (Banda Oriental) ensign, which belonged to the schooner when I bought her from Mr. Low. This incident, trifling as it is, may be worth notice, as showing how necessary it is to be more circumspect and explanatory in every dealing with a small State, than in similar transactions with the Authorities of old established governments. The month of November was passed at Monte Video: lay- ing down chart-work, computing observations, and writing ; procuring and stowing provisions; painting the vessels outside and blacking their rigging ; and occasionally giving the crews leave to go ashore. Mr. Darwin returned at the end of the month; and the first week in December both vessels sailed from the river: but before I go on with them to Tierra del Fuego and the Falklands, some pages shall be devoted to the proceedings of our enterprizing and hard-working labourers, who were employed so zealously during twelve months without intermission, in the little vessels Paz and Liebre. y copias inclusas que S. E, el Sr. D. Francisco Llambi, Ministro Secre- tario de Negocios Extrangeros le hiz6 el honor de dirigirle en 22 del corriente ; y el infrascripto se halla autorizado para decir que ni el 3 de Octubre, de 1833, ni otro dia alguno del presente afio se ha enarbolado o desplegado en la Isla de Gorriti la Bandera de la nacion Britaniea. El 3 de Octubre de 1833, y muchos dias anteriores, la de este Estado fue izada como un senal para D. Francisco Aguilar, avisindole que se iva 4 embiar un bote en busea de carne y comestibles. La casa de madera con vidriera que se dice ser habitada por el comandante, es un observatorio portatil hecho en Inglaterra, que ahora se halla en Ja Isla de Ratas de este Puerto ; y ninguno de los edificios de la Isla de Gorriti, ha sido repa- rado por persona alguna bajo las érdenes del Comandante Fitz-Roy: le que el abajo firmado comunica 4 S.E. saludandole con su particular consi- deracion y aprecio. (Firmado) “ Tomas SAMUEL Hoop.” CHAPTER XIV. Paz and Liebre begin work—Chronometers —Fish—Animals —San Blas—Wrecks—River Negro—Del Carmen—Inhabitants—Indians— Trade—Williams drowned—Port Desire—Gale—Salinas—Lightning —Bones in Tomb—Trees—Dangers—New Bay—Cattle—Seals—Soil —River Chupat— Drift Timber— Fertility —Wild Cattle—Valdes Creek—Imminent danger—Tide Races—Bar of the Negro—Hunting —Attack of Indians—Villarino—Falkner. Tue Paz and Liebre parted company with the Beagle on the 18th of October 1832, and commenced their undertaking by a cursory examination of the entrance to False Bay, Green Bay, and Brightman Inlet. Lieut. Wickham and Mr. King, with Roberts and four men, were in the Liebre.* Messrs. Stokes, Mellersh, and Forsyth, with Harris and five men, were on board the Paz.} While they were northward of the Colo- rado, true bearings of the Ventana Mountain, and observed latitudes, made them independent of their five chronometers ; but it was soon found that the rates of those useful machines were not injured even by the continual as well as sudden mo- tions of so small a vessel. They were bedded in sawdust, wool, and sand,{ within a large tub, which was secured to the deck under the cabin table of the Paz, not far from the centre of least motion. In Brightman Inlet great quantities of fish were caught, by stopping up the mouths of small creeks with a net at high water, and when the tide ebbed many more were left ashore than were wanted. On Green Island they found good water by digging wells seven or eight feet deep. The island itself was oyerrun by deer and cavies: and on the main land the wild pig of the country (javali) was seen. On the 23d they entered the river Colorado, but had much trouble in warping to a safe berth, on account of the water being very shoal at the entrance which they had chosen. The principal mouth was a * Nine tons burthen. + Fifteen tons. ¢ Sawdust alone would have been better. 296 WOLF—DEER—DOGS. Oct. Nov. quarter of a mile further south, the stream being there ‘* broad and rapid,” with two fathoms water when the tide was out ; but beset, to seaward, by sandbanks, which shift with every south- east gale. Quantities of drift-wood, a kind of willow (sauci), lay about every where, indicating that the river sometimes overflowed its banks to a great distance, and brought down these trees from the interior country, as none grow within three leagues of the mouth. The river hereabouts is divided into many streams, forming a great number of small islands, which are nearly all of clay covered with rushes. From one of these streams or channels, the Canada, there are creeks commu- nicating at high-water with Union Bay. Here Lieut. Wick- ham’s party saw a wolf. On the 27th they met a whale-boat (at Creek Island in Ane- gada Bay) from the River Negro, in search of sea-elephants. Next day they reached a snug creek in San Blas Bay, where they heard that the Indians had lately driven off all the cattle from the San Blas Estancia, had destroyed the houses, dis- mounted the guns, and broken the carriages. They were accompanied by a number of desperate criminals who had fled from justice at Buenos Ayres, and idle gauchos, who preferred robbery to work, and were unquestionably the most savage of the troop. On the 29th the Liebre was hauled ashore, to extract a piece of sauci wood that had run through her bot- tom : and a party was afterwards employed in erecting a conspi- cuous mark upon Hog Island;.a very difficult task, because the loose sand, of which that island wholly consists, flies in clouds at every gust, and nowhere affords a solid foundation. By the help of casks filled with it, and spare anchors, they at length suc- ceeded in securing an old spar upright, which was large enough to be seen ten miles round, in that low half-drowned country. Deer were very numerous on Javali Island ; but on the place called Deer Island, there was not one, though they were so plentiful there a few years before. Some dogs had been left there by a whale-ship, which have increased very much in numbers and are very savage: these dogs have exterminated the deer. Dec. 1832. SAN BLAS—WRECKS. 297 Any quantity of fresh water may be obtained in San Blas Bay, by digging wells six or eight feet deep; and fish are abundant: but it is no place for a ship to enter unless under favourable circumstances of weather, wind, and tide; and de- cidedly dangerous with a south-easter, because there is then a sea on the banks outside which confuses the pilot’s eye, and prevents his distinguishing the proper channel ; besides which, thick weather, if not rain, is the general accompaniment to that wind. On the 3d of December the Beagle anchored off San Blas (as formerly mentioned). Both schooners went out to her, and in returning at night into San Blas Bay, working to windward with a strong flood tide, they passed close to an unknown rock which would have made an end of their cruise had they touched it. The least water they had, however, was eight feet ;* but both vessels were close to it, while the tide was running four or five knots. This rock is in the middle of the entrance to San Blas Bay. At midnight they reached their anchorage, without a dry article in either vessel. On the 6th, Lieutenant Wickham remarked, while at anchor between San Blas and the River Negro, off Point Rasa, that the stream of tide began to set northward at half flood, and continued to run in that direction until half ebb, by the shore. ** Tt is not at all uncommon on this coast,” he says, ‘ to see wrecks of vessels above high-water mark, and spars strewed along the beach where the sea does not touch them.” These wrecks took place during south-east gales, when the sea was raised above its usual level in fine weather: and were the vessels spoken of in the previous chapter, as having been entrusted to ignorant or careless prize-masters, who ran for San Blas or the River Negro, not then knowing that so fine a port as Blanco Bay existed. Strong tides, shoals, a low coast, and bad weather would have perplexed professed seamen ; but those difficulties were insurmountable to such unpractised craftsmen as those who were in charge of them, and most of the prizes were lost. One large ship of four or five hundred * The Paz drew five feet and a half, the Liebre four feet. 298 RIVER NEGRO—BANKS. Dee. tons was taken, by a wiser master, to Port Melo, and there her cargo was discharged into small craft, which landed it safely in the River Negro. Many of these ill-fated vessels were never afterwards heard of ; but from the numerous wrecks seen along the coast between the Colorado and the Negro, it may be inferred that they and their unfortunate crews perished in the surf occasioned by south-east gales, or were capsized by sudden pamperoes. Running up the River Negro (on the 7th December), Lieut. Wickham found the ‘freshes’* strongly against him. The banks of the river afforded a pleasing contrast, by their ver- dure, to the arid desert around Anegada Bay. Most part of these banks was cultivated, and great quantities of fine corn was seen growing. Here and there were country houses (quin- tas) surrounded by gardens, in which apple, fig, walnut, cherry, quince, and peach trees, vines, and vegetables of most kinds were abundantly plentiful. Although the banks of the river are so fit for cultivation, it is only in consequence of floods, which take place twice a-year—once during the rainy season of the interior, and once at the time when the snow melts on the Cordillera. ‘These floods swell the river several feet above its banks, bringing a deposit of mud and decayed vegetable matter, which enriches the soil and keeps it moist even during the long droughts of that climate. The plough used there is wooden, and generally worked by oxen, but it does not cut deeply. Manure is never used, the soil being so fattened. by alluvial deposits. The town of Nuestra Senora del Carmen, is about six leagues up the river, on its northern bank, upon a slightly-rising ground about forty feet above the water. It is irregularly built: the houses are small, one only having two stories; and glass win- dows are seldom seen : each house hasa large oven. A square enclosure of some extent, formed by walls of unbaked bricks (adobes), is called the fort, and within it are the church, the * Showing that this was the period of one of the two floods to which the Negro is annually subject. 1832. TOWN OF DEL CARMEN. 299 governor’s house, lodgings for the officers, and public stores. This fort commands the neighbourhood, as well as the houses (or cottages) surrounding it; and of the hundred buildings which compose the town of Carmen, exclusive of about thirty huts on the south bank of the river, the fort is the oldest. It was built about 1763. Some houses, forty years old, are as fresh in outward appearance, as if built only a few years ago. In a population of 1,400, there are about 500 negroes. Alto- _gether there may be in the town about two thousand inhabi- tants, but many of the poorer families and negroes live in caves, which were dug out of cliffs on the river’s bank by the first Spanish settlers. It is said that they served the Spaniards as a secure refuge from the Indians, who could only approach them by one path, easily secured. These caves, dug out of earthy clay, are not despicable dwellings, while there is a fire in them to expel damp. About a league from the entrance of the river are the ruins of a large house, which was the “ Estancia del Rey.” In former days 100,000 head of cattle were attached to that esta- blishment, now there is not even a calf. Some of the first settlers were living at Carmen in 1833, staunch royalists, every one looking back with regret to former times. One of them belonged to the crew of the Spanish launch that first entered the river. He said, that the Indians were then living in detached tribes along both banks of the river, and were very friendly to the Spaniards. This same old man afterwards made one of the exploring party, under Villarino, in 1786, when the natives were not only inoffensive, but gave them assistance. How different from the present day! when if a Christian is seen by the natives, he is immediately hunted, and his safety depends upon the fleetness of his horse. It has sometimes happened, that persons riding along near this river, have been surprized by a marauding party of Indians, and obliged, as their only resource, to leap off the banks (barran- cas), whether high or low, and swim across to the other side. The Indians have never followed ; hence this, though requiring resolution, is a sure mode of escape. 300 INDIANS—HARSH TREATMENT. Dec. Prior to the conclusion of the war between Brazil and Bue- nos Ayres (1828), the settlers at Carmen lived tranquilly— undisturbed by Indian aggression (retaliation ?) but since that time, they have been kept in continual alarm. Prisoners are often brought to Carmen to be ransomed, whom the Indians have taken from other places. They are generally women or children ; and as the Indians often find out who their prisoners are, the ransoms asked are proportionably exorbitant. Men are usually put to death, if they do not die of their wounds. ‘There is a tribe of friendly Indians living near Carmen, at the out- skirts of the town, who do much hard work for the inhabitants for very trifling remuneration ; but they are shamefully abused, cheated in every way by shopkeepers and liquor-venders, and harshly treated by other persons, who seem to consider them inferior beings—unworthy of any kind or humane considera- tion. Should one of these poor creatures fall by the knife of a passionate white man, no notice is taken of it by the authorities ; the murderer boasts of his deed, and the poor relations suffer patiently the loss and the insult, which they dare not avenge. Having quitted the free tribes, seduced by promises never fulfilled, they would not be received among them again; and their own numbers, originally small, are reduced daily by disease and abominable drugs, which the publicans sell them in what is said to be spirituous liquor (agua ardiente). Mr. Wickham saw a poor Indian woman, between forty and fifty years of age, almost killed by a blow on the head from an ox’s skull (with the horns), given by a wretch, who had drawn his knife upon her husband for preventing his kissing a pretty girl, their daughter, who was walking with her. This scoundrel was seen by Mr. Wickham, a few days after- wards, betting at the race-course with the principal people of the place. Thanks to the influence of Harris and Roberts, and their connections (both being married to daughters of Spanish settlers), our officers and men were exceedingly well treated, Every door was open to them; and the fruit in every garden was freely, as well as sincerely offered. Letters had been for- 1832. INHABITANTS—TRADE. 301 warded to the commandant or governor, from Buenos Ayres, desiring that we might have every facility and freedom in our operations ; but the disposition towards us was such, that those letters were not required. From the remains of former buildings, and accounts of the old men, Lieutenant Wickham thought that the Spanish settlers must have been far more industrious and ingenious than their creole descendants, who are idle, indolent, and ignorant. The height of their ambition is to make a show at the Sunday races, where they deceive, drink, wrangle, gamble, and quarrel, These Sabbath occupations are always attended by the female part of the population, who take that opportunity of displaying their finery ; and though seated upon handkerchiefs on the sandy ground, without any defence from sun, wind, dust, or rain, every damsel displays silk stockings and a gaudy dress upon these occasions. The men do not go near them, notwith- standing their attire: they can beat a poor woman almost to death, upon occasion; but they cannot defer a bet, or risk losing a dollar, for the sake of female society. The climate is so healthy, that illness of any kind is scarcely known; and the inhabitants, in general, live to a good old age. There is a stirring trade carried on in small vessels, be- tween Buenos Ayres and this place. Salt, of excellent quality, hides, peltry, seal or sea-elephant oil, and skins, are the prin- cipal exports, in return for which are received manufactures, sugar, spirits, tobacco, &c. The Indians, who live at the outskirts of the town in § tol- dos, which are neither wind nor water-tight, load vessels with salt; but the price of their labour is usually spent in some kind of spirituous liquor, which is made and drugged expressly for them—the publicans often saying, “that it is a sin to give an Indian good spirits.” When drunk, the howling of these poor wretches is quite frightful. Some of them are almost skeletons—the result, probably, of drinking. Some leagues up the river coal is obtained, I was informed, but I did not see a specimen myself. Probably Mr. Darwin had an opportunity of examining its quality. 302 CORPORAL WILLIAMS. Dec. 1832. On the 12th, Lieutenant Wickham sailed for Blanco Bay, to deliver some letters from me (which I had received from Buenos Ayres) to the commandant Rodriguez. 13th. Off the banks in Anegada Bay there was too much sea (during a 8.W. gale) for the Liebre to keep on her course any longer, having run as long as was prudent, and already shipped several seas. When hove-to, under a_balance-reefed foresail, with the tiller unshipped, she was dry and easy, and lay about five points from the wind. Mr. Wickham arrived at Argentina on the 16th, and left it on the following day. In sailing out of Blanco Bay, along the south shore, while it was dark, the Liebre grounded frequently ; but her crew got overboard, and hauled her over the banks as often as she was stopped by them, and at midnight she was at sea. A south-east gale on the 18th drove her into the Colo- rado, where Lieutenant Wickham found a strong outset, owing to the ‘freshes,’ even during the flood-tide. On the 22d, the Liebre entered the river again, and anchored near Carmen. At daylight on the 24th, Corporal Williams was missed, supposed to have fallen overboard in the night, while asleep. He slept on deck sometimes, when tormented by musquitoes ; and as the Liebre’s weather-cloth rail was but a few inches above the deck, he might possibly have rolled overboard into the stream, which would immediately have carried him away. His body was found, about three miles down the river, at sun-set the next evening (Christmas day). The governor (though a Roman catholic) allowed the burial to take place in the con- secrated ground of the church, and the curate himself was present. While the Liebre was absent, Mr. Stokes, in the Paz, sur- veyed many miles of the river, as well as the bar. No vessel drawing more than eleven feet water can enter without much danger: if at a favourable time any person should be induced to risk crossing the bar with a ship of greater draught, he should bear in mind that it is much more difficult to get to sea than it is to enter, because wind which is fair for approach- Jan. 1833. PORT DESIRE—GALE. 303 ing, raises the water ; and the reverse. Although ships drawing fourteen feet have passed the bar, at unusually favourable times, others of only ten feet draught have been detained forty days in the river. 29th. Both our little vessels sailed, and on the 4th of Janu- ary they anchored safely in Port Desire:—this was a bold stroke, but success attended it. T hey were thus placed at the southernmost point of the coast they were to survey, while the sun was farthest south ; and as the days shortened, they would work along the coast northward. Recent traces of Indians were found; and the master of an American sealer told Mr. Wick- ham that they had been there in considerable numbers, about two months previously. The wells were all full; therefore much rain must have fallen during October, November, or December. I have mentioned elsewhere that although the eastern coast of Patagonia is usually an arid desert, there are periodical times, of short duration, at which rain falls abundantly. 11th. Having rated their chronometers, the little vessels stood out to sea, in company with the North American sealer ; but they had not sailed many miles before the wind increased to a gale, and still becoming stronger, bringing clouds of dust and sand off the land, they were reduced to bare poles, and drifted fast off-shore, as well as northward. When the fury of the gale was over, their balance-reefed foresails were set, and with their tillers unshipped they made very good weather, until they were driven near the tide-races off Cape Blanco, where some anxious hours were passed, half-buried in foam, and the wind again almost a hurricane. Towards evening, the storm abated; our water-soaked explorers succeeded in regaining a position under shelter of the land; and anchored next morn- ing under Cape Blanco, to dry themselves and take observa- tions. In this severe gale, the North American schooner split two close-reefed foresails, lost a boat, and was otherwise damaged. Lieutenant Wickham and Mr. Mellersh walked a long way 304 SALINAS—LIGHTNING. Jan. 1833. from Cape Blanco, to trace the coast, and look out for shoals in the offing; in doing which, they found numerous ‘ sali- nas’ (extensive hollow places filled with salt), where the solid mass of very white and good salt was several feet in thickness. Guanacoes were numerous, but shy. On the rocks some fur- seal were seen; too few, however, to be worth a sealer’s notice. The following week was passed in examining St. George Bay. Scarcely any stream of tide was found in its western part, though the rise amounted to nearly twenty feet. About Tilly road, where they landed, the mass or principal part of the soil, where visible in cliffs or ravines, is loose sandy clay (diluvium), with immense quantities of large fossil oyster shells imbedded in it. These shells were found every where, even on summits seven or eight hundred feet above the sea, and some of them weighed eight pounds. A place honoured by the Spaniards with the name of Malas- pina, and described as a port, was found to be a wretched cove, full of rocks, hardly safe even for the Liebre. While moored there, our party witnessed lightning set fire to bushes and grass. ‘The flames spread rapidly, and for two days, the face of the country continued to blaze. Near Port Arredondo, Mr. Wickham went to the tops of several hills ; he found the coun- try unproductive, except of a few bushes, and yellow wiry grass. There were no traces of natives. Very heavy rain fell during the night of the 28th. I mention it thus particularly, because some persons have said that rain never falls on the east coast of Patagonia, in any quantity. The cove called ‘ Oven’ is a singular place, being a parting (as it were) in the solid rock, nearly a mile in length, but very narrow, with four fathoms water in it at low tide. Surrounded on all sides by precipitous hills, it is, indeed, an oven; and would injure a ship seriously, even more than other ports on this arid coast, if she were to lie long in it; as her seams would all be opened, and her planks split by the heat and drought. The water found here was so strongly impregnated with salt-petre, that it was not drinkable ; but probably better Feb. 1833. iNDIAN TOMBS—PORT SANTA ELENA. 305 might have been procured had they dug fresh wells. On the summit of South Cape an Indian tomb was found. 'The stones had been displaced, and some bones were lying about, a few of which were taken on board, but none could be got in a perfect state. Mr. Bynoe afterwards examined them, and informed me that they had belonged to a female of small stature.* Off Ship Island, and thence to Cape Dos Bahias, the tide- stream was again felt strongly, running two, three, or, in some places, four knots an hour. At a little creek, in Camarones Bay, near Cape Dos Bahias, abundance of small wood, fit for fuel, was found; and plenty of fresh water in hollows of the rocks. A guanaco was shot, which weighed upwards of two hundred pounds. Not only is small wood plentiful about Cama- rones Bay, but the country is sufficiently covered with grass of good quality. Several Indian tombs were seen on the hills, whence it may be inferred that natives at times frequent the neighbourhood, although no recent traces were met with by our party. Unfortunately, not one of these tombs, simply irre- gular piles of stones, was found in an undisturbed state, nei- ther were any more bones discovered: they are all similarly situated upon the most conspicuous, smooth, and round-topped hills. At Port Santa Elena many tons of excellent water were pro- cured from hollows in the rocks. (‘7th Feb.) Approaches to trees were found at this place, which though stunted as to height, much like thorn-trees in exposed situations, were of respectable dimensions. One measured more than three feet round the trunk, but its fellow was not seen. After dusk, on the 10th, while endeavouring to enter New Bay, with a fresh wind and strong flood-tide, the Liebre got into a ‘race,’ and was hustled within a fathom of a rock, over which the tide was boiling furiously. Fortunately, the Paz saw the Liebre alter course and make more sail, and by imme- * I gave them to Sir Francis Chantrey, by whom they were shown to several persons. VOL. II. x 306 NEW BAY—RIVER CHUPAT. Feb. diately following her example, avoided the danger. They then hauled off, and passed the night at sea. Next day (11th), they stood towards the bay again, the wind increasing fast, till it blew a gale from W.S.W., which being against a flood-tide stream, running at the rate of four knots through the entrance, raised a short hollow sea, dan- gerous for small craft. Battening down the hatches securely, and close-reefing, the little vessels worked through gallantly, though frequently obliged to lower their sails in squalls, or as they dived into a sea heavier than usual. The tide soon swept them beyond the narrow part, and then they were compara- tively in safety. Part of the west shores of New Bay seemed to be fit for cul- tivation, being covered with a fine dark soil; and there is abundance of fire-wood. Some small ponds of excellent water were found, over a clayey bed, in which were tracks of cattle. A guanaco shot here was superior to any killed elsewhere, as to condition. Many thousand seals were seen on the rocks, which did not take to the water as soon as disturbed—therefore they could not have been much molested by man. On the 24th, Lieutenant Wickham discovered the river Chupat, and after waiting for the tide, anchored half a mile within the entrance. Next day he went a few miles up it in a boat, and found that, though free from drift-timber, it was shoal and narrow, few places being deeper than six feet’ at low- water, or wider than a hundred yards. The stream ran down two or three knots an hour. Many tracks of cattle were seen, but none of natives. As the river seemed to be free from sunken trees, and to have but few banks in it, Mr. Wickham decided to move the Liebre as far up as he could, and then make another excursion in his little two-oared skiff. Between pulling* and sailing, the Liebre was moved twelve miles up in one day, and was moored in the middle of the stream, lest Indians should be near. Next morning, Mr. Wickham went in his boat, about eight * Both the vessels had oars, 1823. RICH SOIL—CATTLE. 307 miles further ; but in a direct line he was then not more than twelve miles from the entrance. Along the banks on each side, as he had advanced, both he and those with him, were much struck by the richness of the alluvial land (caused doubt- less by the river overflowing its low banks), and by the quan- tities of drift-timber, which actually looked like the stores in immense timber-yards. Among the drift-wood there were many large and sound trees left several hundred yards from the banks, therefore the periodical floods must be great. At Mr. Wickham’s westernmost point ‘the river.and. the country round had a beautiful appearance, as seen from a rising ground on the south side—an excellent position for a settlement.” From this elevation the stream was traced to the westward, running with a very serpentine. course, through level meadow land, covered with rich.herbage. Several herds t of wild cattle were seen, and their traces were observed every where in such numbers as to indicate a great abundance of animals. Mr. Wickham returned on the 26th to the entrance, and found that a store of fish had been salted by the cook, while Mr. Stokes and others were going about, surveying the neigh- bourhood. These fish were a kind of bass, nearly as good as salmon. I have no doubt that this is a river whose existence has been many years known by Spaniards, but of which the situa- tion was intentionally concealed, on account of the lucrative trade some individuals hoped to carry on by means of hides and tallow obtained from the herds of wild cattle. The Spa- niards used to anchor their vessels in Port San José, and thence ride in large parties to the Chupat; there they sur- rounded numbers of cattle, and drove them across the peninsula between San José and New Bay, where they slaughtered them at leisure. Numbers were probably killed nearer the river ; but all that could be driven, had doubtless the privilege of conveying their own hides to the neighbourhood of their hun- ters’ ships. There was still living at the River Negro (in 1833) an old man, who was one of the few individuals that escaped x 2 308 SPANISH SETTLEMENT. March during a dreadful massacre of Spanish settlers at Port San José. He said that the Indians were jealous of their encroach- ments, and seized an opportunity, while the Spaniards were attending the performance of mass, to fall upon them, and indiscriminately slay all, except three or four who were taken alive and kept as slaves. That the Spaniards should have chosen San José for the place of their settlement instead of New Bay, or the Chupat itself, is easily accounted for, by mentioning that small vessels can generally run from the River Negro to Port San José without much risk and in a short time, whereas there are strong tides and dangerous ‘races’ off the peninsula of San José, and the entrance of the Chupat will not admit a vessel drawing more than seven feet: even this only at high-water. I think that the Chupat is the river alluded to by Falkner, as being in the “country of Chulilaw.”* He was told that it traversed the continent as far as the Andes, and judging from the drift-timber, as well as volcanic scorize brought down by it, there is ground for thinking that the Chupat* rises in the Cordillera. There is also reason to suppose that the river de- scribed and placed variously by different geographers, under the name of Camarones, is this Chupat, chiefly because the Indians who frequent the country bordering upon the south bank of the Negro, say that there is no river of consequence between that and the Santa Cruz, excepting the Chupat. With this river so near at hand, the west side of New Bay would be an excellent situation for a settlement. ‘There ships of any burthen might anchor in safety, and a communication be carried on with the interior by means of flat-bottomed boats, or barges, so constructed as to admit of being towed, or tracked, in the river, and capable of running up to New Bay before a fair wind. In the River Negro similar boats go a long way up the river for salt ; they are towed by horses or oxen ; and such vessels, even of thirty tons burthen, might enter the Chupat, if constructed so as to draw but little water. I need not dwell upon the possible advantages to be derived from opening a * Falkner, p. 87. + Chupat is the Indian name. 1833. VALDES CREEK—TIDES. 309 communication across the continent with Childe, which might be a means of diffusing Christianity, civilization, and commer- cial intercourse. On the 3d, Lieut. Wickham and his party left the Chupat. Early on the 5th they entered Valdes Creek (by the Spaniards styled ‘ port’), with the flood tide running nearly six knots into the narrow entrance: and on its shores found heaps of horns and bones, besides the wreck of a vessel.* 'These were indications of one of the temporary settlements maintained on the peninsula of San José for the purpose of obtaining hides. The carcases of the animals were invariably left to decay; a few delicate portions only being selected for food. Until the 12th our little vessels were unable to quit this singular place, for the ebb tide set so strongly against the swell outside, raised by a S.E. gale, that they could not attempt to cross the bar. Sometimes the very narrow entrance of Valdes Creek is almost stopped up for a time by shingle and sand, after a S.E. gale has been blowing for a few days, therefore at such a time no vessel ought to run for it. During the war between Brazil and Buenos Ayres (1825-9), Mr. Adams, of Carmen, was master of a merchant vessel hired by Vernet to convey settlers to the Falkland Islands. In returning thence, short of water and provisions, he thought to put into Valdes Creek, knowing that some people were there employed in collecting hides. Heran in for the land, with a fresh §.E. wind, and did not discover, until almost too late, that the bar was not passable. When close in he perceived a heavy sea breaking at the entrance, where he expected smooth water, and directly hauled off; but it was only by carrying a heavy press of sail that he cleared the land ; and at the expense of passing through ‘races,’ which tore off the vessel’s bulwarks and otherwise damaged her materially. As our cock-boats crossed this bar, they had ten feet water, but on each side of it there were five fathoms. The Liebe, sharp built, plunged into each short swell; while the Paz, with her bluff bow, did not * Of about two hundred tons burthen. 310 BAR—CRITICAL POSITION. March take in a single sea. The bar is a continuation of the long shingle spit, or bank, which forms the seaward side of the harbour ; and is about nine miles long, though in some places not a hundred yards broad. Towards noon the wind fell light, and the vessels were swept by a strong tide-stream towards a ‘ race,’ whose noise might have appalled the crews of much larger and stouter barks. No bottom could be struck with the deep-sea lead, and no efforts of the crews at the oars had much effect in arresting their progress towards apparently inevitable destruction. Even at this awful time, habitual familiarity with danger, and zeal for the service, shewed their effects strongly in Mr. Stokes, who eagerly watched for the sun’s meridian altitude, with his sextant to his eye, while every now and then he caught a hasty glimpse of the foaming and roaring race towards which the little craft were fast approaching. At this crisis a breeze sprung up which just enabled them to pass clear; but no one who was in those vessels can ever forget that day, neither do I think they attribute their preservation to blind chance. Sailors see too many of these ‘ chances’ to think of or reflect upon them lightly, and those who have had experience are not wont to forget, that to direct and to preserve are among the least efforts of Omnipotence—so far, at least, as our limited intelligence enables us to discern. At five that afternoon the Paz and Liebre were about eigh- teen miles off shore, out of soundings with their lead-lines, and yet were only a mile and half from the eastern part of the race; therefore they still stood to seaward, to get as far as pos- sible from a neighbourhood so dangerous at any time, but especially so at night. For two hours they passed through a rippling, but could strike no soundings with sixty fathoms of line. In 1830 Mr. Harris (owner of the Paz) sailed from the River Negro in a vessel of about ninety tons, with some horses on board, which he had engaged to convey to a party of gauchoes who were employed on the peninsula of San José, in killing cattle for their hides. Within the Bay of San Matias, about six 1833. © RACES'—SAN JOSE. 311 leagues N.W. of the port (San José), he got into one of these races, * and could not extricate his vessel. No soundings could be obtained: the sails were useless in consequence of the vio- lent motion and want of wind, where the water was breaking so furiously, though elsewhere a fresh breeze was blowing ; and nothing could be done. The crew took to the rigging, to avoid being washed overboard ; and for almost three hours they were tossed about, like an empty bottle in a ripple, before the race abated, with the turn of tide, so as to admit of their sails acting enough to draw them a-head out of the commo- tion. The vessel, though a strong one, was so much shaken and damaged, the horses so much injured, and all hands so much ‘ scared,’ as Harris honestly told me, that he steered back direct for the Negro, forfeited his agreement, and refused to go again. On the 14th March the Paz and Liebre again crossed the bar of the River Negro, and next day they anchored a-breast of the town (Carmen). Lieut. Wickham found that an expedition had been sent from Buenos Ayres for the pur- pose of obliging the Indians to retire beyond (southward of) the Negro; and, if possible, deprive them of their horses. Bad weather and a heavy sea on the bar, caused by south-east gales, prevented the Paz and Liebre from sailing again until the 11th of April, when they went to Port San Antonio, and afterwards into Port San José. Plenty of firewood, and abun- dance of fish, were found at San Antonio; but no fresh water, except by digging wells. The tide-stream rushes into and out of Port San José in a violent manner, especially when opposed by wind ; but after the narrow part of the entrance is passed, all agitation of the water ceases, except what may be caused by wind. It is a barren and desolate place, without wood or fresh water, and too large for a harbour. Our party saw proof of this assertion in the wreck of a small vessel at the north-east part of the port, which had been driven from her anchors and * The tide-races within the bay are less formidable than those off Point Norte, near which our vessels were. 312 REMARKABLE RIPPLES AND RACES. May totally lost, though she was lying in a land-locked bay, or rather gulf. On the 6th of May, while returning from San José to the River Negro, our little vessels got into a ripple, which did not break, but had almost the appearance of a whirlpool. There was a hollow short swell, and an irregular motion in every direction, exactly like the boiling of a pot, on a great scale. Here again they could touch no bottom with fifty fathoms of line and a heavy lead. These races and ripplings in such deep water, about the peninsula of San José, are very remarkable; chiefly because there are none such on any other part of the coast. They will be recurred to in a future page of this volume. May Vth. The Paz and Liebre returned to the Negro, but could not reach an anchorage off Carmen until late the next day, owing to the ‘freshes.’* The next occupation for our party was examining and sounding the entrance and bar of the Negro, a task purposely deferred, as being of minor conse- quence. The mouth of a rapid river like this, subject to floods, and disemboguing at a place exposed to the full force of such a heavy sea as is raised on that coast by a south-east gale, must be frequently changed, as to the detail of its shoals and channels; therefore no plan, however exact at one time, can be depended upon after the lapse of a few years; and no vessel larger than a boat would be justified in attempting to enter without a local pilot, if one can be obtained. In one spot, near Main Point, where a small battery stood in 1826, there were two fathoms water in 1833; and within the same period the deepest water for a few miles within the entrance, changed gra- dually from the south side to the north. Mr. Darwin was told that the river was called Negro after a cacique of that name; but Falkner asserts that it was so called by the Spaniards, be- cause the aborigines knew it by the name of ‘ Cusu Leuvu,? which means black river.+ * There are two floods annually: one about December or January, caused by snow melted on the Cordillera; and the other about May or June, occasioned by heavy rains in the interior country. These inun- dations are very variable. + Falkner, p- 79. 1833. HUNTING—PUMAS—INDIANS. 313 In May, June, July, and August, the neighbourhood of this Tiver swarms with wild fowl, which migrate from the south, for the winter, and return there to breed about September. The old people foretell a severe winter when they arrive early, and in greater numbers than usual. In 1833-4 they formed the staple article of food for the inhabitants of Carmen during the winter, as the Indians had deprived them of their cattle; in the summer cavies and ostriches supplied their tables. Hunt- ing is a favourite amusement of the Carmenites. They sally forth in large parties on horseback, attended by a motley crowd of dogs, inclose a large extent of country, contract the circle gradually,* and at last drive a great number of ostriches, wolves, cavies, deer, foxes, and pumas, into a com- paratively small space, when the indiscriminate attack com- mences—balls and lassoes flying in every direction. Many accidents happen to the horses in these hunts, owing to the ground being so undermined, in some places, by the ‘ tucu- tucu,’+ alittle animal like a small rabbit ; but the riders are so skilful, that they generally save themselves, however awk- wardly their horses may fall. Pumas are an especial object of attack, not only for the risk attached to encountering them, but because they do so much damage to the young animals of all kinds: they have a peculiar method of instantly killing a young colt by breaking its neck with an adroit blow of one paw, while the poor creature is held fast between the other and a most formidably armed mouth. In 1779 there were nume- rous herds of cattle and horses near the town of Carmen, but incursions of the Indians have diminished them to but few. During the time of the old Spaniards, after 17783, more than a thousand Indians attacked the settlement at one time. The in- habitants retreated to their caves,t where, defended by strong doors, with loop-holes for musketry, they were safe; but their * As in eastern countries. + This Indian name, gutturally pronounced, expresses the curious sound made by these creatures while under ground—a noise somewhat like the blow of a distant hammer. } Mentioned in p. 299, 314 VILLARINO—CONSTITUCION. May houses were ransacked and burned, and all their animals driven away. Since that time the frequent predatory excursions of minor parties of Indians have prevented the settlers from again attempting to collect animals in large numbers, seeing that they would assuredly tempt the aborigines to repeat their attacks on a greater scale than'ever. The old man, who was one of Vil- larino’s party,* gave Mr. Darwin some information about that expedition, which entirely corroborates the interesting account of Basilio Villarino himself, who made his way, by excellent management, and extreme perseverance, to the foot of the Cordillera, though surrounded by Indians suspicious of his intentions. He managed so dexterously as to make one tribe become his firm friends and assistants; and behaved so well himself, in his own enterprises, as well as in his conduct to those under him, as to have obtained their hearty co-operation during eight long months. But he was soon afterwards savagely murdered by the natives during another exploring expedition.+- The old man said that Villarino was much guided by the account of an Englishman,+ whose description of the river and Indian country was found to be very accurate. Mr. Darwin heard several anecdotes of the Indians, and their attacks upon the Christians (so they term all white men) which interested me very much; but as I suppose they will be found in his volume, it is unnecessary here to do more than allude to them. On the 12th May Mr. Usborne, in the Constitucion, anchored in the river, and next day put himself under Mr. Stokes’s orders; to whom Lieut. Wickham gave up the charge of this branch of the survey, and then went on board the Constitucion to hasten towards Maldonado. On the 17th all three little vessels sailed, Lieut. Wickham steering for the Plata, and Mr. Stokes for San Blas. From this time till the Paz and Liebre were discharged, in * Bowman of his boat (lancha). + Sir Woodbine Parish has given an abridged translation of Villarino’s Diary in the Journal of the R. GecErs Society for 1836, vol. vi, part ii, pp- 136—167. } Falkner evidently. 1833. MR. STOKES 'S PARTY. B15 August,* Mr. Stokes and his party were most zealously occu- pied between the Negro and Blanco Bay; but time was too fully occupied in the uninteresting, though useful works, of sounding, measuring, observing, and chart-making, to admit of many notices of the country being obtained in addition to those already mentioned ; indeed the nature of the coast, almost flat, uninhabited, without trees, and fronted by extensive sand- banks, precluded the possibility of acquiring much information not of a technical nature. * Already mentioned, p. 288. CHAPTER XV. Beagle and Adventure sail from Monte Video— Port Desire—Bellaco Rock—Refraction—Port San Julian—Viedma —Drake—Magalhaens —Patagonians—Port Famine—San Sebastian Bay—W oollya—Jemmy — Story—Treachery—Oens-men —Improvement — Gratitude —Falk- lands— Events—Captain Seymonr—Search for Murderers—Lieutenant Smith—Brisbane —Wreck—Sufferings —Lieutenant Clive—Sail from Falklands. Dec. 6th, 1833. With a supply of provisions and coals,* sufficient for at least nine months, the Beagle and her tender sailed together from Monte Video. We first touched at Port Desire (23d Dec.), and after passing a very cheerful Christmas-day,+ and exploring the inlet to its extremity, the Adventure was left to complete some alterations in her masts and rigging, while the Beagle would survey the coast between Sea Bear Bay and Port San Julian. The party who went up the inlet were much struck by the wildness and heightt of the rocky cliffs which they saw on each side of what appeared to have been the bed of a former river ; but could go no further with the yawl than I had been in 1829. This I had foreseen, and therefore Mr. Chaffers, who was in charge of the party, took with him a small dinghy, in which he went on after the yawl was stopped by the mud. Having proceeded two miles further, the prospect changed suddenly ; instead of wild glens and precipitous heights of porphyritic rock, low flat banks were seen, covered with rushes near the water, and, further from the stream, with luxuriant pasture. It was almost high water when the dinghy reached this spot and entered a fresh water river about a hundred * Wood and water being easily procured in the regions we were going to visit, we carried only a month’s store of those essentials. ; + After noon on the 25th, both crews amused themselves on shore in wrestling, racing, jumping, and various games. ¢ About three hundred feet. Dec. 1833. RIVER--ROCK AT PORT DESIRE. 317 yards wide, but so shallow that there was only three feet water in the middle. The river narrowed considerably as they ascended, till at the spot where Mr. Chaffers stopped to take sights of the sun, the stream was but forty yards across. In that place the deepest water was three feet at the top of high tide, over a gravelly bottom ; but from the level space between the stream and the foot of the nearest hills, about three quarters of a mile, there was reason for supposing that during floods all the valley might be inundated. From a neighbouring hill, four hundred feet in height, the river could be traced several miles further, making a distance of about eight miles seen by our party, in which the water was quite fresh. It was lost to the westward, winding along an irregular break, or cliff-bounded valley, in the distant hills. The only living creature seen, of any size, was a lame horse, feeding near the river. There were no traces whatever of Indians. Having hastened back with the little boat before the river dried* (at half-ebb), Mr. Chaffers ascended another hill; but saw little more excepting _an appearance of water to the southward, about which he could not clearly distinguish whether it was a lake, part of a river, or a salt-pond. I have no doubt, that during particular sea- sons a large body of fresh water is brought down this valley, but I do not think the river rises near the Andes, because there is no drift-wood on its banks, and the Indians say nothing of it when enumerating the rivers which cross the continent. Jan. 4th, 1834. In working out of Port Desire, the Beagle struck her fore-foot heavily against a rock, so as to shake her fore and aft; but on she went with the tide, and as she made no water, I did not think it worth while returning into port. I was instantly convinced that we had hit the very rock on which the Beagle struck in 1829, in the night—a danger we never again could find by daylight till this day, when I was, rather imprudently, going out with the last quarter-ebb. _ * The tide fell more than fourteen feet perpendicularly; but a small brook remained, perhaps a foot deep, winding its course between the uncovered banks. 318 BELLACO ROCKS—REFRACTION. Jan. At low-water there are but eight feet on this rock, which is not far from mid-channel, just without the entrance. We anchored near Watchman Cape, and in other places along the coast, before reaching Port San Julian, and some time was devoted to an examination of the Bellaco Rock and its vicinity, as there isa dangerous reef extending from Watch- man Cape towards, but not quite out to the Bellaco. In my own notes I find this rock mentioned as “ almost covered at times, but occasionally showing above water as high as the hull of a ship!” In Mr. Stokes’s journal, left with me, it is mentioned in these words: “ Passed between the Bellaco Rocks, close to the eastern one, nearly a-wash ;” and in the diary of the Nodales’ voyage (in 1619), it is spoken of as ‘‘ una baxa que lababa la mar en ella,” which means, a rock a-wash. The rise of tide there is about twenty feet, which explains the various appearances it had to my eye; for at high water I saw it almost covered, or a-wash ; and as the Nodales described it similarly in 1619, there can have been extremely little, if any, change in the relative heights of sea and land in this place during the last two hundred and fifteen years.* Some time ago I thought differently, having formed a hasty opinion upon the fact of my having seen the rock as high out of water as a ship’s hull. I did not then consider how much the tide falls, nor did I recollect, till I referred to notes, that I had also seen it a-wash (the top almost level with the water), at times during the many days we were in the neighbourhood. On the day that Mr. Stokes and myself made our respective notes on the Bellaco (without any communication of opinion), an extraordinary effect of refraction was remarked. The meri- dian altitude of the sun (then far south) observed at opposite horizons, differed no less than sixteen miles! Similar effects. had been noticed before, especially on the Patagonian coast, therefore we generally observed both ways; but to nearly * As the larger and eastern rock is about a hundred yards long and eighty wide, with kelp growing on most parts of it, I do not think the top can wear away while so protected by sea-weed. 1834. VIEWS—PORT SAN JULIAN. 319 such an extent as this we never either before or afterwards wit- nessed an error arising wholly from the state of the atmosphere near the horizon; causing the visible water-line to be apparently raised several minutes of a degree. On these occasions we always used the mean of the two results, which agreed closely with the latitude resulting from triangular connection with points on the shore, whose latitude we knew by observations made with the artificial horizon.* "th. Mr. Stokes and I landed some leagues northward of Port San Julian, near Cape Look-out, and ascended a level- topped range of hills about 300 feet above the sea. The view we obtained was similar to those so tiresomely common in eastern Patagonia. Level, arid, desert-like plains extended to the horizon: a few irregular hills were seen in the distance; some guanacoes and a few ostriches were here and there dis- cerned ; a fox crossed our path, and a condor wheeled over- head ; nothing more was noticed. We returned to the low ground near the sea, and there we found plenty of small wood, stunted shrubby trees, fit for fuel; as well as several ponds of fresh-water. The rise of tide on the shore was considerably more than twenty feet, but we had not time to ascertain it accurately. 9th. Mount Wood,t that excellent land-mark for Port San Julian, was seen at daylight: and about noon the Beagle anchored off the bar of the harbour. Mr. Stokes went with me to examine the passage, and before evening our ship was safely moored in the port. This was one, among numerous instances I could mention, where the good qualities of the Beagle, as to sailing and working, saved us days of delay, trouble, and anxiety. All hands immediately set-to about the plan of the port, and such efficient officers as were with me made short work of it. One day Mr. Darwin and I under. took an excursion in search of fresh-water, to the head of the inlet, and towards a place marked in an old Spanish plan, * Bellaco rocks are the same as Estevan shoal. There are at least two distinct masses of rock. A ship may pass between them. + Nine hundred and fifty feet high. 320 SEARCH FOR FRESH WATER. Jan. “ pozos de agua dulce ;” but after a very fatiguing walk not a drop of water could be found. I lay down on the top of a hill, too tired and thirsty to move farther, seeing two lakes of water, as we thought, about two miles off, but unable to reach them. Mr. Darwin, more accustomed than the men, or myself, to long excursions on shore, thought he could get to the lakes, and went to try. We watched him anxiously from the top of the hill,* saw him stoop down at the lake, but im- mediately leave it and go on to another, that also he quitted without delay, and we knew by his slow returning pace that the apparent lakes were ‘salinas.’ We then had no alterna- tive but to return, if we could, so descending to meet him at one side of the height, we all turned eastward and trudged. along heavily enough. The day had been so hot that our little stock of water was soon exhausted, and we were all more or less laden with instruments, ammunition, or weapons. About dusk I could move no farther, having foolishly carried a heavy double-barrelled gun all day besides instruments, so, choosing a place which could be found again, I sent the party on and lay down to sleep; one man, the most tired next to myself, staying with me. A glass of water would have made me quite fresh, but it was not to be had. After some hours, two of my boat's crew returned with water, and we were very soon revived. ‘Towards morning we all got on board, and no one suffered afterwards from the over-fatigue, except Mr. Darwin, who had had no rest during the whole of that thirsty day—now a matter of amusement, but at the time a very serious affair. Sir Woodbine Parish intends to publish a description of the Spanish settlements on these shores, in which no doubt Viedma’s, at Port San Julian, will have place. A full account of it, in the original language, may be found in the diary of Antonio de Viedma, published at Buenos Ayres, in 1837, by Don Pedro de Angelis. Finding no water near the harbour except after rain, which is there rare, Viedma pitched * Named in the plan ‘ Thirsty Hill.’ 1834. VIEDMA—MAGALHAENS—DRAKE. 321 his tents some leagues inland, near a spring frequented by the Indians, but their doubtful friendship, the progress of scurvy among his own people, their discontent at such a situation, and other reasons, inclined the Spanish viceroy to withdraw the settlement. This dreary port, difficult of access and in- hospitable even when the stranger is within its entrance, is well known to readers of early voyages as the place where Magalhaens so summarily quelled a serious mutiny, and con- spiracy against his own life, by causing the two principal offenders, captains of ships in the squadron, to be put to death :* and as the scene of the unfortunate Doughtie’s mock trial and unjust execution.- That two such remarkable expe- ditions as those of Magalhaens and Drake should have win- tered at Port San Julian, and that two such tragedies should have occurred there is remarkable. In the plan of that port we now see Execution Island, Isle of True Justice, (in- justice?) and Tomb Point: the two former being names given by Drake.{ One naturally asks how their ships ob- tained water, and the answers occurring to me are,—that they were there in the winter season, when the rain which falls is not soon dried up ; and that they may have dug wells, which we did not think it worth while to do, having no time to spare. 15th. A French whaler came in over the bar, at high water, without having sounded it, or knowing what depth she would find. The only instance of similar folly I have witnessed was that of a sealing schooner which I met near Port Famine, whose master had taken her through Possession Bay and both Narrows, without knowing that the tide rose and fell there more than six or seven feet, and without a chart of the Strait. ‘When I told this man that the tide rose six or seven fathoms at the First Narrow, he certainly did not believe me. The bar of San Julian is shingle (or gravel), and often altered in form by south-east gales or unusual tides. Under ordinary circumstances the tide rises thirty feet at full moon. * 1520. + Drake’s Voyage, 1578. ¢ And the latter a memento of Lieut. Sholl, of the Beagle, (vol. I.) VOL. II. ¥ 322 PATAGONIANS—PORT FAMINE. Jan., Feb. 19th. Sailed, and, for once during our experience of these shores, found a heavy swell setting in from the east.* On the 20th we anchored again in Port Desire, and our first employment was to look for the rock whose top (Mr. May as- sured me with a grave face) we had knocked off with our keel. 22d. Both vessels sailed, and at sunset the Adventure parted company, steering for New Island in the Falklands. Lieute- nant Wickham was to make a connected survey of the coast of that archipelago, while the Beagle was in other places.t After giving some time to sounding and examining portions of ground in the neighbourhood of Cape Virgins and the eastern entrance of Magalhaens Strait, we passed the First Narrow and anchored in Gregory Bay. ‘There, of course, we had an interview with old Maria and her party. They received us kindly, but with some form, being assembled and seated on the ground near our landing place, with two men standing up in the midst of them, who looked immoveably grave and stupidly dignified. These men were acting as caciques, Maria said, the real chiefs being absent. They were stripped to the waist, and the upper parts of their bodies spotted with white paint.{ The rest of the people were dressed as usual. An active barter commenced, but the portly actors in the middle did not take part in it, they remained in their solem- nity till we left them. On the 2d of February we anchored in Port Famine, and on the 10th, having obtained chronometric observations for which I went there, we sailed for the neighbourhood of the First Narrow and Lomas Bay (near Point Catherine). We often anchored thereabouts in the prosecution of our work. On the 17th, as we ran along the curious spit or bank of shingle that fronts San Sebastian Bay, I really could not tell, though I had been in that bay before, whether I had not been * I think that this easterly swell must have been caused by a south- east gale, though it came to us from the east. + Appendix, No. 18, + Much as a piece of new knotty wood is spotted with white lead before it receives a coat of paint. A. > tL Wook A IR N fe ISLAND, BUTTON March. SAN SEBASTIAN BAY—-WOOLLYA. 323 deceived as to no channel existing,* so well defined and dis- tinct did a wide opening appear. A few more minutes, how- ever, undeceived me: I discerned low flat land stretching along the western horizon : and soon afterwards we anchored in the bay. The following week was occupied in surveying the north-eastern shore of ‘Tierra del Fuego, which, except San Sebastian Bay, does not contain a port. San Vicente Cove is not worth notice as a harbour. On the 25th, we anchored at the Hermite Islands, on the north-east side of Wollaston Island. Thence, on the 27th, we crossed Nassau Bay to Goree Road, and the following day entered the Beagle Channel. The Ist of March passed in replenishing our wood and water at a cove, where we had an opportunity of making acquaintance with some Yapoo Tekeenica natives, who seemed not to have met white men before. _ Till the 5th the Beagle was actively occupied, by day, in working to windward (westward) through the channel, and then she anchored at Woollya. But few natives were seen as we sailed along: probably they were alarmed at the ship, and ‘did not show themselves. The wigwams in which I had left York, Jemmy, and Fuegia, were found empty, though unin- _ jured: the garden had been trampled over, but some turnips _ and potatoes of moderate size were pulled up by us, and eaten _ at my table, a proof that they may be grown in that region. Not a living soul was visible any where; the wigwams seemed “to have been deserted many months; and an anxious hour or i two passed, after the ship was capone before three canoes were seen in the offing, paddling hastily towards us, from the place _ now called Button Island. Looking through a glass I saw “that two of the natives in them were washing their faces while ~ the rest were paddling with might and main: I was then sure that some of our acquaintances were there, and in a few minutes recognized ‘Tommy Button, Jemmy’s brother. In the other canoe was a face which I knew yet could not name. “ It must be some one I have seen before,” said I,—when his sharp eye * Vol. I. p. 457-8. ¥.2 324 ©JEMMY’ AND HIS FAMILY. March detected me, and a sudden movement of the hand to his head (as a sailor touches his hat) at once told me it was indeed Jemmy Button—but how altered ! I could hardly restrain my feelings, and I was not, by any means, the only one so touched by his squalid miserable appearance. He was naked, like his companions, except a bit of skin about his loins ; his hair was long and matted, just like theirs ; he was wretchedly thin, and his eyes were affected by smoke. We hurried him below, clothed him immediately, and in half an hour he was sitting with me at dinner in my cabin, using his knife and fork pro- perly, and in every way behaving as correctly as if he had never left us. He spoke as much English as ever, and, to our astonishment, his companions, his wife, his brothers and their ‘wives, mixed broken English words in their talking with him. Jemmy recollected every one well, and was very glad to see them all, especially Mr. Bynoe and James Bennett. I thought he was ill, but he surprised me by saying that he was “‘ hearty, sir, never better,”* that he had not been ill, even for a day, was happy and contented, and had no wish whatever to change his way of life. He said that he got “ plenty fruits,” “ plenty birdies,” “ten guanaco in snow time,” and ‘too much fish.” Besides, though he said nothing about her, I soon heard that there was a pot looking} young woman in his canoe, who was said to be hie wife. Directly this became known, shawls, hand- kerchiefs, and a gold-laced cap appeared, with which she was speedily decorated ; but fears had been excited for her hus- band’s safe return to her, and no finery could stop her crying until Jemmy again showed himself on deck. While he was below, his brother Tommy called out in a loud tone—* J emmy Button, canoe, come!” After some time the three canoes went ashore, laden’ with presents, and their owners promised to come again early next morning. Jemmy gave a fine otter skin to me, which he had dressed and kept purposely ; another he gave to Bennett. * A favourite saying of his, formerly. + Excrescences on the birch trees, and berries.. t For a Fuegian. 1834. ‘yorK’s” TREACHERY—JEMMY’'S STORY. 325 - Next morning Jemmy shared my breakfast, and then we had a long conversation by ourselves; the result of which was, that I felt quite decided not to make a second attempt to place Matthews among the natives of Tierra del Fuego. Jemmy told me that he knew very little of his own language ; that he spoke some words of English, and some Tekeenica, when he talked to his family; and that they all understood the English words he used. York and Fuegia left him some months before our arrival, and went in a large canoe to their own country; the last act of that cunning fellow was to rob poor Jemmy of all his clothes; nearly all the tools his Tekee- nica ‘friends’ had left him; and various other necessaries. Fuegia was dressed as usual, and looking well, when they de- camped : her helpmate was also well clothed, and had hardly lost anything I left with him. Jemmy said “ York very much jaw,” “ pick up big stones,” “all men afraid.” Fuegia seemed to be very happy, and quite contented with her lot. Jemmy asserted that she helped to “ catch (steal) his clothes,” while he was asleep, the night before York left him naked. Not long after my departure in Febuary 1833, the much- dreaded Oens-men came in numbers, overland, to Woollya ; obliged Jemmy’s tribe to escape to the small islands, and car- ried off every valuable which his party had not time to remove. They had doubtless heard of the houses and property left there, and hastened to seize upon it—like other ‘ borderers.’ Until this time York had appeared to be settled, and quite at ease, but he had been employed about a suspiciously large canoe, just finished when the inroad was made. He saved this canoe, indeed escaped init, and afterwards induced Jemmy and his family to accompany him “to look at his land.” They went together in four canoes (York’s large one and three others) as far west as Devil Island, at the junction of the north-west and south-west arms of the Beagle Channel: there they met York’s brother and some others of the Alikhoolip tribe ; and, while Jemmy was asleep, all the Alikhoolip party stole off, taking nearly all Jemmy’s things, and leaving him in his original condition. York's fine canoe was evidently not 326 OENS-MEN—IMPROVEMENT. March built for transporting himself alone ; neither was the meeting with his brother accidental. I am now quite sure that from the time of his changing his mind, and desiring to be placed at Woollya, with Matthews and Jemmy, he meditated taking a good opportunity of possessing himself of every thing; and that he thought, if he were left in his own country without Matthews, he would not have many things given to him, nei- ther would he know where he might afterwards look for and plunder poor Jemmy. While Mr. Bynoe was walking about on shore, Jemmy and his brother pointed out to him the places where our tents were pitched in 1833, where the boundary line was, and where any particular occurrence happened. He told Mr. Bynoe that he had watched day after day for the sprouting of the peas, beans, and other vegetables, but that his countrymen walked over them without heeding any thing he said. The large wigwams which we had erected with some labour, proved to be cold in the winter, because they were too high; therefore they had been deserted after the first frosts. Since the last depredations of the Oens-men, he had not ventured to live any longer at Wooll¥a ; his own island, as he called it, affording safer refuge and suffi- cient food. Jemmy told us that these Oens-men crossed over the Beagle Channel, from eastern Tierra del F lego, in canoes which they seized from the Yapoo Tekeenica. To avoid being separated they fastened several canoes together, crossed over in a body, and when once landed, travelled over-land and came upon his people by surprise, from the heights behind Woollya. Jemmy asserted that he had himself killed one of his antagonists. It was generally remarked that his family were become consi- derably more humanized than any savages we had seen in Tierra del Fuego: that they put confidence in us; were pleased by our return; that they were ready to do what we could explain to be for their interest ; and, in short, that the first step towards civilization—that of obtaining their confidence— was undoubtedly made: but an individual, with limited means, could not then go farther. The whole scheme, with Tespect 1834. GRATITUDE—PORT LOUIS. 827 to establishing a missionary with the Fuegians who were in England, among their countrymen, was on too small a scale, although so earnestly assisted by Mr. Wilson,* Mr. Wigram, Mr. Coates, and other kind friends. I cannot help still hoping that some benefit, however slight, may result from the intercourse of these people, Jemmy, York, and Fuegia, with other natives of 'Tierra del Fuego. Perhaps a ship-wrecked seaman may hereafter receive help and kind treatment from Jemmy Button’s children ; prompted, as they can hardly fail to be, by the traditions they will have heard of men of other lands; and by an idea, however faint, of their duty to God as well as their neighbour. That Jemmy felt sincere gratitude is, I think, proved by his having so carefully preserved two fine otter skins, as I men- tioned; by his asking me to carry a bow and quiver full of arrows to the schoolmaster of Walthamstow, with whom he had lived; by his having made two spear-heads expressly for Mr. Darwin ; and by the pleasure he showed at seeing us all again. As nothing more could be done, we took leave of our young friend and his family, every one of whom was loaded with pre- sents, and sailed away from Woollya. On the 9th of March we were off Beauchesne Island. Many persons have fancied that there are two islands near together in that place, having been deceived by two hummocks on the only island, which from a distance show just above the horizon like two islets. Next day we anchored in Berkeley Sound ; first in Johnson Cove, and afterwards in Port Louis. We found a state of affairs somewhat different from that of March 1833; but though more settled, in consequence of the presence of an established authority, resident at Port Louis (a lieutenant in the navy), my worst forebodings had not equalled the sad reality. In a note to page 240, I alluded to the murder of the Buenos Ayrean commanding officer ; and to that of Mr. Brisbane. A few weeks before the Clio arrived in 1833, there was a small * Of Walthamstow. - + Near the Falklands. 328 EVENTS IN THE FALKLANDS. March garrison at Port Louis, consisting of a sergeant’s guard of sol- diers, a subaltern, and a field officer. The men mutinied be- eause their superior was thought to be unnecessarily severe, and occupied them unceasingly in drill and parade, to the pre- judice of their obtaining food sufficient for health. They were obliged, in consequence of his system, to live upon worse fare than the settlers, because they could not go about to forage for themselves ; and the result was that, after many threats, they murdered him. A small armed schooner* arrived a few days afterwards from Buenos Ayres, by whose officers and crew, assisted by some French sailors, the principal mutineers, nine in number, were taken and put into confinement on board. They were afterwards carried to Buenos Ayres. On the 26th of August 1833, three ‘ gauchos’ and five In- dians} (the prisoners before mentioned), set upon and murdered Mr. Brisbane ; Dickson, the man in charge of Vernet’s store oy Simon, the capataz; the poor German; and another settler ; after which atrocious acts they plundered the settlement and drove all the cattle and horses into the interior. Only that morn- ing Mr. Low, who was then living with Mr. Brisbane, left Port Louis on a sealing excursion, with four men. Hardly was his boat out of sight, when the deceitful villains attacked Brisbane in Vernet’s house: suspecting no treachery, he fell at once by the knife of Antonio Rivero. Simon defended himself desperately, but was overpowered ; the others, overcome by fear, fell easy victims. The rest of the settlers, consisting of thirteen men, three women, and two children, remained with the murderers two days, and then escaped to a small island in the Sound; where they lived on birds’ eggs and fish, till the arrival of the English sealer Hopeful,g on board which was an officcr of the navy, || who in some measure relieved their immediate distress, but could not delay to protect them from the assaults which * Sarandi. + Antonio Rivero, J. M. Luna, M. Godoy,—J. Brasido, M, Gonzales, L. Flores, F. Salazar, M. Lattore. tT P.i240: § Noy. 1833. || Mr. Rea. The Hopeful belonged to Messrs. Enderby. ti 1834. SEARCH FOR MURDERERS, 329 they anticipated. About a month after the Hopeful sailed, H.M.S. Challenger, Captain M. Seymour, arrived, having a lieutenant of the navy and four seamen on board, who had volunteered from H.M.S. Tyne, and were duly authorized to remain at the Falklands. The following extract from a letter will show what took place on Captain Seymour’s arrival. ** Captain Seymour, and the consuls, being anxious to visit the settlement of Port Louis, landed some distance from it (the wind being strong from §.S.W.), intending to walk there. About a mile from the houses they were met by an Englishman named Channon, sent by the gauchoes to see who they were, and whether the ship was a whaler in want of beef, or a man- of-war. He informed them that the gauchoes and Indians had. murdered Mr. Brisbane: Dickson, who had been left in charge of the flag by Captain Onslow: Simon; and two others: and had pillaged the houses, destroying every thing in their search for money. He then pointed them out, sitting under a wall, with their horses behind the remains of the government house, ready saddled for a start on our nearer approach. 'They had two gauchoes, prisoners, who had not been concerned in the murders, and whom they threatened to kill, if he, Channon, did not return. He also stated that one of them was willing to” turn king’s evidence, and would bring back all the horses, if possible, provided Captain Seymour would ensure his pardon. ‘The whole of them, nine in number, retreated into the interior as soon as they found out it was a ship of war, taking all the tame horses, between fifty and sixty.* As his party were not armed, Captain Seymour thought it right to return on board ; but after dark, Lieutenant Smith was sent with a party of marines, and two boats, to try and take them, if they should be still about the houses, and to leave with Channon a bottle containing a crucifix, as a signal for Luna. On their landing, Lieutenant Smith took all necessary precautions, left six men in charge of the boats, and proceeded cautiously with the * Thirteen men and three women had escaped to an island in the Sound, as they could do nothing against the murderers, who had all the arms. _ + The gaucho who offered to become king’s evidence. 330 NEW SETTLEMENT BEGUN. March rest. He carefully searched every building in the place, with- out seeing even a trace of them. All was desolation ; yet he learned afterwards from the two innocent gauchoes, that An- tonio Rivero and another, suspecting who the party were, had watched them closely : that at one time Lieut. Smith was near treading on them; which seemed hardly credible, until the arrangements made on landing, the marching in Indian file to hide his men, &c. were mentioned. Mr. Smith left with Chan- non Luna’s pardon, who, on the fourth day, brought in two horses—not having been able to obtain more, as the murderers were very watchful and fearful of each other, so much so, that one of them had fallen a sacrifice to suspicion; and Luna’s desertion reduced their number to six. With Luna for their guide, on the sixth day Lieut. Smith, four midshipmen and twelve marines, were despatched into the interior. They were absent four days, and marched more than a hundred miles, enduring much fatigue, which was increased by the boisterous state of the weather, and by continual rain for three out of the four days. Water in ravines, which on going out hardly rose above their ankles, on their return had increased to torrents: in crossing them some nearly lost their lives, and on the bleak moors they sunk at every step knee-deep in bog. Without sleep or shelter, they lived for the last two days on beef just warmed through, by fires that it took hours to kindle. They were not successful in capturing any of the murderers, but at one time were so near, that they had the mortification to see them drive their horses away at a gallop, and having all the tame ones but two, they were quickly out of reach of musket-shot. So hasty however was their retreat, that they left their provisions behind them. Captain Seymour finding that capturing the Indians would be a tedious and uncertain task, made one of the ruined houses habitable, and leaving six marines as an additional protection to Lieut. Smith and his boat’s crew, proceeded as ordered. The lieutenant endea- voured to make his abode comfortable, by clearing away rub- bish and bones, and putting a garden into some order. With the two horses he succeeded in catching and taming two cows, 1834. RIVERO TAKEN—LOW. 331 which gave about two gallons of milk daily, besides fourteen others, five or six of which were in calf. By one means or other all but one of the murderers were taken, and a cutter was hired to remove them to the flag-ship at Rio de Janeiro.” Before the Beagle’s arrival Lieut. Smith had succeeded in capturing the principal murderer, and transporting him to an islet in the Sound, where he was watched, and furnished with provisions by the boat’s crew. The lieutenant applied to me for assistance, and knowing that he was not safe while such a desperate character as Rivero was at large, though on an islet, and that the life of Luna (the king’s evidence) was still more risked, I took those men, and one named Channon, who was said to have been an accomplice in the plot, though not an active agent, on board the Beagle. Rivero was put in irons, Channon confined to the ship, and Luna left at liberty, though watched. When Mr. Low returned from his sealing expedition he found that his life was sought, asa friend of Mr. Brisbane ; and as he could do nothing on foot against the mounted gau- choes, he retired to Kidney Islet, at the entrance of Berkeley Sound, to await the arrival of some ship. Tired, however, of inaction, he set out to go westward, in search of some whaler, and on the 6th of February, when in great distress, he fell in with our tender, the Adventure, and immediately offered his services as a pilot: they were accepted, provisionally, by Lieut. Wickham, and afterwards by me, trusting that the Admiralty would approve of my so engaging a person who, in pilotage and general information about the Falklands, Tierra del Fuego, Patagonia, and the Galapagos Islands, could afford us more information than any other individual, without exception. Mr. William Low is the son of a respectable land-agent in Scotland; he was brought up as a sailor, and possesses strong common sense, quick apprehension, a readiness at description, and an extraordinary local memory. On the 13th the Adventure arrived: shehad almost completed her examination of the west, south, and south-east outer coasts, in a very satisfactory manner, having been greatly forwarded 332 BRISBANE—WRECK. March 1834. and helped by Mr. Low’s minute acquaintance with every port, and almost every danger. Our tender sailed to continue " her coasting examination on the 21st. She returned on the 26th, and sailed again on the 30th. Meanwhile our own boats were constantly occupied in and near Berkeley Sound and Port William. When I visited the settlement it looked more melancholy than ever ; and at two hundred yards’ distance from the house in which he had lived, I found, to my horror, the feet of poor Brisbane protruding above the ground. So shallow was his grave that dogs had disturbed his mortal remains, and had fed upon the corpse. This was the fate of an honest, indus- trious, and most faithful man: of a man who feared no danger, and despised hardships. He was murdered by villains, because he defended the property of his friend ; he was mangled by them to satisfy their hellish spite; dragged by a lasso, at a horse’s heels, away from the houses, and left to be eaten by dogs. Besides my own acquaintance with him and opinions derived from the personal knowledge of the Beagle’s officers, some of whom had known Brisbane when his vessel, the Saxe Cobourg, was wrecked in Fury Harbour (owing to no fault of his), Mr. Weddell bears testimony to his character on many occa- sions, particularly by an observation in page 48 (Weddell’s Voyage), where he says, “I had full confidence in the care and ability of Mr. Brisbane.” (1823.) In 1830 Mr. Brisbane was wrecked on the eastern coast of Tierra del Fuego, near Policarpo Cove, (54° 38’ S.), when seal- ing there in partnership with Mr. Bray, who afterwards com- manded the sealing schooner ‘Transport,’ lost in 1833, at Hope Harbour. Ihave a copy of their log in my possession,’ from which the following extracts are selected, to show with what enduring patience some of those hardy sealers bear mis- fortune and distress. “Feb. 23d. Employed saving things from the wreck: six Indians came tous. 24th. Twenty-five Indians came, with their women and children. 25th. Another visit from natives: men, women, and children. 26th. Indians began to be very trou- 1830. LOG OF SHIPWRECKED CREW. 333 blesome. 27th. Forty Indians came to us, all armed with bows, ‘arrows, and slings, without women or children. Some of our people employed in building a shallop out of the wreck. 28th. More Indians, with twelve. strong women and eighteen chil- dren : but unarmed on this day. *¢ March Ist. More Indian visitors. 2d. Fifty-one natives, armed.” ‘To the 9th the crew continued to build their shallop, and were almost daily visited by natives, whom two-thirds of the party were obliged to watch with arms in their hands. On the 21st sixty-one natives visited them (these Indians always went away before dusk). On the 23d the time of high-water was observed to be 4". 40™, and the rise seventeen feet, during moderate westerly wind and settled weather. Mr. Brisbane made the latitude, by observation, 54° 38’S. and the longitude he estimated at 65°. 30’. W. “29th. Much troubled every day by natives, who tried to steal our tools; and hard pressed by hunger. No supper(a) the last three days. ** 2d April. Four long guns were found to the eastward, lying on a piece of the forecastle of some large ship, supposed to be a large frigate (b), also two leaden hawse pipes attached to the woodwork. 8th. A large party of Indians, who were plaguing us, quarrelled among themselves, and had a severe fight. 9th. Our last remainder of provisions finished. 15th. Employed caulking the shallop’s deck, and getting limpets from the rocks. N.B. Almost starving. 17th. Not being troubled to-day by natives, and the sea being smooth, went out in a little boat which we had saved, and caught eleven skate.” _ After this day several fish were caught at times, which, with shell-fish, afforded a scanty subsistence; but before this time they had been reduced to eating hide, and half putrid blubber, which they got by barter from the Indians. Mr. Bray, as well as Brisbane, told me that hunger and anxiety so wore and excited them, that they could seldom sleep more than an hour (@) Supper was their principal meal; as during the day, while the Indians were about, they had no time to cook or eat. R. F. (b) Perhaps the O’Higgins—(Chilian). R, F. 834 SUFFERINGS—DISASTERS. 1830. or two at night, though working all day, while they were so hard pressed for food. ‘¢ 22d. Launched the shallop, or rather, hauled her down at low water, and let her float. 24th. Indians more troublesome than ever; obliged to fire at them repeatedly. 27th. Almost starved, eating bullock’s hide. 30th. Nothing to eat but bul- lock’s hide and berries. Could not get the shallop over the reef because of a heavy surf. “* May Ist. Got out to sea; found the shallop leak very much: nothing to eat but hide. 2d. Lat. 54°. 00’. Long. east. 63°. 50’. 5th. Made Cape Meredith (in the Falklands), but could not get near for want of wind. 6th. Two men gave out (c) for want of food: they had gone six days with but one pound of hide. ‘7th. A heavy gale; the shallop under bare poles, and almost sinking ; sea making a clear breach over her; men quite worn out by constant pumping and baling, and by want of food: we hada very hard job to keep her from sinking: at dusk saw land through the rain and spray, half a mile to leeward; showed the head of the jib, and bore away right before the wind for the nearest part: saw a cove, ran into it, and anchored. Killed numbers of geese; thanked God for our safety. 11th. Many of our men ill from the sudden change. 17th. Went ashore in Pleasant Harbour; saw a great number of cattle; the dog caught two of them, and held them for us to kill.(d) 30th of May. Anchored in Port Louis, landed, and hauled the shallop ashore at high-water.” The vessel in which Brisbane and Bray were wrecked, was driven ashore in a northerly gale, while sealing near Policarpo Cove. Their crew consisted of about twenty men, most of whom had fire-arms, and plenty of ammunition. Though it will swell yet more the catalogue of his disasters, I must add that Brisbane was once wrecked on South Georgia, and escaped thence to Monte Video in a shallop, which he and his compa- nions in distress built out of the wreck of their sealing vessel. (ce) Could work no longer. R. F. (d) Seized them by the lip. He was a large, strong animal, between a bull-dog and a mastiff. R.F. April 1834. BURIAL OF LIEUT. CLIVE. 335 I have now by me two of the tools, almost the only ones, which they had to use: one is a cooper’s adze, nearly worn down to the middle ; and the other a saw, made out of a piece of iron hoop, fixed to a wooden frame. 6th April. While the Beagle was preparing for sea the body of Lieut. Clive,* late of H. M. S. Challenger, was found lying at high-water mark, in an unfrequented part of Berkeley Sound ; and the following morning I buried it in a grave on shore, not far from the tomb of our regretted shipmate Hellyer. After noon, on the same day, we sailed from the Falklands, depressed more than ever by the numerous sad associations connected with their name. * Lieut. Clive was drowned accidentally, by the upsetting of a small beat ;—his body could not then be found, CHAPTER XVI. Soundings—Anchor in Santa Cruz—Lay Beagle ashore for repair— Prepare to ascend River—Set out—View of surrounding country Rapid. stream—Cold—Ostriches—Guanacoes—I ndians—Fish—Cliffs — Firewood—Lava Cliffs — Difficulties—Chalia—See Andes—Far- thest West—View round — Return — Danger — Guanaco hunters— Puma—Cat—T ides—Sail from Santa Cruz. In working to the westward from Berkeley Sound to the River Santa Cruz, we sounded frequently, and found that the depth is nowhere much above one hundred fathoms between those places. But the water is not of so little depth between the Falklands and Cape Virgins, or Tierra del Fuego; for there we could not strike soundings in some places, towards the islands, with one hundred and fifty fathoms of line. On the 13th we anchored in the Santa Cruz, and imme- diately prepared to lay our vessel ashore for a tide, to ascertain how much injury had been caused by the rock at Port Desire, and to examine the copper previous to her employment in the Pacific Ocean, where worms soon eat their way through unpro- tected planks. (16th.) When on the beach, at a place we after- wards called ‘ Keel Point,’ it was found that a piece of the false keel under the ‘ fore-foot,’ had been knocked off, and that a few sheets of copper were a good deal rubbed. By Mr. May’s exer- tions all was repaired in one tide; and the following day we were making preparations for an excursion up the river, 17th. An examination, or rather a partial exploring, of the River Santa Cruz had long been meditated. During the former voyage of the Beagle, Captain Stokes had ascended the rapid current as far as a heavy boat could be taken ; but his account served only to stimulate our curiosity, and decided my follow- ing his example. Three light boats were prepared (whale-boats strengthened ): as much provision as they could stow with safety was put into them, and a party of officers and men selected. Lieut. Sulivan, 1834. RIVER SANTA CRUZ—BANKS. 337 having to take charge of the ship during our absence, could not go; neither could Mr. Stewart, or Mr. King, who were required to attend to duties on board; but Mr. Darwin, Mr. Chaffers, Mr. Stokes, Mr. Bynoe, Mr. Mellersh, Mr. Martens, and eighteen seamen and marines prepared to accompany me. Early on the 18th we left the Beagle, and with a favouring wind and flood tide sailed up the estuary, into which the river flows. This wide and turbid estuary receives a torrent which rushes through a confined opening into the ocean, during seven hours, and is opposed and driven back by the flood tide during about five hours of the twelve. On each side of both the estuary and river lie extensive plains of arid desert land : these plains are not, however, on the same level ; for, on the northern bank the land is very little raised above the level of high spring tides ; while, on the southern side of the river, high, perpendicular cliffs form a striking contrast: but after ascending these heights, by any of the ravines which intersect them, one finds a dead level expanse, similar in every respect to that on the northern shore. In the horizon, another ‘ steppe,’ or parallel plain, at a higher elevation, is seen; which, at a distance, appears like a range of hills of equal height. Excepting in the porphyry districts, all the eastern coasts of Patagonia, and the little of the interior which I have seen, seemed to me to be a similar succession of horizontal ranges of level land varying in height, intersected here and there by ravines and water-courses. There are, certainly, hills in many places which appear when one is passing at sea, or in the dis- tance, conical, or at all events peaked; but even those hills are but the gable ends, as it were, of narrow horizontal ridges of land, higher than the surrounding country. The cliffs on the south side of the river have a whitish appearance; and are similar to those on the outer coast, which were said by Sir John Narborough to resemble the coast of Kent. Their upper outline, when seen from a dis- tance, is quite horizontal. Brownish yellow is the prevailing colour, lighter or darker, as the sun shines more, or becomes obscured. Here and there, in hollow places and ravines, a VOL. 11. Z 338 BARRENNESS—ANIMALS: April few shrubby bushes are seen. But over the wide desola- tion of the stony barren waste not a tree—not even a. soli- tary ‘ ombu’*—can be discerned. Scattered herds of ever- wary guanacoes, startled at man’s approach, neighing, stamp- ing, and tossing their elegant heads; a few ostriches striding along in the distant horizon, and here and there a solitary con- dor soaring in the sky, are the only objects which attract the eye. Certainly, upon looking closely, some withered shrubs and a yellow kind of herbage may be discerned ; and, in walk- ing, thorns and prickles assure one painfully that the plain is not actually a desert: but I am quite sure that the general impression upon the mind is that of utter hopeless sterility. Is it not remarkable that water-worn shingle stones, and dilu- vial accumulations, compose the greater portion of these plains? On how vast a scale, and of what duration must have ‘ been the action of those waters which smoothed the shingle stones now buried in the deserts of Patagonia. Fresh water is seldom found in these wastes; salinas}+ are numerous. The climate is delightful to the bodily sensations ; but for productions of the earth, it is almost as bad as any, except that of the Arabian, or African deserts. Rain is sel- dom known during three quarters of the year ; and even in the three winter months, when it may be expected, but little falls excepting on rare occasions, when it comes down heavily for two or three days in succession. Sea winds sometimes bring small misty rain for a few hours, at any time of year, but not enough to do good to vegetable productions. The only ani- mals which abound are guanacoes, and they care little for fresh water, for they have often been seen drinking at the salinas. The puma probably quenches its thirst in their blood; of other animals, supposed to require much liquid, there are none in these regions. The climate is healthy and pleasant; generally a bright, sunny day is succeeded by a cloudless and extremely clear night. In * A kind of elder, growing here and there in Patagonia and the Pam- pas. See page 93. + Salt depositions or incrustations. eC» of Patagonia 69° MOUTH OF THE RIVER SANTA CRUZ Surveyed by the Officers of HM.S. Beagle. Long 68. 24.0. W. ..Var. 20), 54. E. HW. 945, _ Spring Rise 42 feet. Scale, Half an Inch~one Mile. Published by Henry Glbwn., Great Marlborough Street. 183.9. 1834. CLIMATE— BANKS—TIDES. 339 summer the heat is scorching, but not sultry ; and in winter, though the weather is sometimes searchingly cold, especially during southerly winds, the air is always elastic and whole- some. Changes of wind are sudden, and cause rapid, though not very great, variations of temperature. Sometimes the sky is slightly or partially overcast, occasionally clouded heavily ; but on most days there is bright sunshine, and a fresh or strong westerly wind. The confluence of a continental torrent of fresh water, with great tides of the ocean, which here rise forty feet perpendicu- larly, has embarrassed the mouth of the Santa Cruz with a number of banks. They are all composed of shingle and mud, and alter their forms and positions when affected by river- floods, or by the heavy seas caused by south-east gales. Into the entrance of the Santa Cruz, the flood-tide sets about four knots an hour; one may say, from two to five knots, according to the time of tide, and the narrower or broader part of the opening ; and outwards, the water rushes at least six knots on an average in mid-channel. There are places in which at times, when acted upon by wind or unusual floods, it runs with a velocity of not less than seven or eight ‘knots an hour—perhaps even more; but near either shore, and in bights between projecting points, of course the strength of the outward as well as inward current is very inferior. In such a bight, almost under some high cliffs on the south- ern shore, the Beagle was moored, and it is easy to conceive the different views presented in this situation, with forty feet change in the level of the water. At high water, a noble river, unimpeded, moves quietly, or is scarcely in motion: at other times, a rushing torrent struggles amongst numerous banks, whose dark colour and dismal appearance add to the effect of the turbid yellow water, and naked-looking, black, muddy shores. The boats sailed on between some of the banks, with a fresh southerly wind, disturbing every where immense flights of sea-birds. Now and then a monstrous sea-lion lifted his un- wieldy bulk a few inches from the stony bank, lazily looked z2 340 WEDDELL’s BLUFF—FRESH WATER. April around, and with a snort and a growl, threw his huge shapelessness, by a floundering waddle, towards the nearest water. As far as Weddell’s Bluff* we sailed merrily ; but there took to the oars, because the river makes a sudden turn, or rather, the river Santa Cruz (properly so called), enters the estuary of the same name from the south-west, as far as can be seen from Weddell’s Bluff :—but a little beyond where the eye reaches, it takes a westerly direction. Another river, the Chico of Viedma, also enters the estuary at this place from the north-west. Here, a little above the Bluff, the water was fresh on the surface, and sometimes it is quite fresh, even into the estuary ; but in filling casks, or dipping any thing into the stream for fresh water, it is advisable not to dip deep, or to let the hose (if one is used), go many inches below the surface, since it often happens that the upper water is quite fresh, while that underneath is salt. This occurs, more or less, in all rivers which empty themselves into the sea: the fresh water, specifi- cally lighter, is always uppermost. Wind failing us entirely, we pulled to the south-west. On our left, high cliffs still continued, and at their base a wide shingle beach offered tempting landing-places, with many spots ex- tremely well adapted for laying a vessel ashore, to be repaired or cleaned ; on our right, a low shore extended, rising gradually, however, in the north-west, + to cliffs like those near Keel Point. The flowing tide favoured us until about five, when we landed on the north shore, at a spot where the rise and fall of the tide had diminished to four feet. Here the river was six hundred and forty yards in breadth, running down at the rate of about six knots during a part of the ebb, and from two to four knots an hour during the greater part of the flood-tide. It was perfectly fresh to the bottom, and in mid-channel about three fathoms deep; but this depth extended very little way * Named after the enterprizing southern navigator. + On the south side of the north-west arm of the Santa Cruz. 1834. CHANGE OF SCENERY—COLD. 841 across, the deep channel being extremely narrow, not more than twenty yards in width. The distinct difference between the opposite banks of the river had been diminishing, until at this spot* both sides were much alike. We had left the cliffs and salt water, and had fairly entered the fresh-water river. Instead of having a wide extent of dismal-looking banks and dark-coloured muddy shores, we were at the side of a rapid stream, unvarying in width, on whose banks shrubs and grass agreeably relieved our eyes from muddy shingle covered with hosts of crabs. Our first night passed well, for there were plenty of bushes to supply us with fire-wood. Early next morning, some of the party went upon the nearest hills to look for guanacoes, when they saw that although the surface of the country appeared to an observer near the river to be irregular and hilly, upon ascending the heights it became apparent that the stream ran in a large valley; that the general character of the country was similar to what I have already described, and that those which had appeared to be hills were the terminating sides of extensive plains, whose level was about three hundred feet above the river. Near the fresh water, shrubs, bushes, and grass were not scarce; but every where on the higher ground a sterile, stony waste met the eye. Mr. Stokes} and I went on the heights, to obtain a view of the river ; and for a considerable distance we could trace its windings, but were sorry to see a great number of small islands, thickly covered with brushwood, which seemed likely to impede our progress if obliged to track { the boats. The southerly wind blew keenly over the high land, and the surface of the ground was frozen hard ; but the air was healthily fresh and bracing. Where, indeed, could it be purer than on these dry hills? At first setting out we tried the oars, but very soon found them unable to contend with the * The northern bight, or cove, a few miles north-eastward of Islet Reach. + It was his office to make a map of the country we passed through. } Pull, or tow them along by a rope. 342 TRACKING—MEASUREMENT. April strength of the stream; so landing all our party, except two in each boat, we made the boats fast to one another, at a few yards apart, in a line a-head: and then taking the end of a coil of whale-line ashore, half our party fixed themselves to it by laniards of broad canvas straps, which passed across their breasts and over one shoulder, and walked together steadily along the river’s bank. The bight of the line was passed round a stout mast, stepped in the headmost boat and attended by the two men, who veered away or shortened in the line as the varying width of the stream, or frequent impe- diments rendered necessary. In this manner, one-half of our party relieving the other about once an hour, every one wil- lingly taking his turn at the track rope,* we made steady progress against the stream of the river, which rather increased in rapidity as we ascended, until its usual velocity was be- tween six and seven knots an hour. While among the islands which I mentioned tracking was difficult and tedious, many were the thorny bushes through which one half of the party on the rope dragged their companions. Once in motion no mercy was shewn: if the leading man could pass, all the rest were bound to follow. Many were the duckings, and not trifling the wear and tear of clothes, shoes, and skin. At intervals stoppages were made for refreshment and obser- vations. Three chronometers were carried in the boats, with other necessary instruments: among them two mountain barome- ters, with which Mr. Darwin and myself wished to measure the height of the river above the level of the sea, and the heights of the neighbouring ranges of hills above the level of the river. This afternoon we picked up a boat-hook upon the south bank of the river, which was immediately recognized to be one which had been left by accident sticking in a mud- bank, by the party who accompanied Captain Stokes in his excursion up this river in the year 1827. It was very cold at our bivouac this night, being a sharp * Mr. Stokes alone being excepted, as his duty required continual attention, 1834. FROST—OSTRICHES SWIMMING. 343 frost: and while observing the moon’s meridian altitude, dew was deposited so fast upon the roof of the artificial horizon, and froze there so quickly as it fell, that I could hardly make the observation. My sextant was injured a little by the frost, for not having been used before in very cold weather, the brass contracted so much as to injure the silvering at the back of the index glass, and slightly change the index error. In the morning it was so cold that our usual ablutions were shunned, and all were anxious to have the first spell at the rope in order to warm themselves, though few had slept many minutes, and many had hard work the previous day. The ther- mometer was at 22° Fahr.—nothing,—indeed warm weather to Polar voyagers, but to us, accustomed to temperate climates, it appeared a severe degree of cold. 20th. As we were going along the bank of the river, which to our great benefit was becoming more accessible and clearer of bushes, we saw some dark coloured animals crossing the stream at a distance, but no one could guess what they were until the foremost of them reached the shore, and rising upon his stilt-like legs, showed himself to be an ostrich. Six or seven of these birds were swimming across: till then I had no idea that so long-legged a bird, not web-footed, would, of its own accord, take to the water and cross a rapid stream : this, however, was a certain proof to the contrary, for nothing had disturbed them that we could discern. As far as we could tell, at so great a distance, they seemed to be of the kind which the Spanish-patagonians call ‘ Avestruz-petis. They were, however, far too wild to be approached with agun. We saw smoke at a distance and anticipated meeting Indians, in the course of our next day’s journey. The country around con- tinued similar to that already described : but islands no longer impeded our progress, though some high cliffy banks gave us trouble. Atthe next place where we passed a night, Mr. Dar- win tried to catch fish with a casting net, but without success ; so strong a stream being much against successful fishing. Avery sharp frost again this night. The net and other things, which 344 RAPIDITY OF STREAM—GUANACO- April had occupied but little room in the boat, were frozen so hard as to become unmanageable and very difficult to stow. 21st. We proceeded as usual, dragging the boats up the stream (or rather torrent, for it never ran less than six knots, and in many places more) at the rate of about two miles an hour : and as we were approaching near to the smoke, we chose our position for the night, rather more cautiously than usual, upon a little peninsula. 22d. We had not advanced a mile this morning, when fresh tracks of Indians, on horseback, trailing their long lances, aroused our utmost vigilance. We thought-they had been reconnoitring our party, at day-light, and perhaps such was the case. 'The smoke of their fires was seen behind the nearest range of low hills, on our side of the river, being then on the north bank, but the boats had been tracking on either side, as better ground for walking was found. Proceeding on, a dead animal was found in the water, which proved to be a guanaco; how it came by its death did not appear, as it showed no external wound, but some of our party, hungrier or less squeamish than the rest, immediately proposed dividing and eating it; and hunger carried the day: the dead animal was hauled on shore, cut to pieces, and distributed. The guanaco steaks were much relished by all except two or three, who could not conquer their antipathy to supposed carrion. Our meal was eaten close to the place where we thought a tribe of Indians was encamped: and, in consequence, our arms were kept in readiness, and a careful watch set. After- wards cautiously proceeding, we arrived at the spot whence the smoke had issued, but saw no human beings: though marks of very recent fire, and numerous tracks of feet upon a soft muddy place at the side of the river, showed that a party of Indians had lately crossed over, and a smoke rising at some distance on the southern shore, pointed out where they were gone. At this spot there was about an acre of good pasture land, by the water side: and the breadth of the river itself was something less than usual, reasons which had induced the na- 1834. © INDIAN PASS —SHINGLE BEDS. 345 tives to select it as a crossing place.* To pass a river running at the rate of six or seven miles an hour, and about two hun- dred yards in width, can be no easy task to women and chil- dren. But as we saw many prints of very small feet on the muddy bank, both women and children must have crossed at this place with the men. How did they get over? there is no wood, neither are there rushes with which they might make balsas. Perhaps some of the women and children were put into rough, coracle-like boats, made of hides,t and towed across by the horses, holding by whose tails the men swam and perhaps many of the women. This method of holding by the tail, while swimming, is said to be better than resting a hand upon the horse’s neck and holding by the mane. None of the Indians sit upon their horses while swimming. This day (22d) we passed two places which we considered rapids, the stream of the river ran so violently, and we had so much difficulty in passing, even with all hands upon the rope. Besides the strength of the stream we had to contend against high cliffs, over whose upper edges it was difficult to convey the tow-line: yet we made good about twelve miles in the day. The night of the 22d was not so cold as the pre- ceding, but we always found the nights wintry though the days were warm, so much so, indeed, that we were often annoyed by the heat of the sun. So winding was the course of the river that we certainly walked double the distance which was advanced in a direct line: yet very little of inte- rest, as a picturesque subject, had been seen; for no country excepting a desert could wear a more triste and unvarying appearance. Immense accumulations of shingle, rounded stones, imbed- ded, as before mentioned, in diluvial deposition, form the level plain, or valley, through which the river pursues its very winding course. ‘The width of this vale varies from one mile to five miles, and the level of the shingle plain is from * Marked ‘ Indian Pass’ on the plan. + Floats or rafts. } “ Me envié tres indios nadadores, provisto de cueros y palos para formar una pelota.” (Diario de Viedma, p. 58.) $46 * HEIGHTS—VALLEY—SCARCITY OF FUEL. April three hundred to one thousand feet below that of the adjacent higher, but still horizontal ranges—whose broken-down ends, or sides, form the boundaries of the valley through which the river flows. Those of the higher ranges look like hills when one is in the valley, and it is not until after ascending to their summits that their real nature is seen; when, instead of being inclined to consider those heights as hills, one be- comes disposed to think the valley of the river a vast exca- vation, cut down below the level of the neighbouring country. But on the height, or in the valley, all is an unprofitable waste. Scarcely, indeed, could we find bushes enough, even near the river, to make our nightly fires, after the third day’s journey. The wiry, half-withered grass upon which the guanacoes feed is so scanty, that they are obliged to wander over much ground in search of their food. Those few stunted bushy trees which are found here and there, near the rivers are a kind of thorn trees, the wood of which is extremely hard and durable.* The night of the 22d we passed by the side of a little cove, which sheltered the boats from the strength of the stream: and, as all hands were tired, we rested during the morning of the following day. After noon (23d) we went on, and at dark stopped on the south shore. Scarcity of fuel and a cold night, made it neces- sary to take good care of the wood when cut. There may be honour among thieves, but there was little to be found during a cold night among our party, for the fire of those who hap- pened to be on watch was sure to blaze cheerily, at the expense of the sleepers. A little incident occurred here very unim- portant certainly to those unconcerned, yet of much conse- quence to us: we left our stock of salt behind, and a spade, which latter was much wanted for earthing up the sides of our | tents, to keep out the cold wind. 24th. I noticed more than usual a curious effect of the river water being so much warmer than the air over it-f At * A guanaco was shot this day by the running fire of several guns. He was soon cut up and stowed in the boats. + The temperature of the air being 30°, that of the water 46°. 1834. CLIFFS OF EARTH—PROGRESS—LAVA. 347 daybreak, and until after sunrise, the river was smoking, quite as if it were boiling. 'This day we passed some earthy cliffs between two and three hundred feet in height, and where they ‘came in our way it was extremely difficult to manage the boats and tow-lines ; but by veering out at those times a great length of rope, our object was accomplished without any disaster. Near these cliffs the valley of the river begins to contract and become more irregular, and the sides or breaking down of the higher ranges become more abrupt and are nearer to the river. In most places we found a cliffy side opposite to a low pro- jecting point of shingle, but in some spots that we passed both sides were high, and we had no choice on which to take the tow-line. The difference, also, between the level of the higher ranges and that of the river, was observed to be much increased. On this day (25th) our best shots succeeded in killing two guanacoes, but they died.out of our reach, and probably became food for pumas, instead of man. The order of our march was usually one or two riflemen in advance, as scouts —Mr. Darwin, and occasionally Mr. Stokes, or Mr. Bynoe, upon the heights—a party walking along the banks, near the boats, ready to relieve or assist in tracking, and the eight or ten men who were dragging the three boats along at the rate of about two miles an hour over the ground, though full eight knots through the water. Difficult places to pass— delays caused by embarking and disembarking frequently to change banks, and avoid impediments—the necessary observa- tions, rest, and meals, occupied so much time that we did not average more than twelve miles in one day: and even that small distance was not accomplished without making both shoulders and feet sore. 26th. In the distance some very level topped, dark looking cliffs, were seen at the summits of elevated ranges, which Mr. Darwin thought must have a capping or coating of lava. Of course we were very anxious to verify a fact so curious, and at noon were quite satisfied that it was so, having approached to the foot of a height thus capped, whose frag- 348 LAVA DISTRICT—* BASALT GLEN.’ April ments had in falling not only scattered themselves over the adjacent plain, but into the bed of the river, in such a manner as to make the passage exceedingly dangerous ; because large angular masses, in some places showing above the stream in others hidden beneath, but so near the surface that the water eddied and swelled over them, menaced destruction to the boats as they were with difficulty dragged through the eddy- ing rapid ; sometimes the rope caught under or around one of those masses, and caused much trouble. Near the spot where we stopped at noon there is a glen, quite different in character from any place we had passed.* Indeed, upon enter- ing the lava district, or that part of the country over which lava formerly flowed, there was no longer a Patagonian aspect around. Steep precipices, narrow, winding vallies, abundance of huge angular fragments of lava, a more rapid and nar- rower river, and plains of solid lava overlying the whole sur- face of the country, make this diserict even worse in its appear- ance than the eastern coast of Patagonia. Excepting in an occasional ravine nothing grows. Horses could not travel far, the ground being like rough iron; and water, excepting that of the river and its tributary in Basalt Glen, is very scarce. The glen above mentioned is a wild looking ravine, bounded by black lava cliffs. A stream of excellent water winds through it amongst the long grass, and a kind of jungle at the bottom. Lions or rather pumas shelter in it, as the recently torn remains of guanacoes showed us. Condors inha- bit the basaltic cliffs. Near the river some imperfect columns of basalt give to a remarkable rocky height, the semblance of an old castle. Altogether it is a scene of wild loneliness quite fit to be the breedjng place of lions.+ No signs of human visitors were discovered: indeed, the nature of the country must almost prevent horsemen from traversing these regions, there is so little food and such bad ground: only in glens or ravines such as this can any grass or bushes be found. Guanacoes absolutely swarm upon the * © Basalt Glen.’ + ©“ Leonum arida nutrix.” Wid i, 1834. MIRAGE—DRIFTED TREES—ANDES. $49 heights, a consequence probably of their being undisturbed. They spread over the face of the high country like immense flocks of sheep. During a long walk this evening Mr. Stokes and I were repeatedly disappointed by the mirage over an extensive stony plain, between two bends of the river. We were tired and very thirsty, and went from one apparent piece of water to another, only to be tantalized and to increase still more our dilemma. 27th. Similar country. On the banks of the river some drift wood was found ; the trunks of trees of considerable size. Small trees had been found lying by the side of the river, from time to time, but none so large as these, some of which were almost two feet in diameter, and about thirty feet in length. The wood appeared to be ‘Sauci,’ of the red kind. That these trees had been drifted from a great distance was evident, because they were much water worn. 28th. In passing a rapid, whose difficulties were much in- creased by rugged blocks of lava lying in the bed of the river, one of our boats was badly stove and barely rescued from sinking in the middle of the stream: fortunately we got her on shore and there patched her up. There was still no change in the scenery, nor any signs of inhabitants: and our work was as monotonous as heavy. 29th. While upon a high range of lava-capped land, Mr. Stokes and Mr. Darwin descried distant mountains in the west, covered with snow. At last, then, the Andes were in sight! This was imspiriting intelligence to the whole party ; for small had been our daily progress, though continual and severe the labour. The river increased in rapidity, while but little diminution had taken place in the quantity of water brought down: the breadth was rather less, certainly, but the depth in most places greater. No fish had yet been caught ; indeed, only two had been seen, and those seemed to be like trout. 30th. The snowy summits of the distant Cordillera were more distinctly seen from the heights, near the river, that rise 350 BIRDS OF PREY—GUANACOES. April about a thousand feet above its level, which, there, is about three hundred feet above that of the sea. ‘Two guanacoes were shot with my rifle by H. Fuller,* who hastened to the boats for assistance. Some of our party went directly with him to bring in the animals, but condors and cara-carast had eaten every morsel of the flesh of one; though the other was found untouched and brought to the boats. Four hours had sufficed to the cara-caras and condors for the cleaning of every bone. { When our party reached the spot some of those great birds were so heavily laden that they could hardly hop away from the place. The guanaco that was eaten by the birds must have been, by his size, at least fifty pounds heavier than any shot by us in Patagonia, therefore about 300|bs. Mr. Darwin and Mr. Stokes had much amusement with these animals, upon the heights. Being so much tamer there and more numerous, whole flocks were driven by them into nar- row defiles, where dozens might have been killed had there been more people with guns, lassoes, or balls. Though the bed of the river is there so much below the level of the stratum of lava,y it still bears the appearance of having worn away its channel, by the continual action of run- ning water. ‘The surface of the lava may be considered as the natural level of the country, since, when upon it, a plain, which seems to the eye horizontal, extends in every direction. How wonderful must that immense volcanic action have been which spread liquid lava over the surface of such a vast tract of country. Did the lava flow from the Cordillera of the Andes, or was it thrown out from craters in the low country ? Its position with respect to subaqueous deposits, its horizontal surface and cellular texture, are reasons, among others, for thinking that it was thrown out of the earth, while these plains were covered by a depth of sea. The valley, or channel of the river, varies here from one mile, or less, to about three miles ; but it looks narrower, owing * My steward. + A carrion-eating eagle. $ The animal thus eaten lay on high ground : the other was in a hollow: § From ten to twelve hundred feet. ‘SIGNV DVL AO MIIA AMVLSIGC GWY “MAAIW ZAYW May 1834. WEATHER—COUNTRY—CORDILLERA. 351 to the deception caused by high land on each side. Some of the views are certainly. striking, and, from their locality, inte- resting ; I could not, however, have believed that the banks of any large fresh water river could be so destitute of wood, or verdure of any kind, or so little frequented by man, beast,* bird, or fish. May Ist. The weather was invariably fine during the earlier part of our journey ; but this day it began to change, and two or three gloomy clouded days were succeeded by a few hours only of small rain, and by some strong wind. This night - (ist) we slept at the foot of heights whose summits were covered with snow, but the temperature was many degrees warmer than that of the first nights, when it froze so sharply. There was no particular frost aftcr the 21st of April. We had great difficulty with the boats on the 2d, the river being contracted in width, without any diminution of the body of water pouring down. On the 3d, we found a more open country, the lava-capped heights receding gradually on each side, leaving a vale of flat, and apparently good land, from five to fifteen miles in extent. _ The width of the river increased ; on its banks were swampy spaces, covered with herbage; and low earthy cliffs, without either shingle or lava, in some places bounded the river. A little further, however, the usual arid and stony plains of Patagonia were again seen, extending from the banks of the river to ranges of hills, about fourteen hundred feet above its level, on which the horizontal lava-capping could be distinctly discerned. In tne distant west the Cordillera of the Andes stretched along the horizon. During three days, we had advanced to- wards those far distant mountains, seeing them at times very distinctly ; yet this morning our distance seemed nearly as great as on the day we first saw their snow-covered summits. A long day’s work carried us beyond the flat and into the rising country, whose barren appearance I just now mentioned. * Excepting guanacoes. 352 WALKING PARTY—VIEWS. May We were all very tired of the monotonous scene, as well as of the labour of hauling the boats along. 4th. Our provisions being almost exhausted, and the river as large as it was beyond the lava country, our allotted time being out, and every one weary and foot-sore, I decided upon walking overland to the westward, as far as we could go in one day, and then setting out on our return to the Beagle. I was the more inclined to this step, because the river here made a southerly bend, to follow which would have required at least a day, without making much westing, and because I thought that some of our party might walk in that time at least twice as far as they could track the boats, and then return before night. To have followed the course of the river two days longer, we should have needed all the small remainder of our provi- sions, and probably without being enabled to see further than we might by one day’s walk directly westward. Leaving those who were the most tired to take care of the boats, a party set out early, in light marching order. A large plain lay before us, over which shrubs, very small trees, and bushes were sparingly scattered; yet parts of this plain might be called fertile and woody, by comparison with the tracts between us and the eastern sea-coast. At noon we halted on a rising ground, made observations for time, latitude, and bearing ; rested and eat our meal ; on a spot which we found to be only sixty miles from the nearest water of the Pacific Ocean. The Cordillera of the Andes extended along the western side of our view; the weather was very clear, enabling us to discern snow-covered mountains far in the north, and also a long way southward ; hence much of the range was visible, but of the river we could discern nothing. Only from the form of the land could we conclude that at the end of the southerly reach I have mentioned, the direction of the river is nearly east and: west for a few miles, and that then it may turn northward, or rather come from the north along the base of the Cordillera. There are many reasons for inducing one to suppose that it comes not only from the north, but from a considerable dis- 1834. WATER—DRAINAGE—LAKE. 353 tance northward. At the place where we ceased to ascend the stream, the Santa Cruz was almost as large as at the places where we passed the first and second nights near the estuary. The velocity of the current was still at least six knots an hour; though the depth remained undiminished. The temperature of the water was 45°, while that of the air was seldom so high, even in the day-time, and at night was usually below the freez- ing point. Trees, or rather the trunks of trees, were found lying upon the banks, whose water-worn appearance indicated that they had been carried far by the stream. The water was very free from sediment, though of a whitish blue colour, which induces me to suppose that it has been chiefly produced by melted snow, or that it has passed through lakes in which the sediment it might have brought so far was deposited. If filled from the waters of the nearer mountains only, its temperature would surely be lower, approaching that of melted snow : it would also, in all probability, bring much sediment, and would therefore be muddier, and less pure in colour. When one considers how large an extent of country there is between the River Negro and the Strait of Magalhaens, and that through that extensive region only one river of magnitude flows, it may be difficult to account for the manner in which the drainage of the eastern side of the great Cordillera is car- ried off,.or where the melted snow and occasional heavy rains disappear. The Gallegos is small, though it runs into a large estuary. The Chupat river is very small: that at Port Desire is scarcely more than a brook. At times, it is true, these smaller rivers are flooded, but their floods (added to their usual streams) seem unequal to carrying off the continual drainage of the Andes. South of the Negro only the Santa Cruz flows with a full and strong stream throughout the whole year, and my idea is that the sources of the river Santa Cruz are not far from those of the southern branch of the Negro, near the forty-fifth degree of latitude; and that it runs at the foot of the Andes, southward, through several lakes, until it turns to the eastward in the parallel of fifty degrees. VOL. II. 24 354 LAKE VIEDMA OR CAPAR—FLOODS. May In Viedma’s Diary I find that he heard from the Indians at Port San Julian (in 1782) that the river Santa Cruz flowed from a large lake near the Cordillera of the Andes, and that there was abundance of wood on its banks. In consequence of this information, he went, in November, with a party of Spaniards and Indians on horseback, to explore this lake. In his way, Viedma crossed the river Chico, which flows into the estuary of the Santa Cruz, just above Weddell Bluff. The Chico, though small at times and then fordable, was subject, the Indians said, to great floods in the spring, when the melt- ing snows of the Cordillera over-filled a lake, far in the north- west, whence this river ran. Afterwards, Viedma crossed the river Chalia, which they told him rose in another lake near the Cordillera, was likewise subject to floods, and emptied itself into the Santa Cruz: when he passed, it was only up to the horses’ knees (after searching many leagues, however, for a ford), but at his return it was deeper. This Chalia can be no other than the stream which flows through Basalt Glen, a mere brook when we saw it in the dryest season of the year. Viedma reached the lake,* and found every thing correspond to the description ; for it was deep and large, surrounded by snow- covered mountains, on which were many forests. Some persons_have doubted whether there is ever much drainage to be carried off from the eastern side of the Andes, between the parallels of forty and fifty ; but if they will take the trouble to read Viedma’s Diary, and some other notices to be found in the work of Don Pedro de Angelis, I think they will be convinced that there is always a considerable drain- age, and that at times there are heavy floods to be carried off.+ * Called Capar, or Viedma. MS. Chart, t+ As one proof of this assertion, I may quote a passage from Viedma: —“ Reconocido pues todo” (all that there was to see in the neighbour- hood of the lake whence the Santa Cruz flowed), “nos expusé el Indio Patricio nos debiamos apartar luego de aqui, porqne con los vientos fuer- tes, y el sol, solia derretirse tanta nieve que era impos:ble vadear los arro- yos para regresar, y tendriamos que pasar el verano en aquel pasage hasta que las heladas empezasen.”’—(Diario de Viedma, p 57.) 1834. LEVEL OF RIVER—BONES. 355 Reference to the accompanying plan will shew our position when we halted, and I decided to return, not having explored, I should think, more than one-third of its course. At that place the level of the river was found to be four hundred feet higher than that of the sea at the entrance; and as the distance is about two hundred miles,* the average descent or fall of the water must be near two feet in a mile, which, I apprehend, is unusually great. I could not, indeed, believe that the compu- tation and data were correct, until after repeated examination. Two barometers were used at the river-side, and a very good one was carefully watched on board the Beagle.{ Certainly, the rapid descent of the river, in many places, was such, that even to the eye it appeared to be running down-hill ; and this remark was often made in the course of our journey. Two days before we reached our westernmost point, many traces of an old Indian encampment were seen ; but excepting at that place and at the spot which we passed on the 22d, no signs of inhabitants were any where found. Scarcity of pas- ture, and the badness of the ground for their horses’ feet, must deter Indians from remaining in this neighbourhood ; but that they frequently cross the river, when travelling, is well known. The quantities of bones heaped together, or scattered near the river, in so many places which we passed, excited conjec- tures as to what had collected them. Do guanacoes approach the river to drink when they are dying? or are the bones remains of animals eaten by lions or by Indians? or are they washed together by floods ? Certain it is they are remarkably numerous near the banks of the river ; but not so elsewhere. I can hardly think that the guanaco is often allowed to die a natural death; for pumas are always on the alert to seize invalid stragglers from the herd. At night the guanacoes choose the clearest places for sleeping, lying down together like sheep ; and in the day they avoid thickets, and all such places as might * Following the course of the river. + The data will be found in the Appendix. { At the level of the sea. Za 356 RETURN—ANIMALS—FISH. May shelter their ever-watchful enemy. Condors, also, and fierce little wild cats* help to prevent too great an increase of this beautiful, inoffensive, and useful animal. Late on the 4th we returned to our tents, thoroughly tired by a daily succession of hard work, and long walks. At this bivouac we were about one hundred and forty miles, in a straight line, from the estuary of Santa Cruz, or from Wed- dell Bluff; and about two hundred and forty-five miles dis- tant by the course of the river. Our station at noon on the 4th, was eight miles in a straight line farther westward, and about thirty miles from the Cordillera of the Andes. The height of those mountains was from five to seven thousand feet above our level, by angular measurement with a theodolite. Early on the 5th we began the rapid descent. Sometimes the wind favoured, and we passed the land at the rate of ten knots an hour ; sometimes dangerous places obliged us to turn the boat’s head to the stream, pull against it, and so drop down between the rocks. Though easy, the return was far more dangerous than our ascent of the river. 5th. Our first day’s work in returning was a distance of eighty- five miles, which had cost us six days hard labour in ascending. Next day we made good about eighty-two miles; and on the 7th we reached the salt water. Although we made such quick progress in returning, our halts for observations were similar to those made in going. While descending the rapid stream, so quickly and quietly, we saw many more guanacoes and ostriches than we had seen before; but our flying shots only frightened them, and time was too precious to admit of any delay. Only one fish was got, and that was a dead one, which had been left on the bank: it was similar to a trout. Not more than half a dozen live fish were seen, and none could be caught either with hooks or nets. Leaving a very small party near Weddell Bluff to look for guanacoes, I hastened ori board with the boats ; and with the ebb tide reached the Beagle before noon on the 8th. The ship being ready for sea, except- * Though the wild cat could not injure a full-grown animal, it might destroy a young one with great ease. 1834. TIDES—PUMAS—AIGLE ROCK. 357 ing a ton or two of fresh water, the yawl and cutter were dis- patched to get it and bring on board the shooting party. Dur- ing my absence satisfactory observations on the tides had been made, which showed that the neap tides rise about eighteen feet, and the springs from thirty-eight to forty-two feet. One day when walking through a woody ravine, not far from the anchorage, Mr. Stewart saw a puma lying under a bush, glar- ing at him: taking a steady aim, he fired, and laid the animal dead. It was avery large one; and the skin is now in the British Museum. The moment of thus looking a lion in the face, while taking aim, at only a few yards distance, must be somewhat trying to the nerves, I should imagine. A beautiful wild cat was also added to our collections, besides condors and foxes. 9th. The boats, and shooting party, arrived with water and two guanacoes. As the sportsmen were returning with their burthens on the preceding evening, darkness overtook them while yet distant from their tent; and they were soon made uncomfortably* conscious that an enemy was at hand, for the strong and peculiar smell of a lion warned them that one was near. They trudged on with their cargoes, talking to one another; but the scent was still strong until they approached the fire, which had been kept up by their companion, when it ceased entirely. Such a weight as a lion’s, added suddenly to that of a guanaco, would have been rather distressing. We were detained for a day or two by an overcast sky, which prevented my obtaining equal altitudes; but on the 12th the Beagle left the Santa Cruz, and stood towards the alleged place of the shoal, or rock, called ‘ Aigle,’ not far from the western- most of the Falkland Islands. No such danger, nor any sign of shallow water being found, but, on the contrary, no bottom with one hundred fathoms of line, we steered towards Magalhaens Strait, and on the 18th anchored off Cape Virgins. Next morn- ing I landed on the Cape, taking Mr. Darwin and Mr. Stokes with me, and remained till after the noon observation, when, returning on board, the Beagle weighed and sailed to another station. From this time (till the 25th) we were busily em- * Being only two in number. 358 ADVENTURE—FORT FAMINE. May, June. ployed in sounding in the neighbourhood of Cape Virgins, Point Catherine, Lomas Bay, and Possession Bay. On the 23d, at day-light, we saw the Adventure coming from the Falklands. After communicating with us, she went on to survey the portion of coast extending from Sweepstakes Foreland to Cape Monmouth; and we remained to complete our own task of sounding the banks about the First Narrow, and examining the south shore of St. Philip Bay. On the 3d of June both vessels were moored in Port Famine, preparing for their passage to San Carlos in Childe. Tue next chapter will take the Beagle into the Pacific by a route not hitherto used, except by sealing vessels: although it possesses many advantages over either the passage round Cape Horn, or that through the western reaches of the Strait of Magalhaens. Mr. Low is said to be the first discovercr of it, and he certainly was the first to pass through in a ship; but I think one of the Saxe Cobourg’s boats had passed through it previously, and I much question whether Sir Francis Drake’s shallop did not go by that opening into the Strait of Magalhaens in 1578. Before I finally leave Tierra del Fuego, a remark or two may here be made respecting the language of the natives. ‘ Pichi,’ in the Huilli- che or Araucanian language, means ‘small’ or ‘a little,’ and ‘re’ sig- nifies ‘only,’ ‘ but,’ ‘purely,’ or ‘simply.” Hence, Pecheray, always uttered in a begging, or whining tone, may have some such signification. In Beauchesne’s voyage it is said, that the natives in the Eastern parts of Magalhaens Strait were called ‘ Laguedi-che,’ and those westward, ‘ Haveguedi-che.’t These words are to me very interesting, because I suppose the first to be a corruption of Laque-che, which means, in Arau- canian, ‘ People with balls’ (bolas), and the second is not far removed from Huapi-gulu-che, which means ‘ people of mountainous islands heaped together,’ terms respectively most appropriate for natives of eastern and western Tierra del Fuego. * See Burney, vol. i. p. 368 and p. 327, where he shows that Drake discovered Cape Horn, and anchored near it (in or near St. Martin Cove?) in 1578. Another early southern discovery is mentioned in vol. ii. p. 198, where it is stated that Dirck Gherritz discovered land in 64°. S. in 1599, (part of or near South Shetland ?) + Voyage of Beauchesne, in Burney’s History, vol. iv. p. 378. ARWM 1 S » CHAPTER XVII. Beagle and Adventure sail from Port Famine through Magdalen and Cockburn Channel — Enter Pacific—Death of Mr. Rowlett—Chilée —Chile—Government—Adventure sold—Consequent changes—Plans —Mr. Low—Chonos—Lieut. Sulivan’s party—Moraleda—Ladrilleros — De Vea — Sharp—San Andres—Vallenar—Mr Stokes—San Este- van —, Distressed sailors — Anna Pink Bay — Port Low—Potatoes— -Tndian names — Huafo — Voleano—Chilotes—Aborigines—M ilitia— Freebooters — Climate — Docks— Tides—W itchcraft — Alerse—Cal- bucanos —Cesares—Search for men— Meteors. June 9th. Good equal altitudes having been obtained, after an interval of time sufficient for rating our chronometers,* we sailed from Port Famine, went down the Magdalen Chan- nel, enjoying some fine scenery, among which Sarmiento was _ pre-eminent, and anchored in a cove under Cape Turn. The following day we beat to windward through the Cockburn Channel, and would have anchored at night had a safe place offered in time, but as the only cove near us at dusk was a very small one, I preferred leaving that unoccupied for the Adventure, and remaining under way in the Beagle. The night was long and very dark, small rain fell nearly all the time, and squalls from the westward were frequent. There _ were but four square miles in which it was safe to sail to and - fro after dark, and for fourteen hours we traversed that area in every direction. It was necessary to keep under a reason- able press of sail part of the time, to hold our ground against the lee tide; but with the ebb we had often to bear up and ‘run to leeward, when we got too near the islets westward of us. Ina case of this kind a ship is so much more manage- able while going through the water than she is while hove-to, _ and those on board are in general so much more on the alert than when the vessel herself seems half asleep, that I have always been an advocate for short tacks under manageable sail, so as to keep as much as possible near the same place, in pre- ference to heaving-to and drifting. * The Adventure had four chronometers, 360 DEATH OF MR. ROWLETT. June When the day at last broke on the 11th, we saw the Adven- ture coming out to us from the cove where she had passed the night, and then both vessels sailed out of the Channel, past Mount Skyring and all the Furies, as fast as sails could urge them. At sunset we were near the Tower Rocks,* and with a fresh north-west wind stood out into the Pacific, with every inch of canvas set which we could carry. On the 26th we were still together, in latitude 43° and lon- gitude 75°, although gales had occasionally separated us for a few hours. After passing the latitude of 45° we had a succes- sion of bad weather, and adverse (N.W.) winds. Trusting too much to our usual good fortune I had steered in too direct a line towards Childe, and in consequence all these north-west winds were against us. Had I shaped a course which would have taken us farther from the land, while we had the wind south- ward of west, we might have made a fair wind of these pro- voking north-westers, and arrived at Childe at least a week sooner. A few remarks upon the wind and weather, between the parallels of forty and forty-seven, off Chilée and the Chonos Archipelago, will be found in the Appendix (No. 19). On the 27th we witnessed the last moments of Mr. Row- lett’s existence in this world. He had long been sinking under an internal complaint of which it was impossible to cure him, except by a vigorous and uniform mode of treatment to which he was not willing to conform until too late : but his illness had no relation whatever to the service in which he had been em- ployed. He was much’regretted by all of us, having been a kind, honourable friend. The following day we committed the body of our deceased companion to the seaman’s grave, that “‘ ever-changing and mysterious main.” In the evening we were near the north-west end of Childe, and at midnight an anchor was let go in our former berth, off Point Arena, The Adventure arrived two days afterwards, her main-boom having broken in a heavy squall on the 27th, in consequence of which she got to leeward, and was prevented from sooner weathering the north end of the island. A supply of fresh provisions * Not far from Cape Noir, on Noir Island. 1834. CHILIAN GOVERNMENT. 361 and good rates for the chronometers were obtained, after which we sailed (14th July) for Valparaiso, and arrived there together on the 22d. My first object would have been, after seeing the vessels securely moored, to go to Santiago, present my instructions in the proper quarter, and ask for the sanction of the Chilian government, in prosecuting the survey of the coasts of Chile; but I was so much in arrear with respect to computations and charts, that I could not venture to give even a week to an excursion to that agreeable place, where a thousand attractive novelties would inevitably have diverted my attention in some measure from the dull routine of calculation, and attention to the data accumulated by many months’ exertion of those on board the Adventure, as well asin the Beagle; therefore I sent Lieutenant Wickham, who spoke Spanish, and had been at Santiago before, to show my instructions to the Authorities, and request their approval of our examination of the shores under their jurisdiction. Nothing could be more satisfactory than the reply (Appendix No. 20), and from that time until the Beagle left Chile she received every attention and assist- ance which the Chilian officers could afford. As I proposed to remain at Valparaiso during the winter months, Messrs. Stokes, King, Usborne, and myself, whose oc- cupation would be sedentary and would require room, as well as more light and quiet than we could always have on board, took up our quarters on shore ; while those on board attended to the refit and provisioning of our vessels. At this time I was made to feel and endure a bitter dis- appointment ; the mortification it caused preyed deeply, and the regret is still vivid. I found that it would be impossible for me to maintain the Adventure much longer: my own means had been taxed, even to involving myself in difficulties, and as the Lords Commissioners of the Admiralty did not think it proper to give me any assistance, I saw that all my cherished hopes of examining many groups of islands in the Pacific, besides making a complete survey of the Chilian and Peruvian shores, must utterly fail. I had asked to be 362 ADVENTURE SOLD—CHANGES. Nov. allowed to bear twenty additional seamen on the Beagle’s books, whose pay and provisions would then be provided by Government, being willing to defray every other expense myself; but even this was refused. As soon as my mind was made up, after a most painful struggle, I discharged the Adventure’s crew, took the officers back to the Beagle, and sold the vessel.* Early in November our charts of the eastern coasts of Pata- gonia and Tierra del Fuego, as well as those of the Falkland Islands (the work of the Adventure) were finished, and shipped off for England ; and on the 10th we sailed, alone, to resume our more active occupations on the southern coasts. My former intention was to have filled up all blanks in the charts of the outer west coast of Patagonia, between the parallels of fifty- three and forty-eight, and then carried a connected survey along the coast to the equator; after which the Galapagos Islands ; Dangerous Archipelago; Marquesas, Society, Friendly, and Feejee Islands; besides New Zealand; were to have had as earnest an examination as could be effected by both vessels during 1836 and part of 1837. That this plan might have been carried out by the divisions of labour and exertions of the Beagle and her tender may, I think, be inferred from what has actually been executed with inferior means and in much less time. But my reduced arrangements were on a much smaller scale: I could only look to the most useful objects that might be effected within the limited time to which I dared to look forward. All on board partook, more or less, of the mortification caused by parting with our consort, just as she was most wanted, and most able to take an effective part ; and I confess that my own feelings and health were so much altered in consequence—so deprived of their former elasticity and soundness—that I could myself no longer bear the thoughts of such a prolonged sepa- ration from my country, as I had encouraged others to think * Though her sale was very ill-managed, partly owing to my being dispirited and careless, she brought 7,500 dollars, nearly £1,400, and is now (1838) trading on that coast, in sound condition. 1834. PLANS FOR FUTURE—MR. Low. 363 lightly of, while I could hold out to them the prospect of seeing as well as doing a great deal among the islands of the Pacific, besides completing the surveys of Chile and Peru. I now proposed, first, to go to San Carlos, there set two of our boats at work among the islands eastward of the large island, while the Beagle would survey the more exposed coasts, those to the west and south; then the ship was to examine the seaward shores of the Chonos archipelago, while another of her boats was employed among those islands; and, the Chonos explored, she would return to San Carlos, collect her scattered parties, and proceed along the coast, northwards, taking all the ports and islands in her way. On the 21st we arrived at San Carlos, and were pleased to find that Mr. Low had returned safe from his difficult under- taking ; and that a person (Mr. Douglas) whom I had engaged to make an excursion to Calbuco and into the forests of ‘Alerse,’ on the Cordillera of the Andes, had also come back with the required information, and was ready to engage himself to act as a pilot and interpreter. When last at San Carlos I proposed to Mr. Low, then serving as pilot on board the Adventure, to pass the time of our absence at Valparaiso, in exploring part of the Chonos Archipelago with a whale-boat belonging to me, and a crew of natives (Chilotes). Low, ever restless and enterprising, entered eagerly into my views ; so furnishing him with money, achart, and a few instruments, I explained where I wished him to go, and when he should be again at San Carlos, all further arrange- ment being left to him. Mr. Low hired a crew of six men,* and set out. After he had quitted the southernmost place at which provisions could be procured, called Caylin, or ‘ El fin de la Christiandad,’ one of his men+ persuaded some of the others} to eat up the stock * A Welshman, two Chilotes, a Chilian, and two Sandwich Islanders who had been left at San Carlos by a whaler. + The Chilian. + The Chilotes and Sandwich Islanders. Taffy remained faithful : he and Low, being able-bodied active men, frightened the rest into reluctant submission, 364 ISLAND OF SOCORRO—INDIANS. Dec of provisions in the boat as soon as possible, in order that they might be obliged to return without going far. But Low was too much inured to hardship to be so easily diverted from his plan; he went on, directly south, even after his provisions were consumed ; obliging them to live for fourteen days upon shell-fish and sea-weed. After exploring much of the Chonos Archipelago, sufficiently to facilitate our survey materially, he returned with his hungry crew to Caylin. 24th. Lieutenant Sulivan set out with the yawl and a whale- boat, to survey the east side of Childe and the islets in the Gulf of Ancud.* With him were Messrs. Darwin, Usborne, Stewart and Kent ; Douglas as a pilot, and ten men. Two days afterwards, the Beagle sailed, to examine the western coast of Childe, and the Chonos Archipelago. Dec. 2d. While standing towards distant mountainous land, about the latitude of 45°, we saw a comparatively low and level island ;+ considerably detached from those which seemed like Tierra del Fuego, being a range of irregular mountains and hills, forming apparently a continuous coast. This level island I have since ascertained to be that formerly called Nuestra Senora del Socorro, where Narborough anchored and landed, in 1670. It was selected in 1740, by Anson, as a rendezvous for his squadron ; but no one seemed to know where to look for it : the Anna Pink having made the land in 45°. 35’, and the unfor- tunate Wager in 47°, near Cape Tres Montes. Narborough mentions seeing ‘ an old Indian hut’ on this island; and in a MS. journal, written by Moraledat (now in my possession) it is said that the former natives of the Chonos used to make annual excursions to that as well as other outlying islands. After witnessing the distance to which savages venture in such frail canoes as those of Tierra del Fuego, it does not surprise one to find them going fifteen or twenty miles across an open * Orders in Appendix, No. 21. + About three or four hundred feet in height, excepting one hill, which is seven hundred feet. ~ MS. Diary of Moraleda’s examination of Chilée and part of the Chonos Islands in 1787-93, given to me at Lima, by a friend to whom I am much indebted for valuable information. 1834. HUAFO—BREAK ANCHORS. 365 space of sea in such large canoes as those of the Chonos Indians, which are indeed boats. Fuegian wigwams have been found upon Staten Land and upon Noir Island, each of which is as far from any neighbouring coast as Socorro is from the nearest shore. While Narborough’s ship was under sail, near Socorro, he went in his boat to the island which is nearest to it, by him named Narborough Island.* There he landed, and took posses- sion for his Majesty and his heirs.+- 3d. Having passed the night quietly at single anchor, near the north-east point of Socorro, we weighed and continued our route to and fro along the coast, taking angles, soundings, and observations. On the 5th, we were near Huafo,t which, to our surprise, we found to be twenty-five miles farther north than the Spanish charts (following Moraleda) showed its position, yet the longitude was almost correct. In a small cove, near the south-east point of Huafo, we anchored, but broke a bower-anchor in doing so; for the cove is small—an unexpected puff of wind gave us too much way—and dropping the bower in haste, it fell upon arock, and broke.§ Only two days before another anchor was broken, near Socorro, by the ship pitching while a short scope of cable was out, and the anchor hooking to arock. I found, on landing, that the formation of the island, like that of Socorro and Narborough Island, isa soft sandstone; which can be cut with a knife as easily as a cake of chocolate. * “ Neither the chart in Ulloa, nor any of the Spanish charts lately in use, show the name of N.S. del Socorro to any island near the coast here- abouts. The Spanish Atlas of 1798, places an island very near the coast; in 44° 50’ S, latitude, which in shape and situation answers nearly to Nar- borough’s description of the island, to which he gave his own name.”— (Burney, vol. iii. p. 360. Note.) + “ Isaw no kind of mineral in it. Not finding this island noted in any draught (chart), I called it after my own name, Narbrough Island, and took possession of it for his Majesty and his heirs.”—(Narborough’s Voyage to Patagonia and Chile, in 1669-1671.) { Called by Narborough ‘“‘ No-man’s Island.” § Or between two rocks, so that the first sudden strain snapped the shank. 366 HUAMBLIN MOUNTAIN—VALLENAR. . Dec. These three outlying islands are thickly wooded, rather level, compared with their neighbours, and not exceeding eight hun- dred feet in height. There are few, if any others, like them in the Chonos Archipelago ; almost all the rest, however portions of some may resemble them, being mountainous, and very like those of Tierra del Fuego and the west coast of Patagonia, beyond 47° south; therefore I need only: remark, that the vegetation is more luxuriant ; that there isa slight difference in it, consequent probably upon a milder climate; that some productions, such as canes and potatoes, &c., are found there which do not grow near the Strait of Magalhaens ; and that in other respects, as to appearance, nature, and climate, the Chonos Archipelago is like Tierra del Fuego in summer. We remained a few days in San Pedro harbour; and on the 9th Mr. Sulivan and his party joined us. Next day Mr. Stokes and I endeavoured to get to the top of the moun- tain named Huampelen, Huamblin, or San Pedro; but after climbing, creeping, struggling, and tumbling about, among old decayed trees, strongly interwoven canes, steep, slippery places, and treacherous bog, we failed, and gave up the attempt. Mr. Darwin, Douglas, and others were with me, but we were all foiled. 11th. Having despatched Mr. Sulivan, with the same party excepting Mr. Darwin, we got under weigh, and hastened towards the middle of the Chonos group, in order to find a port whence Mr. Stokes might set out to explore northwards, while I should examine the southern half of the archipelago. 13th. We succeeded in finding a sheltered, and apparently safe anchorage in a road named by me Vallenar, because it corresponded in situation to an island so called in an old chart, said to be of the Chonos, but which bore no resemblance what- ever to them. However, being anxious to remove no neigh- bour’s landmark,” and retain original names, when they could be ascertained, I kept them wherever I was able to doso. As to the native names, those given by Indians, I had not the means of finding them out, for no inhabitants were seen ; but, so far as Moraleda had collected them from his Indian inter- 1834. MORALEDA—NOTICES OF CHONOS. 367 preters, and made them known by his chart,* I have scrupu- lously followed him.+ 16th. Mr. Stokes set out, in a whale-boat, to work north- wards, as near the sea-coast as possible, and meet me at a har- bour in the Huaytecas group of islands, now called Port Low. He was accompanied by Mr. Low, Mr. May,{ and four men.§ Moraleda, in his diary and chart, describes a channel which crosses the Chonos Archipelago, and is called by the natives ‘ Ninualac.’||, Through this passage the Chonos Indians used to go once or twice a year to inspect the small herds of goats, or flocks of sheep which they then had upon those outlying is- lands I have already mentioned, namely Huamblin4] (Socorro), and Ipun (Narborough) ; as well as upon others, of which I be- lieve Lemu, a woody island on the north side of Vallenar Road, was one. Moraleda himself explored part of the continent, and some of the islands adjacent to it (between 1786 and 1796), but he saw nothing of the sea face of the Chonos. What few notices of it existed, prior to 1834, were obtamed from the voyage of Ladrilleros in 1557; from the Anna Pink in 1741 ; from Machado in 1769; and from the Santa Barbara in 1792; which, when compared together, tended to confuse a hydro- grapher more than they assisted him. In Spanish charts of the coast from Cape Tres Montes northward to Taitaohao- huon (a name long enough to perplex more verbose men than sailors) from which all others, of that coast, were copied, that portion must have been originally laid down according to mag- * Now in my possession. + His Huamblin and Ipun I take to be Socorro and Narborough Islands, but am not certain. { Having very little occupation on board, in his own particular line, just at that time, Mr. May volunteered to take an oar, as one of the boat’s erew. § Orders in Appendix, No. 22. || “‘ Gran Canal de Ninualac, que atraviese el Archipiélago, por el in- forme del practico Huenupal que casi anualmente la transita con el motivo expresado en el Diario.’”’—(Moraleda’s MS. Chart, 1795.) §] Huamblin, if, as I suppose it, a corruption of Huampelen, means ‘ on watch,’ ‘posted as a sentinel :’ Ipun means ‘ swept off,’ or ‘swept away :’ Lemu means ‘ wood :’ names singularly applicable to each of those islands respectively. 368 ULLOA—LADRILLEROS. Dec: netic, instead of true bearing; and the fragments of know- ledge acquired, about the latitude of 46° S., from the master of the Anna Pink, the pilot Machado, and the officers of the Santa Barbara frigate, clashed so much that their result was what we see in the charts hitherto used, a dotted line, and a few straggling islands, totally unlike the truth, leading one to expect a comparatively open space, whereas there is a succes- sion of high and considerable islands, so near one another, that from the offing they ‘ make’ like a solid unbroken coast. While on this subject I may remind the reader that besides the expeditions above-mentioned, the missionary voyages des- cribed by Agiieros (Appendix, No. 23), the important under- taking of Sarmiento, and the disastrous voyage of the Wager, there have been other visitors to the west coast of Patagonia, part of whose acquired information, though slight, is upon record. In 1552, two ships, commanded by Don Francisco de Ulloa, were sent by Valdivia to gain some knowledge of the Strait of Magalhaens.* The journal of their voyage is not extant. Five years afterwards (in 1557), Don Garcia Hurtado, Viceroy of Peru, sent two vessels to examine the southern part of the coast of Chile, as far as the Strait of Magalhaens. The commander was Juan Ladrilleros, and with him were two pilots, named ' Hernan Gallego and Pedro Gallego. A mutiny took place, and one ship deserted, but with the other Ladrilleros persevered, passed four months in the Strait at anchor during the winter, then reconnoitred the eastern entrance, and afterwards sailed back to Chile, where he at last arrived with only one seaman and a negro, the rest of his people having perished by expo- sure to hardships, by scurvy, or by famine. The principal geographical information obtained at so high a price, was some slight knowledge of Childe, and the archipelago of islands near it.—(Burney, vol. i. p. 246-9.) Sarmiento’s expedition in 1579-1580, has already been often quoted in the first volume of this narrative. In 1675 Antonio de Vea was sent from Peru in a ship, * Pastene, a Genoese, was, I believe, in this expedition, His MS. Journal is said to exist in the archives of Barcelona. Dec. 1834. DE VEA—SHARP—CONE CREEK. 369 accompanied by small barks, as tenders, to reconnoitre the Gulf of Trinidad, and the western entrance of Magalhaens Strait. De Vea made an examination of those places, and was convinced, from the poverty of the land, that no settlement of Europeans could be maintained there. One of the Spanish barks, with a crew of sixteen men, was wrecked on the’ small islands called Evangelists, at the west entrance of the Strait. De Vea returned to Callao in 1767.—(Burney, iv. 76.) In 1681, the notorious Sharp anchored in a gulf, surrounded by craggy mountains, whose tops were covered with snow, in 50°. 40’. south latitude; where “the difference of the rise and fall of the tide was seven feet perpendicular.” Sharp named the anchorage Shergall’s Harbour, the sound he called English Gulf; and the islands adjacent ** Duke of York’s Islands.” The account of this buccaneer’s visit is sufficiently connected with the object of this volume, to warrant my inserting it in the Appendix, copied verbatim from that interesting work, invaluable to seamen and hydrographers, Burney’s History of the Discoveries in the South Sea.* 18th Dec. The Beagle weighed and sailed out of Vallenar Road, after experiencing the shelter afforded by that anchor- age, during a heavy gale from the south-west and southward. At day-light on the 20th we were off Cape Tres Montes : having a fine day and smooth water, we surveyed the coast between that promontory and San Andres Bay, but it became dark before an anchorage could be gained. Next morning we anchored in a narrow creek, close by a singular cone (1,300 feet high), an unfailing landmark. -Finding it a place difficult to get out of, and not to be recommended, unless in distress, we did not stay there long, but moved to a cove at the south- west part of the bay. While under sail for this purpose, advan- * In this extract from Burney (Appendix No. 23), there is a criticism upon a hydrographical error, made by some copyist, which is interest- ing to me from its correspondence with what I suspect to have taken place in the old charts of Nassau Bay and Cape Horn.—(See pages 122, 123.) + Cone Creek. ¢t Christmas Cove. VOL. II, 2B 370 SAN ESTEVAN—DISTRESSED MEN, Dec. tage was taken of an interval of moderate weather to rum seve- ral miles along the coast northward, and back again. Strong gales set in afterwards and kept us prisoners several days. This Christmas was unlike the last: it was a sombre period. The wind. blew heavily (though we did not feel it much, being well shel- tered) ; all looked dismal around us; our prospects for the future were sadly altered; and our immediate task was the survey of another Tierra del Fuego, a place swampy with rain, tormented by storms, without the interest even of population : for hitherto we had neither found traces,* nor heard the voices of natives. 28th. Directly the weather would admit, we weighed and coasted along till the sun was getting low, when we ran under shelter from sea and wind, and anchored in the corner of a bay which I afterwards concluded must be the bay or port called Stephens, and more properly, San Estevan. While we were furling sails, some men were seen on a point of land near the ship, making signals to us in a very earnest manner. Being dressed as sailors, it was natural for us to con- clude that they were some boat’s crew left there to collect seal- skins. A boat was sent to them, and directly she touched the land they rushed into her, without saying a word, as men would if pursued by a dreaded enemy; and not till they were afloat could they compose themselves enough to tell their story. They were North American sailors, who had deserted from the Frances Henrietta (a whaler of New Bedford), in October 1833. When off Cape Tres Montes, but out of sight of land, and in the middle of the night, these six men lowered a boat and left their ship, intending to coast along until they should arrive at Childe. Their first landing was effected on the 18th, but owing to negligence the boat was so badly stove that they could not repair her, and all their hopes of effecting a coasting voyage were thus crushed in the very outset. * With one exception. On a height near Cone Creek Mr. Darwin found, in a sheltered hollow of the rock, strewed with dry grass, what appeared to him the place on which a man had slept. For some time this puzzled us considerably : probably a sealer had slept there. ea 1834. STORY OF RESCUED SAILORS. 371 Finding it impossible to penetrate far into the country, on account of its ruggedness, and thick forests, which, though only trifling in height, were almost impervious, they began a pilgrimage along-shore ; but it was soon evident, to their dis- may, that there were so many arms of the sea to pass round, and it was so difficult to walk, or rather climb, along the rocky shores, that they must abandon that idea also, and remain stationary. To this decision they were perhaps more inclined after the death of one of their number; who, in trying to cross a chasm between two cliffs, failed in his leap, fell, and was dashed to pieces. Their permanent abode was then taken up at the point which shelters Port San Estevan, now called Rescue Point ; where they passed a year in anxious hope. Of course the few provisions which their boat had carried ashore were soon exhausted, and for thirteen months they had lived only upon seals’ flesh, shell-fish, and wild celery: yet those five men, when received on board the Beagle, were in better condition, as to healthy fleshiness, colour, and actual health, than any five individuals belonging to our ship. Few remarks worth noticing had been made by them, as the only experienced man (whose name was John Lawson) lost his life as above-men- tioned. There was an almost continual succession of rain and wind for several months after their first landing, except from the 20th to the 29th of December, which passed without rain : in July (1834) they had an extraordinary storm from south-- west, which began early one morning, after a rainy night with northerly wind: and in November (1834) there were twenty-one days successively without rain. One day (in May) they saw eight vessels sailing northwards together ; excepting which, not a sail was ever seen by their aching eyes till the Beagle hove in sight. Between San Andres, near which they first landed, and San Estevan, the hull of a small vessel was found, quite bedded in sand; she seemed to be about thirty-five tons burthen, from thirty to thirty-five feet in the keel, and about sixteen broad. She was full-built ; neither coppered nor sheathed. In a cave, which had been used as a dwelling, near San Andres, the skull of a man was found, and some burned wood. A bracelet of 23.2 372 ANIMALS—TIDES— INCHE-MO. Dec. beads was lying in the cave, but they noticed nothing else. The skull seemed to them to have been that of a black man. No animals were seen at any time except deer and nutria, seal and otter ; the former were of a reddish colour, with short straight horns, and very rough coats: no traces of other quadrupeds were observed, nor during the whole fourteen months did they ever meet a native human being. They told me that the night tides seemed always to be a foot or more higher than’ those of the day, which, as they said, rose from four to seven or eight feet perpendicularly. I had intended to explore the interior of Port San Estevan; but as they had already done so, and found it terminate in a fresh water river, or rather mountain stream, I gave up that plan, and sailed next day. 29th. While examining the coast towards Cape Taytao* (I must omit haohuon), we found a very dangerous patch of rocks,+ five miles from the nearest land; there are soundings near them. In the evening we dropped our anchor under Inche- mo Island ; an interesting locality, because there the Anna Pink anchored before she was drifted across the adjacent bay into Port Refuge (in 1741). 30th. On landing an old wooden hut was discovered in a sheltered corner, and we found that the island was over- run with goats, which I suppose to have been left by the Santa Barbara’s crew, if not by Machado’s people. While Mr. Stokes and I were engaged with the instruments, and two boats sounding, a couple of guns were sent against the goats, and in consequence of their effectual employment in the hands: of Mr. Bynoe and H. Fuller, all on board had a good fresh meal - the next two days. After noon we sailed across the Bay,} and found a snug, though very small cove,§ where we moored in security, and remained till the 4th of January, exploring the neighbourhood—an unprofitable wilderness of rocky moun- tains, woody and swampy valleys, islands and rocks in pro- * Cape Taytao is a high bold promontory. + Hellyer Rocks. + Now called Anna Pink Bay. § Patch Cove. Jan. 1835. PORT REFUGE—SAN RAFAEL. 3738 fusion, and inlets or arms of the sea penetrating in every direction. On the 4th we moved to Port Refuge, a safe, but out of the way place. In the “ narrative of what befel the Anna Pink,” given in Anson’s Voyage, this harbour is described in very glowing colours; but we may remember that those who dis- covered it, were there saved from destruction; and naturally looked upon all things around them with excited feelings.* How the officers of the Santa Barbara made their survey of this port and its neighbourhood I am ata loss to know; a mere eye-sketch, drawn upon the spot, might have been much better than that which they gave to the world as a mathema- tical plan. In their distorted representation of Port Refuge, many soundings have been scattered, apparently at random, and quite at variance with truth. This is so unlike most Spanish works of a similar nature, some of which are very accurate,+ considering the date of their manufacture, and the means em- ployed,—that I conclude the officers of that frigate, not under- standing marine surveying, merely drew rough sketches of what they saw, which were afterwards ‘cooked’ into a more regular ‘appearance,’ by some one who was not on board with them. Had time allowed I should have explored the Gulf of San Rafael, at the back of Tres Montes Peninsula,} but know- ing that it could only be an object. of geographical, not imme- diately practical interest to do so, [ refrained from indulging mere curiosity, much as I desired to corroborate the account of Spanish missionaries who often went there, crossing the Isthmus of Ofqui, in search of Indians among the Guaianeco islands, and even farther south, of whom they might make converts to Christianity. Doubtless some of these voyages were undertaken and completed with benevolent and _single- minded intentions; but I suspect that others were conducted. on a different principle; and that their chief object was to procure able-bodied slaves to be employed in the mines of * Anson’s Voyage, chapter iii. + Exclusive of mistakes made by compilers or translators. { Appendix, No. 24. 3874 PORT LOW—STOKES’S JOURNAL. Jan. Chil6e or Southern Chile. I should be glad to learn that this suspicion is ill-founded.* On the 7th we anchored in Port Low, and found Mr. Stokes just arrived, after a fagging cruise among the Chonos islands. His journal contains a great deal of information, from which I have extracted those passages most likely to interest the gene- ral reader. His whale-boat was so loaded at starting (16th Dec.) that her gunwale amidships was but a foot above water. She was twenty-five feet long and six feet broad, and then carried seven men, besides instruments and a month’s provisions. Of water she had only two ‘ barecas,’ because on that coast fresh water is only too plentiful. In passing a promontory, the following day, while their boat was still deep, the swell became so great that Mr. Low said he had never before been in a boat exposed to greater danger. In some places where they landed the woods were so thick that Mr. Stokes was obliged to climb trees to get angles ; and not being able to tell previously which would answer his pur- pose, sometimes he made three or four useless ascents, before he could obtain a view: “ but,” he says “ there is a pleasure I cannot express in roaming over places never visited by civilized man.” On Rowlett Island potatoes were found growing wild ; the largest dug up measured two inches in length, and an inch in thickness: they were quite tasteless. At the east side of Ipun, on Narborough Island, an excellent small port was found, which was named Scotchwell Harbour. On the shore, near it, was a large bed of strawberries, like those that grow in English woods; and there was a sweet-scented pea, besides abundance of other vegetable produce, both her- bage and wood, and plenty of water. ‘** Hitherto, all the islands we had seen were of slate-rock, some parts so soft, that I could break them easily with my finger, and I found that they blacked my hand, like plumbago ; * It is difficult to account for the present abandoned state of these regions, if no harsh usage was experienced by their former natives. 1835. CHONOS ISLANDS—WILD POTATO. 375 but Ipun is quite different in structure, being an earthy sand- stone.”* Syzygial high water at Ipun takes place at noon, and the tide rises six or eight feet. The flood-tide comes from the southward. At May Harbour (which may be the Bello Dique of the Santa Barbara), many cypress trees were noticed, for the first time hereabouts, and a surprising number of otters. The tide rose seven feet. About the Huaytecas Islands, the northern- most of the Archipelago, quantities of excellent oysters were found, quite as good as any sold in London. No quadrupeds were seen, except nutria and otters, which were numerous. Their numbers, and the quantity of birds, show that Indians do not now frequent that quarter ; indeed, no traces of them whatever were found by Mr. Stokes, or any of our party, among the Chonos islands. 10th. While lying at Port Low we caught plenty of fish with the seine ; we obtained oysters from neighbouring creeks, and shot ducks and geese, so there was no want of fresh pro- vision. Some piraguas from Childe were in the port: the Chilotes in them were in search of otters, seals, and nutria, and had come across the gulf of Huafo, in their ill-conditioned ves- sels, with no little trepidation. On an outlying islet, near Port Low, I first saw the wild potato. Next to seeing a wild man, I recollect few objects which struck me much more than that group of wild potatoes :—but I have neither inclination nor space here to speak of my own sensations. The stems, leaves, and flowers of these vegetables were as large, and appeared to be as healthy, as those in an English garden, but the potatoes at their roots were small, watery, and insipid. It ought to be recollected, however, that we saw them early in J anuary—corresponding to July— many weeks, at least, before one could expect to find eatable potatoes in an English field. It was remarked in the Chonos islands, as well as in Tierra del Fuego, that the trees which grow in thin soil, lying upon * Stokes, MS. 376 ROOTS OF TREES—MELI-MOYU. Jan. slaty rocks, extend their roots so horizontally that it is not surprising to find, running through woodland, broad tracts whence the shallow-rooted trees have been swept away, partly by wind, partly by the action of mountain-torrents.* As wood grows even at the water’s edge in those countries, where not exposed to the first attack of wind from seaward, and as there are so many loose overhanging masses of rock, one cannot be surprised at the vast quantities of drift-wood found in some places; or think it improbable for a quadruped to be occa- sionally precipitated into the sea, with a falling mass of rocks and trees, and afterwards drifted by wind and current to some other locality. From Port Low we saw a notable mountain, one of the Cordillera of the Andes, having three points upon a small flat top, about eight thousand feet above the sea. I called it the Trident at that time ; but afterwards learned that there are four peaks (one of which was hid by another from our point of view), and that it is called by the aborigines Meli-moyu, which in the Huilli-che language signifies four points. Three other remarkable mountains, active volcanoes, are visible from the northern Huaytecas islands, as well as from Childe; I mean the Corcobado (hump-backed), of which I do not remember the Indian name ; Yanteles (or Yanchinu, which * The writer of Anson’s voyage, speaking of Juan Fernandez, exactly describes the loose state of trees in such places, when he says, “ The nor- thern part of this island is composed of high, craggy hills, many of them inaccessible, though generally covered with trees. The soil of this part is loose and shallow, so that very large trees on the hills soon perish for want of root, and are then easily overturned, which occasioned the death of one of our sailors ; who being upon the hills, in search of goats, caught hold of a tree upon a decliyity, to assist him in his ascent, and this giving way, he immediately rolled down the hill; and though in his fall he fas- tened on another tree of considerable bulk, yet that, too, gave way, and he fell among the rocks, and was dashed to pieces. Mr. Brett likewise met with an accident, only by resting his back against a tree, near as large about as himself, which stood on a slope; for the tree giving way, he fell to a considerable distance, though without receiving any injury.”— (Anson’s Voyage, 8vo. edit., p. 159.) 1835. VOLCANOES—NAMES—HUAFO. 377 means ‘having a shivering, and unnatural heat’), and Minchen- madom, which, in the Huilli-che tongue, means ¢ under a fire- brand’; names so expressive and appropriate as to put to shame much of our own nomenclature. Wherever I have been able to discover the aboriginal name of a place in South America, and could ascertain its meaning, I have been struck by the extreme appositeness, as well as by the copious though condensed allu- sion usually conveyed. In Childe and about the north-eastern Chonos Islands, almost all the aboriginal names are preserved, because there interpre- ters could be procured ; but, of course, such advantages were generally unattainable in Patagonia and Tierra del Fuego. In Childe, as in Araucania, every corner and every con- spicuous spot, whether land or water, has a particular and expressive name, a word usually compounded of two or three others: thus, Huapi-quilan means Three Islands: Calbu-co, Blue Water; Cauca-huapi, Gull Island ; Huechu-cucuy, Point Cucuy,* or Grandmother ; Carel-mapu (Cara-el-mapu), Bad-city-country ; Petu-cura, middle stone (a rock in Chacao Narrow), &c. 15th. We sailed from Port Low and went to Huafo once more, wishing to give Mr. Darwin an opportunity of examining it geologically. There are now no inhabitants on that island, though there are a good many sheep belonging to Chilotes, who live at Caylin. Formerly there were Indians called Huy- huen-che,t upon Huafo; but the Spaniards obliged them to quit it, for fear they should give information or supplies to English ships. Near the Beagle, when at anchor, there was a square place, like an entrance to some cave, seemingly cut by man in the soft sand-stone rock; and I have since often reproached myself for having left the place without ascertaining * Cucuy is the name of a bird, much noticed by the aborigines because its motions are supposed to be ominous: it also means grandmother. + The Huyhuen-che, often called Huyhuenes, were a tribe of Chonos Indians, adjoining the Pichi-huilli-che, who lived in the northern portion of Chilée. The word Huyhuen signifies whistle,’ or ‘ hiss,’ or ‘to whistle, or hiss.’ 378 POINT ARENA—VOLCANO ACTIVE. Jam its real nature. It may be the entrance to some cave, formerly used as a burying-place, similar to those explored by Low, and by the surgeon of the Wager. On the 17th we sailed, and next day anchored off Point Arena, in San Carlos Harbour. Lieutenant Sulivan, with his party, had arrived a few days previously, after a very satisfac- tory cruise. We found his boats hauled up and refitted, his people lodged under their tents, and himself with Mr. Usborne busily occupied in my little observatory, laying down the work for which they had collected materials. Thus we were again assembled in safety, after being considerably divided, and, in consequence, exposed to numerous dangers which human pru- dence can neither foresee nor prevent. As some soundings were still wanted near the English bank, and about the approach to San Carlos, we employed the 19th in taking them, on board the Beagle, accompanied by her boats, and returned to our usual anchorage, close to Point Arena, at dark. When sounding on the English bank, we repeatedly tried to ascertain its nature by forcing a very long iron lance down- wards as far as possible. The instrument penetrated about two feet into sand in all instances but one, when it was stopped abruptly by a substance which bent the lance and turned its point. It did not, however, feel like rock, rather, I should say, like hard wood.* This hard place was about a square yard in extent, and all around was sand. In the night, or rather from two to three the following morning, Osorno was observed in eruption, throwing up bril- liant jets of flame or ignited matter, high into the darkness, while lava flowed down its steep sides in torrents, which from our distance (seventy-three miles) looked merely like red lines. Daybreak diminished the effect, and as the light increased only a dark column of smoke could be discerned. This mountain is one of the most striking in form which I ever saw. It is not only quite conical from the base to the summit, but it is so sharply pointed that its appearance is very artificial. When seen * Mr. Sulivan had the lance in his hand at that time. » Feb.1835. OSORNO—SAN CARLOS——CHILOE. 379 from the sea, at a distance of ninety or a hundred miles, the whole of the cone, 6,000 feet in height* at least, and covered with snow, stands out in the boldest relief from among ranges of inferior mountains. The apex of this cone being very acute, and the cone itself regularly formed, it bears a resemblance to a gigantic glass-house ; which similitude is increased not a little by the column of smoke so frequently seen ascending. We remained till the 4th of February in the port of San Carlos. Mr. Darwin profited by the opportunity afforded to make an excursion into the interior of the island, while the surveying party were occupied in arranging data, in laying down chart-work, and in taking and calculating observations. I paid Douglas for his services and for a variety of informa- tion collected for me, from which—from Lieut. Sulivan’s journal—and from my own notes—I shall now add such few notices of Childe as I think may be interesting, and which have not been already introduced in the first volume. (pp. 269—301.) Various accounts have been given of the characters and dispositions of the Chilotes. Some have said that they are a noble, industrious, and docile race; others that they are dis- honest, idle, and ill-disposed : to reconcile these contradictory accounts is, therefore, at first sight, rather perplexing. There are four distinct classes of inhabitants in Childe and the adja- cent islands ;+ the aboriginal Huyhuen-che, or Chonos; the Huilli-che, who came from southern Chile; the foreigners, those neither born in Childe nor descended from Chilotes; and the Creoles. Of these the Chonos are now nearly lost : in con- sequence of disease and emigration they have by degrees aban- doned not only Childe but the adjacent Chonos islands, and are only found southward. Some Indians to the south-west of Castro, in the interior of the island near the lake Cucao, * The voleano of Osorno, or Purraraque, or Huefiauca, is 7,550 feet above the sea level. + The smaller islands of the Archipelago of Childe, those in the gulf between Childe and the main-land, called the Gulf of Ancoed or Ancud. 380 NATIVES—HUILLI-CHE—CHONOS. Feb. are under the nominal jurisdiction of their own caciques: whether they are Chonos or Huilli-che, I did not ascertain clearly. Being a race who are naturally little inclined to cul- tivate the soil, and preferring a comparatively idle life among muscles, seal, and fish, to voluntary labour on their own account, with a considerable degree of compulsory toil for the Spanish Government and priests, they quitted Childe in suc- cessive families. From them, probably, are derived the glim- merings of religion, and the crosses among the Indians of Madre de Dios, and other parts of the west coast of Patagonia. That their canoes or rather piraguas, should be similar to those of Childe seems natural enough; but the fact is that the Chonos people taught the Huilli-che how to make them.* Coming from an inland district near Valdivia, the Huilli-che had. never required boats, though they knew how to cultivate potatoes, maize, and beans ; how to make ‘ ponchos,’ and take care of sheep and cattle. These, though more industrious, and in some respects better members of society, are a tame and docile race compared with the Chonos, whose spirit of inde- pendence has shown itself in their migration, and impatience of mis-government. The principal population of Childe is now Huilli-che, no- minally Christian but painfully ignorant of pure Christianity - Abandoned to the crooked direction of ungodly pastors, intent upon their own worldly interest instead of the welfare of their flock, extorting ‘ primicias’+ and tithes from poor Indians, whom they scarcely see once in a year (I speak advisedly)—and taught only the Romish doctrine in its worst form; can any one expect the poor Chilotes to be really religious and conse- quently moral? That they should be extremely superstitious is much more probable, and such is the fact. Their’s is a confused demi-religion, in which a medley of ideas concerning the Virgin Mary, saints, images, and witches,} is found far * These piraguas are extremely like the Madras surf-boats. (See vol. i- p. 285, for a description of the piragua. + First fruits of everything, animal as well as vegetable. t They are implicit believers in witcheraft. 1835. RELIGION—KINDNESS—TRADE. 381 more often than any clear reference to our Saviour or the Almighty. In the foregoing remarks on the Roman Catholic priests at Childe whom I conversed with and heard much about between 1829 and 1835, I do not include all. There was certainly one man (I hope there were more) whom I believe to have been as sincerely pious, and therefore good, as any Roman Catholic, but there were others whose lives scandalized even their nomi- nal Christianity. The foreigners settled in Childe of course resemble their own countrymen as to morals and habits, not being likely to take example from the Indians: and the Creoles adopt their ideas as hastily as our milliners adopt French fashions. But there is a virtue in Childe, which if sins could be atoned for by the good works of man alone, would go far towards pur- chasing good treatment and very slight purgatory for the souls of Chilotes: I mean the warni-hearted kindness shewn to one another, and particularly to strangers. Conspicuous as such. a feeling of hospitality and disinterested good-nature is among the descendants of Spaniards in South America, it is no where more to be observed than in Childe. Increased intercourse with other countries is annually dimi- nishing the local peculiarities of Chilote society, a remarkable one being that of transacting mercantile business by barter, for want of current coin. Planks of alerse, indigo, tobacco, pepper, salt, &c. were substitutes for silver and gold in 1829, excepting among a very few foreigners or comparatively rich descendants of Spaniards and Creoles. At that time it was extremely difficult to get a few dollars in exchange for a bill upon good security at Valparaiso, even at the exorbitant price of sixty-pence English for each dollar. In 1834, so much had the state of trade improved at San Carlos, that there was no difficulty in obtaining as many dollars as we wanted for forty- eight pence each. In the first volume most of the products of Chiloe are men- tioned, except fish and coal. Of the shell-fish there is a full 382 FISH—COAL—CASTRO. Feb. account, but I may here add that smelt, mullet, a kind of bass, and other fish are plentiful during the summer months. The natives often catch many more than they want by placing very simple weirs across creeks at high-water, with a passage in the middle, which is shut when the tide begins to ebb. Some of these weirs are rough stone walls (on a small scale), others are wattled like hurdles. The number of fish kept back by them and left dry, as the water falls, is really sur- prising. Seals are now rare, and whales are fast diminishing in numbers. There is a good deal of coal in Chil6e, but I am told that it is of an inferior description, like that of Concep- cion. Geologists say it is not true coal: lignite would be a more appropriate term. Be this as it may I tried some of it* in my cabin stove, and found it burn readily, though what I had was a lump taken from the surface of the ground. The Chilotes scarcely noticed it then, having so much wood around them, but a day may arrive in which its value may be better appreciated. Next to San Carlos,+ in size and population, is Castro, the former seat of Government, which has dwindled to a mere village. Chacao, where the governor afterwards resided, is only a hamlet. Remains of a town, such as lines of streets and the ruins of a church, are visible, but there are now only a few straggling cottages and a ruinous chapel. It is said, on the spot, that the former church of Chacao was burned by the old Spaniards, to oblige the natives to quit the place and go to San Carlos. Castro, formerly styled a city, now consists of two or three short streets of bad wooden houses and two churches : one of which was built by the Jesuits more than a hundred years ago, and is fast decaying though ‘ shored up’ (supported by props) on all sides. The first discovery of Chiloe was made by Spaniards in 1558, one of whom was Ercilla. Enthusiastic in every thing, the warrior-poet tells us that he ran to a tree, half-a-mile south * Obtained for me by Mr. Robert Williams from the neighbourhood of San Carlos. + Described in vol. i. p. 274-5. 1835. ERCILLA—POPULATION—MINES. 383. of the place where his companions halted, and cut some lines on the bark.* The populous state of Childe, in 1558, when first visited by Europeans may be estimated by Ercilla’s description, allow- ing for poetical license. All accounts agree in stating that the Chonos Indians, or Huyhuen-che, were once very numerous. ‘“¢ Era un ancho archipielago poblado De innumerables islas deleytosas, Cruzando por el uno y otro lado Géndolas y piraguas presurosas : * * * ? * * Lleg6 una corva gondola ligera De doce largos remos impelida.” La Araucawa, Cantos xxxv and xxxvi. That the Spaniards then with Ercilla, were thought to be deities, is shown by the following lines :— ‘‘ Hombres, o Dioses rtisticos, nacidos En estos sacros bosques y montaiias, Por celeste influencia producidos,” &c. Ipem, Canto xxxvi. Some years afterwards (in 1566) Castro was founded, to be the capital, and Chacao for a sea-port. From this time till about 1633 mines were worked in Childe, but then discon- tinued, partly because they were less productive than those of Chile, and partly on account of the difficulty of obtaining labourers after a raging epidemic had carried off one-third of the aboriginal inhabitants; and fear of infection as well as horror of the mining slavery, .had driven away a large portion of the residue.+ About this time the Huilli-che were carried to * “ Agui llegdé, donde otro no ha llegado, Don Alonso de Ercilla, que el primero En un pequeno barco deslastrado Con solos diez, pas6 el desaguadero El afio de cincuenta y ocho entrado Sobre mil y quinientos por Hebrero, A las dos de la tarde el postrer dia, Volviendo 4 la dexada compaiia.” La Araucana, Canto xxxvi. + These were Huyhuenes, or Chonos, whose place was afterwards supplied by Huilli-che from southern Chile. 384 HUILLI-CHE—CHILOUE—PIRATES. Feb. Chil6e, in addition to those who had accompanied the fugitives from Osorno (in 1599—1604) to Calbuco, Carel-mapu, and thence to Childe ; who being a docile patient race, accustomed to agriculture, increased rapidly and supplanted the Chonos emigrants. We read in the narrative of Brouwer’s voyage (1643) that the port which the Dutch called Brouwer’s Haven, was by some called Chilova, and by others English Haven: and in 1624, according to Agiieros (quoting D. Cosme Bueno), Englishmen were on this coast: but I think it more probable that the Bank Ingles and Port Ingles, near San Carlos, ob- tained those names from William Adams, in 1599,* rather than from them. In the Dutch chart published with the journal, this island is called Chiloue, and the adjacent gulf, Ankaos, or Ancoed.+ Brouwer alarmed the inhabitants of Childe not a little, but they were even more frightened and harassed before that time by Cordes, in 1600; Spilbergen, in 1615; and afterwards by Shelvocke, in 1719; besides others. To guard against, or rather watch for such visitors, as well as to obtain the earliest intelligence of an enemy being on the coast, the Spaniards established look-out stations in com- * Voyage of Five Ships of Rotterdam, Burney, vol. ii. p. 193. (sup- posing 46° should be 42° S.) t+ I mention this to show that the accent, or stress, was then upon the second syllable of that name, not upon the third. The name Childe is derived from Chilue, or, more strivtly speaking, from Chili-hue (see Agiieros and Molina), which means ‘< farther,’ or ‘ new,’ or ‘the end of’ Chili, and ought, by derivation, to have the accent, as Agiieros placed it, on the o. No reason can be given by a Spaniard for placing an accent on the final e of that word, yet it is almost generally placed there. My own idea is that the French traders to Chile in 1700—1780, first placed an accent on thee in writing, and that Feuillée, Frezier, and others have been followed without inquiry. Had not the stress been laid on the o, surely the natives of Chiloe would have been called Chiloetes, or Chiloe- nos, instead of Chilotes. As to the name Chile, every one knows it is derived from the Indian word Chili, (Herrera, Ovalle, Agiieros, Mo- lina, &c.) but why it was altered by the Spaniards to Chile, I have never been able to discover. 1835. TETHES—OPPRESSION—TASKS. 385 manding positions and outer points, such as Cocotue heights, Guabun Head, and Point Centinela; but at the present time no such precautions being thought necessary, there is a supine indifference to molestation. Wherever Mr. Sulivan went with our boats, nearly all the Indians showed an anxiety for the island to be again under the dominion of Old Spain, and asserted that they were much happier and more prosperous before the revolution than they had ever been since. In a place where he passed two days (Huildad) there was an unusual difficulty in obtaining provi- sions, and it was accounted for by the natives in the follow- ing manner: the proprietor of the tithes had just been there, and had taken from them, in sheep and pigs, the full tenth, not only of those animals, but of the growing crops of corn, apples, and potatoes. He had taken away all that the poor people could be deprived of, excepting only what was abso- lutely necessary as stock for next year’s supply. Lieut. Sulivan says, in his journal :—*‘ Besides the tithes, they have also to give ‘first fruits’ to the priests, and so hard are they on their parishioners, with respect to tithes and first fruits, that whether the yearly produce be bad or good, the same quantity must be contributed to swell the revenue of a person whom they seldom see, except at the times of collection.” This oppression, however, is not allowed by the superiors of the Church, when it is duly represented and proved: for not long ago a curate was dismissed from his parish in Childe, because he was a severe extortioner: I was informed that during five years that man had amassed more than thirty thousand dol- lars.* Some of the natives complained bitterly to Lieut. Sulivan of the task-work they were compelled to perform. At Lemuy he met a small piragua with only three men in it, who were on their way from Castro to Quelan. They had walked across the island from San Carlos where they had been working at the new mole, which all the ‘militia’ were obliged * The number stated to me was 35,000. + Every able-bodied native man is enrolled in the local militia, and obliged to work thus till disabled by infirmity. VOL. Il, 2c 386 PATRIOTS—SPAIN—CLIMATE. Jan. Feb. to do in turn, each man a fortnight: part of which time was allowed for the journey. These three had worked eight days, finding themselves in everything and receiving no pay; two were old men: one more than sixty years of age; and the third was the oldest man’s son. They all declaimed against the so-called ‘ Patriots’ (Chilians) very vehemently, and asked repeatedly when they might hope to see the Spanish flag hoisted again. The old man had been a cacique, and under the Spanish authority had charge of a watch-house and a small party of men, on Point Centinela: but directly the Spaniards were overthrown he was made a private militia-man—“ not to fight,” he said, “ but to work.” If any public work was in progress, a party of militia-men were ordered to it, in their respective turns: and if the commandant had a friend to oblige, who wanted a job done, he would order a man to work at it for a week, when another would take his place, and so on. For these services no pay was given. The old man said that they were paid in money for every service performed when under the Spaniards ; and he could hardly be made to believe that there was no prospect of their returning. There is a marked difference of climate between the east and west sides of Childe, as to quantity of rain and wind. A proportion of both appears to be arrested (as it were) on the windward side of the heights, so that the neighbourhood of Castro and the islands in the Gulf of Ancud, enjoy much finer weather than is met with about San Carlos. But even there the inhabitants say a change has taken place gradually, and that they have not now nearly so much rain as used to fall formerly. ‘They attribute this to the wood being cleared away, not only on Childe itself, but on the neighbouring Cordillera. There is an idea prevalent in Childe that, after a great erup- tion of Osorno in particular, or indeed of any of the neigh- bouring volcanoes, fine weather is sure to follow. Without denying the possibility of some such correspondence, I should incline to think that there have been accidental coincidences ; and that fine weather occurring about or soon after those times, has been more remarked than at other periods. 1835. ALAU—CALBUCO—DOCKS. 387 On the little uninhabited island, Chiut, in the middle of Ancud Gulf, Mr. Sulivan founda great number of wild straw- berries: they were not very good, being unripe. Near the islands beyond Chiut (called Desertas), on the shore of the main-land, he saw several piraguas stranded, evidently during a Jate gale, as their crews were engaged in repairing them on the beach. In the island Alau, Lieut. Sulivan met an old native, about 112 years of age; who had great-grandchildren about him, from twelve to fourteen years old. His eyesight and intel- lectual faculties were still good, and he walked firmly. From the inhabitants of Alau, Mr. Sulivan heard that an English armed brig, accompanied by a Spanish vessel of war, had an- chored at that island about seventy years before 1835 (1765). Our boats visited Calbuco, and happening to arrive during the time of Mass, found nobody stirring. At last one man came out of church—ran back instantly—as if to tell the news, and immediately hundreds came pouring out to see the strangers. Calbuco, called also El] Fuerte, is much superior to Castro in appearance as well as size. It ranks next to San Carlos, in consequence to the Chilotes. Near here it was that friendly Indians helping the distressed inhabitants of Osorno to escape from the Araucanians (1599-1605), raised a cry of Calbu-co (blue water), when, emerging from the woodland, they caught a glimpse of the sea. Our party examined places on the east coast of Childe, where docks might be constructed, or vessels laid ashore with much facility, as the tide rises from fifteen to twenty-five feet in several land-locked coves where the swell of the ocean never penetrates. Round Chil6e the flood tide-streams run both ways, from the south-west ; and meet in the north-west part of Ancud Gulf ; the times of syzygial high water, in all the archipelago, vary only from noon to an hour and half after noon. In December and January our boat expedition found that the night tides were _always higher than those of the day, and the inhabitants said that was always the case in summer. In the months of J uly and VOL. Il. 2c2 aw CA 388 HUILLI-CHE—SUPERSTITIONS. Jan. Feb. August 1829 the day tides were higher than the night, I am quite certain ; and an old Biscayan, resident near point Arena, told me that they were always so in winter: hence we may conclude they are regularly higher at that time of year. I refrain from entering here into many very interesting customs of the Huilli-che, because they are almost the same as those of the Araucanian Indians, about whom so much has been sung or said by Ercilla, Molina, and others, because my pages are limited, there being still information of a newer character to be written; but I would ask the reader, who may feel interested about the migrations of our race, to compare such customs with those of the Polynesian islanders, especially that of the ‘ Minga,’ and making ¢ Cava.’ * The superstitious ideas, arising out of a debased Romish doctrine, have not deprived the Huilli-che of their belief in witchcraft, a belief held in common. with all ignorant nations. Mr. Douglas, in his MS. Journal, says :—“ No Chilote doubts the existence of wizards (bruxos). When I was a magistrate, a complaint was made to me of a young woman who, they asserted, had tried to bewitch a young man. The witnesses stated that she had bought from a professed witch (bruxa) a charm (llapui), which was produced in evidence. It consisted of a piece of loadstone, with iron filings adhering to it ; some ‘fish-scales; some hair and soap suds, proved to have been on the young man’s face, and sold by the barber; some parings of his nails; a small dead lizard; some slips of a peculiar tree ; and many other ingredients. With this charm, with two pre- pared apples, and a bottle half full of a liquid mixed by the witch, she proposed to win the young man’s affections to such a degree that he would give her all his property. The liquid appeared to be a decoction of the deadly nightshade, and some poisonous ferns. The witnesses stated also, that this witch had a lantern made of the skin of a still-born child, which she lighted with a candle that burned with a blue flame; and gave * The Minga is described in Molina, and Spanish authors. For an excellent discussion respecting the Cava, see Burney—Brouwer’s Voyage, 1643, vol iii. p. 137, 8, 9. 1835. © BRUXOS "—WIZARDS—TREASURE. 389 out sparks, when the witch flew through the air from place to place. “T have been informed,” continues Mr. Douglas, “ upon in- disputable authority, that such lanterns do exist ; and that when two or more witches wish to communicate by signal, one of them ties a lantern to a long pole, and throws it up and down very quickly, making the sparks fly. The other then makes similar use of her lantern, at a considerable distance, and those who casually see the lights, think that a witch has flown from one place to the other. The magical art of the wizard is often exer- cised in a search for hidden treasure. There are some places where, in a dark night, inflammable gas, or phosphoric light, is seen, near theground, not like a Will-o’-th’-wisp of Europe, but a clear steady light, of a white, yellow, or red colour. Popular superstition ascribes these lights to the ghosts of departed misers, watching their hidden treasure; and when one is dis- covered by any person, he calls a friend to assist him and watch it, about the time of new moon, until they ascertain the spot whence it proceeds; and there they dig in search of an anticipated heap of gold or silver. Not succeeding (of course), they apply to a wizard, who pretends to discover where the treasure lies, and what it is, by looking earnest] y into a smooth slab of black stone (which I suppose to be basalt). The wizard may not himself find the prize, nor may he be present at the search ; but, after telling the people where and when to dig, he takes good care to alarm and frighten them away in some strange manner, just at the moment they expect to grasp the store of gold. Among other devices, the wizard, or witch, pretends to cover a worsted thread with quicksilver, and hold- ing it over the supposed place, allows the quicksilver to run off into the ground, and then he desires them to dig till they find the quicksilver, thus affording time for creating some sudden alarm, which they attribute to the ‘devoto,’ or familiar spirit of the deceased. It is believed by some that I am able to dis- cover hidden treasure, and for my amusement I have more than once made an experiment before them, by sticking up two stakes in a line towards the light; then going a quarter of a circle 390 CALBUCANO’S MODE OF LIFE. Jan. Feb. round it, I stuck up two more stakes, also in a line towards it ; and next day followed the lines to their crossing, at which spot I dug, and about two feet underground found a decayed tree.” (Whence a gaseous exhalation ?) Mr. Douglas’s account of the life of an industrious Calbu- cano* is interesting. He says, that those who are called ‘ hom- bres de bien’ (honest men) are generally the sons of worthy parents, and who marry, while young, some hard-working sober woman. Such a pair, as one of these men and his wife, sow some corn and plant potatoes, then leave the land, with their house, in the care of an old relation, and go to the Cordillera to work in an astillero.t If their luck is good, that is, if they find plenty of fine, straight grained trees, not farther than usual from the sea,} this pair will cut and bring down five hundred boards in a month; then returning home they clean the potato grounds, and attend to domestic affairs, until their feet heal, and a paralytic motion of the legs, acquired in the astillero, has ceased. When quite refreshed they go for another cargo, and work till their legs and feet can stand it no longer. A third trip is afterwards made by the husband, for about a fortnight, to a nearer astillero, where he cuts pieces of timber and plank of as large a size as he can carry (tablones y cuartones), then returns to collect his harvest, make chicha, and sow corn for next year. The winter months are passed in comparative in- activity, but not without due consumption of cider and pota- toes. Occasionally the Calbucano goes to San Carlos, to sell, or rather barter his boards for indigo, tobacco, red pepper, clothes, axes, spirits, &c.; and on these occasions, as well as when they go from Calbuco to the continent, several unite together to man a piragua, in the manner described by Cap- tain King, vol. i, p. 285-6. Directly his children are able to walk a few miles, he takes them with him to the astillero; begins by giving them two half-boards to carry, and as they grow stronger, increases their * Native of Calbuco. + A timber-yard: or a place where alerse is cut down, on the flanks of the Cordillera of the Andes. + From three to five miles. 1835. ALERSE FORESTS—SIZE OF TREES. 391 load. At about sixteen they borrow an axe, and make the boards they afterwards carry. The alerse forests are like mines to the Calbucano; and nothing but old age or accident can check him from making boards after he has had one season of good luck. The profitable parts of the forests are now, of course, much farther from the sea than they were, owing to constant thinning. To get a load of twenty boards twice as much labour is therefore required as was necessary for a similar purpose thirty years ago. The largest alerse tree that has been found by any Calbucano during the last forty years, measured. thirty feet in girth, at five feet from the ground ; and more than seventy-six feet to the first branches. This famous tree gave eight lengths of boards and half a length. The two largest trees seen by Mr. Douglas, in his excursion for me, measured one twenty-four, and the other twenty-two feet round, at five feet from the ground: but these were dead trees, hollow in the centre. He saw none above ten feet in circumference, that were quite sound. Report, however, says, that in the Cordillera, out of reach of the Calbuco woodsmen, there are enormous trees, from thirty to forty feet in girth, and from eighty to ninety feet in height to the first branches, above which the heads of those giant trees are said to rise some forty or fifty feet. The alerse has short, stout branches, with leaves like those of a pine, in their bluish green colour, but shorter, being only half an inch long, and one-twentieth of an inch wide: on one stem there are four rows of these small leaves, at opposite sides. Captain King has fully described the alerse (vol. i, p. 282-3), and the manner of making the boards. I will add a few no- tices of the way in which it is obtained. In carrying his load along many miles of bad road from an ‘astillero,” to the nearest water conveyance, the Calbucano wears a sheep-skin on his shoulders, under a woollen shirt, and taking a stick, with its lower end forked,* he trudges along * To steady him across bridges of single trees, thrown over ravines, as well as to assist in supporting the load. Sometimes they climb up or down precipices with their loads, by a fallen tree, notched to receive the feet. 392 LOADS—LAND-SLIPS—‘ CESARES.’ Jan. Feb. with the load on one shoulder, and on the other the stick, which partly supports the weight till one shoulder is tired; he then shifts the burthen to the other, and goes on. This half rest is called ‘cantuntun.’ After eight, ten, or twelve of these, according to his strength, and the road, he casts down the load, and rests about ten minutes. This is his ‘descanso ;’ and he makes about one such every two or three miles. The astil- lero of Melipulli is ten ‘ descansos,’ a whole day’s journey, from the place of embarkation. In examining the different forests of alerse, Mr. Douglas saw some immense land-slips (quechi), one of which was said to have brought down one thousand alerses, some of them being five fathoms round near the roots. This land-slip measured seven hundred yards in length and three hundred yards in width. Mr. Douglas finds much fault with the manner in which the Chilotes associate for a voyage, or any joint undertaking. He says, ‘‘their voyages being planned like a commonwealth, it follows that their government on board must be republican, and the consequence is that every thing is decided by most votes and most noise.” He also complains of their extreme selfishness, and of their reluctance to do any thing, however trifling, for a neighbour, unless for a consideration ; another evil consequence of democratic inclinations. When Moraleda was about Childe he went across the cor- dillera to the lake N ahuel-huapi, in quest of information rela- tive to the ‘ Cesares;’ but he could hear nothing positive about any such city or people, from the Indians whom he met near that lake—well known to the Spaniards as a jesuit mis- sionary station. Mr. Douglas’s father-in-law* once commanded a party sent from Childe to look for this reported city of ¢ Cesa- res.+ He got over and beyond the Cordillera to an elevated plain, where he saw a very large number of Indian huts (tol- dos), placed so as to form regular streets. Near them were large droves of horses and cattle, and small patches of culti- * A Spaniard of Castile. + Don Pedro de Angelis, of Buenos Ayres, has collected and published a great number of documents relating to the ‘ Cesares.’ 1835. DESERTERS—PADRE FORASTES. 393 vated ground: but he had no time to make further remarks, for his party was discovered, vigorously attacked and driven back, with loss, to the sea. The old man said the climate and soil of that plain were better than those of Childe: and, as a proof of it, he found Indian corn with from five to nine large heads, though in Childe the same kind of plant only bears from one to three small heads. A few of the remarks relative to Childe, contained in the preceding pages, arose out of an excursion made by me, in 1829, among the neighbouring islands: and many of the other notices mentioned by Captain King (vol.i.) or myself, and given in the narrative as they were received from our associates, were corroborated by what I then witnessed. The excursion alluded to was undertaken in consequence of two carpenters belonging to the Beagle being enticed to desert by a Roman Catholic priest named Forastes, who not only afforded them the means of travelling to Castro and Lemuy, but hid them on his own premises afterwards; and, when he heard that I was seeking for them among the islands, sent them across the gulf of Ancud, in a piragua, to remain in a cove near the Cor- covado until the search should be over. One of these men was not worth taking trouble about ; but the other was a man who had borne a high character, and had a wife and children in England depending upon him for support. I was satisfied that this man (Wells) had not deserted. until overcome by extraor- dinary temptation‘and the evil advice of his companion, and determined to do my utmost to recover him. He had pay due for several years’ service, and his ‘servitude time’* was consi- derable. I despatched Mr. Kirke overland to Castro for intelligence ; and set out in alight whale-boat, with five men, all as eager as I was myself to rescue their shipmate from the deceitful allure- ments of Padre Forastes. As a carpenter, also, every one was well aware, that his recovery was of much consequence to our small vessel, in a place where we could not obtain a substitute. * For the pension granted to seamen in the Royal Navy after twenty- one years’ servitude. 394 SCHOOLS—VAQUEANO. Aug. Sept. While visiting various islands I was much struck by the good order and cheerful alertness of several schools of boys, and by the apparent respectability of their teachers: and I was informed that these schools were much fostered by General Aldunate and his worthy secretary, Forelius (a Swede). Nothing could be more pleasing than the appearance of the islands ; all highly cultivated, and thickly peopled by a quiet race of men, apparently industrious, certainly most obliging and hospitable. At Lemuy I heard that the fugitives had just left Chelin and Quehuy, in a piragua belonging to one Antonio Vargas, and were gone to the Cordillera, somewhere near the Corcovado, to kill seals and collect oil for him and Padre Forastes, until we should leave Childe, when they would return and work for the priest. This information cost me an ounce of gold, given to Vargas’s own brother: and for six dollars, in advance, with a promise of more, I engaged a guide (vaqueano) to go with me to the main land. This man had no idea of moving by night ; but, understanding clearly that the piragua was gone to an inlet under the Corcovado Mountain, I sailed at once across the gulf, steering by the light of the volcano, much to the terror of our vaqueano, who shrunk down to the bottom of the boat, drew his poncho over his head, and kept muttering prayers, sometimes to the Virgin and his ‘ devoto’ (patron saint), sometimes to ‘ bruxos;’ but never ventured to look up at the large sail, or watch the boat reeling through the waves, as she sailed across with a fresh westerly wind. After a variety of petty difficulties and disappointments, and searching every inlet within twenty miles of the Corcovado, without finding a trace of the fugitives, I at last abandoned the pursuit and returned to San Carlos; having relanded our unhappy vaqueano, who, while close to the land, had been use- ful; but whom we had ruined, he often asserted, by obliging him to promise away all his property in masses, in offerings to saints, and in presents to ‘ bruxos’ for his safe deliverance from such continual peril. After hearing such a melancholy state- ment of his prospects, I added a present to his earnings, which 1829-1835. DESERTERS—METEORS. 395 he assured me would amply satisfy both ‘bruxos’ and ‘ de- votos,’ and left him, notwithstanding his temporary fears, a happy man. In 1834 I learned that we had actually been within a boat’s length of the deserters on one occasion, and that they had made up their minds to yield unconditionally. They were hidden in some thick bushes on the borders of an inlet* under the Cor- covado, and their piragua was hauled up behind a rock, out of immediate observation. It is now high time to quit Childe, and proceed along the coast northward : but before I do so, let me take advantage of this opportunity to express the gratitude of those with me, as well as of myself, for a succession of private assistance and sincere kindness experienced from many persons at San Carlos, whose names [| refrain from mentioning, because I have a great dislike even to the idea of publishing any thing that occurs in the unreserved intercourse of friends. * Palbitad, or Almangrande. Extraordinary meteoric appearances have occasionally been noticed about Childe, and the islands southward of it. In describing the Carel- mapu earthquake, of 1633, Agiieros says that torrents of rain followed ; and that on a high hill near the town was seen a globe of fire, which rose for a short interval, and then fell into the sea: the waters of which were in consequence much disturbed. A violent tempest ensued, with hail Jarger than musket-balls. Another remarkable earthquake happened thereabouts on the 23d—24th of December, 1737: and on the 30th, in the early part of the evening, a great exhalation or cloud of fire was seen passing, from north to south, over all the archipelago. It fell on the Huayteca islands, covered them with ashes, and burned up the vegetation to such a degree that it was only in 1750, that the islands began again to look green.—Agiieros, pp. 102, 104, 105. In Sarmiento’s voyage an appearance of a similar nature is mentioned, as having been seen near the Strait of Magalhaens: (Viage al Estrecho de Magallanes, p. 205).—Other authorities might be quoted. CHAPTER XVIII. Leave Childe — Valdivia — Earthquake — Aborigines — Traditions — Words—Convicts—Tolten — Boroa — Imperial—Mocha—Shocks of Earthquake—Anchor off Taleahuano— Ruins—Account of a great Earthquake which destroyed the city of Concepcion: and was felt from Childe to Copiapé6; from Juan Fernandes to Mendoza. Ar daylight on the 5th of February the Beagle sailed from Childe, and passed along the coast of southern Chile, towards the port of Valdivia. This is a bold and high tract of land, without a danger for shipping to avoid ; but, at the same time, without a safe anchorage between the ports above-mentioned. Soundings extend some miles into the offing, though the water is deep. At two miles westward of this shore we usually found about forty fathoms water; at three miles about sixty, and at five miles from seventy to eighty or ninety fathoms, with a soft, sandy, or muddy bottom. Whenever, as in this case, we were obliged to carry on the survey without landing, our observations for latitude—often those for time also—were made at the opposite points of the horizon, as well as in the usual manner, when land did not intervene, and the mean results taken as the most correct. In this way, it is probable that errors occasioned by refraction were in a considerable degree avoided.* The day before arriving at Valdivia we had a strong nor- therly wind, with cold, rainy weather, though the glasses were high. Such an anomaly I have elsewhere noticed, especially in Tierra del Fuego; but any attempt to explain it must be deferred. Another singularity was the temperature of the * We had three sextants, made for me by Worthington, which had additional horizon glasses, enabling them to measure any angle less than 160°. The contrivance was my own, and found to answer. It is des- cribed in the Appendix. Feb. 1835. VALDIVIA —FORTRESSES—RIVERS. 397 ocean, not being higher than that near the Chonos Archipelago, and very little warmer than that of Magalhaens Strait: this fact will also be recurred to again. Feb. 8th. We anchored in the deceiving port of Valdivia. I say deceiving, because it offers to the eye ample space and the utmost security, while, in fact, the safe anchorage is very li- mited ; so much mud and sand being brought down by the river that extensive banks are formed, and increase yearly. We were struck by the apparent strength of the fortresses, built origi- nally ‘by the Dutch in 1643, but improved and increased by the Spaniards. Now, however, their strength is but apparent ; for a closer inspection shows that they are almost in ruins and the guns out of order; indeed so nearly disabled, that they could hardly fire a salute without danger. Around the port are high hills, completely. covered with wood ; and they attract clouds so much, that almost as great a quantity of rain falls there as on the western shores of Childe. Several rivers empty themselves at this one mouth, which is the only opening among hills that form a barrier between the ocean and an extensive tract of champaign country,* reaching to the Cordillera of the Andes. The principal of these rivers are the Calla-callat and the Cruces; their tributaries are very numerous, few countries being better watered by running streams than that about Val- divia. Every facility and kindness in his power was offered to us by Don Isaac Thompson, the Yutendente :—and by his secretary, Don Francisco Solano Perez, I was presented with a rare edition of Febrés’s ‘ Arte de la Lengua Chilena,’ which has been of much use in explaining the meaning of aboriginal words and names. Don Francisco wished me to take another curious work, but I declined ; and have often regretted since that I did not ask him to let me copy a map in it which contained the tracks of Spanish missionaries from Castro in Childe to the lake of San Rafael, isthmus of Ofqui, and archipelago of islands in latitude * Called “Los Llanos,” or the plains. + On which is the town of Valdivia. 398 TOWN— ABORIGINAL NATIVES. Feb. 48-9° S. I thought another copy might be found at Lima, but during my subsequent stay there, not one could be discovered. The town of Valdivia, formerly dignified by the appellation of city, disappointed our party extremely. It proved to be no more than a straggling village of wooden houses, surrounded with apple-trees ; and the only building, even partially con- structed of stone, was a church.* Many of us were in the town on the 20th of February, at the time of that great earth- quake, which ruined so many places besides the city of Con- cepcion : an awful event, which will be related in the following pages. An English carpenter, who had served on board the Beagle, in 1828, but had since settled on the banks of the river Cruces, about thirty miles from Valdivia, came on board his old ship one day, to see those whom he knew. It happened that I had formerly been of some assistance to him, and he was naturally glad to oblige me, by giving such information about the coun- try and the natiyes as he was able to impart ; and having lived nearly four years among them, his accounts were not only in- teresting, but, I think, worthy of credence.+ As some of these were confirmed by what I heard from residents at Valdivia, and I have no doubt of their truth, I shall mention them with- out hesitation in the course of my narrative. I was much struck by the peculiar physiognomy of those aboriginal natives whom I saw during my stay : and there must — have been some ground for Mr. Darwin and myself remarking at different times, unknown at first to one another, that their countenances reminded us of portraits of CharlesI. ‘This was my impression at the first glance; but after closer examination it wore off, and I thought less of that likeness than I did of their resemblance to the Hindoo race. ‘There was neither aa iii rn the open honesty of a Patagonian, nor the brutal look of » most Fuegians; but there was a sombre cast of depressed * That church and other edifices have since been laid in ruins by the violent earthquake of Nov. 7, 1837. : + He was avery intelligent, observing man, and a good workman : while belonging to the Beagle, he was rated carpenter’s mate. + ~ 1835. FEA TURES—DRESS—FEELING. 399 intelligence that at once said, “* we are restrained, but not sub- dued.” Their countenances were less wide, and more swarthy, than those to which our eyes had been accustomed ; and they eyed us with a sinister although resolute glance, which seemed to ask whether we were also come to try for a share of their country. These men were of a middle stature; and formed more slightly than those of the south. They were all tolerably clothed in blue cloth of their own manufacture ; and the men of different tribes were distinguished by a slight difference in dress; the Juncos, who live south of Valdivia, wearing a sort of petticoat, instead of trowsers, while the Rancos, another subdivision, wore short loose breeches. In other respects they are similar, as to outward appearance, and their language is that of all southern Chile.* These Juncos and Rancos are but portions of that collection of tribes usually known among Eu- ropeans by the celebrated name of Araucanians ; but among the natives, bythe terms Molu-che, Huilli-che, &c. I certainly gazed at these Indians with excessive interest, while I reflected on the multiplied sufferings undergone by their ancestors—the num- bers that perished in mines—or in trying to defend their coun- try—and the insidious attempts made to thin their numbers by frequent intoxication, if not by introducing deadly disease. To keep these Indians on peaceable terms, and in order to have early intelligence of any general combination, the Chilians maintain among them ‘ capitanes de los amigos,’ whose apparent office is‘to take the part of an Indian, if he should be ill- treated by a Chilian (of Spanish descent), and to interpret between parties who wish to barter goods. There is also a € comisario de los Indios,’ who is a centre of reference for the ‘ capitanes,’ and who ought to be the friend and protector of the aborigines. Many tribes, however, will have nothing to say to either the commissary or his captains, seeing through their object, and detesting even the descendant of a Spaniard too deeply to admit any one of that abhorred race into their territory. About Valdivia there are only a few leagues of ground held by Chile, excepting which all that magnificent * The Huilli-che. + By giving them infected things. 400 TRADITIONS—DELUGE— CHEM. Feb. tract of country, reaching from the Gulf of Ancud nearly to the river Bio-Bio, probably the finest district in all South America, is still kept by the brave Araucanians. These Indians are extremely superstitious, but in their rites there are curious customs, perhaps indicative of their origin. About Valdivia, whenever an aboriginal and heathen native dies, he is buried in a small canoe, with a scanty supply of provisions and chicha,* on the bank of a river which flows to the sea. Their idea is that the spirit goes by water to that place, in the direction of the setting sun, whence their remote ancestors came. Febrés says, in his work before mentioned, that the island Mocha is the place meant: but if we reflect that Mocha is very small, only twenty miles from the main- land, and that when first discovered, early in the sixteenth century, it was inhabited by Indians who often crossed over to the continent, I think we must look much farther west for the place of departed souls to which these people refer. The aborigines who live near volcanoes offer propitiatory sacrifices to the evil spirit, Pillan, who is said to cause earth- quakes and eruptions. They sacrifice bulls and rams to him, besides offering fruit, vegetables, and chicha. On a mountain called Theghin, or Theg-theghin, (which means to crackle or sparkle like fire), these people say that their early progenitors escaped from the Deluge. There is aword in common use among them, meaning ‘the great ancestor,’ or ‘our great ancestors, or ‘ the renowned,’ which is hardly to be distinguished from Shem. Febrés spells it ‘ Them,’ but, as the th is frequently pro- nounced, .it would sound like chem.+ Can this be handed down from their ancestor of the Ark ?+ Another word that attracted my notice particularly, was ‘minga.’ I have a note by me (unfortunately without the proper reference) remarking the resemblance of minga, not * Fermented liquor made from maize, apples, or other substances. + Molina, Hist. Civilde Chile. Vol. ii. p. 333. Falkner says that the Vuta Huilliche substitute t for ch, p. 99. { Iam informed by Doctor Andrew Smith, that the word Ham is still common among the nations of southern Africa, as a distinguishing appellation, 1835. © MING A’—CONVICTS—TOLTEN. 401 only,in sound but in meaning, to the Hebrew word mincha. Molina (p. 333) says that these people have a nasal g, which brings the two words to an identity of sound. The Hebrew term, I am told, means an offering or collection of fruits, liquors, &c.; and the corresponding Huilli-che word means a a feast of which those partake who are about to unite in a work for the benefit of him who makes the ‘ minga.” In the Appendix a few Greek, Latin, and Araucanian words are arranged so as to show the remarkable similarity existing between them. I was told by the Yntendente that some Englishmen had arrived in his district a few months before we came, whose character and business he did not understand. Rumours had reached his ears of their having escaped from one of our convict settlements, at the other side of the Pacific, and he was inclined to believe the report. Three of these men had married since their arrival, and all but one were industrious members of his community : indeed I saw two of them hard at work on a boat belonging to the Yntendente. Having however no proof of their delinquency, I did not deem my- self authorized to ask him to have them arrested and deli- vered up to me, in order that I might convey them to the senior British officer at Valparaiso. Afterwards I learned that these men, seven or eight in number, had escaped from Van Diemen’s land in a very small vessel, and sailing always east- ward, had at last arrived on the coast near Valdivia, whence they were conducted by a fisherman into the port. Even- tually they were made prisoners by the Chilian auithorities, delivered up to our Commodore, and by him sent to England. I was informed that there is coal in many places about Val- divia; but I did not see any. We sailed on the 22d, after receiving, on all occasions, the kindest treatment from the residents. As we passed along the low coast about the river Tolten, numbers of Indians on horseback, and armed with lances, were seen riding along the shore, evidently watching our move- ments. ‘This part of the coast is shoal, and at night would VOL. II. 2D 402 BOROA INDIANS—MOCHA. Feb. be dangerous, for the low land projects considerably, and would not then be readily seen. We could not distinguish the mouths of either the Tolten or the Imperial (or Cauten) quite satisfactorily, but as they are bar rivers—useless to shipping—I would not risk anchoring on so exposed a coast, or sending a boat away into such a surf as we saw breaking, without having more time at my disposal and a higher object in view. On the Cauten was the city called Imperial—celebrated in Araucanian story—and near its site now live the Boroa tribe, some of whom have light-coloured eyes, fair complexions, and even red hair. I saw one of these Indians at Valdivia, who had blue eyes, but dark hair. She told me that in her own country, ‘ Boroa,’ there were many with eyes like her’s ; that some were ‘rubios,’ that is, of a red and white complexion, and that a few had red hair. Her parents.had told her, she said, that those people were descended from the ‘ Huincas.’* How the red hair originated is rather curious; I have heard of it from good authorities at other times, while in Chile. Late on the 24th we anchored at Mocha, and the follow- ing week was occupied in surveying its shores and the space between them and the mainland.+- Shocks of earthquakes were frequently felt, more or less severely ; sometimes I thought that the anchor had been accidentally let go, and the chain was run- ning out; and while at anchor, I often fancied the ship was driving, till I saw that there was neither swell, current, nor wind sufficient. to move her from the anchorage. We naturally con- cluded that some strange convulsion was working, and anxious for the fate of Concepcion, hastened to Talcahuano Bay as soon as our duty would allow: arriving there on the 4th of March—to our dismay—we saw ruins in every direction. The following account of this catastrophe was subsequently obtained :— At ten in the morning of the 20th of February, very large flights of sea-fowl were noticed, passing over the city of Con- * An Araucanian name for the Spaniards, signifying assassins. +1 shall recur to Mocha again, ; 1835. EARTHQUAKE AT CONCEPCION. 403 cepcion, from the sea-coast, towards the interior: and in the minds of old inhabitants, well acquainted with the climate of Concepcion, some surprise was excited by so unusual and simultaneous a change in the habits of those birds,* no signs of an approaching storm being visible, nor any expected at that season. About eleven, the southerly breeze} freshened up as usual—the sky was clear, and almost cloudless. At forty mi- nutes after eleven, a shock of an earthquake was felt, shghtly at first, but increasing rapidly. During the first half minute, many persons remained in their houses; but then the convul- sive movements were so strong, that the alarm became general, and they all rushed into open spaces for safety. ‘The horrid motion increased ; people could hardly stand ; buildings waved and tottered—suddenly an awful overpowering shock caused universal destruction—and in less than six seconds the city was inruins. ‘The stunning noise of falling houses; the horrible eracking of the earth, which opened and shut rapidly and repeatedly in numerous places ;§ the desperate heart-rending outcries of the people ; the stifling heat ; the blinding, smother- ing clouds of dust ; the utter helplessness and confusion ; and the extreme horror and alarm, can neither be described nor fully imagined. This fatal convulsion took place about a minute and a half or two minutes after the first shock; and it lasted for nearly two minutes, with equal violence. During this time no one could stand unsupported ; people clung to each other, to trees, or to posts. Some threw themselves on the ground ; but there the motion was so violent that they were obliged to stretch out their arms on each side, to prevent being tossed over and over. The poultry flew about screaming wildly. Horses and other animals were greatly frightened, standing with their legs spread out, and their heads down, trembling excessively. After the most violent shock ceased, the clouds of dust which * Chiefly gulls. + Sea-breeze. ¢ Mean time. Equation=14 m. subtractive from mean time. § The direction of these cracks was not uniform, though generally south-east and north-west. OB) th) Oy 404. DESTRUCTION OF THE CITY. Feb. had been raised by falling buildings, began to disperse ; people breathed more freely, and dared to look around them. Ghastly and sepulchral was the sight. Had the graves opened and given up their dead, their appearance could scarcely have been more shocking. Pale and trembling, covered with dust and perspiration, they ran from place to place, calling for relations and friends; and many seemed to be quite bereft of reason. Considerable shocks continued to harass and alarm at short intervals. The earth was never long quiet during that or the next day, nor indeed for the three days following the great shock; and during many hours after the ruin, it was tremulous, and the shocks were very frequent, though not severe. Many of these, but not all, were preceded by a rumbling, subterranean noise, like distant thunder. Some compared the sound to the distant discharge of many pieces of artillery. These noises came from the south-west quarter, and preceded the shock by one or two seconds; sometimes, but not often, the sound was unaccompanied by any shock. It was the general opinion that the motion was from south- west to north-east. Some whole walls, whose direction was south-east and north-west, were laid flat, the bricks still main- taining their relative position, though end-wise, without being scattered upon the ground. These walls fell, without excep- tion, to the north-east.* Others were scattered as they fell; but still the greatest masses of brick-work were thrown towards the north-east. Walls standing in the opposite direction, north- east and south-west, suffered far less: none fell bodily or in masses ; fragments were shaken or torn off; and some of the walls were very much cracked,+ but others suffered little. Houses built of ‘ adobes,’} became confused heaps, and roofs fell in every where. The cathedral, whose walls were four feet in thickness, supported by great buttresses, and built of good brick and mortar,§ suffered more than other buildings. Ad- * The streets of Concepcion lie north-east and south-west: north- west and south-east. + Vertically, as if by the undulatory movement of the earth’s surface in the direction of their length. } Large unbaked bricks, § Both bricks and mortar were excellent. a ee ae eel JO IMVNOHIAVS tvaHO JHL AB GAINING "NOIDAAVINOD LY IVAGINHLYD JIML JO SWNIYVWAYW 1835. SITUATION—ANECDOTES. 405 hering to the remains of the walls were left the lower parts of some buttresses—the upper parts of others—while in one place _ a buttress stood on its own foundation, separated entirely from the wall. The city of Concepcion stands upon a plain, very little higher than the level of the river Bio Bio. The soil is loose and allu- vial. To the eastward and northward lie rocky irregular hills: from the foot of which the loose earth was every where parted by the great convulsion, large cracks being left, from an inch to more than a foot in width. It seemed as if the low land had been separated from the hills, having been more disturbed by the shock. Women washing in the river near Concepcion were startled by the sudden rise of the water—from their ankles to their knees—and at the same moment felt the beginning of the con- vulsion. It was said that the dogs avoided the ruin, by run- ning away before it occurred. This, though known with certainty to have been the case at Talcahuano, wants con- firmation with respect to Concepcion. Of nine men who were repairing the inside of a church, seven were killed, and two severely hurt. One of these poor fellows was half-buried in the ruins, during five days, with a dead body lying across him, through which it was necessary to cut, for his release. A mother, escaping with her children, saw one fall into a hole; a wall close to her was tottering; she pushed a piece of wood across the hole, and ran on; the wall fell, covering the hole with masses of brick-work ; but, next day, the child was taken out un- hurt. Another woman missed a child ; saw that a high wall was tottering, but ran for her son, and brought him out. As she crossed the street, the wall fell, but they were safe; when the tremendous crash came, the whole street, which she had just crossed, was filled up with part of the ruins of the cathedral. Besides a waving or undulatory movement, vertical, horizontal, and circular or twisting motions were felt. An angular stone pinnacle was particularly noticed, which had been turned half round, without being thrown down, or leaving its base. Persons riding at the time of the great shock, were stopped 406 EFFECTS AT TALCAHUANO. Feb. short ; some, with their horses, were thrown to the ground: others dismounted, but could not stand. So little was the ground at rest after the great destruction, that between the 20th of February and the 4th of March, more than three hun- dred shocks were counted. Much misery was alleviated by the good conduct and extreme hospitality of the inhabitants of Concepcion. Mutual assistance was every where rendered, and theft was almost unknown. The higher classes immediately set people to work, to‘build straw- covered huts and temporary houses of board, living meanwhile in the open air under trees. Those who soonest obtained or contrived shelter, collected as many about them as they could assist, and in a very few days all had a temporary shelter, under which they tried to laugh at their misfortunes and the shifts to which they were reduced. At Talcahuano the great earthquake was felt as severely on the 20th February as in the city of Concepcion. It took place at the same time, and in a precisely similar manner: three houses only, upon a rocky foundation, escaped the fate of all those standing upon the loose sandy soil, which lies between the sea-beach and the hills. Nearly all the inhabitants escaped uninjured ; but they had scarcely recovered from the sensations of the ruinous shocks, when an alarm was given that the sea was retiring! Penco* was not forgotten; apprehensive of an overwhelming wave, they hurried to the hills as fast as possible. About half an hour after the shock, when the greater part of the population had reached the heights,—the sea having retired so much, that all the vessels at anchor, even those which had been lying in seven fathoms water, were aground, and every rock and shoal in the bay was visible,—an enormous wave was seen forcing its way through the western passage which separates Quiriquina Island from the mainland. This terrific swell passed rapidly along the western side of the Bay of Concepcion, sweeping the steep shores of every thing move- able within thirty feet (vertically) from high water-mark. It * Penco, the first Spanish capital of the province of Concepcion, was overwhelmed by the sea in 1730: and old Concepcion in 1751. 1835. EARTHQUAKE-WAVES—SHOCKS. 407 broke over, dashed along, and whirled about the shipping as if they had been light boats ; overflowed the greater part of the town, and then rushed back with such a torrent that every moveable which the earthquake had not buried under heaps of ruins was carried out to sea. In a few minutes, the vessels were again aground, and a second great wave was seen approaching, with more noise and impetuosity than the first ; but though this was more powerful, its effects were not so considerable—simply because there was less to destroy. Again the sea fell, dragging away quantities of woodwork and the lighter materials of houses, and leaving the shipping aground. After some minutes of awful suspense, a third enormous swell was seen between Quiriquina and the mainland, apparently larger than either of the two former. Roaring as it dashed against every obstacle with irresistible force, it rushed—destroy- ing and overwhelming—along the shore. Quickly retiring, as if spurned by the foot of the hills, the retreating wave dragged away such quantities of household effects, fences, furniture, and. other moveables, that after the tumultuous rush was over, the sea appeared to be covered with wreck. Earth and water trembled: and exhaustion appeared to follow these mighty efforts. Numbers of the inhabitants then hastened to the ruins, anxious to ascertain the extent of their losses, and to save some money, or a few valuable articles, which, having escaped the sweep of the sea, were exposed to depredators.* During the remainder of the day, and the following night, the earth was not quiet many minutes at a time. Frequent, almost incessant tremors, occasional shocks more or less severe, and distant subterranean noises, kept every one in anx- ious suspense. Some thought the crisis had not arrived, and would not descend from the hills into the ruined town. Those who were searching among the ruins, started at every shock, however slight, and almost doubted that the sea was not actu- * Thieves were numerous in Talcahuano. Directly after the ruin these scoundrels set to work—though crying ‘Misericordia,’ and with one hand beating their breast—with the other they stole most industriously. 408 EFFECTS UPON THE SHIPPING. Feb. ally rushing in again to overwhelm them. Nearly all the inha- bitants, excepting a few who went on board vessels in the har- bour, passed the night upon the hills, without shelter: and next day they began to raise sheds and huts upon the high grounds, still dreading the sea. It was said, and generally considered certain, that every dog at Talcahuano had left the town before the shock, which ruined the buildings, was felt. Without explanation it appears astonishing how the ship- ping escaped destruction. There were three large whale-ships, a bark, two brigs, and a schooner, very near the town, in from four to seven fathoms water: they were lying at single anchor,* with a good scope of cable :-- one only was well moored. With the southerly breeze, which was rather fresh at the time of the earthquake, these vessels lay to seaward} of their anchors, having their sterns towards the sea; and were left aground in this position. The captain of the port, D. Pablo Delano, was on board one of the whale ships at the time, with the hatches battened down, and dead lights shipped. All hands took to the rigging for safety. he first great wave came in an unbroken swell to the stern of the vessel, broke over and lifted her along without doing any material harm, more than sweeping her decks: and the slack chain dragging over the mud checked her gradually, as the first impetus of the wave diminished. Whirling her round, the water rushed out to seaward again, leaving the vessel stranded nearly in her former position. From two fathoms, when aground, the depth alongside increased to ten, as the water rose highest during the last swell. The two latter waves approached, and affected the shipping similarly to the former: all withstood their force, though the light anchors were dragged. Some of the vessels were thrown violently against others ; and whirled around as if they had been in the vortex of a whirlpool. Previous to the rush of waters, the Paulina and Orion, two merchantmen, were * Or steadied by asecond anchor which was too light to withstand any great strain. + Chain.—T he holding-ground is excellent, a soft, tenacious mud. { Nearly half acable’s length; or from sixty to one hundred yards. 1835. ANECDOTES—MOTION OF SEA. 409 lying a full cable’s length apart ; and after it had passed they were side by side, with three round turns in their cables. Each vessel had therefore gone round the other with each wave: the bow of one was stove in: to the other little damage was done. A small vessel* was on the stocks, almost ready for launching; she was carried by the sea two hundred yards in-shore, and left there unhurt.